COLUMBIA 400 LC-41-550FG Garmin 1000

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 322
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document provides information about operating a Columbia 400 aircraft, including normal revisions to the manual and optional supplemental equipment.

The log of normal revisions records changes made to the manual through regular revisions over time.

Each supplement contains the same first five sections as the primary manual and has its own table of contents and page numbers to make it self-contained.

PILOT'S OPERATING HANDBOOK AND FAA APPROVED AIRPLANE FLIGHT MANUAL

(Document No. RC050005 Revision G)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Garmin Integrated Flight Display


Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation 22550 Nelson Road Bend Municipal Airport Bend, Oregon 97701 Phone: (541) 318-1144 Fax: (541) 318-1177

Serial Number: _______________ Registration Number: _______________ Type Certificate No. A00003SE
THIS HANDBOOK INCLUDES THE MATERIAL REQUIRED TO BE FURNISHED TO THE PILOT BY THE FEDERAL AVIATION REGULATIONS AND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION PROVIDED BY THE MANUFACTURER, AND CONSTITUTES THE FAA APPROVED AIRPLANE FLIGHT MANUAL.

This Handbook meets GAMA Specification No. 1, Specification for Pilot's Operating Handbook, issued February 15, 1975 and revised September 1, 1984.
Approved by the Federal Aviation Administration By: E. P. Kolano (Name) Date: 31 Mar 06 Title: Manager. Seattle Area Certification Office Initial Issue: _09 Dec 05__ Revised: 16 Oct 07

Log of Normal Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

PILOT OPERATING HANDBOOK LOG OF NORMAL REVISIONS


Normal Revision No. -Revised Pages Description of Revision or Referenced Narrative Discussion Pages Initial Revision Approved By Date --

-Title Page, iii, vii to xvi, 2-6, 2-11 to 2-14, 2-18, 219, 3-6 to 3-11, 3-21, 322, 3-28, 4-6, 4-13 to 417, 4-23, 4-30 to 4-37, 51, 5-7, 5-12 to 5-38, 6-A1 to 6-A8, 6-B1 to 6-B6, 71 to 7-5, 7-9 to 7-14, 717, 7-18, 7-23 to 7-72, 811, 8-12 Title Page, iii, vii to xvi, 1-9 to 1-11, 2-4, 2-6, 2-10 to 2-14, 3-16, 3-31, 3-34, 4-2, 4-3, 4-9 to 4-11, 4-13 to 4-18, 4-26 to 4-38, 5-1 to 5-40, 7-23 to 7-29, 735, 7-42, 7-44, 7-45, 748, 7-49, and 7-56 All Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xix, xx, 1-1, 1-20, 2-9, 211, 3-9, 4-29, 5-1, 5-43, 5-44, 6A-3 to 6A-18, 6B1 to 6B-10, 7-1, 7-2, 7-4, 7-7 to 7-9, 7-14, 7-15, 729, 7-54 to 7-56, Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xx to xxii, 2-1, 2-17, 3-1, 3-2, 3-12, 3-13, 3-24, 326 to 3-28, 4-1, 4-2, 4-5 to 4-15, 4-17 to 4-32, 6A-3 to 6A-18, 6B-1 to 6B-10, 7-1 to 7-4, 7-7 to 7-72 Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xxi, xxii, 1-4, 1-5, 2-1, 25, 2-8 to 2-12, 2-15, 2-18, 4-1, 4-2, 4-6, 4-7, 4-9 to 4-15, 4-17 to 4-34, 5-19 to 5-32, 5-34, 5-35, 6-13, 7-2 to 7-4, 7-21, 7-27, 731 to 7-34, 7-37, 7-45 to 7-47, 8-4, 8-5

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

--

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

E. P. Kolano 03-31-06

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

Shaun Ripple 21 Nov 2006

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

E.P. Kolano 02-08-07

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

E.P. Kolano 05-31-07

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

Jeffrey A. Morfitt 09-24-07

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 iii

Log of Normal Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Normal Revision No. Revised Pages Title Page, iv, vii to xxiv, 2-1, 2-10 to 2-24, 3-19, 326, 5-3, 6-1, 6-2, 6-13, 6A-3 to 6A-18, 6B-1 to 6B-10, 7-2 to 7-4, 7-21 to 7-26, 7-32 to 7-34, 7-48, 7-59, 7-61, 7-67 to 7-69, 8-4 Description of Revision or Referenced Narrative Discussion Pages Approved By Date

See Narrative Discussion of Revisions

Jeffrey A. Morfitt ANM-1005 11-09-07

RC050005 iv

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Log of Temporary Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

PILOT OPERATING HANDBOOK LOG OF TEMPORARY REVISIONS


Temporary Revision No. and Date Revised Pages Description of Revision or Referenced Narrative Discussion Pages Approved By Date

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 v

Log of Temporary Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 vi

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

List of Effective Pages Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page Rev Added Pages Page Rev LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 1-10 1-11 1-12 1-13 1-14 1-15 1-16 1-17 1-18 1-19 1-20 Rev C C C C C C C C C C D SECTION 2 (Limitations) 2-1 2-2 2-3 2-4 2-5 2-6 2-7 2-8 2-9 2-10 2-11 2-12 2-13 2-14 2-15 2-16 2-17 2-18 2-19 2-20 2-21 G C C C F C C F F G G G G G G G G G G G G 2-23 2-24 G G Added Pages Page Rev

INTRODUCTION PAGES Title ii iii iv v vi vii viii ix x xi xii xiii xiv xv xvi xvii xviii xix xx xxi xxii G C F G C C G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G SECTION 1 (General) 1-1 1-2 1-3 1-4 1-5 1-6 1-7 1-8 1-9 D C C F F C C C C xxiii xxiv G G

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 vii

List of Effective Pages Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 2-22 Rev G SECTION 3 (Emergency Procedures) 3-1 3-2 3-3 3-4 3-5 3-6 3-7 3-8 3-9 3-10 3-11 3-12 3-13 3-14 3-15 3-16 3-17 3-18 3-19 3-20 3-21 3-22 3-23 3-24 3-25 3-26 3-27 3-28 E E C C C C C C D C C E E C C C C C G C C C C E C G E E Added Pages Page Rev LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 4-3 4-4 4-5 4-6 4-7 4-8 4-9 4-10 4-11 4-12 4-13 4-14 4-15 4-16 4-17 4-18 4-19 4-20 4-21 4-22 4-23 4-24 4-25 4-26 4-27 4-28 4-29 4-30 4-31 4-32 4-33 4-34 Rev C C E F F E F F F F F F F C F F F F F F F F F F F F F F F F F F Added Pages Page Rev

SECTION 4 (Normal Procedures) 4-1 4-2 RC050005 viii F F

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

List of Effective Pages Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page Rev Added Pages Page Rev LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 5-34 5-35 5-36 5-37 5-38 5-39 5-40 5-41 5-42 5-43 5-44 Rev F F C C C C C C C D D Added Pages Page Rev

SECTION 5 (Performance) 5-1 5-2 5-3 5-4 5-5 5-6 5-7 5-8 5-9 5-10 5-11 5-12 5-13 5-14 5-15 5-16 5-17 5-18 5-19 5-20 5-21 5-22 5-23 5-24 5-25 5-26 5-27 5-28 5-29 5-30 5-31 5-32 5-33 D C G C C C C C C C C C C C C C C C F F F F F F F F F F F F F F C

SECTION 6 (Weight & Balance) 6-1 6-2 6-3 6-4 6-5 6-6 6-7 6-8 6-9 6-10 6-11 6-12 6-13 6-14 6-15 6-16 6-17 6-18 6-19 6-20 G G C C C C C C C C C C G C C C C C C C

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 ix

List of Effective Pages Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page Rev Added Pages Page Rev LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page Rev Added Pages Page Rev

Weight & Balance (Appendix A) Type of Equipment for Operation List 6A-1 6A-2 6A-3 6A-4 6A-5 6A-6 6A-7 6A-8 6A-9 6A-10 6A-11 6A-12 6A-13 6A-14 6A-15 6A-16 6A-17 6A-18 C C G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G 7-1 7-2 7-3 7-4 7-5 7-6 7-7 7-8 7-9

SECTION 7 (Description of Airplane & Systems) E G G G C C E E E E E E E E E E E E E E G G G G G G F E E E F

7-10 7-11 7-12 7-13 7-14 7-15 7-16 7-17 7-18 7-19 7-20 7-21 7-22 7-23 7-24 7-25 7-26 7-27 7-28 7-29 7-30 7-31

Weight & Balance (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List 6B-1 6B-2 6B-3 6B-4 6B-5 6B-6 6B-7 6B-8 6B-9 6B-10 G G G G G G G G G G

RC050005 x

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

List of Effective Pages Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 7-32 7-33 7-34 7-35 7-36 7-37 7-38 7-39 7-40 7-41 7-42 7-43 7-44 7-45 7-46 7-47 7-48 7-49 7-50 7-51 7-52 7-53 7-54 7-55 7-56 7-57 7-58 7-59 7-60 7-61 7-62 7-63 7-64 7-65 Rev G G G E E F E E E E E E E F F F G E E E E E E E E E E G E G E E E E 9-1 9-2 8-1 8-2 8-3 8-4 8-5 8-6 8-7 8-8 8-9 8-10 8-11 8-12 8-13 8-14 8-15 8-16 8-17 8-18 8-19 8-20 8-21 8-22 Added Pages Page Rev LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Reissue Page 7-66 7-67 7-68 7-69 7-70 7-71 7-72 Rev E G G G E E E SECTION 8 (Handling, Servicing & Maintenance) C C C G F C C C C C C C C C C C C C C C C C Added Pages Page Rev

SECTION 9 (Supplements) C C

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xi

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 xii

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level A A A 2-11 through 2-14 A A A 2-18 and 219 3-2 Page No. All Title Page, iii, vii through xvi 2-6 Comment Initial revision. Revised to indicate Revision A. Revised LOEP. Revised Narrative Discussion of Revisions. Revised Figure 2-3. Added approach operation limitation at propeller RPM of approx. 1800. Added VOR and VAPP mode limitation to the Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System Limitations section. Repaginated pages. Revised compass placard. Added panel light dimmer placard. Repaginated pages. Revised Table of Contents. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Engine Failure During Climb to Cruise Altitude, Engine Failure During Flight Below 15,000 Ft., Loss of Fuel Pressure or Flow, Engine Failure With Fuel Annunciation Illuminated below 15,000 Ft., and Engine Failure With Fuel Annunciation Illuminated above 15,000 Ft. checklists. Changed boost to fuel, changed too rich to to full rich in 3.2, and changed to rich to to full rich and boost to fuel in the Warning, in the Procedures After an Engine Restart checklist. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Emergency Landing Without Engine Power, Emergency Landing With Throttle Stuck at Idle Power, Engine Driven Fuel Pump (EDFP) Partial Failure, and Engine Fire on the Ground During Startup checklists. Changed EIS to System in the In-flight Cabin Fire checklist. Changed engine to System in the Oxygen System Malfunction and Carbon Monoxide Detection checklists. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Emergency Backup Boost Pump title and section. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Critical Issues (Backup Boost Pump) title and section. Changed engine page to System page in the Electrical Problems section. Changed engine driven boost pump to engine driven fuel pump in the Failure of Engine Driven Fuel Pump section. Revised Table of Contents. Revised Item 16 in the Area 1 Preflight Inspection checklist. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Before Takeoff, Short Field Takeoff, Normal Climb, Maximum Performance Climb, Cruise, Descent, Before Landing, Short Field Landing, and Balked Landing checklists. Change EIS to System in the Engine Starting section. Changed auxiliary boost pumps are off to auxiliary fuel pump is off in the Over Priming section.

3-6 through 3-12

A A

3-17 3-21 and 322

A 3-28 A A A 4-13 through 4-17 A 4-22 and 423 4-3 4-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xiii

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level A Page No. Comment Added paragraph directing fuel pump switch be off for descent and landing in the Descent section. Changed boost to fuel in the Balked Landings section. Added discussion of flat triangular leading edge tape on the wings and zig zag tape on bottom of horizontal tail section to the Stalls section. Revised the last sentence of the first paragraph in the Cold Weather Operations section. Changed boost pumps to fuel pump in the third paragraph of the Hot Weather Operations section. Revised Table of Contents. Revised Figure 5-8 to indicate speeds with flat triangular leading edge tape on the wings. Added Figure 5-13 for maximum rate of climb with flat triangular leading edge tape on the wings. Renumbered following figures, revised cross references and repaginated pages. Deleted Items 21-23 and 21-24. Deleted model #s and size from Items 34-35, 34-36, and 34-37. Deleted Items 21-23 and 21-24. Deleted model #sand size from Items 34-35, 34-36, and 34-37. Revised Table of Contents Moved Aileron Servo Tab section if front of Elevator section. Changed convenience to inconvenience in the Control Lock section. Changed Engine Indication System (EIS) page to various pages in the Elevator and Aileron section. Revised the Hat Switches section. Revised Trim Position Indicator section. Deleted the last sentence from the Autopilot/Trim Master Switch (A/P Trim) section. Changed flaps does to flaps switch does in the 6th sentence of the 2nd paragraph of the Wing Flaps section. Revised Figure 7-3. Revised Figure 7-4. Changed on the left side to at the front in the Front Seat Adjustment section. Revised 2nd paragraph of the Baggage Door section. Changed clockwise to inboard, and deleted 90 counterclockwise or in the Parking Brake section. Added Baro-correction Warning note and AHRS Warning note to the Garmin G1000 Integrated Cockpit System section. Added MFD Map Scale, MFD Holding Pattern Depiction, and VOR Frequency Display in the MFD section. Added GCU 476 Remote Keypad. Added Figure 7-6 and renumbered following figures. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Backup Boost Pump and Vapor Suppression section title. Changed Boost to Fuel in the Primer section. Added tables to the Aircraft Alerts, Caution Alerts, Annunciation Advisory, and Message Advisory Alerts sections. Added AFCS

4-30 through 4-37

A A A

5-1 5-7 5-12 to 5-38

A A A A

6-A1 through 6A8 6-B1 through 6-B6 7-1 through 7-5

7-9 through 7-14

A A

7-17 and 718

7-23 through 7-72

RC050005 xiv

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level Page No. Comment Alerts, TAWS Alerts, and TAWS System Status Annunciations and Other Annunciations sections. Revised the Backup Attitude Indicator section. Revised description of the Kollsman Window in the Backup Altimeter section. Changed MFD EIS page to MFD in the 2nd paragraph, and to MFD System page in the 3rd paragraph of the Fuel Quantity Indication section. Revised Figure 7-14 and renumbered it to Figure 7-15. Changed MFD EIS page to MFD System page in the Fuel Selector section. Revised location of the backup pump and vapor suppression switches in the Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression section. Deleted single speed from the Airflow paragraph of the Environmental Control System section. Revised location of the avionics master switch in the Avionics Master Switch paragraph of the Electrical System section. Revised switch operation in the Overhead Reading Lights and Instrument Flood Bar sections. Revised Lower Instruments, Circuit Breaker and Master Switches Panels section. Revised the Flaps Panel and 5 Pack Switches (Press-to-Test PTT) section and renamed it to Press-to-Test PTT Button. Revised the Control Stick Switches and Headset Plug Positions section. Revised the Autopilot Disconnect/Trim Interrupt Switch section. Revised the description of condition required for ELT activation, and the location of the ELT switch in the Emergency Locator Transmitter section. Added Preflight Testing and changed EIS page to System page in the Precise Flight Fixed Oxygen System section. Changed EIS to System and revised description of Test/Reset button in the CO Guardian Carbon Monoxide Detector section. Added Reference to Garmin Cockpit Reference Guide for operating instructions in the XM Weather (WX) Data System section. Revised the Ryan Model 9900BX TCAD section. Added titles to Figure 7-24 and 7-25 and renumbered to 7-25 and 7-26. Deleted the Acknowledge/Traffic Button section. Changed maximum performance to maximum ACCS performance in the 5th General Hint for ACCS Operation. Added Warnings about use of GPS autopilot mode in the terminal area and G1000 inability to command the autopilot to fly procedure turns or holding patterns automatically, revised CWS (Control Wheel Steering) Button paragraph, and added additional information to the GA (Go Around) Button paragraphs in the Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System section. Repaginated pages and revised cross references. Added pages 7-67 through 7-72. A 8-11 and 812 Revised Figure 8-4. Repaginated pages.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xv

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Page Comment No. Title Page, Revised to indicate Revision B. iii, vii Revised LOEP. through xvi Revised Narrative Discussion of Revisions. Revised Limit Load to Limit Load Factor, Ultimate Load to 1-9 to Ultimate Load Factor and revised those definitions. Repaginated 1-11 pages. 2-1 2-4 2-6 Revised Table of Contents. Revised Figure 2-2. Revised Figure 2-3. Revised software version table in No. 1, Changed G10000 to G1000 in No. 4, changed , flight director or manual electric trim to or flight director and added PFT annunciation description in No. 6, and changed autopilot maximum and minimum engagement speeds from TBD to 210 and 80 (respectively) in No. 10 of the Garmin G1000 System Limitations section. Added explanation of automatic switching caution to no. 2 and removed paragraph no. 3 of the Approach Operation Limitations in the Garmin G1000 System Limitations section. Changed 14 CFR Part 121 or Part 135 to 14 CFR Part 135 in paragraph 2 in the GTX Mode S Transponder Limitations section. Revised the Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System Limitations section. Changed PA to (Pressure Altitude), added oxygen system operation verification Warning, and expanded the lipstick/chapstick Warning in the Oxygen Limitations section. Expanded Leading Edge Devices paragraph under the Other Limitations section. Repaginated pages. Revised Items Unavailable with a Bus Failure table. Revised Figure 3-5. Changed Note regarding failures in breathing stations, cannulas, masks and flow meters to a Warning. Revised Table of Contents. Revised the Before Starting Engine, Starting Cold Engine, Starting Hot Engine, After Engine Start, and Crosstie Operation checklists. Revised the Warning in the Autopilot Autotrim Operations checklist. Added Warning to verify oxygen system operation to the Before Takeoff checklist. Revised the Normal Takeoff checklist. Repaginated pages. Added Oxygen System paragraph to the Before Takeoff section. Added paragraph on ILS approaches to the Approach section. Added Oxygen System paragraph to the Landings section. Added The maximum demonstrated crosswind component for takeoff is 23 knots. to the Crosswind Takeoff paragraph under the Takeoffs section. Added maximum demonstrated crosswind component for landing is 23 knots to the Crosswind Landings paragraph under the Landings section. Repaginated pages Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Revision Level B B B B B B

2-10 to 2-14

B B B B B

3-16 3-31 3-34 4-2 and 4-3

4-9 to 4-18

4-26 to 4-38

RC050005 xvi

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level B Page No. Comment Revised Table of Contents. Revised Figure 5-11. Changed section title Takeoff Speed Schedule to Short Field Takeoff Speed Schedule and revised section. Changed title of Figure 5-12 to Maximum rate of Climb Without Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape On The Wings. Replaced Figure 5-14. Added Figure 5-15. Renumbered following figures and revised cross references. Added statement that cruise performance is not affected by the flat triangular leading edge tape. Added pages 5-29 and 5-30. Changed first Warning to Note in the Garmin G1000 Integrated Cockpit System section. Revised the Alerts Window paragraph under the Annunciation and Alerts section. Changed all occurrences of Columbia 350/400 to Columbia 400. Replaced Figure 7-14. Deleted rudder hold from the Left Bus paragraph. Revised Figure 7-17 and Figure 7-18. Added Note to the Stall Warning System section that audio entertainment is inhibited automatically when the stall horn is active. Expanded the lipstick/chapstick Warning in the Breathing Devices (Masks and Cannulas) paragraph under the Precise Flight Fixed Oxygen System section. Reformatted entire manual to 5.5 x 8.5. Page numbers indicated for Revision Level C were made prior to reformatting of the manual; refer to Rev. B manual to compare changes. Revised Title Page to indicate Revision C. Revised LOEP. Revised Narrative Discussion of Revisions. Revised Figure 2-3. Revised the Maximum Empty Weight from 2748 lbs. to 2708 lbs. Revised compass placard. Revised Table of Contents. Revised Emergency Procedure checklists to delete excess or redundant information, and standardize terminology. Changed Engine Failure During Flight Above 15,000 FT. to Engine Failure During Flight under the High Altitude Negative G Loading section. Changed Emergency Landing Without Engine Power to Forced Landing (Engine Out or Partial Power) in the Engine Does Not Restart, High Oil Temperature and Low Oil Pressure sections. Revised the 3rd and 4th paragraphs under the Emergency Backup Fuel Pump section. Changed cross reference to page 3-4, Engine Failure During Flight in the Failure of Turbocharger section. Revised the Under Voltage section. Revised the last sentence in the Master Switches section. Revised the Circuit Breaker Panel section. Revised the location of the static air RC050005 xvii

5-1 to 5-40

B 7-23 to 7-29

B B B B B

7-35 7-42 7-44 and 745 7-48 and 749 7-56

C All C C C C C C Title Page, iii, vii through xx 2-6 2-7 2-18 3-1 to 3-3

3-6 to 3-34

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level Page No. Comment source switch under the Static Air Source Blockage section. Revised the bullet list in the first paragraph of the Oxygen System section. Repaginated pages. Deleted pages 3-35 and 3-36. C C 4-1 to 4-3 Revised Table of Contents. Revised Normal Procedures checklists to delete excess or redundant information, and standardize terminology. Revised the Over Priming paragraph under the Engine Starting Section. Revised the Battery Recharging section. Changed there may be no point to there is no point in the Crosstie Operations Checklist section. Revised the 3rd paragraph under the Engine Runup section. Changed is less than 35.5 to is at or below 35.5 in the Takeoffs section. Revised the Mixture Settings paragraph under the Cruise section. Revised the Crosswind Landings section. Changed 106 to 95 in the Balked Landings section. Changed 1650 to 1625 in the Control by Turbine Inlet Temperature (TIT) section. Referenced Figure 5-11 in the Short Field Takeoff Section. Deleted the 2nd to last sentence of the first paragraph of the Power Settings paragraph and changed rocker switch to switch in the vapor Suppression paragraph under the Normal and Maximum Performance Climbs section.. Revised the first sentence in the Descent section. Revised the 3rd paragraph under the Hot Weather Operations section. Revised location of the blue dots in the Fuel Selector section. Deleted the 2nd paragraph under the Engine Starting section. Revised the first paragraph of the Glideslope Flight Procedure with Autopilot section. Repaginated pages. Changed landing performance chart to takeoff performance chart in Figure 5-10. Revised Figure 5-14 and Figure 5-15. Revised the Lean of Peak Engine Operation section. Revised Table of Contents. Added Caution and example regarding specific weight of Aviation Gasoline. Revised Figure 6-3. Deleted indication of an optional restraint system from the Baggage Nets section. Revised the Maximum Empty Weight section. Revised Figure 6-20. Repaginated pages and added pages 6-19 and 6-20. Changed five through eight to four through seven in the Flight Operation Requirements on the first page. Added optional Oregon Aero seats, Artex ELT ME406, electrically driven compressor, interlock assembly, and accessories alternator. Indicated IFR for Items 34-10 and 34-17. Added optional Oregon Aero seats, Artex ELT ME406, electrically driven compressor, interlock assembly, and accessories alternator. Revised POH/AFM weight. Revised GTX 33 weight. Revised Table of Contents. Revised the description of the wing cuffs in the Wings and Fuel Tanks section.

4-6 to 4-38

C C C C C

5-10 5-14 and 515 5-31 6-1

6-4 to 6-20 C 6A-1 to 6A-8 C 6B-1 to 6B-6 C C 7-1, 7-3 to 76 7-8

RC050005 xviii

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level C C 7-15 and 719 C 7-21 C 7-30 to 7-33 C 7-39 C 7-46 to 7-49 C Page No. 7-13 Comment Changed dimmer thumb-wheel to dimmer in the Wing Flaps section. Added Warning to the Door section. DO NOT open door during flight. Changed Door Open to DOOR OPEN in the Latching Mechanism and Door Seal System sections. Changed manifold gauge to manifold pressure indicator in the Throttle paragraph under the Engine Controls section. Changed pilots left knee to pilots right knee and fuel manifold to intake manifold in the Induction section. Changed or pressure is above 18 psi to or a pressure differential greater than 18 psi is detected in the Engine Oil section. Revised the description of the OXYGEN PRES message. Revised the description of the LOW MAN PRES message. Replaced chart under the AFCS Alerts section, TAWS Alerts section, and TAWS System Status Annunciations section. Changed L-LOW FUEL to L LOW FUEL in the Fuel Low Annunciation Messages section. Revised the first paragraph of the Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression section. Revised the Upper Instruments, and the Lower Instruments, Circuit Breaker, and Master Switches Panels sections. Deleted the first sentence of the second paragraph of the Press-to-Test PTT Button section. Revised the first sentence of the airplane Exterior Lighting System section. Revised Figure 7-19. Repaginated pages. Revised the Emergency Locator Transmitter (ELT) section to include the Artex ME406 ELT. Revised the last paragraph in the Oxygen Display section. Changed test/reset softkey to reset softkey and two occurrences of 50 to 75 in the CO Guardian Carbon Monoxide Detector section. Indicated the location of the XM antenna in the XM Weather (WX) Data System section. Indicated engine driven or electrically driven compressor. Added a Note to delay after turning off the system before turning it back on again in the System Operation paragraph of the Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS) section. Added section System Operation Using Ground Power describing use of ACCS to pre-cool cabin of the aircraft. This is possible only by ACCS equipped with electric compressor powered by ground power. Added GTA 82 Trim Adapter to the list of LRU in the GRC 700 AFCS. Changed GA to GO AROUND in the Additional AFCS Controls section. Repaginated pages. Added pages 73 to 76 Revised Figure 8-3. Revised the Oxygen System Servicing section. Revised administrative pages. Revised Table of Contents. Added atmospheric pressure relationships Figure 1-17. Revised paragraph 3.b. under the Garmin G1000 System Limitations section. Added A5 Flowmeters to the Oxygen Limitations section. Revised step 5 in the Spin Recovery procedure.

7-52 to 7-76

C D D D D D D

8-8 and 8-9 Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xiii to xx 1-1 1-20 2-9 2-11 3-9

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xix

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level D D D D D D D 7-7 to 7-9 D D D 7-54 to 7-56 E E E E E E E E E 4-5 to 4-15 E 4-19 to 4-32 E 6-A3 to 6A18 Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xx to xxii 2-1 2-17 3-1 and 3-2 3-12 and 313 3-24 3-26 to 3-28 4-1 and 4-2 7-14 and 715 7-29 Page No. 4-29 5-1 5-43 and 544 6A-3 to 6A18 6B-1 to 6B10 7-1, 7-2 and 7-4 Comment Changed as soon as possible to after the spin rotation has stopped in the 4th paragraph and in the Warning note of the Spins section. Revised Table of Contents. Added Figure 5-38 for A5 Flowmeter and revised Figure 5-37. Revised cross references. Added Item 52-01 Remote Keyless Entry System to the Equipment for Types of Operation List. Revised Item 34-36. Changed shaded blocks to check marks. Added Item 52-01 Remote Keyless Entry System to the Installed Equipment List. Revised Table of Contents. Added description of rudder pedal connector on some aircraft allowing two rudder pedal positions to the end of the Rudder paragraph. Added paragraph for description of the remote keyless entry system. Revised Elevator Mistrim Up and Down, and Aileron Mistrim Left and Right in the AFCS Alerts table. Added A5 Flowmeters under the Oxygen Flow Controls section. Added use of soap and water solution to get rid of static charge in the A5 Flowmeter. Revised administrative pages. Revised Table of Contents Indicated (when air conditioning is installed) for the Air Conditioning System Bay Access Cover placard. Revised Table of Contents. Added Malfunction of Rudder Hold System emergency procedure. Changed 75 to 50 in the Carbon Monoxide Detection procedure Note. Revised Figure 3-5. Added Rudder Hold System to page 3-26. Repaginated following pages. Revised Table of Contents. Added item 16 Induction Heated Air to Area 1 of the Preflight Inspection procedure. Added item 7 Rudder Hold to the After Engine Start procedure. Added Rudder Hold System Operations normal procedure to page 10. Repaginated pages. Added description of the battery charging circuit to page 4-19. Added Rudder Hold to page 4-32. Repaginated following pages. Revised cross references. Revised 24-04 and added 24-05 to 24-07 Battery, 28 Volt. Added 27-05 Rudder Hold Assembly and 33-08 to 33-11 Precise Flight Landing and Taxi Lights.

RC050005 xx

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level E E E Page No. 6-B1 to 6B10 7-1 to 7-4 Comment Revised 24-04 and added 24-05 to 24-07 Battery, 28 Volt. Added 27-05 Rudder Hold Assembly and 33-08 to 33-11 Precise Flight Landing and Taxi Lights. Revised Table of Contents. Added Rudder Hold System description. Deleted The Control Lock section. Added RUDR HOLD annunciation to the Annunciation Advisory section on page 7-29. Added Battery Charging Circuit description to page 7-41. Revised Figure 7-17. Revised two occurrences of 75 to 50 in the CO Guardian Carbon Monoxide Detector section on pages 7-58 and 7-59. Added interlock assembly and pre-cooling using ground power to the general description of the Automatic Climate Control System section. Repaginated pages and added pages 7-71 and 7-72. Revised administrative pages. Revised Total Fuel Capacity section. Repaginated pages. Revised the Table of Contents. Revised the Fuel Quantity row in Figure 2-3. Revised Total Fuel Capacity section. Added Item 12. Flight Plan WARNING note to page 2-10. Added SafeTaxi limitations to page 2-10. Revised Figure 2-7. Repaginated pages. Revised the Engraved On Fuel Selector Knob and Upper Plate placard. Revised the Near Fill Cap of Fuel Tank placard. Revised the Table of Contents. Added , bushing in place to Item 2 under Area 5 of the Preflight Inspection checklist. Deleted Item 3 of the Before Starting Engine checklist and renumbered the following items. Added Item 1 and Item 14 regarding Air Conditioning to the Crosstie Operation checklist. Deleted the Rudder Hold System Operations checklist and distributed the procedures to the Before Takeoff (Runup), Normal Climb, Maximum Performance Climb, Cruise, and Before Landing checklists. Changed 65% to 75% in Item 3 Mixture under the Cruise procedure and renumbered it to Item 4. Repaginated pages. Revised the Fuel Quantity section. Added a NOTE regarding the Press-to-Test button to the end of the Rudder Hold System section. Added pages 33 and 34. Revised the Cruise Performance tables. Changed Full Fuel Tanks to Fuel Tanks Filled To under conditions in Figure 5-31 and Figure 5-32. Revised the Fuel row and footnote in Figure 6-12.

7-7 to 7-72

F F F F F

Title Page, iii, vii to xi, xxi, xxii 1-4 and 1-5 2-1 2-5 2-8 to 2-12

F F F F

2-15 2-18 4-1 and 4-2 4-6 and 4-7

4-9 to 4-15

F 4-17 to 4-34 F F F 5-19 to 5-32 5-34 and 535 6-13

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xxi

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Page Comment No. 7-2 to 7-4 Revised the Table of Contents. 7-21, 7-27, and 7-31 7-31 to 7-34 7-37 7-45 to 7-47 8-4 and 8-5 Title Page, iv, vii to xxiv 2-1 2-10 to 2-24 3-19 3-26 5-3 6-1 and 6-2 6-13 6A-3 to 6A18 G 6B-1 to 6B10 G G 7-21 to 7-26 7-2 to 7-4 Indicated reference to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide. Also changed 190-00567-00 to 19000567-01. Changed 400 to 350/400. Added SmartView, FliteCharts, and SafeTaxi descriptions. Revised the Fuel Low Annunciation Messages section. Added description of rudder hold function when the Press-to Test Button is pressed to the Press-to Test PTT Button section. Revised the Fuel Capacities under the Fuel Servicing section. Revised administrative pages. Revised Table of Contents. Added Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) Limitations section. Repaginated pages. Added pages 2-23 and 2-24. Changed right bus to essential bus in the first sentence of the last paragraph of the Trim Tab Malfunctions section. Added 90 to 110 KIAS airspeed to the Rudder Hold System section. Corrected the revision level/date in the footer. Revised the Table of Contents. Corrected the revision level/date in the footer. Added 34-02 GA 35 GPS Antenna, 34-03 GA 37 GPS and XM Satellite Radio Antenna, and 34-25 GDU 1044 MFD with connector. Renumbered following Item Nos. Changed GIA 63 to GIA 63/GIA 63W in Item Nos. 34-23, 34-24, and 34-25, and renumbered them to 34-26, 34-27, and 34-28. Added 34-02 GA 35 GPS Antenna, 34-03 GA 37 GPS and XM Satellite Radio Antenna, and 34-25 GDU 1044 MFD with connector. Renumbered following Item Nos. Changed GIA 63 to GIA 63/GIA 63W in Item Nos. 34-23, 34-24, and 34-25, and renumbered them to 34-26, 34-27, and 34-28. Revised Table of Contents. Revised the System Description list of LRUs. Changed all occurrences of GDU 1042 to GDU 1042/GDU 1044 and GIA 63 to GIA 63/GIA 63W in the GDU 1040 PFD and GDU 1042 MFD, GMA 1347 Audio Panel, GIA 63, GDL 69A Data Link Receiver, GRS 77, GDC 74A, GEA 71, and GTX 33 sections, as applicable. Described the function of the GDU 1044 and GIA 63W in the sections listed above, as applicable. Added Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) section. Repaginated pages. Indicated reference to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide. Also changed 190-00567-00 to 19000567-01.

Revision Level F F F F F F G G G G G G G G G

G G

7-32 to 7-34 7-48, 7-59, and 7-61

RC050005 xxii

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NARRATIVE DISCUSSION OF REVISIONS Revision Level G Page No. 7-67 to 7-69 G Comment Indicated reference to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide. Also changed 190-00567-00 to 19000567-01. Changed GDU 1042 to GDU 1042/GDU 1044 and GIA 63 to GIA 63/GIA 63W throughout the Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System (AFCS) section. Changed 190-00567-00 to 190-00567-01 in the Customer Delivery Package table.

8-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 xxiii

Narrative Discussion of Revisions Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionall Left Blank

RC050005 xxiv

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 1 General

Section 1 General
TABLE OF CONTENTS THREE-VIEW DRAWING OF THE AIRPLANE ....................................................................... 1-2 INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................................... 1-3 DESCRIPTIVE DATA .................................................................................................................. 1-4 Engine ................................................................................................................................... 1-4 Propeller ................................................................................................................................ 1-4 Fuel ........................................................................................................................................ 1-4 Oil .......................................................................................................................................... 1-4 Maximum Certificated Weights ........................................................................................... 1-5 Typical Airplane Weights ..................................................................................................... 1-5 Cabin and Entry Dimensions ................................................................................................ 1-5 Space and Entry Dimensions of Baggage Compartment ..................................................... 1-5 Specific Loadings ................................................................................................................. 1-5 ABBREVIATIONS, TERMINOLOGY, AND SYMBOLS ......................................................... 1-6 Airspeed Terminology .......................................................................................................... 1-6 Meteorological Terminology ................................................................................................ 1-7 Engine Power and Controls Terminology ............................................................................ 1-7 Airplane Performance & Flight Planning Terminology ....................................................... 1-8 Weight and Balance Terminology ........................................................................................ 1-8 Miscellaneous .....................................................................................................................1-10 REVISIONS AND CONVENTIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL ............................................1-11 Supplements ........................................................................................................................1-11 Use of the terms Warning, Caution, and Note ....................................................................1-11 Meaning of Shall, Will, Should, and May ..........................................................................1-11 Meaning of Land as Soon as Possible or Practicable .........................................................1-11 CONVERSION CHARTS ...........................................................................................................1-11 Kilograms and Pounds ........................................................................................................1-12 Feet and Meters ...................................................................................................................1-13 Inches and Centimeters........................................................................................................1-14 Nautical Miles, Statute Miles, and Kilometers....................................................................1-15 Liters, Imperial Gallons, and U.S. Gallons ........................................................................1-16 Temperature Relationship (Fahrenheit and Celsius)...........................................................1-19 Fuel Weights and Conversion Relationships ......................................................................1-20 Atmospheric Pressure Relationships (In. Hg and Hectopascal) .........................................1-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007

RC050005 1-1

Section 1 General

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

THREE-VIEW DRAWING OF THE AIRPLANE


SPECIFICATIONS 2 2 Wing Area 141.2 ft. (13.1 m ) Wing Span 35.8 ft. (10.9 m) Length 25.2 ft. (7.68 m) Empty Weight () 2500 lbs. (1134 kg) Gross Weight 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Stall Speed 59 KIAS 60 KCAS Maneuvering Speed 158 KIAS 162 KCAS Cruising Speed 181 KIAS 185 KCAS Never Exceed Speed 230 KIAS 235 KCAS Engine 310 HP Continental TSIO-550-C Propeller Hartzell 78 in. (198 cm) Constant Speed Governor McCauley *Note: Wingspan is 36 ft. with position lights.

Figure 1 - 1

RC050005 1-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 1 General

Section 1 General INTRODUCTION


This handbook is written in nine sections and includes the material required to be furnished to the pilot by Federal Aviation Regulations and additional information provided by the manufacturer and constitutes the FAA Approved Airplane Flight Manual. Section 1 contains generalized descriptive data about the airplane including dimensions, fuel and oil capacities, and certificated weights. There are also definitions and explanations of symbols, abbreviations, and commonly used terminology for this airplane. Finally, conventions specific to this manual are detailed. NOTE Federal Aviation Regulations require that a current Handbook be in the airplane during flight. It is the operators responsibility to maintain the Handbook in a current status. The manufacturer provides the registered owner(s) of the airplane with revisions. In countries other than the United States, FAA operating rules may not apply. Operators must ensure that the aircraft is operated in accordance with national operating rules.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-3

Section 1 General

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

DESCRIPTIVE DATA
ENGINE Number of Engines: 1 Engine Manufacturer: Teledyne Continental Engine Model Number: TSIO-550-C Engine Type: Twin-turbocharged, direct drive, air-cooled, horizontally opposed, fuel-injected, sixcylinder engine with 552 in.3 (9.0 L) displacement Takeoff Power: 310 BHP at 2600 RPM , 35.5 in of Hg Maximum Continuous Power: 310 BHP at 2600 RPM Maximum Normal Operating Power: 262 BHP (85%) at 2500 RPM, and 33.5 in of Hg Maximum Climb Power: 310 BHP at 2600 RPM Maximum Cruise Power: 262 BHP at 2550 RPM PROPELLER Propeller Manufacturer: Hartzell Propeller Hub and Blade Model Number: HC-H3YF-1RF and F7693DF Number of Blades: 3 Propeller Diameter: 77 in. (196 cm) minimum, 78 in. (198 cm) maximum Propeller Type: Constant speed and hydraulically actuated, with a low pitch setting of 16.5o 0.2 and a high pitch setting of 42.0o 1.0 (30 inch station) FUEL The following fuel grades, including the respective colors, are approved for this airplane. 100LL Grade Aviation Fuel (Blue) 100 Grade Aviation Fuel (Green) Total Fuel Capacity - 106 Gallons US (401 L) Total Capacity Each Tank: 53 Gallons US (201 L) Total Usable Fuel: S/N 41501 to 41799 49 Gallons US (186 L)/tank, 98 Gallons US (371 L) Total S/N 41800 and on Standard: 43 Gallons US (163 L)/tank, 86 Gallons US (326 L) Total Long Range: 51 Gallons US (193 L)/tank, 102 Gallons US (386 L) Total NOTE Under certain atmospheric conditions, ice can form along various segments of the fuel system. Under these conditions, isopropyl alcohol, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, or diethylene glycol monomethyl ether may be added to the fuel supply. Additive concentrations shall not exceed 3% for isopropyl alcohol or 0.15% for ethylene glycol monomethyl ether and diethylene glycol monomethyl ether (military specification MIL-I27686E). See Figure 8 - 1 in Section 8 for a chart of fuel additive mixing ratios. OIL Specification or Oil Grade (the first 25 engine hours) Non-dispersant mineral oil conforming to SAE J1966 shall be used during the first 25 hours of flight operations. However, if the engine is flown less than once a week, a straight mineral oil with corrosion preventative MIL-C-6529 for the first 25 hours is recommended. Specification or Oil Grade (after 25 engine hours) Teledyne Continental Motors Specification MHS-24. An ashless dispersant oil shall be used after 25 hours.

RC050005 1-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Viscosity Recommended for Various Average Air Temperature Ranges Below 40F (4C) SAE 30, 10W30, 15W50, or 20W50 Above 40F (4C) SAE 50, 15W50, or 20W50 Total Oil Capacity Sump: 8 Quarts (7.6 L) Total: 10 Quarts (9.5 L) Drain and Refill Quantity: 8 Quarts (7.6 L) Oil Quantity Operating Range: 6 to 8 Quarts (5.7 to 7.6 L) NOTE The first time the airplane is filled with oil, additional oil is required for the filter, oil cooler, and propeller dome. At subsequent oil changes, this additional oil is not drainable from the system, and the added oil is mixed with a few quarts of older oil in the oil system. MAXIMUM CERTIFICATED WEIGHTS Ramp Weight: Takeoff Weight: Landing Weight: Baggage Weight: 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 3420 lbs. (1551 kg) 120 lbs. (54.4 kg)

Section 1 General

TYPICAL AIRPLANE WEIGHTS The empty weight of a typical airplane offered with four-place seating, standard interior, avionics, accessories, and equipment has a standard empty weight of about 2500 lbs. (1134 kg). Maximum Useful Load: 1100 lbs.* (499 kg) *(The useful load varies for each airplane. Please see Section 6 for specific details.) CABIN AND ENTRY DIMENSIONS Maximum Cabin Width: 48.17 inches (122 cm) Maximum Cabin Length (Firewall to aft limit of baggage compartment): 139.6 inches (354.6 cm) Maximum Cabin Height: 49 inches (124.5 cm) Minimum Entry Width: 33 inches (83.8 cm) Minimum Entry Height: 33 inches (83.8 cm) Maximum Entry Clearance: 46 inches (116.8 cm) SPACE AND ENTRY DIMENSIONS OF BAGGAGE COMPARTMENT Maximum Baggage Compartment Width: 38.5 inches (97.8 cm) Maximum Baggage Compartment Length: 52 inches (132 cm) (Including Shelf) Maximum Baggage Compartment Height: 34.5 inches (87.6 cm) Maximum Baggage Entry Width: 28 inches (71.1 cm) (Diagonal Measurement) SPECIFIC LOADINGS Wing Loading: 25.50 lbs./sq. ft Power Loading: 11.61 lbs./hp

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 1-5

Section 1 General

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

ABBREVIATIONS, TERMINOLOGY, AND SYMBOLS


AIRSPEED TERMINOLOGY CAS Calibrated Airspeed means the indicated speed of an aircraft, corrected for position and instrument error. Calibrated airspeed is equal to true airspeed in standard atmosphere at sea level. KCAS GS IAS Calibrated Airspeed expressed in knots. Ground Speed is the speed of an airplane relative to the ground. Indicated Airspeed is the speed of an aircraft as shown on the airspeed indicator when corrected for instrument error. IAS values published in this Handbook assume zero instrument error. Indicated Airspeed expressed in knots. True Airspeed is the airspeed of an airplane relative to undisturbed air, which is the CAS, corrected for altitude, temperature and compressibility. This term refers to the maximum speed in level flight with maximum continuous power. The maximum operating maneuvering speed of the airplane. Do not apply full or abrupt control movements above this speed. If a maneuver is entered gradually at VO with maximum weight and full forward CG, the airplane will stall at limit load. However, limit load can be exceeded at VO if abrupt control movements are used or the CG is farther aft. Maximum Flap Extended Speed is the highest speed permissible with wing flaps in a prescribed extended position. Never Exceed Speed is the speed limit that may not be exceeded at any time. Maximum Structural Cruising Speed is the speed that must not be exceeded except in smooth air and then only with caution. Stalling Speed or the minimum steady flight speed at which the airplane is controllable. Stalling Speed or the minimum steady flight speed at which the airplane is controllable in the landing configuration. Best Angle-of-Climb Speed is the airspeed that delivers the greatest gain of altitude in the shortest possible horizontal distance. Best Rate-of-Climb Speed is the airspeed that delivers the greatest gain in altitude in the shortest possible time.

KIAS TAS VH VO

VFE VNE VNO VS VSO VX VY

RC050005 1-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 1 General

METEOROLOGICAL TERMINOLOGY ISA International Standard Atmosphere in which: 1. The air is a dry perfect gas; 2. The temperature at sea level (SL) is 15 C (59 F); 3. The pressure at SL is 29.92 inches of Hg (1013.2 mb); 4. The temperature gradient from SL to an altitude where the temperature is -56.5C (-69.7F) is -0.00198C (-.003564F) per foot, and zero above that altitude. Standard Temperature OAT Standard Temperature is 15C (59F) at sea level pressure altitude and decreases 2C (3.2F) for each 1000 feet of altitude. Outside Air Temperature is the free air static temperature obtained either from in-flight temperature indications or ground meteorological sources, adjusted for instrument error and compressibility effects. The number actually read from an altimeter when the barometric subscale has been set to 29.92 inches of Hg (1013.2 mb). Altitude measured from standard sea level pressure (29.92 inches of Hg) by a pressure or barometric altimeter. It is the indicated pressure altitude corrected for position and instrument error. In this Handbook, altimeter instrument errors are assumed to be zero. Actual atmospheric pressure at field elevation. The wind velocities recorded as variables on the charts of this handbook are to be understood as the headwind or tailwind components of the reported winds.

Indicated Pressure Altitude Pressure (PA) Altitude

Station Pressure Wind

ENGINE POWER & CONTROLS TERMINOLOGY BHP Brake Horsepower is the power developed by the engine. MP MCP Maximum Cruise Power MNOP Manifold Pressure is the pressure measured in the intake system of the engine and is depicted as inches of Hg. Maximum Continuous Power is the maximum power for abnormal or emergency operations. The maximum power recommended for cruise. Maximum Normal Operating Power is the maximum power for all normal operations (except takeoff). This power, in most situations, is the same as Maximum Continuous Power. The Mixture Control provides a mechanical linkage with the fuel control unit of fuel injection engines, to control the size of the fuel feed aperture, and thus, the air/fuel mixture. It is also a primary means to shut down the engine. The lever used to select a propeller speed. The device that regulates the RPM of the engine and propeller by increasing or decreasing the propeller pitch, through a pitch change mechanism in the propeller hub. RC050005 1-7

Mixture Control

Propeller Control Propeller Governor

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Section 1 General RPM Stall Strip

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Revolutions Per Minute is a measure of engine and/or propeller speed. Small triangular strips installed along the leading edge of an airplane wing to disrupt the airflow at high angles of attack in a controlled way. The strips improve stall characteristics and spin recovery. An instrument that indicates propeller rotation and is expressed as revolutions per minute (RPM). The lever used to control engine power, from the lowest through the highest power, by controlling propeller pitch, fuel flow, engine speed, or any combination of these. The Turbine Inlet Temperature indicator is the instrument used to identify the lean fuel flow mixtures for various power settings. Specially shaped composite construction on the outboard leading edge of the wing. The cuff increases the camber of the airfoil and improves the slowflight and stall characteristics of the wing.

Tachometer Throttle

TIT Gauge Wing Cuff

AIRPLANE PERFORMANCE & FLIGHT PLANNING TERMINOLOGY Demonstrated Demonstrated Crosswind Velocity is the velocity of the crosswind component for which adequate control of the airplane can be maintained during takeoff Crosswind and landing. The value shown is not considered limiting. Velocity G A unit of acceleration equal to the acceleration of gravity at the surface of the earth. The term is frequently used to quantify additional forces exerted on the airplane and is expressed as multiples of the basic gravitational force, e.g., a 1.7-g force. Gallons Per Hour is the quantity of fuel consumed in an hour expressed in gallons. The limit load factor is expressed in multiples of gravity (g) which the airplane can safely withstand. If the limit load factor is exceeded, the airplane may be damaged. Nautical Miles per Gallon is the distance (in nautical miles) which can be expected per gallon of fuel consumed at a specific power setting and/or flight configuration. Pounds Per Hour is the quantity of fuel consumed in an hour expressed in pounds. Unusable Fuel is the amount of fuel expressed in gallons that cannot safely be used in flight. Unusable Fuel is the fuel remaining after a runout test has been completed in accordance with governmental regulations. The ultimate load factor is 1.5 times the limit load factor. If the ultimate load factor is exceeded, the airplane can fail catastrophically. Usable Fuel is the quantity available that can safely be used for flight planning purposes.

GPH Limit Load Factor

NMPG

PPH Unusable Fuel

Ultimate Load Factor Usable Fuel

WEIGHT AND BALANCE TERMINOLOGY Arm The Arm is the horizontal distance from the reference datum to the center of RC050005 1-8 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) gravity (C.G.) of an item. Basic Empty Weight CG

Section 1 General

The Basic Empty Weight is the Standard Empty Weight plus optional equipment. The Center of Gravity is the point at which the airplane will balance if suspended. Its distance from the datum is found by dividing the total moment by the total weight of the airplane. The arm obtained by adding the individual moments of the airplane and dividing the sum by the total weight. The extreme center of gravity locations within which the airplane must be operated at a given weight. This is the maximum allowable weight of the airplane when empty, before fuel, passengers, and baggage are added. Subtracting the minimum useful load from the maximum gross weight produces the maximum empty weight. The amount of additional equipment that can be added to the airplane is determined by subtracting the standard empty weight from the maximum empty weight. See page 6-16 for an example. The maximum loaded weight of an aircraft. Gross weight includes the total weight of the aircraft, the weight of the fuel and oil, and the weight of all the load it is carrying. The maximum weight approved for landing touchdown. The maximum weight approved for ground maneuver. (It includes the weight of the fuel used for startup, taxi, and runup.) The maximum weight approved for the start of the takeoff run.

CG Arm CG Limits Maximum Empty Weight

Maximum Gross Weight Maximum Landing Weight Maximum Ramp Weight Maximum Takeoff Weight

Maximum Zero-Fuel The maximum weight authorized for an aircraft that does not include the Weight weight of the fuel. This weight includes the basic empty weight plus the weight of the passengers and baggage. The maximum zero-fuel weight can change depending on the center of gravity location. See Figure 2 - 4 for an example. Minimum Flight Weight This is the minimum weight permitted for flight operations and includes the basic empty weight plus fuel, pilot, passengers, and baggage. The minimum flight weight can change depending on the center of gravity location. See Figure 2 - 4 for an example. For utility category airplanes, certified for night or IFR operations, a weight of 190 pounds for each installed seat plus the fuel weight for 45 minutes at maximum continuous power. The moment of a lever is the distance, in inches, between the point at which a force is applied and the fulcrum, or the point about which a lever rotates, multiplied by the force, in pounds. Moment is expressed in inch-pounds. This is an imaginary vertical plane from which all horizontal distances are measured for balance purposes. RC050005 1-9

Minimum Useful Load Moment

Reference Datum

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Section 1 General Standard Empty Weight Station

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) This is the weight of a standard airplane including unusable fuel, full operating fluids, and full oil. The Station is a location along the airplane's fuselage usually given in terms of distance from the reference datum, i.e., Station 40 would be 40 inches from the reference datum. The Useful Load is the difference between Takeoff Weight or Ramp Weight, if applicable, and Basic Empty Weight.

Useful Load

MISCELLANEOUS Flight Time Pilot time that commences when an aircraft moves under its own power for the purpose of flight and ends when the aircraft comes to rest after landing. Airplanes

Time in Service

Time in service, with respect to maintenance time records, means the time from the moment an aircraft leaves the surface of the earth until it touches it at the next point of landing.

RC050005 1-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 1 General

SUPPLEMENTS Equipment, which is not covered in Sections 1 through 8 of the Information Manual, is included in Section 9, as applicable. USE OF THE TERMS WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE The following conventions will be used for the terms, Warning, Caution, and Note. WARNING The use of a Warning symbol means that information which follows is of critical importance and concerns procedures and techniques which could cause or result in personal injury or death if not carefully followed. CAUTION The use of a Caution symbol means that information which follows is of significant importance and concerns procedures and techniques which could cause or result in damage to the airplane and/or its equipment if not carefully followed. NOTE The use of the term NOTE means the information that follows is essential to emphasize. MEANING OF SHALL, WILL, SHOULD, AND MAY The words shall and will are used to denote a mandatory requirement. The word should denotes something that is recommended but not mandatory. The word may is permissive in nature and suggests something that is optional. MEANING OF LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE OR PRACTICABLE The use of these two terms relates to the urgency of the situation. When it is suggested to land as soon as possible, this means to land at the nearest suitable airfield after considering weather conditions, ambient lighting, approach facilities, and landing requirements. When it is suggested to land as soon as practicable, this means that the flight may be continued to an airport with superior facilities, including maintenance support, and weather conditions. CONVERSION CHARTS On the following pages are a series of charts and graphs for conversion to and from U.S. weights and measures to metric and imperial equivalents. The charts and graphs are included to help pilots who live in countries other than the United States or pilots from the United States who are traveling to or within other countries.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-11

Section 1 General KILOGRAMS AND POUNDS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CONVERTING KILOGRAMS TO POUNDS


Kilograms 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 22.046 44.092 66.139 88.185 0 1 2.205 24.251 46.297 68.343 90.390 2 4.409 26.455 48.502 70.548 92.594 3 6.614 28.660 50.706 72.753 94.799 4 8.818 30.865 52.911 74.957 97.003 5 11.023 33.069 55.116 77.162 99.208 6 13.228 35.274 57.320 79.366 7 15.432 37.479 59.525 81.571 8 17.637 39.683 61.729 83.776 9 19.842 41.888 63.934 85.980

101.413 103.617 105.822 108.026

110.231 112.436 114.640 116.845 119.050 121.254 123.459 125.663 127.868 130.073 132.277 134.482 136.687 138.891 141.096 143.300 145.505 147.710 149.914 152.119 154.324 156.528 158.733 160.937 163.142 165.347 167.551 169.756 171.961 174.165 176.370 178.574 180.779 182.984 185.188 187.393 189.597 191.802 194.007 196.211 198.416 200.621 202.825 205.030 207.234 209.439 211.644 213.848 216.053 218.258 220.462 222.667 224.871 227.076 229.281 231.485 233.690 235.895 238.099 240.304

Example: Convert 76 kilograms to pounds. Locate the 70 row in the first column and then move right, horizontally to Column No. 6 and read the solution, 167.551 pounds.

Figure 1 - 2

CONVERTING POUNDS TO KILOGRAMS


Pounds 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 4.536 9.072 13.608 18.144 22.680 27.216 31.751 36.287 40.823 45.359 0 1 0.454 4.990 9.525 14.061 18.597 23.133 27.669 32.205 36.741 41.277 45.813 2 0.907 5.443 9.979 14.515 19.051 23.587 28.123 32.659 37.195 41.730 46.266 3 1.361 5.897 10.433 14.969 19.504 24.040 28.576 33.112 37.648 42.184 46.720 4 1.814 6.350 10.886 15.422 19.958 24.494 29.030 33.566 38.102 42.638 47.174 5 2.268 6.804 11.340 15.876 20.412 24.948 29.483 34.019 38.555 43.091 47.627 6 2.722 7.257 11.793 16.329 20.865 25.401 29.937 34.473 39.009 43.545 48.081 7 3.175 7.711 12.247 16.783 21.319 25.855 30.391 34.927 39.463 43.998 48.534 8 3.629 8.165 12.701 17.236 21.772 26.308 30.844 35.380 39.916 44.452 48.988 9 4.082 8.618 13.154 17.690 22.226 26.762 31.298 35.834 40.370 44.906 49.442

Example: Convert 40 pounds to kilograms. Locate the 40 row in the first column and then move right one column to Column No. 0 and read the solution, 18.144 kilograms.

Figure 1 - 3

RC050005 1-12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 1 General

FEET AND METERS

CONVERTING METERS TO FEET


Meters 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 32.808 65.617 98.425 0 1 3.281 36.089 68.898 2 6.562 39.370 72.178 3 9.843 42.651 75.459 4 13.123 45.932 78.740 5 16.404 49.213 82.021 6 19.685 52.493 85.302 7 22.966 55.774 88.583 8 26.247 59.055 91.864 9 29.528 62.336 95.144

101.706 104.987 108.268 111.549 114.829 118.110 121.391 124.672 127.953

131.234 134.514 137.795 141.076 144.357 147.638 150.919 154.199 157.480 160.761 164.042 167.323 170.604 173.885 177.165 180.446 183.727 187.008 190.289 193.570 196.850 200.131 203.412 206.693 209.974 213.255 216.535 219.816 223.097 226.378 229.659 232.940 236.220 239.501 242.782 246.063 249.344 252.625 255.906 259.186 262.467 265.748 269.029 272.310 275.591 278.871 282.152 285.433 288.714 291.995 295.276 298.556 301.837 305.118 308.399 311.680 314.961 318.241 321.522 324.803 328.084 331.365 334.646 337.927 341.207 344.488 347.769 351.050 354.331 357.612

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 4

CONVERTING FEET TO METERS


Feet 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 3.048 6.096 9.144 12.192 15.240 18.288 21.336 24.384 27.432 30.480 0 1 0.305 3.353 6.401 9.449 12.497 15.545 18.593 21.641 24.689 27.737 30.785 2 0.610 3.658 6.706 9.754 12.802 15.850 18.898 21.946 24.994 28.042 31.090 3 0.914 3.962 7.010 10.058 13.106 16.154 19.202 22.250 25.298 28.346 31.394 4 1.219 4.267 7.315 10.363 13.411 16.459 19.507 22.555 25.603 28.651 31.699 5 1.524 4.572 7.620 10.668 13.716 16.764 19.812 22.860 25.908 28.956 32.004 6 1.829 4.877 7.925 10.973 14.021 17.069 20.117 23.165 26.213 29.261 32.309 7 2.134 5.182 8.230 11.278 14.326 17.374 20.422 23.470 26.518 29.566 32.614 8 2.438 5.486 8.534 11.582 14.630 17.678 20.726 23.774 26.822 29.870 32.918 9 2.743 5.791 8.839 11.887 14.935 17.983 21.031 24.079 27.127 30.175 33.223

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 5

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-13

Section 1 General INCHES AND CENTIMETERS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CONVERTING CENTIMETERS TO INCHES


Centimeters 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 3.937 7.874 11.811 15.748 19.685 23.622 27.559 31.496 35.433 39.370 0 1 0.394 4.331 8.268 12.205 16.142 20.079 24.016 27.953 31.890 35.827 39.764 2 0.787 4.724 8.661 12.598 16.535 20.472 24.409 28.346 32.283 36.220 40.157 3 1.181 5.118 9.055 12.992 16.929 20.866 24.803 28.740 32.677 36.614 40.551 4 1.575 5.512 9.449 13.386 17.323 21.260 25.197 29.134 33.071 37.008 40.945 5 1.969 5.906 9.843 13.780 17.717 21.654 25.591 29.528 33.465 37.402 41.339 6 2.362 6.299 10.236 14.173 18.110 22.047 25.984 29.921 33.858 37.795 41.732 7 2.756 6.693 10.630 14.567 18.504 22.441 26.378 30.315 34.252 38.189 42.126 8 3.150 7.087 11.024 14.961 18.898 22.835 26.772 30.709 34.646 38.583 42.520 9 3.543 7.480 11.417 15.354 19.291 23.228 27.165 31.102 35.039 38.976 42.913

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 6

CONVERTING INCHES TO CENTIMETERS


Inches 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 25.40 50.80 76.20 101.60 127.00 152.40 177.80 203.20 228.60 254.00 0 1 2.54 27.94 53.34 78.74 104.14 129.54 154.94 180.34 205.74 231.14 256.54 2 5.08 30.48 55.88 81.28 106.68 132.08 157.48 182.88 208.28 233.68 259.08 3 7.62 33.02 58.42 83.82 109.22 134.62 160.02 185.42 210.82 236.22 261.62 4 10.16 35.56 60.96 86.36 111.76 137.16 162.56 187.96 213.36 238.76 264.16 5 12.70 38.10 63.50 88.90 114.30 139.70 165.10 190.50 215.90 241.30 266.70 6 15.24 40.64 66.04 91.44 116.84 142.24 167.64 193.04 218.44 243.84 269.24 7 17.78 43.18 68.58 93.98 119.38 144.78 170.18 195.58 220.98 246.38 271.78 8 20.32 45.72 71.12 96.52 121.92 147.32 172.72 198.12 223.52 248.92 274.32 9 22.86 48.26 73.66 99.06 124.46 149.86 175.26 200.66 226.06 251.46 276.86

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 7

RC050005 1-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NAUTICAL MILES, STATUTE MILES, AND KILOMETERS

Section 1 General

Nautical Statute Kilo- Nautical Statute Kilo- Nautical Statute Miles Miles meters Miles Miles meters Miles Miles
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120 125 130 135 140 145 150 155 160 165 170 6 12 17 23 29 35 40 46 52 58 63 69 75 81 86 92 98 104 109 115 121 127 132 138 144 150 155 161 167 173 178 184 190 196 9 19 28 37 46 56 65 74 83 93 102 111 120 130 139 148 157 167 176 185 194 204 213 222 232 241 250 259 269 278 287 296 306 315 175 180 185 190 195 200 205 210 215 220 225 230 235 240 245 250 255 260 265 270 275 280 285 290 295 300 305 310 315 320 325 330 335 340 202 207 213 219 225 230 236 242 248 253 259 265 271 276 282 288 294 299 305 311 317 322 328 334 340 345 351 357 363 369 374 380 386 392 324 333 343 352 361 370 380 389 398 407 417 426 435 444 454 463 472 482 491 500 509 519 528 537 546 556 565 574 583 593 602 611 620 630 345 350 355 360 365 370 375 380 385 390 395 400 405 410 415 420 425 430 435 440 445 450 455 460 465 470 475 480 485 490 495 500 505 510 397 403 409 415 420 426 432 438 443 449 455 461 466 472 478 484 489 495 501 507 512 518 524 530 535 541 547 553 559 564 570 576 582 587

Kilometers
639 648 657 667 676 685 695 704 713 722 732 741 750 759 769 778 787 796 806 815 824 833 843 852 861 870 880 889 898 907 917 926 935 945

Figure 1 - 8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-15

Section 1 General LITERS, IMPERIAL GALLONS, AND U.S. GALLONS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CONVERTING LITERS TO IMPERIAL GALLONS


Liters 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 2.20 4.40 6.60 8.80 11.00 13.20 15.40 17.60 19.80 22.00 0 1 0.22 2.42 4.62 6.82 9.02 11.22 13.42 15.62 17.82 20.02 22.22 2 0.44 2.64 4.84 7.04 9.24 11.44 13.64 15.84 18.04 20.24 22.44 3 0.66 2.86 5.06 7.26 9.46 11.66 13.86 16.06 18.26 20.46 22.66 4 0.88 3.08 5.28 7.48 9.68 11.88 14.08 16.28 18.48 20.68 22.88 5 1.10 3.30 5.50 7.70 9.90 12.10 14.30 16.50 18.70 20.90 23.10 6 1.32 3.52 5.72 7.92 10.12 12.32 14.52 16.72 18.92 21.12 23.32 7 1.54 3.74 5.94 8.14 10.34 12.54 14.74 16.94 19.14 21.34 23.54 8 1.76 3.96 6.16 8.36 10.56 12.76 14.96 17.16 19.36 21.56 23.76 9 1.98 4.18 6.38 8.58 10.78 12.98 15.18 17.38 19.58 21.78 23.98

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 9

CONVERTING IMPERIAL GALLONS TO LITERS


Imperial Gallons 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 0.00 45.46 90.92 136.38 181.84 227.30 272.76 318.22 363.68 409.14 454.60 1 4.55 50.01 95.47 140.93 186.39 231.85 277.31 322.77 368.23 413.69 459.15 2 9.09 54.55 100.01 145.47 190.93 236.39 281.85 327.31 372.77 418.23 463.69 3 13.64 59.10 104.56 150.02 195.48 240.94 286.40 331.86 377.32 422.78 468.24 4 18.18 63.64 109.10 154.56 200.02 245.48 290.94 336.40 381.86 427.32 472.78 5 22.73 68.19 113.65 159.11 204.57 250.03 295.49 340.95 386.41 431.87 477.33 6 27.28 72.74 118.20 163.66 209.12 254.58 300.04 345.50 390.96 436.42 481.88 7 31.82 77.28 122.74 168.20 213.66 259.12 304.58 350.04 395.50 440.96 486.42 8 36.37 81.83 127.29 172.75 218.21 263.67 309.13 354.59 400.05 445.51 490.97 9 40.91 86.37 131.83 177.29 222.75 268.21 313.67 359.13 404.59 450.05 495.51

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 10

RC050005 1-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LITERS, IMPERIAL GALLONS, AND U.S. GALLONS (Continued)

Section 1 General

CONVERTING LITERS TO U.S. GALLONS


Liters 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 0.00 2.64 5.28 7.93 10.57 13.21 15.85 18.49 21.13 23.78 26.42 1 0.26 2.91 5.55 8.19 10.83 13.47 16.11 18.76 21.40 24.04 26.68 2 0.53 3.17 5.81 8.45 11.10 13.74 16.38 19.02 21.66 24.30 26.95 3 0.79 3.43 6.08 8.72 11.36 14.00 16.64 19.28 21.93 24.57 27.21 4 1.06 3.70 6.34 8.98 11.62 14.27 16.91 19.55 22.19 24.83 27.47 5 1.32 3.96 6.60 9.25 11.89 14.53 17.17 19.81 22.45 25.10 27.74 6 1.59 4.23 6.87 9.51 12.15 14.79 17.44 20.08 22.72 25.36 28.00 7 1.85 4.49 7.13 9.77 12.42 15.06 17.70 20.34 22.98 25.62 28.27 8 2.11 4.76 7.40 10.04 12.68 15.32 17.96 20.61 23.25 25.89 28.53 9 2.38 5.02 7.66 10.30 12.94 15.59 18.23 20.87 23.51 26.15 28.79

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 11

CONVERTING U.S. GALLONS TO LITERS


U.S. Gallons 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 0.00 37.85 75.70 113.55 151.40 189.25 227.10 264.95 302.80 340.65 378.50 1 3.79 41.64 79.49 117.34 155.19 193.04 230.89 268.74 306.59 344.44 382.29 2 7.57 45.42 83.27 121.12 158.97 196.82 234.67 272.52 310.37 348.22 386.07 3 11.36 49.21 87.06 124.91 162.76 200.61 238.46 276.31 314.16 352.01 389.86 4 15.14 52.99 90.84 128.69 166.54 204.39 242.24 280.09 317.94 355.79 393.64 5 18.93 56.78 94.63 132.48 170.33 208.18 246.03 283.88 321.73 359.58 397.43 6 22.71 60.56 98.41 136.26 174.11 211.96 249.81 287.66 325.51 363.36 401.21 7 26.50 64.35 102.20 140.05 177.90 215.75 253.60 291.45 329.30 367.15 405.00 8 30.28 68.13 105.98 143.83 181.68 219.53 257.38 295.23 333.08 370.93 408.78 9 34.07 71.92 109.77 147.62 185.47 223.32 261.17 299.02 336.87 374.72 412.57

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-17

Section 1 General

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

LITERS, IMPERIAL GALLONS, AND U.S. GALLONS (Continued)

CONVERTING IMPERIAL GALLONS TO U.S. GALLONS


Imperial Gallons 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 0.00 12.01 24.02 36.03 48.04 60.05 72.06 84.07 96.08 108.09 120.10 1 1.20 13.21 25.22 37.23 49.24 61.25 73.26 85.27 97.28 109.29 121.30 2 2.40 14.41 26.42 38.43 50.44 62.45 74.46 86.47 98.48 110.49 122.50 3 3.60 15.61 27.62 39.63 51.64 63.65 75.66 87.67 99.68 111.69 123.70 4 4.80 16.81 28.82 40.83 52.84 64.85 76.86 88.87 100.88 112.89 124.90 5 6.01 18.02 30.03 42.04 54.05 66.06 78.07 90.08 102.09 114.10 126.11 6 7.21 19.22 31.23 43.24 55.25 67.26 79.27 91.28 103.29 115.30 127.31 7 8.41 20.42 32.43 44.44 56.45 68.46 80.47 92.48 104.49 116.50 128.51 8 9.61 21.62 33.63 45.64 57.65 69.66 81.67 93.68 105.69 117.70 129.71 9 10.81 22.82 34.83 46.84 58.85 70.86 82.87 94.88 106.89 118.90 130.91

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 13

CONVERTING U.S. GALLONS TO IMPERIAL GALLONS


U.S. Gallons 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 0.00 8.33 16.65 24.98 33.31 41.63 49.96 58.29 66.61 74.94 83.27 1 0.83 9.16 17.49 25.81 34.14 42.47 50.79 59.12 67.45 75.77 84.10 2 1.67 9.99 18.32 26.65 34.97 43.30 51.63 59.95 68.28 76.61 84.93 3 2.50 10.82 19.15 27.48 35.81 44.13 52.46 60.79 69.11 77.44 85.77 4 3.33 11.66 19.98 28.31 36.64 44.96 53.29 61.62 69.95 78.27 86.60 5 4.16 12.49 20.82 29.14 37.47 45.80 54.12 62.45 70.78 79.10 87.43 6 5.00 13.32 21.65 29.98 38.30 46.63 54.96 63.28 71.61 79.94 88.26 7 5.83 14.16 22.48 30.81 39.14 47.46 55.79 64.12 72.44 80.77 89.10 8 6.66 14.99 23.32 31.64 39.97 48.30 56.62 64.95 73.28 81.60 89.93 9 7.49 15.82 24.15 32.47 40.80 49.13 57.45 65.78 74.11 82.44 90.76

Example: Refer to Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-3 for examples of how to use these types of tables.

Figure 1 - 14

RC050005 1-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) TEMPERATURE RELATIONSHIPS (FAHRENHEIT AND CELSIUS)


Fahrenheit
-40F -35F -30F -25F -20F -15F -10F -5F 0F 5F 10F 15F 20F 25F 30F 35F 40F 45F 50F 55F 60F 65F 70F 75F 80F 85F 90F 95F 100F 105F 110F 115F 120F 125F 130F 135F 140F

Section 1 General

Celsius
-40C -37C -34C -32C -29C -26C -23C -21C -18C -15C -12C -9C -7C -4C -1C 2C 4C 7C 10C 13C 16C 18C 21C 24C 27C 29C 32C 35C 38C 41C 43C 46C 49C 52C 54C 57C 60C

Fahrenheit
145F 150F 155F 160F 165F 170F 175F 180F 185F 190F 195F 200F 205F 210F 215F 220F 225F 230F 235F 240F 245F 250F 255F 260F 265F 270F 275F 280F 285F 290F 295F 300F 305F 310F 315F 320F 325F

Celsius
63C 66C 68C 71C 74C 77C 79C 82C 85C 88C 91C 93C 96C 99C 102C 104C 107C 110C 113C 116C 118C 121C 124C 127C 129C 132C 135C 138C 141C 143C 146C 149C 152C 154C 157C 160C 163C

Fahrenheit
330F 335F 340F 345F 350F 355F 360F 365F 370F 375F 380F 385F 390F 395F 400F 405F 410F 415F 420F 425F 430F 435F 440F 445F 450F 455F 460F 465F 470F 475F 480F 485F 490F 495F 500F 505F 510F

Celsius
166C 168C 171C 174C 177C 179C 182C 185C 188C 191C 193C 196C 199C 202C 204C 207C 210C 213C 216C 218C 221C 224C 227C 229C 232C 235C 238C 241C 243C 246C 249C 252C 254C 257C 260C 263C 266C

Figure 1 - 15

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 1-19

Section 1 General

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

FUEL WEIGHTS AND CONVERSION RELATIONSHIPS The table below summarizes the weights and conversion relationships for liters, U.S. Gallons, and Imperial Gallons. The chart values are only to two decimal places. The table is intended to provide approximate values for converting from one particular quantity of measurement to another.
Quantity Liters Imperial Gallons U.S. Gallons Weight Kg. Lbs.
0.72 3.72 2.72 1.58 7.2 6.0

Converting To U.S. Gallons

Converting To Imperial Gallons

Converting To Liters

26% of the liter quantity 22% of the liter quantity 1.2 times the number of Imperial Gallons 83% of the U.S. Gallon quantity 4.55 times the number of Imperial Gallons 3.78 times the number of U.S. Gallons

Figure 1 - 16 ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE RELATIONSHIPS (IN. HG AND HECTOPASCAL)


Pressure In. Hg
27.70 27.75 27.80 27.85 27.90 27.95 28.00 28.05 28.10 28.15 28.20 28.25 28.30 28.35 28.40 28.45 28.50 28.55 28.60 28.65

hPa
938 940 941 943 945 946 948 950 952 953 955 957 958 960 962 963 965 967 969 970

In. Hg
28.70 28.75 28.80 28.85 28.90 28.95 29.00 29.05 29.10 29.15 29.20 29.25 29.30 29.35 29.40 29.45 29.50 29.55 29.60 29.65

hPa
972 974 975 977 979 980 982 984 985 987 989 991 992 994 996 997 999 1001 1002 1004

In. Hg
29.70 29.75 29.80 29.85 29.90 29.92 29.95 30.00 30.05 30.10 30.15 30.20 30.25 30.30 30.35 30.40 30.45 30.50 30.55 30.60

hPa
1006 1007 1009 1011 1013 1013 1014 1016 1018 1019 1021 1023 1024 1026 1028 1029 1031 1033 1035 1036

In. Hg
30.65 30.70 30.75 30.80 30.85 30.90 30.95 31.00 31.05 31.10 31.15 31.20 31.25 31.30 31.35 31.40 31.45 31.50 31.55 31.60

hPa
1038 1040 1041 1043 1045 1046 1048 1050 1051 1053 1055 1057 1058 1060 1062 1063 1065 1067 1068 1070

Figure 1 - 17

RC050005 1-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

Section 2 Limitations
TABLE OF CONTENTS INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 2-2 LIMITATIONS............................................................................................................................... 2-3 Airspeed Limitations ............................................................................................................. 2-3 Airspeed Indicator Markings ................................................................................................. 2-3 Powerplant Limitations.......................................................................................................... 2-4 Powerplant Fuel and Oil Data ............................................................................................... 2-4 Oil Grades Recommended for Various Average Temperature Ranges ..................................................................................................... 2-4 Oil Temperature............................................................................................................ 2-4 Oil Pressures ................................................................................................................. 2-4 Approved Fuel Grades.................................................................................................. 2-4 Fuel Flow ......................................................................................................................2-4 Vapor Suppression........................................................................................................ 2-4 Powerplant Instrument Markings .......................................................................................... 2-4 Propeller Data and Limitations.............................................................................................. 2-5 Propeller Diameters ...................................................................................................... 2-5 Propeller Blade Angles at 30 Inches Station ................................................................ 2-5 Weight Limits ........................................................................................................................ 2-6 Other Weight Limitations ...................................................................................................... 2-6 Center of Gravity Limits........................................................................................................ 2-6 Center of Gravity Table ......................................................................................................... 2-6 Maneuvering Limits............................................................................................................... 2-6 Utility Category ............................................................................................................ 2-6 Approved Acrobatic Maneuvers............................................................................................ 2-7 Spins....................................................................................................................................... 2-7 Flight Load Factor Limits...................................................................................................... 2-7 Utility Category ............................................................................................................ 2-8 Kinds of Operation Limits and Pilot Requirements .............................................................. 2-8 Icing Conditions..................................................................................................................... 2-8 Fuel Limitations..................................................................................................................... 2-8 Garmin G1000 System Limitations.......................................................................................2-8 Approach Operation Limitations................................................................................2-10 SafeTaxi Limitations ..................................................................................................2-10 Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) Limitations...........................................2-10 GTX 33 Mode S Transponder Limitations..........................................................................2-11 Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System Limitations.......................................2-11 Oxygen Limitations .............................................................................................................2-11 Ryan Model 9900BX TCAD Limitations ...........................................................................2-12 Other Limitations.................................................................................................................2-13 Altitude .......................................................................................................................2-13 Flap Limitations..........................................................................................................2-13 Passenger Seating Capacity ........................................................................................2-13 Leading Edge Devices ................................................................................................2-13 PLACARDS..................................................................................................................................2-15 General .................................................................................................................................2-15 Interior Placards...................................................................................................................2-15 Exterior Placards..................................................................................................................2-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-1

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations INTRODUCTION


Section 2 contains the operating limitations of this airplane. The Federal Aviation Administration approves the limitations included in this Section. These include operating limitations, instrument markings, and basic placards necessary for the safe operation of the airplane, the airplanes engine, the airplanes standard systems, and the airplanes standard equipment. NOTE This section covers limitations associated with the standard systems and equipment in the airplane. Refer to Section 9 for amended operating procedures, limitations, and related performance data for equipment installed via an STC.

RC050005 2-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

LIMITATIONS
AIRSPEED LIMITATIONS The airspeed limitations below are based on the maximum gross takeoff weight of 3600 lbs (1633 kg). The maximum operating maneuvering speeds (VO) and applicable gross weight limitations are shown in Figure 2 - 1.
SPEED
Max. Operating Maneuvering Speed 2600 Pounds Gross Weight 2600 Pounds Gross Weight @ FL250 3600 Pounds Gross Weight 3600Pounds Gross Weight @ FL250 *Decrease 3 knots for each 1000 ft. above 12,000 feet (Press. Alt.) Maximum Flap Extended Speed (Down or 40O Flap Setting) *Decrease 2.4 knots for each 1000 ft. above 12,000 feet (Press. Alt.) Max. Structural Cruising Speed Max. Structural Cruising Speed @ FL250 *Decrease 3.5 knots for each 1000 ft. above 12,000 feet (Press. Alt.) Never Exceed Speed Never Exceed Speed @ FL250 *Decrease 4.4 knots for each 1000 ft. above 12,000 feet (Press. Alt.)

KCAS
138* 96 162* 123

KIAS
135* 93 158* 120

REMARKS

VO

Do not apply full or abrupt control movements above this speed.

VFE

120*

117*

Do not exceed this speed with full flaps. Takeoff flaps can be extended at 130 KCAS (127 KIAS). Do not use flaps above 14,000 ft. Do not exceed this speed except in smooth air and then only with caution.

VNO

185* 140

181* 137

VNE

235* 178

230* 174

Do not exceed this speed in any operation.

Figure 2 - 1 AIRSPEED INDICATOR MARKINGS The airspeed is shown on both the PFD and backup airspeed indicator. The airspeed on the PFD is indicated with an airspeed tape and colored bands (see discussion in Section 7). The backup airspeed indicator has four colored arcs on the outer circumference. The meaning and range of each band and arc is tabulated in Figure 2 - 2.
MARKING
White Band/Arc Green Band/Arc Yellow Band/Arc Red Line

KIAS VALUE OR RANGE


60 117* 73 181* 181 230* 230*

SIGNIFICANCE
Full Flap Operating Range - Lower limit is maximum weight stalling speed in the landing configuration. Upper limit is maximum speed permissible with flaps extended. Normal Operating Range - Lower limit is maximum weight stalling speed with flaps retracted. Upper limit is maximum structural cruising speed. Operations must be conducted with caution and only in smooth air. Maximum speed for all operations

*Decrease the airspeed shown on the backup airspeed indicator by amount listed in Figure 2 - 1 for each 1000 ft. above 12,000 ft. (Pressure Altitude). The PFD displays corrected airspeed automatically. Figure 2 - 2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 2-3

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

POWERPLANT LIMITATIONS Number of Engines: One (1) Engine Manufacturer: Teledyne Continental Engine Model Number: TSIO-550-C Recommended Time Between Overhaul: 2000 Hours (Time in Service) Maximum Power: 310 BHP at 2600 RPM Maximum Manifold Pressure: 35.5 inches of Hg Minimum Power Setting Above 18,000 ft.: 15 inches of Hg and 2200 RPM Maximum Recommended Cruise: 262 BHP (85%) Maximum Cylinder Head Temperature: 460F (238C) Maximum Turbine Inlet Temperature: 1750F (954C)/1850F (1010C) for 30 sec. POWERPLANT FUEL AND OIL DATA Oil Grades Recommended for Various Average Air Temperature Ranges Below 40F (4C) SAE 30, 10W30, 15W50, or 20W50 Above 40F (4C) SAE 50, 15W50, or 20W50 Oil Temperature Maximum Allowable: 240F (116C) Recommended takeoff minimum: 100F (38C) Recommended flight operations: 170F to 220F (76.7C to 104.4C) Oil Pressures Normal Operations: 30-60 psi (pounds per square inch) Idle, minimum: 10 psi Maximum allowable (cold oil): 100 psi Approved Fuel Grades 100LL Grade Aviation Fuel (Blue) 100 Grade Aviation Fuel (Green) Fuel Flow Normal Operations: 13 to 25 GPH (49 to 95 LPH) Idle, minimum: 2 to 3 GPH (7 to 11 LPH) Maximum allowable: 38.5 GPH (146 LPH) Vapor Suppression Required Usage: The Vapor Suppression rocker switch is required to be on above 18,000 ft. The Vapor Suppression rocker switch must be turned ON if TIT is rising above 1460F at full power with the mixture full rich (at any altitude). Vapor suppression may be turned off below 18,000 ft if power has been reduced below 85% and engine temperatures have stabilized.

RC050005 2-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

POWERPLANT INSTRUMENT MARKINGS The following table, Figure 2 - 3, shows applicable color-coded ranges for the various powerplant gauges displayed on the MFD.
RED LINE INSTRUMENT YELLOW RANGE WHITE RANGE GREEN RANGE RED LINE

Minimum Limit
Minimum for idle 600 RPM N/A Minimum for takeoff 100F* (38C) Minimum for idle 10 psi A red line at zero indicates the remaining four gallons (S/N 41501 to 41799), or two gallons (S/N 41800 and on), in each tank cannot be used safely in flight.

Warning
N/A N/A 220F 240F (104C 116C) N/A

Limited Time Operations


2500 2600 RPM 33.5 35.5 In. of Hg 100F 170F (38C 77C) 10 30 psi and 60 100 psi

Normal Operating
2000 2500 RPM 15 33.5 In. of Hg (No Placard) 170F 220F (77C 104C) 30 60 psi

Limit

Tachometer Manifold Pressure

2600 RPM 35.5 In. of Hg 240F (116C) 100 psi (Cold Oil)

Oil Temperature Oil Pressure

Fuel Quantity

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Fuel Flow 100F 240F (38C 116C) N/A 420F 460F (216C 238C) N/A 1650F 1750F (538C 954C) N/A N/A

10 25 GPH (38 83 LPH)

40 GPH (151 LPH)

Cylinder Head Temperature

240F 420F (116C 216C)

460F (238C)

Turbine Inlet Temperature

1000F 1650F (538C 899C)

1750F (954C) (1850F (1010C) for 30 sec. limit)*

* These temperatures or pressures are not marked on the gauge. However, it is important information that the pilot must be aware of.

Figure 2 - 3

PROPELLER DATA AND LIMITATIONS Number of Propellers: 1 Propeller Manufacture: Hartzell Propeller Hub and Blade Model Numbers: HC-H3YF-1RF and F7693DF Propeller Diameters Minimum: 77 in. (196 cm) Maximum: 78 in. (198 cm) Propeller Blade Angle at 30 inch Station Low: 16.5 0.2 High: 42.0 1.0

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 2-5

Section 2 Limitations WEIGHT LIMITS Maximum Ramp Weight: Maximum Empty Weight: Maximum Takeoff Weight: Maximum Landing Weight: Maximum Baggage Weight:*

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Utility Category 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 2708 lbs. (1228 kg) 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 3420 lbs. (1551 kg) 120 lbs. (54.4 kg)

*The baggage compartment has two areas, the main area and the hat rack area. The combined weight in these areas cannot exceed 120 pounds (54.4 kg). The main area is centered at station 166.6 with maximum weight allowance of 120 pounds (54.4 kg). The hat rack area, which is centered at station 199.8, has a maximum weight allowance of 20 pounds (9.1 kg). When loading baggage in the main baggage compartment, Zone A (the forward portion of the main baggage area) must always be loaded first. See page 6-13 for a diagram of loading stations and baggage zones.
OTHER WEIGHT LIMITATIONS TYPE OF WEIGHT LIMITATION FORWARD DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT AFT DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT VARIATION

Minimum Flying Weight Maximum Zero Fuel Weight

105 inches and 2600 lbs. 107.2 inches and 3300 lbs.

112 inches and 2900 lbs. 112 inches and 3300 lbs.

Straight Line Straight Line

Reference Datum: The reference datum is located one inch aft of the tip of the propeller spinner. As distance from the datum increases, there is an increase in weight for each of the two limitation categories. The variation is linear or straight line from the fore to the aft positions. Figure 2 - 4
CENTER OF GRAVITY LIMITS Figure 2 - 5 specifies the center of gravity limits for utility category operations. The variation along the arm between the forward and aft datum points is linear or straight line. The straight-line variation means that at any given point along the arm, an increase in moments changes directly according to the variations in weight and distance from the datum. CENTER OF GRAVITY TABLE CATEGORY FORWARD DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT AFT DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT VARIATION

Utility Category

105 inches at 2600 to 2900 lbs. 108.8 inches at 3600 lbs.

112 inches 2900 to 3600 lbs.

Straight Line

Reference Datum: The reference datum is located one inch aft of the tip of the propeller spinner. This location causes all arm distances and moments (the product of arm and weight) to be positive values. Figure 2 - 5
MANEUVER LIMITS Utility Category This airplane is certified in the utility category. Only the acrobatic maneuvers shown in Figure 2 - 6 are approved.

RC050005 2-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) APPROVED ACROBATIC MANEUVERS MANEUVER ENTRY SPEED

Section 2 Limitations

Chandelles Lazy Eights Steep Turns Stalls *

150 KIAS 150 KIAS 150 KIAS Slow Deceleration*

Ensure that maximum fuel imbalance does not exceed 10 gallons (38 L). Figure 2 - 6

While there are no limitations to the performance of the acrobatic maneuvers listed in Figure 2 - 6, it is recommended that the pilot not exceed 60 of bank since this will improve the service life of the gyros. Also, it is important to remember that the airplane accelerates quite rapidly in a nose down attitude, such as when performing a lazy eight.
SPINS The intentional spinning of the aircraft is prohibited. Flight tests have shown that the aircraft will recover from a one turn spin in less than one additional turn after the application of recovery controls for all points in the weight and balance envelope, up to the maximum certified altitude. The recommended recovery inputs are: power idle, rudder full against the spin, elevator full forward and aileron full against the spin. If the flaps are extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation is stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during pull out. When rotation stops, the aircraft will be in a steep nose down attitude. Airspeeds up to 160 KIAS are possible during a 3 g pull out. Above 126 KIAS it may be possible to pull more than 3.7 gs in light weight conditions. Care should be taken, under such conditions, to avoid overstressing the airframe. A steady state spin may be encountered if pro-spin control inputs are held for 1 turns or more. Steady state spins entered above 20,000 feet at heavy weight and aft CG conditions will take the most turns to recover. If a steady state spin is entered, making and holding the recommended recovery inputs will produce the fastest recovery. WARNING The intentional spinning of the aircraft is prohibited. WARNING If a spin is entered with the flaps extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation is stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during recovery. WARNING If a steady state spin is entered, holding the recommended recovery inputs of power idle, rudder full against the spin, elevator full forward and aileron full against the spin will produce the fastest recovery. When recovering from a steady state spin, the aircraft may exceed the typical one turn recovery time, and additional turns may be experienced until the aircraft recovers from the spin.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 2-7

Section 2 Limitations FLIGHT LOAD FACTOR LIMITS Utility Category - Maximum flight load factors for all weights are:

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Flaps Position Up (Cruise Position) Down (Landing Position)

Max. Load Factor +4.4g and -1.76g +2.0g and -0.0g

KINDS OF OPERATION LIMITS AND PILOT REQUIREMENTS The airplane has the necessary equipment available and is certified for daytime and nighttime VFR and IFR operations with only one pilot. The operational minimum equipment and instrumentation for the kinds of operation are detailed in Part 91 of the FARs. ICING CONDITIONS Flight into known icing is prohibited. FUEL LIMITATIONS Total Capacity: 106 Gallons US (401 L) Total Capacity Each Tank: 53 Gallons US (201 L) Maximum Fuel Imbalance: 10 gallons US (38 L) between left and right fuel tanks Total Usable Fuel S/N 41501 to 41799 49 Gallons US (186 L)/tank, 98 Gallons US (371 L) Total S/N 41800 and on Standard: 43 Gallons US (163 L)/tank, 86 Gallons US (326 L) Total Long Range: 51 Gallons US (193 L)/tank, 102 Gallons US (386 L) Total GARMIN G1000 SYSTEM LIMITATIONS

1.

The G1000 must utilize the following or later FAA approved software versions: Sub-System PFD MFD COM GCU GDC GMA GDL GMU AHRS ADC GIA GEA GPS GRS GSA Software Version 5.01 5.01 7.00 2.01 2.05 2.11 3.02.00 2.01 2.03 2.05 4.30 2.07 3.03 2.06 3.01

The database version is displayed on the MFD power-up page immediately after system powerup and must be acknowledged. The remaining system software versions can be verified on the AUX group sub-page 5, AUX - SYSTEM STATUS.

RC050005 2-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

2.

IFR enroute, oceanic and terminal navigation predicated upon the G1000 GPS Receiver is prohibited unless the pilot verifies the currency of the database or verifies each selected waypoint for accuracy by reference to current approved navigation data. Instrument approach navigation predicated upon the G1000 GPS Receiver must be accomplished in accordance with approved instrument approach procedures that are retrieved from the GPS equipment database. The GPS equipment database must incorporate the current update cycle or be verified for accuracy using current approved navigation data. a. b. c. d. Instrument approaches utilizing the GPS receiver must be conducted in the approach mode and Receiver Autonomous Integrity Monitoring (RAIM) must be available at the Final Approach Fix. Accomplishment of ILS, LOC, LOC-BC, LDA, SDF, MLS or any other type of approach not approved for GPS overlay using GPS for lateral guidance on the final approach segment is not authorized. Use of the G1000 VOR/ILS receiver to fly approaches not approved for GPS require VOR/ILS navigation data to be valid on the PFD display. When an alternate airport is required by the applicable operating rules, it must be served by an approach based on other than GPS navigation, the aircraft must have the operational equipment capable of using that navigation aid, and the required navigation aid must be operational. VNAV information may be utilized for advisory information only. Use of VNAV information for Instrument Approach Procedures does not guarantee step-down fix altitude protection, or arrival at approach minimums in normal position to land. VNAV also does not guarantee compliance with intermediate altitude constraints between the top of descent and the waypoint where the VNAV path terminates in terminal or enroute operations.

3.

e.

4.

If not previously defined, the following default settings must be made in the SYSTEM SETUP menu of the G1000 prior to operation (refer to Pilot's Cockpit Reference Guide for procedure if necessary): a. b. c. d. kt (sets navigation units to nautical miles and knots) ALT, VS ft fpm (sets altitude units to feet and feet per minute) MAP DATUM WGS 84 (sets map datum to WGS-84, see note below) POSITION deg-min (sets navigation grid units to decimal minutes) example: dd.mm.ss: 45 30 30 in decimal minutes are: 45 30.5
DIS, SPD NOTE In some areas outside the United States, datums other than WGS-84 or NAD-83 may be used. If the G1000 is authorized for use by the appropriate Airworthiness authority, the required geodetic datum must be set in the G1000 prior to its use for navigation.

5.

Operation is prohibited north of 70N and south of 70S latitudes. In addition, operation is prohibited in the following two regions: 1) north of 65N between 75W and 120W longitude and 2) south of 55S between 120E and 165E longitude. The GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System preflight test must be successfully completed prior to use of the autopilot or flight director. A white PFT annunciation will display for 2 to 3 seconds and clear upon successful completion of the test. An unsuccessful test will display a red PFT annunciation that will not automatically clear. A pilot with the seat belt fastened must occupy the left pilots seat during all autopilot operations. The autopilot must be off during takeoff and landing. The autopilot must be disengaged below 200 AGL during approach operations and minimum engagement height on takeoff is 400 AGL. Cruise engagement minimum height is 1000 AGL.

6.

7. 8.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 2-9

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

9.

Autopilot operation with the G1000 in the reversionary (Display Backup) mode is limited to training operations and display failure operations.

10. Autopilot maximum engagement speed 210 KIAS Autopilot minimum engagement speed 80 KIAS Electric Trim maximum operating speed VNE 11. Maximum fuel imbalance with autopilot engaged 10 gallons (approximately 61 pounds) 12. Flight Plan: This limitation is applicable to all G1000 systems with GDU software version prior to v8.02. View the System Status Page to verify the GDU software version.
WARNING Do not load a new arrival or departure procedure in the flight plan if one currently exists without first removing the existing arrival or departure procedure. Failing to observe this limitation can cause erroneous course deviation indications, loss of GPS navigation information, and other display anomalies. Note: If display anomalies are noted after editing the flight plan, perform either a direct to or activate leg operation as appropriate on the flight plan to ensure correct flight plan sequencing and guidance. Approach Operation Limitations:

1. 2.

The GFC 700 autopilot is approved for Category I precision instrument approaches and nonprecision approaches only. CAUTION: CDI automatic source switching to the ILS on Nav 1 or 2 must be set to manual for instrument approaches conducted with the autopilot coupled. Upon selection of Nav 1 or 2, APR mode or NAV mode will have to be reselected for capture. If the CDI source is changed when the autopilot is engaged in NAV mode, the autopilot lateral mode will revert to roll attitude hold mode (ROL) and NAV mode must be manually reselected by the pilot. The caution above on automatic switching is the result of potential shifting of the GPS "localizer" vs. the actual ILS localizer position. This generally is not an issue, but there is a slight possibility that an offset between the two could cause a problem with the automatic switching which would not successfully capture the localizer.

SafeTaxi Limitations

SafeTaxi displays of airport surface areas are supplementary and may not be used as primary reference for aircraft ground operations.
Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) Limitations

1. 2.

The aircraft must have operational ground-based navigation equipment on board. Flight planning to an alternate airport cannot be based on satnav approaches, it must be based on an available approach from a ground-based navaid. - If the equipment indicates that satnav service is available after the aircraft gets to the alternate airport, it is permissible to fly a satnav approach.

RC050005 2-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) GTX 33 MODE S TRANSPONDER LIMITATIONS NOTE If the optional Ryan TCAD is installed, TIS will not be available.

Section 2 Limitations

1.

Display of TIS traffic information is advisory only and does not relieve the pilot responsibility to see and avoid other aircraft. Aircraft maneuvers shall not be predicated on the TIS displayed information. Display of TIS traffic information does not constitute a TCAS I or TCAS II collision avoidance system as required by 14 CFR Part 135. Title 14 of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) states that When an Air Traffic Control (ATC) clearance has been obtained, no pilot-in-command (PIC) may deviate from that clearance, except in an emergency, unless he obtains an amended clearance. Traffic information provided by the TIS up-link does not relieve the PIC the responsibility to see and avoid traffic and receive appropriate ATC clearance.

2. 3.

GARMIN GFC 700 AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM LIMITATIONS 1. Operation of the autopilot is prohibited below 80 KIAS and above 210 KIAS. Reduce the autopilot maximum operating speed by 2.8 KIAS for each 1000 feet above 12,000 feet MSL. The autopilot maximum operating speed at 25,000 ft is 174 KIAS 2. Operation of the autopilot less than 400 feet above ground level is prohibited for takeoff. 3. Operation of the autopilot during takeoff and landing is prohibited. 4. Category I and non-precision approaches authorized. 5. Altitude loss during a malfunction and recovery are as follows in Figure 2 - 7.

Configuration Climb Cruise Descent Maneuvering Approach

Bank Angle 50 48 50 52 17.5

Altitude Loss N/A -260 feet -75 feet -100 feet -198 feet Figure 2 - 7

Recovery Delay 3 Seconds 3 Seconds 3 Seconds 1 Second 1 Second

6. VOR and VAPP autopilot/flight director modes may not provide adequate tracking guidance. In the event that VOR or VAPP modes do not track the selected course adequately, disengage the autopilot and flight director and fly the course using raw data.
OXYGEN LIMITATIONS 1. A4 and A5 Flowmeter and standard cannulas may be used for altitudes up to 18,000 ft (Pressure Altitude). 2. Cannulas may only be used by persons not experiencing nasal congestion. 3. A4 and A5 Flowmeter with oxygen mask may be used for altitudes up to 25,000 ft (Pressure Altitude) ONLY. 4. Oxygen masks are required above 18,000 ft (Pressure Altitude). WARNING Prior to takeoff on a flight where the oxygen system is anticipated to be used, verify the proper operation of the system and masks assuring oxygen flow. WARNING Do not use oxygen when utilizing lipstick, chapstick, petroleum jelly or any product containing oil or grease. These substances become highly flammable in oxygen rich conditions. Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 2-11

Section 2 Limitations NOTE

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

If the pilot has nasal congestion or other breathing conditions, flight at altitudes where oxygen is required should be avoided, and a mask with microphone should be used. RYAN MODEL 9900BX TCAD LIMITATIONS 1. Display of TCAD traffic information is advisory only and does not relieve the pilot responsibility to see and avoid other aircraft. Aircraft maneuvers shall not be predicated on the TCAD displayed information.

2. 3.

Display of TCAD traffic information does not constitute a TCAS I or TCAS II collision avoidance system as required by 14 CFR Part 121 or Part 135. Title 14 of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) states that When an Air Traffic Control (ATC) clearance has been obtained, no pilot-in-command (PIC) may deviate from that clearance, except in an emergency, unless he obtains an amended clearance. Traffic information provided by the TCAD does not relieve the PIC the responsibility to see and avoid traffic and receive appropriate ATC clearance. The TCAD only displays intruders equipped with operative transponders. TCAD provides no indication of traffic conflicts with aircraft without transponders. Airframe Shadowing Microwave energy can be obstructed by the airframes of both the host and threat aircraft. A shadowing occurs when the signals must pass around metal structures. a. TCAD is designed to operate optimally when the host TCAD antenna and the threat transponder antenna are in line of sight. With the TCAD antenna top and bottom mounted, the optimal condition generally exists when threats are above, to approximately 15 degrees below, the host aircraft. When the threat is further below the host aircraft, or during turns, signals can be attenuated, causing display of greater than actual indicated nautical miles (iNM). Transponder antenna placement on the threat aircraft and flight maneuvers also have an effect. Whenever a detected threat is below the aircraft, consider airframe shadowing when analyzing the data. For a threat to remain in the shadowed region, a lengthy and parallel track between host and threat is necessary, such as final approach to a runway when the threat is below your aircraft. Airframe shadowing does not affect the accuracy of altitude separation information.

4. 5.

b.

c. 6.

7.

Transponder signals can be reflected by nearby structures. This can result in unreliable altitude and iNM indications, especially near hangars or buildings. This condition occurs primarily when the host aircraft is on the ground, since the top mounted TCAD antenna is less exposed to reflections while in flight. When two aircraft are interrogated at the same instant, the replies received by TCAD can be mixed, degrading the ability to decode the replies. This is more likely to occur in higher density areas, when both aircraft are illuminated at the same moment by the same radar. By using degarbling techniques, the processor can often provide data on the closest threat. In some instances, both aircraft will be decoded, and in other instances, accurate decoding is impossible. This means the traffic may not be displayed on TCAD at all. By keeping the shield size small in high-density areas, the potential for garbled replies is minimized. If the communication link between the TCAD and the intruder transponder is not established, the intruder will not be displayed. A poor transponder transmitter on the intruder aircraft, a geometry where the antennas are shadowed from each other, and high traffic density can limit detection range.

8. 9.

10. When the host aircraft is above 12,000 feet pressure altitude, non-Mode C intruders are not tracked.

RC050005 2-12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

OTHER LIMITATIONS Altitude The maximum flight altitude is 25,000 MSL with an FAA approved oxygen installation and 14,000 MSL without oxygen installed. See FAR Part 91 for applicable oxygen requirements. Flap Limitations Flaps may not be extended at altitudes above 14,000 ft PA. Approved Takeoff Range: 12 Approved Landing Range: 12 and 40 Passenger Seating Capacity The maximum passenger seating configuration is four persons (one pilot and three passengers). Leading Edge Devices All leading edge devices (stall strips, leading edge tape, flat triangular leading edge tape, and zig zag tape) must be installed and in good condition for flight.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-13

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 2-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

PLACARDS
GENERAL Federal Aviation Regulations require that a number of different placards be prominently displayed on the interior and exterior of the airplane. The placards contain information about the airplane and its operation that is of significant importance. The placard is placed in a location proximate to the item it describes. For example, the fuel capacity placard is near the tank filler caps. The placards and their locations are shown on the following pages as they appear on the interior and exterior of the airplane.

INTERIOR PLACARDS
Near Pilot and Copilot Interior Door Handles

Near Door Handle on Passenger Side

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-15

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

On Crash Ax

On Parking Brake Handle

On the Upper Left Side of the Tower Assembly

RC050005 2-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) On Left Panel Behind Pilots Control Stick

Section 2 Limitations

On Instrument Panel to Left of Backup Attitude Indicator

Engraved On Fuel Selector Knob and Upper Plate S/N 41501 to 41799 S/N 41800 and on

LEFT

RIGHT

LEFT

RIGHT

OFF

OFF

OFF

OFF

On Top Front of Center Console

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-17

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

On Right Panel Behind Copilot's Control Stick

On Flaps Panel

On the Compass With Electric A/C Without Electric A/C

The magnetic direction indicator is calibrated for level flight with the engine, radios, and strobes operating.
On Oxygen Distribution Manifold in Forward Overhead Panel

RC050005 2-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Under All Seats

Section 2 Limitations

Under Left Rear Seat Next to Leveling Washer

On Baggage Compartment Door Joggle

On Oxygen Fill Port Set into Hat Shelf

In Aft Cabin on Aft Baggage Bulkhead

On Air Conditioning System Bay Access Cover (when air conditioning is installed) UPON REINSTALLATION ENSURE THIS ACCESS PANEL IS SEALED TO PREVENT CARBON MONOXIDE FROM ENTERING THE CABIN

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-19

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EXTERIOR PLACARDS
Near Pilot and Passenger Door Handles

On Flaps Near Wing Root (Both Sides)

Near Fill Cap of Fuel Tank S/N 41501 to 41799 S/N 41800 and on
AVGAS ONLY MIN FUEL GRADE 100 / 100 LL
TOTAL STANDARD USEABLE 43 GAL US / 163 L TOTAL LONG RANGE USEABLE 51 GAL US / 193 L TOTAL CAPACITY 53 GAL US / 201 L

AVGAS ONLY MIN FUEL GRADE 100 / 100LL


TOTAL USEABLE 49 GAL US / 185 LTR TOTAL CAPACITY 53 GAL US / 201 LTR

Under Each Wing Near Fuel Drains FOR DRAINING OF WING FUEL SUMP: TO OPEN: PRESS CUP GENTLY INTO BOTTOM OF VALVE TO DRAIN REQUIRED AMOUNT OF FUEL. TO CLOSE: REMOVE CUP AND VALVE WILL CLOSE. TO DRAIN WING TANKS: REFER TO MAINTENANCE MANUAL.

On Main Wheel Pants

RC050005 2-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) On Exterior of Fuselage Forward of Wing on Copilots Side

Section 2 Limitations

On Forward Portion of Nose Gear Fairing

TURN LIMIT

On Nose Gear Wheel Pant (if installed)

On Nose Gear Wheel Pant or Nose Gear Fairing (if nose gear wheel pant not installed)

On Oil Filler Access Door

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-21

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) On Exterior of Fuselage Forward of Wing on Pilots Side

On Exterior of Gascolator Door (Underside of Fuselage)

RC050005 2-22

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 2 Limitations

On Interior of Gascolator Door

On Ground Power Supply Plug Cover

24

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 2-23

Section 2 Limitations

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 2-24

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Section 3 Emergency Procedures


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 3-3 Airspeeds for Emergency Operations.................................................................................... 3-3 EMERGENCY PROCEDURES CHECKLISTS ........................................................................... 3-4 Engine Failure During Takeoff.............................................................................................. 3-4 Engine Failure Immediately After Takeoff (Below 400 feet AGL) ..................................... 3-4 Engine Failure During Flight................................................................................................. 3-4 Loss of Oil Pressure............................................................................................................... 3-4 Procedures After an Engine Restart ...................................................................................... 3-4 Forced Landing (Engine Out or Partial Power...................................................................... 3-5 Precautionary Landing With Engine Power .......................................................................... 3-6 Engine Driven Fuel Pump (EDFP) Partial Failure............................................................. 3-6 Ditching.................................................................................................................................. 3-6 Engine Fire On The Ground During Startup ......................................................................... 3-7 Engine Fire In Flight.............................................................................................................. 3-7 Electrical Fire In Flight.......................................................................................................... 3-8 Cabin Fire In Flight (Fuel/Hydraulic Fluid).......................................................................... 3-8 Wing Fire In Flight ................................................................................................................ 3-8 Spin Recovery........................................................................................................................ 3-9 Inadvertent Icing ................................................................................................................... 3-9 Landing With a Flat Main Gear Tire .................................................................................... 3-9 Landing With a Flat Nose Tire ............................................................................................3-10 SpeedBrake System Malfunction ....................................................................................3-10 Electrical System Overcharging ..........................................................................................3-10 Alternator Failure Electrical System Discharging ...........................................................3-10 Left or Right Bus Failure/Crosstie Discharges Working Bus.............................................3-11 Electric Trim/Autopilot Failure ...........................................................................................3-11 Partial Restoration of Disabled Trim System......................................................................3-12 Malfunction of Autopilot.....................................................................................................3-12 Malfunction of Autopilot Autotrim .....................................................................................3-12 Malfunction of Rudder Hold System ..................................................................................3-12 Broken or Stuck Throttle Cable...........................................................................................3-12 Oxygen System Malfunction ...............................................................................................3-12 Carbon Monoxide Detection ...............................................................................................3-12 Something Stuck in or Interfering With a Doorjamb ..........................................................3-13 Evacuating the Airplane ......................................................................................................3-13 Circuit Breaker Panel...........................................................................................................3-14 AMPLIFIED EMERGENCY PROCEDURES............................................................................3-15 Engine Failure and Forced Landings...................................................................................3-15 General........................................................................................................................3-15 Engine Failure After Takeoff (Below 400 feet AGL)................................................3-15 Engine Failure After Takeoff (Above 400 feet AGL) ...............................................3-15 In-Flight Engine Failure .............................................................................................3-15 Best Glide Speed Versus Minimum Rate of Descent Speed .....................................3-16 Emergency Backup Fuel Pump ..................................................................................3-16 Critical Issues (Backup Fuel Pump) ...........................................................................3-16 Engine Restarts ...........................................................................................................3-17 Engine Does Not Restart ............................................................................................3-17 Forced Landing with the Throttle Stuck in the Idle Position.....................................3-18 Stuck Throttle with Enough Power to Sustain Flight.................................................3-18
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007 RC050005 3-1

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Flight Controls Malfunctions...............................................................................................3-18 General ........................................................................................................................3-18 Aileron or Rudder Failure...........................................................................................3-18 Elevator Failure...........................................................................................................3-18 Trim Tab Malfunctions........................................................................................................3-19 Fires......................................................................................................................................3-19 General ........................................................................................................................3-19 Engine Fires ................................................................................................................3-19 Cabin Fires ..................................................................................................................3-20 Lightning Strike ...................................................................................................................3-20 Engine and Propeller Problems ...........................................................................................3-20 Engine Roughness.......................................................................................................3-20 High Altitude Negative G Loading ............................................................................3-20 High Cylinder Head Temperatures.............................................................................3-20 High Oil Temperature.................................................................................................3-21 Low Oil Pressure ........................................................................................................3-21 Failure of Turbocharger..............................................................................................3-21 Failure of Engine Driven Fuel Pump..........................................................................3-21 Propeller Surging or Wandering.................................................................................3-22 Electrical Problems ..............................................................................................................3-22 Under Voltage.............................................................................................................3-23 Alternator Failure........................................................................................................3-23 Load Shedding ............................................................................................................3-23 Over Voltage...............................................................................................................3-23 Master Switches..........................................................................................................3-23 Complete Left or Right Bus Failure ....................................................................................3-23 General ........................................................................................................................3-23 Crosstie Switch ...........................................................................................................3-24 Summary of Buses ......................................................................................................3-24 Static Air Source Blockage..................................................................................................3-25 Spins.....................................................................................................................................3-25 Multi-Function Display........................................................................................................3-25 Primary Flight Display.........................................................................................................3-26 Autopilot ..............................................................................................................................3-26 Rudder Hold System............................................................................................................3-26 Oxygen System ....................................................................................................................3-26 General ........................................................................................................................3-26 Cabin Fire....................................................................................................................3-27 Emergency Exit....................................................................................................................3-27 General ........................................................................................................................3-27 Doors...........................................................................................................................3-27 Seat Belts ....................................................................................................................3-27 Exiting (Cabin Door(s) Operable) ..............................................................................3-27 Exiting (Cabin Doors Inoperable) ..............................................................................3-27 Inverted Exit Procedures......................................................................................................3-27 General ........................................................................................................................3-27 Exterior Emergency Exit Release...............................................................................3-28 Crash Ax ..............................................................................................................................3-28

RC050005 3-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Section 3 Emergency Procedures INTRODUCTION


The emergency procedures are included before the normal procedures, as these items have a higher level of importance. The owner of this handbook is encouraged to copy or otherwise tabulate the following emergency procedures in a format that is usable under flight conditions. Plastic laminated pages printed on both sides and bound together are preferable. Such a checklist is included as part of the airplanes delivery package. Complete Emergency Procedures Checklists shall be carried in the aircraft at all times in a location that is easily accessible to the pilot-in-command. Many emergency procedures require immediate action by the pilot-in-command, and corrective action must be initiated without direct reference to the emergency checklist. Therefore, the pilot-incommand must memorize the appropriate corrective action for these types of emergencies. In this instance, the Emergency Procedures Checklist is used as a crosscheck to ensure that no items are excluded and is used only after control of the airplane is established. When the airplane is under control and the demands of the situation permit, the Emergency Procedures Checklist should be used to verify that all required actions are completed. In all emergencies, it is important to communicate with Air Traffic Control (ATC) or the appropriate controlling entity within radio range. However, communicating is secondary to controlling the airplane and should be done, if time and conditions permit, after the essential elements of handling the emergency are performed.
AIRSPEEDS FOR EMERGENCY OPERATIONS
Engine Failure After Takeoff Wing Flaps Up (Cruise Position) Wing Flaps Takeoff Position Maneuvering Speed 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight 2600 lbs. (1270 kg) Gross Weight *Decrease 3 knots for each 1000-ft above 12,000 ft (Press. Alt.) Precautionary Landing (With engine power, flaps in the landing position) 80 KIAS Maximum Glide (Flaps Up) 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight 2700 lbs. (1224 kg) Gross Weight Minimum Rate of Descent (Flaps Up) 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight 2700 lbs. (1224 kg) Gross Weight

108 KIAS 95 KIAS *158 KIAS *135 KIAS

108 KIAS 96 KIAS 87 KIAS 82 KIAS

Approach Speed without Power Wing Flaps Up (Cruise Position) Wing Flaps Landing Position

98 - 108 KIAS 80 - 90 KIAS

Figure 3 - 1

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-3

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EMERGENCY PROCEDURES CHECKLISTS


ENGINE FAILURE DURING TAKEOFF 1. Throttle IDLE 2. Brakes APPLY STEADY PRESSURE (Release momentarily if skidding occurs.) 3. Wing Flaps UP 4. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 5. Mixture CUTOFF 6. Fuel Selector OFF 7. Ignition Switch OFF 8. Left and Right Master Switches OFF ENGINE FAILURE IMMEDIATELY AFTER TAKEOFF (Below 400 Feet AGL) 1. Airspeed 108 KIAS (with flaps in the up position)* 95 KIAS (with flaps in the takeoff position)* 2. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 3. Mixture CUTOFF 4. Fuel Selector OFF 5. Ignition Switch OFF 6. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION (If airspeed and height above the ground permit full extension of flaps. Otherwise, the maximum flap extension practicable should be used depending on airspeed and height above the ground.) 7. Left and Right Master Switches OFF *Obtain this airspeed if altitude permits; otherwise lower the nose, maintain current airspeed, and land straight ahead. ENGINE FAILURE DURING FLIGHT 1. Airspeed BEST GLIDE (108 KIAS with flaps up) 2. Vapor Suppression ON 3. Mixture FULL RICH 4. Fuel Selector SWITCH TANKS 5. Heated Induction Air ON 6. Ignition Switch VERIFY SET TO R/L 7. Backup Fuel Pump ARM 7.1. Engine Does Not Restart 7.1.1. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 7.1.2. Throttle HALF WAY OUT 7.1.3. Mixture FULL LEAN THEN RICHEN UNTIL ENGINE STARTS 7.1.4. Engine Does Not Restart PERFORM FORCED LANDING CHECKLIST 8. Engine Restarts PERFORM PROCEDURES AFTER AN ENGINE RESTART CHECKLIST LOSS OF OIL PRESSURE 8. Oil Temperature CHECK WITHIN PROPER RANGES 170 to 220F (77 to 104 C) If oil temperature is within operating range LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE 8.1. 8.2. If oil temperature is above the operating range 8.2.1. Throttle REDUCE to the minimum required power 8.2.2. LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE 8.2.3. BE PREPARED FOR LOSS OF ENGINE POWER AND PREPARE FOR AN EMERGENCY LANDING PROCEDURES AFTER AN ENGINE RESTART RC050005 3-4 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

1. Airspeed APPROPRIATE TO THE SITUATION 2. Throttle MINIMUM FOR LEVEL FLIGHT AT SAFE SPEED (Until the engine warms up.) 3. Failure Analysis DETERMINE CAUSE (Proceed to 3.1, 3.2, or 3.3 as applicable.) 3.1. Improper Fuel Management If the engine failure cause is improper fuel management, set the backup fuel pump to OFF, adjust power and mixture as necessary, and resume flight. 3.2. Engine Driven Fuel Pump Failure If fuel management is correct, failure of the engine driven fuel pump or a clogged fuel filter is probable. If practicable, reduce power to 75% or less and land as soon as possible. Do not set the mixture to full rich for descent or landing. Refer to the amplified discussion on page 3-16. 3.3. Improper Mixture Setting If fuel management is correct and the engine driven fuel pump is working properly, it is possible the mixture is either too lean or too rich. If above 15,000 ft, it is likely the mixture is too rich and may need to be leaned. If below 15,000 ft, the mixture may be too lean and should be richened.
WARNING If the backup fuel pump is in use during an emergency, proper leaning procedures are important. During the descent and approach to landing phases of the flight, DO NOT set the mixture to full rich as prescribed in the normal before landing procedures, and avoid closing the throttle completely. If a balked landing is necessary, coordinate the simultaneous application of mixture and throttle. Please see the amplified discussion on page 3-16. FORCED LANDING (ENGINE OUT OR PARTIAL POWER) 1. Glide 1.1. Airspeed BEST GLIDE (Figure 3 - 4) 1.2. Propeller ControlFULL AFT 1.3. Wing FlapsUP 1.4. RadioTRANSMIT MAYDAY (121.5. Give estimated position and intentions.) 1.5. Transponder SQUAWK 7700 1.6. ELTACTIVATE (If off airport.) 1.7. Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses FASTENED AND SECURE 1.8. Loose objects SECURE 1.9. Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression OFF 2. Landing 2.1. Mixture IDLE CUTOFF (If the engine is developing partial power, delay this as long as possible.) 2.2. Fuel Selector OFF 2.3. Ignition Switch OFF 2.4. Wing Flaps (When landing is assured.) AS REQUIRED (Full flaps recommended for landing.) 2.5. SpeedBrake Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION 2.6. Left and Right Master Switches OFF 2.7. Landing Flare INITIATE AT APPROPRIATE POINT TO ARREST DESCENT RATE, AND TOUCHDOWN AT NORMAL LANDING SPEEDS 2.8. Stopping APPLY HEAVY BRAKING

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-5

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

WARNING Two special conditions associated with forced landings are specifically applicable to the Columbia 400 (and are different from many other General Aviation airplanes). These differences must be clearly understood. 1. Because the trim tabs and flaps are electrically operated, setting the master switches to OFF should be delayed until the pilot is certain that further use of the trim, particularly the elevator trim, and the flaps are not required. Do not open the cabin doors in flight. The air loads placed on the doors in flight will damage them and can cause separation from the airplane. A damaged or separated door will alter the flight characteristics of the airplane and possibly damage other control surfaces.

2.

PRECAUTIONARY LANDING WITH ENGINE POWER 1. Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses FASTENED AND SECURE 2. Loose Objects SECURE 3. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF POSITION 4. Airspeed 95 to 105 KIAS 5. Select a landing area FLY OVER AREA (Determine the wind direction and survey the terrain. Note obstructions and most suitable landing area. Climb to approximately 1000 feet above ground level (AGL), and retract flaps when at a safe altitude and airspeed. Set up a normal traffic pattern for a landing into the wind.) 6. Avionics Master Switch OFF 7. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION (When on final approach.) 8. Airspeed 80 KIAS 9. Left and Right Master Switches OFF (Just before touchdown.) 10. Landing LAND AS SLOW AS PRACTICABLE IN A NOSE UP ATTITUDE 11. Mixture IDLE CUTOFF 12. Ignition Switch OFF 13. Stopping APPLY HEAVY BRAKING ENGINE DRIVEN FUEL PUMP (EDFP) PARTIAL FAILURE (Fuel pressure too high to activate backup pump. Intermittent power No fuel pump annunciation) 1. Vapor Suppression ON 2. Backup Fuel Pump ARMED 3. Throttle FULL OPEN 4. Primer Button ENGAGE AND DISENGAGE (If holding in the primer switch restores fuel flow/power, the partial EDFP failure is confirmed. Release the switch and proceed to Step 5.) 5. Mixture TOWARDS IDLE CUTOFF (At a fuel pressure of 5.5 psi, the backup pump should engage, which will restore fuel flow and engine power.) 6. Mixture TOWARDS RICH (Degree of richness depends on altitude; see Chapter 5.) DITCHING 1. Radio TRANSMIT MAYDAY (121.5. Give estimated position and intentions.) 2. Loose Objects SECURE 3. Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses FASTENED AND SECURE 4. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION 5. SpeedBrake Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION 6. Descent ESTABLISH MINIMUM DESCENT (Set airspeed to 87 KIAS, and use power to establish minimum descent, 200 feet/minute. See 8.2 below for landings without power.) RC050005 3-6 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

7. Approach In high winds and heavy swell conditions, approach into the wind. In light winds and heavy swell conditions, approach parallel to the swell. If no swells exist, approach into the wind. 8. Touchdown Alternatives 8.1. Touchdown (Engine power available) Maintain minimum descent attitude. Apply power to slow or stop descent if necessary. When over a suitable touchdown area, reduce power and slowly settle into the water in a nose up attitude near the stalling speed. 8.2. Touchdown (No engine power available) Use an 80 to 85 KIAS approach speed down to the flare-out point, and then glide momentarily to get a feel for the surface. Allow the airplane to settle into the water in a nose up attitude near the stalling speed. 9. Evacuation of Airplane Evacuate the airplane through the pilot or passenger doors. It may be necessary to allow some cabin flooding to equalize pressure on the doors. If the pilot or passenger doors are inoperative, use the crash ax/hatchet (located below the front seat on the pilots side) to break either window on the main cabin doors. For more information see the Crash Ax discussion on page 3-28. 10. Flotation Devices DEPLOY FLOTATION DEVICES
NOTE Over glassy smooth water, or at night without sufficient light, even experienced pilots can misjudge altitude by 50 feet or more. Under such conditions, carry enough power to maintain a nose up attitude at 10 to 20 percent above stalling speed until the airplane makes contact with the water. NOTE In situations that require electrical system shutdown under poor ambient light conditions, cabin illumination is available through use of the overhead flip lights. The flip lights are connected directly to the battery and will operate provided there is adequate battery power. ENGINE FIRE ON THE GROUND DURING STARTUP If flames are observed in the induction or exhaust system, use the following procedures. 1. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 2. Mixture CUTOFF 3. Fuel Selector OFF 4. Throttle FULL OPEN 5. Ignition Switch HOLD IN START POSITION (Until fire is extinguished.) 6. Parking Brake RELEASE (If the parking brake is engaged.) 7. Fire Extinguisher OBTAIN FROM CABIN AND EVACUATE AIRPLANE 8. Follow-up If fire is present, extinguish it. Inspect for damage and make the appropriate repairs or replacements. NOTE Sometimes a fire will occur on the ground because of improper starting procedures. If circumstances permit, move the airplane away from the ground fire by pushing aft on the horizontal stabilizer, and then extinguish the ground fire. This must only be attempted if the ground fire is small and sufficient ground personnel are present to move the airplane. ENGINE FIRE IN FLIGHT 1. Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression OFF 2. Mixture OFF Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 3-7

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Fuel Selector OFF Throttle CLOSED Ignition Switch OFF Heating System OFF Propeller Control FULL AFT Right Master Switch OFF (Left master ON for Comm/Nav and PFD.) Airspeed 170 to 180 KIAS (If fire is not extinguished at this speed, increase speed to a level that extinguishes the fire if sufficient altitude exists.) 10. Landing PERFORM FORCED LANDING CHECKLIST 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
ELECTRICAL FIRE IN FLIGHT 1. All Heating and Ventilating Controls ON 2. Left and Right Master Switches OFF 3. Oxygen System OFF (On MFD System page, altitude permittingsee discussion on page 3-20.) 4. Guarded Oxygen Manual Valve OFF 5. A/P Trim System Switch on Overhead OFF 6. Fire Extinguisher DISCHARGE IN AREA OF THE FIRE 7. Post Fire Details OPEN VENTILATION (If fire is extinguished.) 8. Phased System Power-upDetermine if electrical power is necessary for the safe continuation of the flight. If it is required, proceed with items 9 and 10 below. 9. Avionics Master Switch OFF 10. Left and Right Master Switches ON 11. Flight LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE. CABIN FIRE IN FLIGHT (Fuel/Hydraulic Fluid) 1. All Heating and Ventilating Controls ON 2. Left and Right Master Switches OFF 3. Fuel Selector OFF 4. Oxygen Switch OFF (On MFD System page, altitude permittingsee discussion on page 3-20.) 5. Guarded Oxygen Manual Valve OFF (on overhead) 6. Fire Extinguisher DISCHARGE IN AREA OF THE FIRE 7. When Fire is Extinguished VENTILATE CABIN (Turn on master switch, cabin fan, open ventilation, and deactivate door seals.) 8. Landing PERFORM FORCED LANDING CHECKLIST WARNING The fire extinguishing substance is toxic, and the fumes must not be inhaled for extended periods. After discharging the extinguisher, the cabin must be ventilated. If oxygen is available, put masks on and start oxygen flow. Oxygen must only be used after it is determined that the fire is extinguished. WING FIRE IN FLIGHT 1. Pitot Heat Switch OFF 2. Strobe and Position Lights OFF 3. Landing and Taxi Lights OFF 4. Flight Action Do not perform a sideslip. A sideslip will vent fuel from the low wing or direct flames towards the fuselage. Land the airplane as soon as possible. Use wing flaps only if essential for a safe landing.

RC050005 3-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

SPIN RECOVERY 1. Throttle IDLE 2. Rudder FULL AGAINST THE SPIN 3. Elevator FULL FORWARD 4. Ailerons FULL AGAINST THE SPIN 5. Wing Flaps RETRACT (When rotation stops.) 6. Flight Action When rotation stops, neutralize controls, then pull out of steep dive to achieve normal attitude. Pulling out of the dive will produce 2 to 3 gs and airspeeds up to 160 KIAS. WARNING Recovery from a spin may require up to one additional turn with normal use of controls for recovery. WARNING If a steady state spin is entered, holding the recommended recovery inputs of power idle, rudder full against the spin, elevator full forward and aileron full against the spin will produce the fastest recovery. When recovering from a steady state spin, the aircraft may exceed the typical one turn recovery time, and additional turns may be experienced until the aircraft recovers from the spin. INADVERTENT ICING 1. Detection CHECK SURFACES (The stall strips and wing cuffs are good inspection points for evidence of structural icing.) 2. Pitot Heat and Propeller Heat ON 3. Course REVERSE COURSE 4. Altitude CHANGE (To a level where the temperature is above freezing.) 5. Defroster Divert all heated air to the defroster. 6. Propeller Control INCREASE (Higher propeller speeds will mitigate ice accumulation.) 7. Manifold Pressure MONITOR (A drop in manifold pressure may be an indication of induction icing; increase throttle settings as required.) 8. Heated Induction Air ON (Operate if induction icing is evident or suspected.) 9. Alternate Static Source (Open if static source icing is evident or suspected.) 10. Flight Characteristics ADD MARGIN OF SAFETY (An ice buildup on the wings and other surfaces will increase stalling speeds. Add a margin to approach and landing speeds.) 11. Approach Speed Appropriate for the amount of ice accumulation and flap setting. If there is a heavy ice buildup on the windshield, a gentle forward slip or small S-turns may improve forward visibility by allowing use of the side windows. 12. Landing Attitude LIMITED FLARE (Land at a higher speed and in a flat attitude sufficient to prevent the nose wheel from touching the ground first.) WARNING When flying in areas where inadvertent icing is possible, i.e., areas of visible moisture that are not forecasted to have icing conditions, turn on the pitot heat at least five minutes before entering the areas of visible moisture. LANDING WITH A FLAT MAIN GEAR TIRE 1. Approach NORMAL 2. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION 3. Touchdown Land on the side of the runway corresponding to the good tire. Touch down on the inflated tire first and maintain full aileron deflection towards the good tire, keeping the flat Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007 RC050005 3-9

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

4.

tire off the ground for as long as possible. Be prepared for abnormal yaw in the direction of the flat tire. Taxiing Do not attempt to taxi. Stop the aircraft and perform a normal engine shutdown.

LANDING WITH A FLAT NOSE TIRE 1. Approach NORMAL 2. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION 3. Touchdown Touch down on the main landing gear tires first. Maintain sufficient back elevator deflection to keep the nose tire off the ground for as long as possible. 4. Taxiing Do not attempt to taxi. Stop the aircraft and perform a normal engine shutdown. SPEEDBRAKE SYSTEM MALFUNCTION 1. SpeedBrakeTM Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION 2. SpeedBrakeTM Circuit Breaker PULL NOTE If the SpeedBrake System should malfunction or perform improperly, do not attempt to identify or analyze the problem. If the malfunction results in an abnormal change in the pitch and/or roll axis, immediately regain control of the airplane by the input of control forces that override the SpeedBrake failure(s). Do not, under any circumstances, re-engage a SpeedBrake System that has malfunctioned until the problem is corrected. ELECTRICAL SYSTEM OVERCHARGING* (Both alternators stay on-line, ammeter shows excessive charge, and voltmeter has high voltage indication.) 1. Defective Alternator Switch OFF 2. Crosstie Switch ON 3. Flight If the electrical system is restored, continue with flight. If the electrical system is not restored, land as soon as practicable. *NOTE The voltage regulator will trip the alternator off-line in conditions of over voltage, i.e., greater than 31.0 volts. If this happens the annunciation window on the PFD will indicate the alternator is out. The most likely cause is transitory spikes or surges tripped the alternator off-line. ALTERNATOR FAILUREELECTRICAL SYSTEM DISCHARGING (Ammeter shows a discharging condition on the left or right bus, and the PFD annunciations window displays L Alt Off or R Alt Off) 1. Crosstie Switch OFF 2. Affected Alternator Master Switch CYCLE OFF THEN ON 3. Alternator Annunciation Message (Follow either step 3.1 or 3.2 below) 3.1. Alternators Annunciation Message Clears If after recycling the system, the alternator annunciation message clears, proceed with normal operations. 3.2. Alternator Annunciation Remains Displayed If after recycling the system the alternator annunciation message remains displayed or trips the alternator off-line again, follow steps 4 - 6 below. 4. Affected Alternator Master Switch OFF 5. Crosstie Switch ON
TM

RC050005 3-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

6. Good Alternator ENSURE PROPER OPERATION (If the Alt Off message is displayed, reduce loads or increase RPM until the annunciation clears and the batteries are in a charging state.) 7. Electrical System If the electrical system is not restored, land as soon as practicable.
LEFT OR RIGHT BUS FAILURE/CROSSTIE DISCHARGES WORKING BUS (Activating the crosstie switch causes the current sensor of the working bus to discharge significantly, e.g., the left bus was showing a positive charge prior to activating the crosstie switch.) 1. Crosstie Switch OFF 2. Master Switch of the failed bus OFF 3. Review the following table for items that are on the failed bus and make appropriate allowances. ITEMS UNAVAILABLE WITH A BUS FAILURE Left Bus Items Right Bus Items

Aileron Trim Pitot Heat SpeedBrakes Position Lights Landing Light Left Voltage Regulator Fan

Strobe Lights Taxi Light Right Voltage Regulator Door Seal/Power Point Carbon Monoxide Detector Oxygen Display Keypad Air Conditioning

4. Depending on which bus failed (left or right) and the dictates of the current conditions, i.e., day, night, IMC, VMC, land the airplane as soon as practicable or possible.
ELECTRIC TRIM/AUTOPILOT FAILURE (sudden and unexplained changes in control stick force.) 1. Flight MANUALLY CONTROL THE AIRCRAFT 2. Red Autopilot Disconnect/Trim Interrupt Button on Control Stick PRESS 3. A/P Trim System Switch in Overhead OFF 4. Power Settings REDUCE TO 50% BHP OR LESS (Or to a setting that relieves forces.) 5. Airspeed 100 to 110 KIAS (Or to speed that relieves forces.) 6. Circuit Breakers PULL AS REQUIRED 7. Flight TERMINATE AS SOON AS PRACTICABLE OR POSSIBLE (This depends on the magnitude of control force(s) required to maintain a normal flight attitude.) 8. Landing PREPARE FOR CONTROL FORCE CHANGES (When power is reduced and airspeed is reduced, there can be substantial changes in the required control pressures.) WARNING In a runaway trim emergency the two most important considerations are to (1) IMMEDIATELY turn off the trim system and (2) maintain control of the airplane. The airplane will not maintain level flight and/or proper directional control without pilot input to the affected flight control(s). If excessive control force is required to maintain level flight, land as soon as possible. Pilot fatigue can be increased significantly in this situation with the potential for making the landing difficult.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-11

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

PARTIAL RESTORATION OF A DISABLED TRIM SYSTEM 1. A/P Trim System Switch in Overhead ON 2. Malfunction Analysis DETERMINE AXIS OF MALFUNCTION 3. Circuit Breaker(s) SET PROPERLY FUNCTIONING AXIS BREAKER TO ON MALFUNCTION OF AUTOPILOT 1. Flight MANUALLY CONTROL THE AIRCRAFT 2. Autopilot Disconnect Switch on Control Stick PRESS (If the autopilot does not disconnect proceed to step 3.) 3. Pitch Trim Switch MOVE (If the autopilot does not disconnect proceed to step 4.) 4. A/P Trim System Switch on Overhead OFF (If the autopilot does not disconnect proceed to step 5.) 5. Circuit Breaker PULL BREAKER TO THE OFF POSITION MALFUNCTION OF AUTOPILOT AUTOTRIM 1. Flight MANUALLY CONTROL AIRCRAFT AND DISCONNECT THE AUTOPILOT 2. Manual Electric Trim (MET) VERIFY PROPER OPERATION WITH TRIM SWITCH ON CONTROL STICK. IF MET OPERATES IMPROPERLY, PERFORM STEP 3. 3. AP Switch on MFD SET TO OFF TO DISABLE THE SYSTEM MALFUNCTION OF RUDDER HOLD SYSTEM 1. Rudder Hold Stuck and cant be Overridden MAINTAIN AIRSPEED BETWEEN 90 AND 110 KIAS. APPLY APPROXIMATELY 90 LBS FORCE TO A PEDAL (RIGHT PEDAL RECOMMENDED) UNTIL THE SHEAR PIN BREAKS. 2. Flight MANUALLY CONTROL AIRCRAFT. BROKEN OR STUCK THROTTLE CABLE (With enough power for continued flight.) 1. Continued Flight LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE 2. Airport Selection ADEQUATE FOR POWER OFF APPROACH 3. Descent CONTROL WITH PROPELLER CONTROL 4. Fuel Selector SET TO FULLER TANK 5. Approach Airspeed 93 KIAS (With flaps in the up position) 90 KIAS (With flaps in the landing position) 6. Seat Belts FASTENED AND SECURE 7. Loose Objects SECURE 8. Wing FlapsAS REQUIRED (Full flaps should be extended only when reaching the runway is assured.) 9. Mixture (Reaching the runway is assured.) IDLE CUTOFF 10. Touchdown MAIN WHEELS FIRST, GENTLY LOWER NOSE WHEEL 11. Braking AS REQUIRED OXYGEN SYSTEM MALFUNCTION 1. Oxygen System OFF THEN ON (On MFD System page.) 2. Guarded Oxygen Manual Valve OFF THEN ON 3. Flow Meters VERIFY FLOW TO BREATHING DEVICES 4. If no oxygen flowing: 4.1. Descend 12,500 ft or below (In a safe and controlled manner.) 4.2. Oxygen Switch OFF (On MFD System page.) CARBON MONOXIDE DETECTION (When optional CO detector is installed, annunciation displays, and aural warning sounds.) 1. System Softkey on the MFD PRESS 2. CO RST Softkey PRESS (If alert continues go to step 3.) RC050005 3-12 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

3. 4. 5. 6. 7.

Heater OFF Vents ON Airspeed INCREASE TO GREATER THAN 120 KIAS Oxygen DON (If installed.) Flight LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE
NOTE The red annunciation will stay displayed until the CO level drops below 50 ppm. Do not recycle the unit through the circuit breaker, as there is a three minute delay for the CO sensor to stabilize.

SOMETHING STUCK IN OR INTERFERING WITH A DOOR JAMB 1. Affected Door DO NOT OPEN THE DOOR IN FLIGHT WARNING Do not open any of the airplane doors in flight. The doors are not designed to be opened in flight; subsequent airloads on an opened door will forcefully pull it completely open and detach it from the airplane.

2. Flight LAND AS SOON AS PRACTICABLE


EVACUATING THE AIRPLANE 1. Seat BeltsREMOVE (Do not remove seat belts until the airplane comes to a complete stop, unless there is a compelling reason to do otherwise. If the onset of the emergency is anticipated, ensure the seat belt is as tight as possible. See discussion on page 3-27.) 2. DoorsUSE BOTH IF POSSIBLE AND REQUIRED (Do not open doors in flight.) 3. Crash AxUSE AS REQUIRED (If the cabin doors are inoperable, break out a cabin door window. See crash ax discussion on page 3-28.) 4. Exiting the AirplaneAS APPROPRIATE (If possible, use both doors. Generally, it is best to go aft unless there are compelling reasons to do otherwise. See discussion on page 3-27.) 5. AssistanceAS APPROPRIATE (If possible, necessary, and not life threatening, render assistance to others in the airplane.) 6. Congregating Point DESIGNATE (Pilot and passengers should have a designated congregating point, say 100 feet aft of the airplane.)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 3-13

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL Many of the above emergency procedures involve resetting or pulling circuit breakers, which requires a good understanding of the panels location and layout. The circuit breaker panel is located forward of the pilots front seat on the lower side-panel. A picture of the circuit breaker panel and a table listing each circuit breaker is provided in Figure 3 - 2. See Figure 7 18 on page 7-43 for a diagram of the electrical system.

Essential Essential Left Bus Right Bus Avionics

PFD Panel Lights Position Lights Strobe Lights Audio Mkr

AHRS Landing Lights Taxi Lights Integ Avion 2

ADC L Bus Relays Left Volt Reg Right Volt Reg Com 2

Engine Airframe Fuel Pump Speed Brakes Avionics Fan

Integ Com 1 Avion 1 Stall Warn Flaps Fan Xpnder

Stby ADI R Bus Relays Rudder Hold Disp Keypad Traffic Elv Trim Aileron Trim CO Detect Autopilot Pitot Heat MFD Door Seal P/P Weather

Note 1: A indicates that the circuit breaker position is unused but reserved for future optional equipment. Note 2: The actual arrangement may vary slightly depending on the optional equipment installed.

Figure 3 - 2

RC050005 3-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

AMPLIFIED EMERGENCY PROCEDURES


ENGINE FAILURE AND FORCED LANDINGS General The most important thing in any emergency is to maintain control of the airplane. If an engine failure occurs during the takeoff run, the primary consideration is to safely stop the airplane in the remaining available runway. The throttle is reduced first to prevent momentary surging of the engine. Raising the flaps reduces lift, which improves ground friction and facilitates braking. In emergencies involving loss of power, it is important to minimize fire potential, which includes shutting down or closing the electrical and fuel systems. Engine Failure After Takeoff (Below 400 feet AGL) With an engine failure immediately after takeoff, time is of the essence. The most important consideration in this situation is to maintain the proper airspeed. The airplane will be in a climb attitude and when the engine fails, airspeed decays rapidly. Therefore, the nose must be lowered immediately and a proper glide speed established according to Figure 3 - 3. It may not be possible to accelerate to the best distance glide speed due to altitude limitations. In this instance, lower the nose, maintain current airspeed, and land straight ahead.

It is unlikely there will be enough altitude to do any significant maneuvering; only gentle turns left or right to avoid obstructions should be attempted. If there are no obstructions, it is best to land straight ahead unless there is a significant crosswind component. Flaps should be applied if airspeed and altitude permit since they can provide a 10+ knot reduction in landing speed.
Engine Failure After Takeoff (Above 400 feet AGL) With an engine failure after takeoff, there may be time to employ modified restarting procedures. Still, the most important consideration in this situation is to maintain the proper airspeed. The airplane will be in a climb attitude and when the engine fails, airspeed decays rapidly. Therefore, the nose must be lowered immediately and a proper glide speed established according to Figure 3 - 3. It may not be possible to accelerate to the best distance glide speed due to altitude limitations. In this instance, lower the nose, maintain current airspeed, and land straight ahead. In-Flight Engine Failure The extra time afforded by altitude may permit some diagnosis of the situation. The first item is to establish the proper rate of descent at the best glide speed for the situation, as shown in Figure 3 - 3. If altitude and other factors permit, an engine restart should be attempted. The checklist items 2 through 7, Engine Failure During Flight, on page 3-4, ensure that the fuel supply and ignition are available. The most likely cause of engine failure is poor fuel management. The two more frequent errors are forgetting to change the fuel selector or, during an extended descent, failure to readjust the mixture. Best Distance Glide (Most Distance) Min. Rate Glide (Min. rate of descent)

Gross Weight 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 2700 lbs. (1224 kg)

KIAS 108 96 Figure 3 - 3

KIAS 87 82

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-15

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Best Glide Speed Versus Minimum Rate of Descent Speed The best distance glide speed will provide the most distance covered over the ground for a given altitude loss, while the minimum rate of descent speed, as its name suggests, will provide the least altitude lost in a given time period. The best distance glide speed might be used in situations where a pilot, with an engine failure but several thousand feet above the ground, is attempting to reach a distant airport. The minimum rate of descent could be used in a situation when the pilot is over the desired landing spot and wishes to maximize the time aloft for checklists and restart procedures. Emergency Backup Fuel Pump The backup fuel pump is intended for use during an emergency situation when failure of the engine driven pump has occurred. The switch that controls this operation is on the flap panel. The labeling on the switch reads BACKUP PUMP ARMED. The switch is normally in the ARMED position for takeoff and climb to cruise altitude and in the OFF position for cruise, descent, and approach to landing. The top of the switch is engraved with the word OFF and is readable only when the switch is off.

If the engine driven pump malfunctions, ensure the backup fuel pump is in the ARMED position, and the backup fuel pump will turn on automatically when the fuel pressure is less than about 5.5 psi. This condition will also activate a yellow caution message FUEL PUMP in the PFD annunciation window and an associated aural message FUEL PUMP ON. There may be degradation in the smoothness of engine operation as well. With the backup pump operating, fuel is not as precisely metered, compared to the normal engine driven system, and frequent mixture adjustments are necessary when changes are made to the power settings. In particular, avoid large power changes, since an over-rich or over-lean mixture will affect the proper operation of the engine. With a failed engine driven pump, full power should be available, but power should be reduced below 85% as soon as practical. In the unlikely event of an engine driven fuel pump failure and a backup fuel pump relay failure, the primer switch may be held down to effectively restore fuel flow. In general, as power is reduced below the 75% of BHP level, there must be a corresponding leaning of the mixture. On an approach to landing, the normal checklist procedures must be modified to exclude setting the mixture to full rich. It is best to make a partial power approach with full flaps, and only reduce power when over the runway. If a balked landing is necessary, coordinate the simultaneous application of mixture and throttle. At power settings above the 85% level, the engine will operate with a very lean mixture. At full throttle, the engine will produce approximately 100% of its rated BHP. In this situation, the fuel-air mixture is lean of peak, and higher cylinder head temperatures and TIT readings will result from extended use in the condition. Full throttle operations must be kept to a minimum and only used to clear an obstacle, execute a balked landing, or other similar situations that require use of all available power.
Critical Issues (Backup Fuel Pump) One of the more critical times for an engine driven fuel pump failure is when the engine is at idle power, such as a descent for landing. There are two reasons that make this situation more serious compared with other flight phases. (1) The airplane is more likely to be at a lower altitude, which limits time for detection, analysis, and corrective measures. (2) With the engine at idle power, there is no aural indication of engine stoppage. If the engine failure is a result of fuel starvation with a fuel pressure less than 5.5 psi, then the FUEL PUMP message in the PFD annunciation window will provide a visual indication.

There is a latching relay that basically controls the logic of the system. For example, it turns the backup pump on, when the backup boost switch is in the ARMED position and the fuel pressure drops below 5.5 psi. Moreover, if the backup system is automatically turned on while the vapor suppression is on, it will suspend operation of the vapor suppression. Most functions in the system are integrated with the latching relay, and failure of this relay will result in failure of the system.
RC050005 3-16 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

However, the FUEL PUMP message is independent of this system and will operate anytime the fuel pressure is less than 5.5 psi. In a situation involving a double failure, i.e., a malfunction of the engine driven pump and the latching relay, the FUEL PUMP message will be displayed. Since the primer and backup fuel pump are one and the same, the pilot can bypass the latching relay by holding the primer switch in the depressed position. In this particular situation, this would restore engine power and permit continuation of the flight and a landing, which must be done as soon as possible. Of course, the pilot must continually depress the primer switch, which increases the cockpit workload.
CAUTION Do not shut down an engine for practice or training purposes. If engine failure is to be simulated, it shall be done by reducing power. A few minutes of exposure to temperatures and airspeeds at flight altitudes can have the same effect on an inoperative engine as hours of cold-soaking in sub-Arctic conditions.
Gliding Distance (Zero Wind Best Distance Glide)
14000

12000

10000

Altitude (FT)

8000

6000

4000

2000

0 0 5 10 15 20 25

Ground Distance (NM)

Propeller control pulled to low rpm, flaps up, 108 KIAS, L/Dmax = 13/1

Figure 3 - 4
Engine Restarts If the engine restarts, two special issues must be considered: (1) If the airplane was in a glide for an extended period of time at cold ambient air temperatures, the engine should be operated at lower RPM settings for a few minutes until the oil and cylinder temperatures return to normal ranges if possible. (2) If the engine failure is not related to pilot error, i.e., poor fuel management or failure to enrich the mixture during a long descent from a high altitude, then a landing should be made as soon as possible to determine the cause of the engine failure. Engine Does Not Restart If the engine does not restart, then a forced landing without power must be completed as detailed earlier in this section on page 3-5, Forced Landing (Engine Out or Partial Power). Maintaining the best distance glide speed provides the maximum distance over the ground with the least altitude loss. The preceding graph Figure 3 - 4 provides information on ground distance covered for a given height above the ground. Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 3-17

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Forced Landing with the Throttle Stuck in the Idle Position If the throttle is stuck at idle or near idle power, then a forced landing must be performed. The procedures are somewhat similar to those associated with a complete power loss. However, powerplant shutdown should be delayed as long as safely practicable since the stuck throttle may be spontaneously cured. Changes in altitude, temperature, and other atmospheric conditions associated with the descent may combine to alleviate the stuck throttle condition. On the other hand, the problem could be the result of a broken throttle cable, which has no immediate cure. Regardless of the cause, the pilot lacks both the time and resources to properly analyze the cause. Running the engine until the last practicable moment, within the confines of safety, is the most prudent course of action.

It is possible that the throttle may stick at a power setting that is above idle, but at insufficient brake horsepower to sustain level flight. At the same time, this condition may restrict the desired rate of descent. In this situation, the pilot can use the propeller control to control power.
Stuck Throttle with Sufficient Power to Sustain Flight If the throttle sticks at a power setting that produces enough power for continued flight then a landing should be made as soon as possible. Power may be partially controlled with the use of the mixture control or propeller (RPM) control. If the airplane is near the ground, climb to an altitude that provides a greater margin of safety, provided there is sufficient power to do so. Do not begin the descent for landing until the airplane is near or over the airport. Again, as mentioned in the previous paragraph, the pilot can set the mixture control to idle cutoff to momentarily stop the operation of the engine. If cylinder head temperatures fall below 240, restart the engine as necessary by enriching the mixture. A checklist for a stuck throttle condition that will sustain flight is discussed on page 3-12. FLIGHT CONTROLS MALFUNCTIONS General The elevator and aileron controls are actuated by pushrods, which provide direct positive response to the input of control pressures. The rudder is actuated by cable controls. The pushrod system makes the likelihood of a control failure in the roll and pitch axis remote. Aileron or Rudder Failure The failure of the rudder or ailerons does not impose a critical situation since control around either the vertical and longitudinal axes can still be approximately maintained with either control surface. Plan a landing as soon as practicable on a runway that minimizes the crosswind component. Remember that the skidding and slipping maneuvers inherent in such an approach will increase the airplanes stall speed, and a margin for safety should be added to the approach airspeed. Elevator Failure In the event of a failure of the elevator control system, the airplane can be controlled and landed using the elevator trim tab. The airplane should be landed as soon as possible with priority given to an airport with a long runway. En route, establish horizontal flight at 65% to 75% power. When within 15 miles of the landing airport, slow to 120 KIAS, set the flaps to the takeoff position, and establish a timed shallow descent. If possible, make a straight in approach to landing adjusting the descent with power. On final approach, set the flaps to the landing position and re-trim the airplane to a 500 fpm descent at about 80 KIAS. Do not make further adjustment to the elevator trim, and avoid excessive power adjustments. On the final approach to landing, make small power changes to control the descent. Do not reduce power suddenly at the flare-out point as this will cause an excessive nose down change and may cause the airplane to land on the nose wheel first. At the flare-out point, coordinate the reduction of power with the full nose-up application of elevator trim.

RC050005 3-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

TRIM TAB MALFUNCTIONS The airplane has two axis electrically powered trim tabs. There is an autopilot/trim system on/off switch located on the right side of the overhead rocker switch panel, which turns off power to the actuators in both axes and the autopilot. If a runaway trim condition is encountered in flight, characterized by sudden and unexplained changes in control forces, the red autopilot disconnect/trim interrupt button must be depressed and held and the autopilot/trim system switch must immediately be set to the OFF position. If the pilot wishes to restore part of the systems trim, the following procedure should be used.

1. 2. 3. 4.

After the trim system switch has been set to OFF, the trim circuit breakers (elevator and aileron) should be pulled to the OFF position. Turn the autopilot/trim system switch to the ON position. Based on the forces experienced during the trim runaway, determine which tab is least likely to have caused the runaway and which tab is most likely to have caused the runaway. Set the circuit breakers least likely to have caused the runaway to the ON position. The pilot should be prepared to set the autopilot/trim system switch to the OFF position in the event the diagnosis is incorrect and the faulty trim actuator is brought back on line. In most situations, the pilot should be able to easily determine which trim axis experienced the runaway condition.
WARNING In a runaway trim emergency the two most important considerations are to (1) IMMEDIATELY press and hold the red autopilot disconnect/trim interrupt button on the stick and turn off the trim system and (2) maintain control of the airplane. The airplane will not maintain level flight and/or proper directional control without pilot input to the affected flight control(s). If excessive control force is required to maintain level flight, the flight must be terminated as soon as possible. Pilot fatigue can increase significantly in this situation with the potential for making the landing more difficult.

The left bus supplies the power to the aileron actuator motor, and the essential bus supplies the power to the elevator actuator motor. In the event of a power failure, the trim tabs will not operate, and the settings in place before the failure will be maintained until power is restored. Flight under these conditions or during a trim runaway condition should not impose a significant problem. Atypical control forces will be required and the flight should be terminated as soon as possible or practicable (depending on flight conditions) to mitigate pilot fatigue. Remember that during touchdown, when power is reduced and airspeed decays, there can be substantial changes in the required control forces.
FIRES General Fires in flight (either engine, electrical, or cabin) are inherently more critical; however, the likelihood of such an occurrence is extremely rare. The onset of an in-flight fire can, to some degree, be forestalled through diligent monitoring of the engine instruments and vigilance for suspicious odors. Fires on the ground can be mitigated through proper starting techniques, particularly when the engine is very cold. Engine Fires The most common engine fires occur on the ground and are usually the result of improper starting procedures. The immoderate use of the primer pump is a primary reason since this causes engine flooding. In situations of extensive primer pump use, the excess fuel drains from the intake ports and puddles on the ground. If this happens, the aircraft should be moved away from the puddle. Otherwise, the potential exists for the exhaust system to ignite the fuel puddle on the ground. Inadvertent engine flooding is likely during situations where the engine has been cold-soaked at temperatures below 25F (-4C) for over two hours. See cold weather operations on page 4-30.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 3-19

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Cabin Fires Follow the manufacturers instructions for use of the fire extinguisher. For more information on using the fire extinguisher see the discussion on page 7-53. Once a cabin fire is extinguished, it is important to ventilate the cabin as soon as possible. The residual smoke and toxins from the fire extinguisher must not be inhaled for extended periods. The ventilation system should be operated at full volume with the cabin fan on. Deactivating the door seals enhances the ventilation process.

Oxygen should be turned off in the event of a cabin fire and only used after it is determined that the fire is extinguished. However, good pilot judgment should be used when flying at altitudes where oxygen is required to weigh the effects of lack of oxygen with the potential fire hazard. Once the fire is extinguished and if oxygen is available, put masks on and start the oxygen flow. If fire cannot be extinguished, open the guard on the oxygen system in the overhead panel, place the manual valve in the OFF position, and press the oxygen softkey on the MFD to the OFF position.
LIGHTNING STRIKE In order to prevent as much damage as possible to the electrical system, components, and avionics in the event of a lightning strike, surge protection has been built into the Columbia 400s electrical system. This surge protection comes from large MOVs (metal oxide varistor) soldered in behind the circuit breaker panel. The Columbia 400 system has one MOV on the avionics bus and one on the essential bus. The MOVs are located behind the circuit breaker panel and are not accessible by the pilot in-flight. It is imperative that after a lightning strike, the MOVs are replaced before the next flight. CAUTION After a lightning strike, the MOVs must be replaced before the next flight.

If the aircraft is struck by lightning in flight, the MOVs will have likely prevented significant damage to the electrical components. The most likely damage will be to the equipment on the extreme ends of the airplane, such as the strobe and anti-collision lights. After the lightning strike, the pilot should reset all tripped circuit breakers. If any of the circuit breakers trip off again, they should not be reset a second time. The pilot should then determine which equipment is operating properly, and adjust the flight accordingly.
ENGINE AND PROPELLER PROBLEMS Engine Roughness The most common cause of a rough running engine is an improper mixture setting. Adjust the mixture in reference to the power setting and altitude in use. Do not immediately go to a full rich setting since the roughness may be caused by too rich of a mixture. If adjusting the mixture does not correct the problem, reduce throttle until roughness becomes minimal, and perform a magneto check.

Check operations on the individual left and right magnetos. If the engine operates smoothly when operating on an individual magneto, adjust power as necessary and continue. However, do not operate the engine in this manner any longer than necessary. Land as soon as possible for determination and repair of the problem. If individual magneto operations do not improve performance, set the magneto switch to R/L, and land as soon as possible for engine repairs.
High Altitude Negative G Loading Per the TCM model specification, the TSIO-550 Series aircraft engines are not approved for continuous negative or zero g operations. Short duration negative g operations such as gust loading will have small or no effect on engine operation.

Sustained negative g loading at altitudes above 17,000 ft. may result in partial or total loss of engine power. Engine recovery may require pilot intervention by leaning the mixture to restart. Sustained negative g loading may cause the unporting of the oil pick-up tube. The resulting loss of oil pressure will allow the wastegate controller to move to the open position thereby rapidly decreasing manifold pressure at high altitude. This rapid decrease in manifold pressure can cause an overly rich mixture
RC050005 3-20 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

resulting in partial or total loss of engine power. If the engine stops running follow the procedures described on page 3-4, Engine Failure During Flight.
High Cylinder Head Temperatures High cylinder head temperatures are often caused by improper leaning at high power setting or vapor formation in the fuel lines (indicated by rising TIT). Be sure the mixture is adjusted for the power setting and altitude in use and turn vapor suppression on. Put the aircraft in a gentle descent to increase airspeed. If cylinder head temperatures cannot be maintained within the prescribed limits, land as soon as possible to have the problem evaluated and repaired. High Oil Temperature A prolonged high oil temperature indication is usually accompanied by a drop in oil pressure. If oil pressure remains normal, then the cause of the problem could be a faulty gauge or thermo-bulb. If the oil pressure drops as temperature increases, put the aircraft in a gentle descent to increase airspeed. If oil temperature does not drop after increasing airspeed, reduce power and land as soon as possible. CAUTION If the above steps do not restore oil temperature to normal, severe damage or an engine failure can result. Reduce power to idle, and select a suitable area for a forced landing. Follow the procedures described on page 3-5, Forced Landing (Engine Out or Partial Power). The use of power must be minimized and used only to reach the desired landing area. Low Oil Pressure If oil pressure drops below 30 psi at normal cruise power settings without apparent reason and the oil temperature remains normal, monitor both oil pressure and temperature closely, and land as soon as possible for evaluation and repair. If a drop in oil pressure from prescribed limits is accompanied by a corresponding excessive temperature increase, engine failure should be anticipated. Reduce power and follow the procedures described on page 3-5, Forced Landing (Engine Out or Partial Power). The use of power must be minimized and used only to reach the desired landing area. CAUTION The engine oil annunciation is set to illuminate when the oil pressure is less than 5 psi, which provides important information for ground operations. It is not designed to indicate the onset of potential problems in flight. Failure of Turbocharger Turbocharger failure may be evidenced by the inability of the engine to develop manifold air pressure above the ambient pressure. The engine will revert to normally aspirated and can be operated but will produce less than its rated horsepower. If turbocharger failure occurs before takeoff, do not fly the aircraft. If a failure occurs in flight, readjust mixture as necessary to obtain fuel flow appropriate to manifold air pressure and RPM.

An interruption in fuel flow or manifold pressure to the engine will result in turbocharger rundown. At high altitude, merely restoring fuel flow may not cause the engine to restart, because without turbocharger boost, the mixture will be excessively rich. If the engine does not fire, there will be insufficient mass flow through the exhaust to turn the turbine. This condition may lead one to suspect a turbocharger failure. Follow the procedures described on page 3-4, Engine Failure During Flight. Engine starting will be apparent by a surge of power. As the turbocharger begins to operate, manifold pressure will increase and mixture can be adjusted accordingly. If manifold pressure does not increase then the turbocharger has failed.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-21

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

WARNING If turbocharger failure is a result of a loose, disconnected or burned through exhaust, then a serious fire hazard exists. Failure of Engine Driven Fuel Pump In the event the engine driven fuel pump fails in flight or during takeoff, there is an electrically operated backup fuel pump located in the wing area. The first indication of failure of the engine driven pump is a drop in fuel flow followed by a FUEL annunciation and a loss of engine power.

The backup pump is normally in the ARMED position for takeoff and climb and will be activated if fuel pressure drops below 5.5 psi. In the cruise and descent configurations, the pump arming is normally in the OFF position. At the first indication of engine driven pump failure (fuel pump warning annunciation, low fuel pressure, or rough engine operations), set the throttle to full open, and set the backup pump switch to the ARMED position. Thereafter, it must remain in this position and a landing must be made as soon as practicable to repair the engine driven fuel pump. Please see an amplified discussion on page 3-16.
NOTE When operating at high altitudes, 15,000 MSL or above, in hot weather, it may be necessary to set the vapor suppression switch to ON. Operation of the vapor suppression will lower engine temperatures and reduce the chance of formation of vapor in the fuel lines. Operation of the vapor suppression may be required at lower altitudes when the ambient temperature is significantly above normal. Vapor suppression must be turned on if TIT is rising above 1460F at full power and the mixture is set to full rich (at any altitude). Vapor suppression may be turned off below 18,000 MSL if power has been reduced below 85% and engine temperatures have stabilized. Propeller Surging or Wandering If the propeller has a tendency to surge up and down or the RPM settings seem to slowly and gently vary (propeller wandering), set the propeller control full forward. Propeller surging may be caused by one or more of the following conditions.

1.

There may be excessive leakage in the transfer bearing. The governor may not be able to get enough oil pressure, which causes a delay in propeller responsiveness. By the time the propeller responds to earlier governor inputs, they have changed, resulting in propeller wandering. Dirty oil is another cause. Contaminants in engine oil cause blockage of close tolerance passages in the governor, leading to erratic operations. Excessive play in the linkage between the governor and cockpit control can lead to erratic operations.
NOTE Propeller surging or wandering in most instances does not limit the safe continuation of the flight. However, to preclude the occurrence of more serious problems, the issue should be corrected in a timely manner, i.e., at the conclusion of the flight. If the surging or wandering is excessive, then a landing should be made as soon as practicable.

2. 3.

ELECTRICAL PROBLEMS The potential for electrical problems can be reduced by systematic monitoring of the voltmeter, and ammeter readings on the MFD. The onset of most electrical problems is indicated by abnormal readings from any or all of these gauges. The dual ammeter, which is presented on vertical bar gauges, measures the condition of the battery output/input and alternator output while the voltmeter indicates the condition of the airplanes electrical system on a bar graph on the MFD System page. RC050005 3-22 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

The MFD System page shows bus voltage, as well as battery and alternator current on bar graphs with a boundary around the group marked electrical.
Under Voltage If there is an electrical demand above what can be produced by the alternator on either the right or left bus, the battery temporarily satisfies the increased requirement and a battery discharging condition exists. For example, if either alternator should fail, the associated battery carries the entire electrical demand of the affected bus. As the battery charge is expended, the voltage to the system will read something less than the optimum 24 volts. At approximately 8 volts, most electrical components on the affected bus will cease to work or will operate erratically and unreliably. For Garmin G1000 installations, minimum voltage for proper operation is 9 volts. Anytime the electrical demand is greater than what can be supplied by the alternator at any RPM on either the left or right bus, the battery is in a discharging state. The PFD annunciation window will display L Alt Off or R Alt Off when that bus drops below 24 volts. The alternator will continue to output as much as it can for the RPM the engine is producing. Reducing loads on the affected bus or increasing RPM will clear the L Alt Off or R Alt Off annunciation message and the battery will be in a charging state. If the discharging state is not corrected, in time, there is a decay in the voltage available to the electrical system of the airplane and systems will cease to operate. Alternator Failure If the left or right alternator has an internal failure, i.e., it cannot be recycled and the annunciation remains displayed, the alternator side of the split master switch for the appropriate alternator should be set to the OFF position. A relay will disconnect it from its bus and prevent battery drain if the failure is associated with an internal short. The crosstie switch should then be turned on to allow the good alternator to carry the entire load on both buses. Load Shedding If the under voltage condition cannot be fixed either by turning on the crosstie switch or reducing the electrical load to the system, land as soon as possible or as soon as practicable depending on flight conditions. All nonessential electrical and avionics equipment must be turned off. Over Voltage The voltage regulator is designed to trip the left or right alternator off-line in conditions of over voltage, i.e., greater than 31.0 volts. When this happens a message on the PFD will indicate the left or right alternator is offline. The most likely cause is transitory spikes or surges tripping the alternator off-line in the electrical system. If the alternator is not automatically disconnected in an over voltage situation, the voltage regulator is probably faulty. In this situation, the pilot must manually turn off the alternator, otherwise, damage to the electrical and avionics equipment is likely. There is increased potential for an electrical fire in an uncorrected over voltage situation. Master Switches The systems two master switches are located in the master switch panel in the overhead with the bus crosstie and avionics master switches. This manual refers to each of the left and right split-rocker switches as a master switch (left master switch and right master switch). Although these switches are not technically master switches, as they do not control the entire system, it is a common term used to prevent confusion. Each switch is a split-rocker design with the alternator switch on the left side and the battery switch on the right side. Pressing the top of the alternator portion of the split-switch turns on both switches, and pressing the bottom of the battery portion of the split-switch turns off both switches. The battery side of the switch is used on the ground for checking electrical devices and will limit battery drain since power is not required for alternator excitation. The alternator switches are used individually (with the battery on) to recycle the alternators and are turned off during load shedding. COMPLETE LEFT OR RIGHT BUS FAILURE General Normally, a pilot can anticipate the onset of a complete electrical failure. Items like an alternator failure and a battery discharging state usually precedes the total loss of electrical power on the left or right bus. At the point the pilot first determines the electrical system is in an uncorrectable state of decay, appropriate planning should be initiated. Turning on the crosstie switch should restore Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 3-23

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

the bus to normal operation. If turning on the crosstie switch negatively affects the good bus, the crosstie switch should be turned off and only the remaining bus should be used. The checklist should be reviewed for items that are on the failed bus and rendered inoperative. The table shown in Figure 3 - 5 lists the equipment driven by each bus.
Crosstie Switch The crosstie switch is the white switch located between the left and right master switches. This switch is to remain in the OFF position during normal operations. The crosstie switch is only closed, or turned on, when the aircraft is connected to ground power or in the event of an alternator failure. This switch will join the left and right buses together for ground operations when connected to ground power. In the event of a left or right alternator failure, this switch will join the two buses allowing the functioning alternator to carry the load on both buses and charge both batteries.
Bus

SUMMARY OF BUSES Bus Component


Audio/MKR Integrated Avionics #2 Com #2 Transponder Avionics Fan Traffic Autopilot MFD Weather Aileron Trim or Rudder Hold/Aileron Trim Pitot Heat SpeedBrakes Position Lights Landing Light Left Voltage Regulator Fan Strobe Lights Taxi Light Right Voltage Regulator Door Seal/Power Point Carbon Monoxide Detector Oxygen Display Keypad Air Conditioning Attitude Horizon Elevator Trim Panel Lights Air Data Computer PFD AHRS Engine Airframe Integrated Avionics #1 Com #1 Left Bus Relays Fuel Pump Stall Warning Flaps Standby Attitude Horizon Right Bus Relays Hobbs Meter ELT Courtesy Lights

Circuit Breaker
5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 3 amp 3 amp 5 amp 5 amp 3 amp 2 amp 7.5 amp 3 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 2 amp* 5 amp 5 amp 2 amp 3 amp 2 amp 15 amp 5 amp 2 amp 7.5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 1 amp 5 amp 2 amp 10 amp 3 amp 1 amp 3 amp 3 amp 3 amp

* 5 amp for Precise Flight taxi light, S/N 41563 and on. Figure 3 - 5
RC050005 3-24 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

BATTERY BUS

ESSENTIAL BUS

RIGHT BUS

LEFT BUS

AVIONICS BUS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

STATIC AIR SOURCE BLOCKAGE The static source for the airspeed indicator, the altimeter, the rate of climb indicator, and encoder is located on the right side of the airplanes fuselage, between the cabin door and the horizontal stabilizer. The location of the static port is in an area of relatively undisturbed air. Because of the airplanes composite construction, the static source is less susceptible to airframe longevity error inherent with aluminum airplanes.

If the normal static source is blocked, an alternate static source, which uses pressure within the cabin, can be selected. Access for the alternate static source is on the tower to the right of the pilots knee and is labeled ALT STATIC. To access the alternate static source, rotate the static control knob clockwise until it locks in the ALT position. When the alternate static source is in use, the indications of the airspeed indicator and altimeter will vary slightly. Airspeed calibration charts are in Section 5 and begin on page 5-3. No altimeter calibrations are shown since the error is less than 50 feet.
SPINS The intentional spinning of the aircraft is prohibited. Flight tests have shown that the aircraft will recover from a one turn spin in less than one additional turn after the application of recovery controls for all points in the weight and balance envelope, up to the maximum certified altitude. The recommended recovery inputs are: power idle, rudder full against the spin, elevator full forward and aileron full against the spin. If the flaps are extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation is stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during pull out. When rotation stops, the aircraft will be in a steep nose down attitude. Airspeeds up to 160 KIAS are possible during a 3 g pull out. Above 126 KIAS it may be possible to pull more than 3.7 gs in light weight conditions. Care should be taken, under such conditions, to avoid overstressing the airframe. A steady state spin may be encountered if pro-spin control inputs are held for 1 turns or more. Steady state spins entered above 20,000 feet at heavy weight and aft CG conditions will take the most turns to recover. If a steady state spin is entered, making and holding the recommended recovery inputs will produce the fastest recovery. WARNING The intentional spinning of the aircraft is prohibited. WARNING If a spin is entered with the flaps extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation is stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during recovery. WARNING If a steady state spin is entered, holding the recommended recovery inputs of power idle, rudder full against the spin, elevator full forward and aileron full against the spin will produce the fastest recovery. When recovering from a steady state spin, the aircraft may exceed the typical one turn recovery time, and additional turns may be experienced until the aircraft recovers from the spin. MULTI-FUNCTION DISPLAY If the MFD should malfunction or perform improperly, you may continue to utilize those portions of the MFD data that are not in question. Moving map errors may be associated with a RAIM alarm indicating the loss of adequate GPS position containment. Data or functions that have failed are typically remove and replaced with a red X in the appropriate area.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 3-25

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

PRIMARY FLIGHT DISPLAY If the malfunction results in improper information from the air data computer and/or an abnormal display of attitude information, use the standby instruments on the left side of the cockpit. The loss of air data (altitude, airspeed) is indicated by the affected indicator being removed from the display and replaced with a red X. Loss of attitude data (pitch, roll, heading) is indicated by the affected indicator being removed from the display and replaced with a red X.

Those functions that do not have a red X may still be usable.


AUTOPILOT If the autopilot should malfunction or perform improperly, do not attempt to identify or analyze the problem. If the malfunction results in an abnormal change in the pitch and/or roll axis, immediately regain control of the airplane by the disengaging the autopilot using either the pilots or copilots red disengagement button located on the stick. Do not, under any circumstances, reengage an autopilot that has malfunctioned until the problem is corrected.

Loss of instruments or components of the G1000 system will affect the GFC 700 Autopilot as follows:

Loss of the AHRS will cause the autopilot to disconnect. The autopilot will be inoperative. Loss of the heading function of the AHRS will result in loss of the HDG mode. If in heading mode at the time, the autopilot will revert to a basic roll mode (ROL) Loss of the MFD will not cause the autopilot to disconnect, and will remain engaged with limited functionality, but the autopilot cannot be re-engaged after disconnect by the pilot. Loss of the PFD will cause the autopilot to disconnect. The autopilot will be inoperative. Loss of air data computer information will cause the autopilot to disconnect. The autopilot will be inoperative. Loss of either GIA will cause the autopilot to disconnect. The autopilot will be inoperative.

RUDDER HOLD SYSTEM If there is a malfunction of the rudder hold system and none of the normal methods to disengage it work, perform the following to regain rudder control:

1. 2.

Maintain airspeed between 90 and 110 KIAS. Push a rudder pedal until the brake surface held by friction slips (about 50 to 70 lbs with no air loads). The Rudder should move into a new position and be held until the pedal is pushed again If the braking surface is not slipping, a shear pin in the rudder hold mechanism can be broken by applying force (100 to 110 lbs with no air loads) to a rudder pedal (right pedal recommended). Once the shear pin breaks the capstan will move freely allowing full rudder deflection

3.

OXYGEN SYSTEM General The Garmin G1000 and oxygen system have monitoring logic to notify the pilot via the PFD annunciations and aural tone if any of the following advisory conditions exist:

The system has not been activated above approximately 12,000 ft pressure altitude. There is an inadequate quantity of oxygen (system pressure less than 250 psig) with the system turned on. The oxygen outlet pressure is not within range for proper operation. Low pressure at the distribution manifold (Outlet Pressure less than 16.5 psig). Oxygen system ON while on the ground.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 3-26

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Check the oxygen display on the Engine Indication page on the MFD for more detailed information.
WARNING Failures in the breathing stations, cannulas, masks, and flow meters are not indicated on the display panel or annunciations unless it causes one of the three alarms to activate.

Failures that the pilot may rectify in flight are leaks downstream of the distribution manifold, which may consist of misadjusted or pinched flexible lines, or replacement of failed flow devices in the system. These failures can be indicated by the outlet pressure display at the bottom of the oxygen panel and by inadequate flows as indicated by the flow meter or flow indicators.
NOTE If oxygen is flowing into the cabin and the oxygen system master softkey on the MFD will not turn the oxygen system off, the guarded overhead switch can be used to terminate the flow of oxygen to the cabin in the event of an emergency as required by the pilot. Cabin Fire See the discussion on page 3-20 for information on the use of oxygen after a cabin fire. EMERGENCY EXIT General It is impossible to cover all the contingencies of an emergency situation. The pilot-incommand must analyze all possible alternatives and select a course of action appropriate to the situation. The discussion on the following pages is intended as a generalized overview of recommended actions and issues associated with emergency egress. Doors In most emergencies, the main cabin doors are used as exit points. The operation of these doors is discussed on page 7-14, and there are placards near the door handles, which explain their operation. In addition, the Passenger Briefing Card discusses the operation of the cabin doors in an emergency situation. It is important that passengers are familiar with their operation since the pilot may be incapacitated during emergency exiting operations. Seat Belts The seat belt should not be removed until the airplane has come to a complete stop, unless there are compelling reasons to do otherwise. At other times, such as when the airplane has come to rest in an area of treetops, leaving the belts fastened might be the best course of action. When the seat belts are removed, it is helpful if the pilot and passengers stow them in a manner that minimizes interference with airplane egress patterns. Exiting (Cabin Door(s) Operable) If possible, use both cabin doors as exit points. In the event of a wing fire, exit on the side away from the fire. The front seat passengers should normally exit first and then, if appropriate, render assistance to the rear seat occupants. When outside and on the wing, move to the rear of the airplane, over the trailing edge of the wing, all other things being equal. If practicable, all passengers and the pilot should have a designated congregating point. For example, 100 feet aft of the airplane. Exiting (Cabin Doors Inoperable) If the cabin doors are inoperable, there is a crash ax (hatchet) located under the pilots seat that can be used to break out one of the cabin door windows. Please see the crash ax discussion on page 3-28. INVERTED EXIT PROCEDURES General In emergencies where the airplane has come to rest in an inverted position, the gull wing doors will not open sufficiently to exit the airplane. If this happens, there is a crash ax below the pilots front seat that can be used to break either of the cabin door windows. Use the following procedure.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 3-27

Section 3 Emergency Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

1. Release the seat belt. The pilot should position himself or herself in a manner that minimizes injury before releasing the seat belt. 2. Remove crash ax from its holder. 3. If the airplane is situated with one wing down and touching the ground and one wing up, break the cabin door window on the up-wing side. If the wings are about level, break the door window that offers the best access. See crash ax discussion on page 3-28. 4. Exit the airplane and/or render assistance to passengers as required.
Exterior Emergency Exit Release There is an emergency exit door hinge release that can be activated by ground personnel in the event the pilot and passengers are incapacitated. The release strap loop is located on the bottom of the airplane near the left wing saddle inside the same compartment that contains the gascolator. It is important for the pilot to understand the procedures for using the exterior release. In some instances, the pilot may be incapacitated but conscious and able to offer verbal instructions to ground personnel. The following procedures are applicable to exterior removal of the door by ground personnel.

1. Open the gascolator compartment by pressing the two spring buttons. 2. Move the door latching mechanism of the pilots door to the open position. 3. Pull up sharply on the emergency strap loop door hinge release. 4. Pull on the door release handle to open the door a few inches, and then move the door latching mechanism to the locked position. This will prevent the door from closing and provide an adequate handhold for removing the door. 5. Using both hands, grasp the left and right edges of the door, near the middle, and pull it away from the fuselage. 6. Rock wing to assist in the removal of the door.
WARNING Do not pull the emergency release strap loop to test its operation. An operational test is specified during the airplanes annual inspection. If the door release is inadvertently activated, the airplane is unsafe to fly, and an appropriately trained and certificated mechanic must rearm the system. CRASH AX A crash ax is located under the pilots seat for use in the event the cabin door and the emergency door releases cannot be used. The blade of the ax points down and is inserted in an aluminum sheath, and the unit is secured with a Velcro strip. To use the ax, open the Velcro fastener and remove the ax from its sheath.

It generally works best to strike the corner edge of the window near the doorframe. Several smart blows to the window area around the perimeter of the doorframe will remove enough pieces so that the middle portion of the window can be removed with a few heavy blows. Once the major portion of the window is removed and if time and circumstances permit, use the ax blade to smooth down the jagged edges around the doorframe. This will minimize injury when egressing the airplane through the window.
WARNING The crash ax/hatchet is a required item for the safe operation of the airplane. It must be installed and secured in its sheath during all flight operations. Do not use the crash ax for any other purposes, such as chopping wood, since it can diminish the effectiveness of the tool. RC050005 3-28 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Section 4 Normal Procedures


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 4-3 Indicated Airspeeds for Normal Operations.......................................................................... 4-3 NORMAL PROCEDURES CHECKLISTS................................................................................... 4-4 Preflight Inspection................................................................................................................ 4-4 Before Starting Engine .......................................................................................................... 4-6 Starting Cold Engine.............................................................................................................. 4-7 Starting Hot Engine ............................................................................................................... 4-7 Starting Engine with Ground Power Cart.............................................................................. 4-8 After Engine Start .................................................................................................................. 4-8 Crosstie Operation ................................................................................................................. 4-9 SpeedBrake Ground Operations ........................................................................................4-9 Autopilot Autotrim Operations..............................................................................................4-9 Ground Operation of Air Conditioning ...............................................................................4-10 Before Taxi ..........................................................................................................................4-10 Taxiing .................................................................................................................................4-10 Before Takeoff.....................................................................................................................4-10 Minor Spark Plug Fouling ...................................................................................................4-11 Normal Takeoff....................................................................................................................4-12 Short Field Takeoff..............................................................................................................4-12 Crosswind Operations..........................................................................................................4-12 Normal Climb ......................................................................................................................4-12 Maximum Performance Climb ............................................................................................4-13 Cruise ...................................................................................................................................4-13 Descent.................................................................................................................................4-14 Expedited Descent ...............................................................................................................4-14 Approach..............................................................................................................................4-14 Before Landing ....................................................................................................................4-14 Normal Landing...................................................................................................................4-14 Short Field Landing .............................................................................................................4-15 Balked Landing....................................................................................................................4-15 After Landing.......................................................................................................................4-15 Shutdown .............................................................................................................................4-15 AMPLIFIED PROCEDURES ......................................................................................................4-16 Preflight Inspection..............................................................................................................4-16 Wing Flaps..................................................................................................................4-16 Aileron Servo Tab.......................................................................................................4-16 Fuel Drains..................................................................................................................4-16 Stall Warning Vane.....................................................................................................4-16 Fuel Vents ...................................................................................................................4-16 Fuel Selector ........................................................................................................................4-17 Fuel Quantity .......................................................................................................................4-17 Static Wicks .........................................................................................................................4-17 Before Starting Engine ........................................................................................................4-18 Fresh Air Vents...........................................................................................................4-18 Three Point Restraints (Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses).....................................4-18 Child Restraints ..........................................................................................................4-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-1

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Engine Starting.....................................................................................................................4-19 Normal Starting...........................................................................................................4-19 Under Priming.............................................................................................................4-19 Over Priming...............................................................................................................4-19 Battery Recharging ..............................................................................................................4-19 Ground Power Operations ..........................................................................................4-19 Left Battery Inoperative..............................................................................................4-20 Right Battery Inoperative ...........................................................................................4-20 Crosstie Operations Checklist..............................................................................................4-20 Passenger Briefing Card ......................................................................................................4-20 Control Position Versus Wind Component (Table) ............................................................4-21 Taxiing .................................................................................................................................4-22 Before Takeoff .....................................................................................................................4-22 Engine Temperatures ..................................................................................................4-22 Engine Runup .............................................................................................................4-22 Door Seals...................................................................................................................4-23 Oxygen System ...........................................................................................................4-23 Takeoffs ...............................................................................................................................4-23 Normal Takeoff...........................................................................................................4-23 Short Field Takeoff.....................................................................................................4-23 Crosswind Takeoff......................................................................................................4-23 Normal and Maximum Performance Climbs ......................................................................4-24 Best Rate of Climb Speeds .........................................................................................4-24 Cruise Climb ...............................................................................................................4-24 Best Angle of Climb Speeds.......................................................................................4-24 Power Settings ............................................................................................................4-24 Vapor Suppression......................................................................................................4-24 Normal Operations above 18,000 Ft....................................................................................4-25 Cruise ...................................................................................................................................4-25 Flight Planning............................................................................................................4-25 Mixture Settings..........................................................................................................4-25 Control by Turbine Inlet Temperature (TIT) .............................................................4-25 Door Seals...................................................................................................................4-26 Inoperative Door Seal Dump Valve ...........................................................................4-26 Descent.................................................................................................................................4-26 Approach..............................................................................................................................4-26 Glideslope Flight Procedure with Autopilot ..............................................................4-27 Landings...............................................................................................................................4-27 Normal Landings ........................................................................................................4-27 Short Field Landings...................................................................................................4-27 Crosswind Landings ...................................................................................................4-27 Balked Landings .........................................................................................................4-28 Heavy Braking ............................................................................................................4-28 Oxygen System ...........................................................................................................4-28 Shutdown .............................................................................................................................4-28 Stalls.....................................................................................................................................4-28 Practicing Stalls ..........................................................................................................4-28 Loading and Stall Characteristics ...............................................................................4-29 Spins.....................................................................................................................................4-29 Cold Weather Operations ....................................................................................................4-30 Hot Weather Operations ......................................................................................................4-31 Noise Abatement..................................................................................................................4-32 Rudder Hold System ...........................................................................................................4-32

RC050005 4-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Section 4 Normal Procedures INTRODUCTION


Section 4 contains checklists for normal procedures. As mentioned in Section 3, the owner of this handbook is encouraged to copy or otherwise tabulate the following normal procedures checklists in a format that is usable under flight conditions. Plastic laminated pages printed on both sides and bound together (if more than one sheet) are preferable. The first portion of Section 4 contains various checklists appropriate for normal operations. The last portion of this section contains an amplified discussion in a narrative format.
INDICATED AIRSPEEDS FOR NORMAL OPERATIONS The speeds tabulated below, Figure 4 - 1, provide a general overview for normal operations and are based on a maximum certificated gross weight of 3600 pounds. At weights less than maximum certificated gross weight, the indicated airspeeds are different. The pilot should refer to Section 5 for specific configuration data.
Takeoff
Normal Climb Out Short Field Takeoff to 50 feet

Flaps Setting
Up Position Takeoff Position

Airspeed
110 KIAS 80 KIAS

Climb To Altitude
Normal (Best Engine Cooling) Best Rate of Climb at Sea Level Best Rate of Climb at 10,000 Feet Best Angle of Climb at Sea Level Best Angle of Climb at 10,000 Feet

Flaps Setting
Up Position Up Position Up Position Up Position Up Position

Airspeed
110 KIAS 110 KIAS 110 KIAS 82 KIAS 86 KIAS

Approach To Landing
Normal Approach Normal Approach Short Field Landing

Flaps Setting
Up Position Down Position Down Position

Airspeed
105-110 KIAS 85-90 KIAS 80 KIAS

Balked Landing (Go Around)


Apply Maximum Power Apply Maximum Power

Flaps Setting
Takeoff Position Landing Position

Airspeed
90 KIAS 82 KIAS

Maximum Recommended Turbulent Air Penetration Speed


3600 lbs. (1633 kg) 2600 lbs. (1179 kg)

Flaps Setting
Up Position Up Position

Airspeed
162 KIAS 138 KIAS

Maximum Demonstrated Crosswind Velocity*


Takeoff Landing

Flaps Setting
Takeoff Position Landing Position

Airspeed
23 Knots 23 Knots

* The maximum demonstrated crosswind velocity assumes normal pilot technique and a wind with a fairly constant velocity and direction. The maximum demonstrated crosswind component of 23 knots is not considered limiting. See pages 4-58, 4-81, 4-90, and 5-11 for a discussion of techniques and a computation table.

Figure 4 - 1

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 4-3

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

NORMAL PROCEDURES CHECKLISTS


PREFLIGHT INSPECTION Figure 4-2 depicts the major inspection points, and the arrow shows the sequence for inspecting each point. The inspection sequence in Figure 4 - 2 runs in a clockwise direction; however, it does not matter in which direction the pilot performs the preflight inspection so long as it is systematic. The inspection should be initiated in the cockpit from the pilots side of the airplane.

Figure 4 - 2
Area 1 (The Cabin) 1. Pitot Tube Cover REMOVE AND STORE 2. Required Aircraft Documents AVAILABLE IN THE AIRPLANE 3. Ignition Switch OFF 4. Mixture IDLE CUTOFF 5. Avionics Master Switch OFF 6. Crosstie Switch OFF 7. Left Battery Switch ON (Press right side of split rocker switch.) 8. Right Battery Switch ON (Press right side of split rocker switch.) 9. A/P Trim System Switch in Overhead CHECK 10. Flaps TAKEOFF THEN LANDING POSITION 11. Trim Tabs NEUTRAL 12. Fuel Quantity Indicators CHECK FUEL QUANTITY 13. Fuel Annunciation NOT DISPLAYED 14. Oxygen System CHECK IF REQUIRED 14.1. Avionics Switch ON 14.2. Oxygen SystemON, CHECK QUANTITY, ENSURE SYSTEM RETAINS PRESSURE, VERIFY PROPER OXYGEN FLOW AT ALL BREATHING DEVICES 14.3. Oxygen System OFF RC050005 4-4 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

14.4. Avionics Switch OFF 15. Pitot Heat, Propeller Heat, and Exterior Lights ON AS REQUIRED, CHECK OPERATION (See Note and Warning that follows.) 16. Induction Heated Air CYCLE THEN OFF 17. Stall Warning Vane CHECK WARNING HORN 18. Pitot Heat, Propeller Heat, and Exterior Lights OFF 19. Left and Right Battery Switches OFF 20. Circuit Breakers CHECK IN
NOTE The heated pitot housing should be warm to the touch in a minute or so, and it should not be operated for more than one to two minutes when the airplane is in the static condition. For this reason the operational check must be performed out of sequence. The pitot heat system includes a relay which will keep it from getting too hot on the ground. Full pitot heat is only available during flight. WARNING The pitot tube can get hot within one minute, and care must be used when touching the housing. The technique used for testing the hotness of an iron should be employed. Area 2 (Left Wing Flap, Trailing Edge and Wing Tip) 1. Flap CHECK (Proper extension and security of hardware.) 2. Left Wing Tie-Down REMOVE 3. Aileron CHECK (Movement, condition, and security of hardware.) 4. Aileron Servo Tab CHECK FOR PROPER OPERATION 5. Static Wicks (2) CHECK FOR INSTALLATION AND CONDITION 6. Wing Tip CHECK (Look for damage; check security of position and anti-collision lights.) Area 3 (Left Wing Leading Edge, Fuel Tank, and Left Tire) 1. Leading Edge, Leading Edge Tape, Triangular Shaped Leading Edge Tape, and Stall Strips CHECK (Look for damage.) 2. Fuel Vent CHECK FOR OBSTRUCTIONS 3. Landing Light CHECK (Look for lens cracks and check security.) 4. Fuel Quantity CHECK VISUALLY AND SECURE FILLER CAP 5. Stall Warning Vane CHECK FOR FREE MOVEMENT AND ENSURE NOT BENT 6. Wing Fuel Drain CHECK FOR CONTAMINATION (Preceding first flight of the day or after refueling.) 7. Left Main Strut and Tire CHECK (Remove wheel chocks, check tire for proper inflation, check gear strut for evidence of damage, bushing in place.) 8. Main Fuel Drain CHECK FOR CONTAMINATION (Preceding first flight of the day or after refueling.) 9. Gascolator Access Door and Inspection Panels CHECK (Security of hardware.) Area 4 (Nose Section) 1. Left Windscreen, Cowl, and Exhaust CHECK (Condition and security of hardware.) 2. Engine Oil CHECK LEVEL (Maintain between 6 and 8 quarts, and fill to 8 quarts for extended flights.) 3. Engine Oil Filler Cap and Accessory Door CAP AND ACCESSORY DOOR SECURE 4. Propeller and Spinner CHECK (Look for nicks, security, and evidence of oil leakage.) 5. Alternator Belt CHECK (Condition and tension.) Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007 RC050005 4-5

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

6. Nose Wheel Strut CHECK INFLATION (Approximately 3 to 4 inch of chrome strut must be visible.) 7. Nose Tire CHECK (Remove wheel chocks, check tire for proper inflation.) 8. Right Windscreen, Cowl, Cabin Air Inlet, and Exhaust CHECK (Condition, air inlet duct connected, no obstructions, and security of hardware.)
Area 5 (Right Wing Leading Edge, Fuel Tank, and Right Tire) 1. Wing Fuel Drain CHECK FOR CONTAMINATION (Preceding first flight of the day or after refueling.) 2. Right Main Strut and Tire CHECK (Remove wheel chocks, check tire for proper inflation, check gear strut for evidence of damage, bushing in place.) 3. Leading Edge, Leading Edge Tape, Triangular Shaped Leading Edge Tape, and Stall Strips CHECK (Look for damage.) 4. Fuel Quantity CHECK VISUALLY AND SECURE FILLER CAP 5. Fuel Vent CHECK FOR OBSTRUCTIONS 6. Pitot Tube CHECK FOR OBSTRUCTIONS Area 6 (Right Wing Tip, Trailing Edge, Wing Flap, and Right Fuselage Area) 1. Wing Tip CHECK (Look for damage; check security of position and anti-collision lights.) 2. Aileron CHECK (Movement, condition, and security of hardware.) 3. Aileron Trim Tab CHECK FOR NEUTRAL POSITION 4. Static Wicks (2) CHECK FOR INSTALLATION AND CONDITION 5. Right Wing Tie-Down REMOVE 6. Flap CHECK (Visually check for proper extension and security of hardware.) 7. Antennas Bottom of Fuselage CHECK FOR SECURITY 8. Static Port CHECK FOR BLOCKAGE Area 7 (Tail Section) 1. Leading Edge of Horizontal and Vertical Surfaces CHECK (Look for damage.) 2. Leading Edge Tape and Zig Zag Tape CHECK (Attached and in good condition.) 3. Antennas Vertical Stabilizer CHECK FOR SECURITY 4. Rudder/Elevator Hardware CHECK (General condition and security.) 5. Rudder Surface CHECK (Freedom of movement.) 6. Fixed Elevator Surfaces CHECK SECURE, CHECK CLEARANCE TO RUDDER AT FULL DEFLECTION 7. Elevator Surface CHECK (Freedom of movement.) 8. Elevator Trim Tab CHECK FOR NEUTRAL POSITION 9. Ventral Fin CHECK FOR SECURITY AND LOWER EDGE DAMAGE 10. Static Wicks (5) CHECK FOR INSTALLATION AND CONDITION 11. Tail Tie-Down REMOVE Area 8 (Aft Fuselage and Cabin) 1. Baggage Door CHECK CLOSED AND LOCKED 2. Fire Extinguisher CHECK FOR PRESENCE AND SECURITY 3. Crash Ax/Hatchet CHECK FOR PRESENCE AND SECURITY BEFORE STARTING ENGINE 1. Preflight Inspection COMPLETE 2. Fresh Air Vents CLOSED FOR ENGINE START 3. Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses SECURE (Stow all unused seat belts.) 4. Fuel Selector SET TO LEFT OR RIGHT TANK 5. Avionics Master Switch OFF

RC050005 4-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

6. 7. 8. 9. 10.

Crosstie Switch VERIFY OFF Brakes TESTED AND SET Circuit Breakers CHECK IN Oxygen Masks and Cannulas CHECK (Kinks in hose, rips or tears.) Passenger Briefing Card ADVISE PASSENGERS TO REVIEW
CAUTION There is a significant amount of electric current required to start the engine. For this reason, the avionics master switch must be set to the OFF position during starting to prevent possible serious damage to the avionics equipment.

STARTING COLD ENGINE 1. Mixture RICH 2. Propeller HIGH RPM 3. Vapor Suppression OFF 4. Induction Heated Air OFF 5. Throttle CLOSED, THEN OPEN APPROXIMATELY ONE INCH 6. Left and Right Battery Switches ON 7. Anti-Collision/Position Lights ON AS REQUIRED 8. Primer Switch PUSH IN (Approximately 5 seconds) 9. Throttle CLOSED, THEN OPEN 1/8 INCH to 1/4 INCH 10. Check Propeller Area CLEAR (Ensure people/equipment are not in the propeller area.) 11. Ignition Switch START 12. Throttle ADJUST IDLE (900 to 1000 RPM) 13. Oil Pressure CHECK (Ensure the oil pressure gauge reads between 30 to 60 psi.) CAUTION If no oil pressure is noted within 30 seconds, shut down the engine and investigate the cause. Operating the engine without oil pressure may result in engine malfunction or stoppage.

14. Left and Right Alternator Switches ON


STARTING HOT ENGINE 1. Mixture IDLE CUTOFF 2. Propeller HIGH RPM 3. Throttle CLOSED 4. Induction Heated Air OFF 5. Left and Right Battery Switches ON 6. Anti-Collision/Position Lights ON AS REQUIRED 7. Vapor Suppression ON FOR 30 TO 60 SECONDS, THEN OFF 8. Mixture RICH 9. Primer Switch PUSH IN (Approximately 3 seconds.) 10. Throttle CLOSED, THEN OPEN APPROXIMATELY 1/4 INCH 11. Check Propeller Area CLEAR (Ensure people/equipment are not in the propeller area.) 12. Ignition Switch START NOTE It may be necessary to leave the vapor suppression on during starting (steps 7 10) and turn it off approximately one minute after engine start.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-7

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

NOTE If the engine is only moderately warm it may be necessary to push the primer switch for a few seconds before starting.

13. Throttle IDLE (900 to 1000 RPM) 14. Oil Pressure CHECK (Ensure the oil pressure gauge reads between 30 to 60 psi.) 15. Left and Right Alternator Switches ON
STARTING ENGINE WITH GROUND POWER CART CAUTION When starting with a ground power cart, the battery conditions cannot be monitored during the start cycle. Do not start the engine if both batteries are completely dead. Recharge or replace the batteries if weak or dead; before flight.

1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15.

Left and Right Master Switches VERIFY OFF Check Propeller Area CLEAR (Ensure people/equipment are not in the propeller area.) Auxiliary Power CONNECTED AND ON (Use a 24 volt DC source.) Crosstie Switch ON Aircraft Buses VERIFY POWERED UP (Do not turn on any BATT or ALT Switch.) Anti-Collision/Position Lights ON AS REQUIRED Mixture RICH Propeller HIGH RPM Vapor Suppression OFF Induction Heated Air OFF Throttle CLOSED, THEN OPEN APPROXIMATELY ONE INCH Primer Switch PUSH IN (Approximately 5 seconds.) Throttle CLOSED, THEN OPEN 1/8 INCH TO 1/4 INCH Check Propeller Area CLEAR (Ensure people/equipment are not in the propeller area.) Ignition Switch START CAUTION If the engine starter is engaged for 30 seconds and the engine will not start, release the starter switch, and allow the starter motor to cool for three to five minutes. Release the starter as soon as the engine fires. Never engage the starter while the propeller is still turning.
CAUTION The master switches should not be turned on until after the engine has started and the ground power plug has been removed.

16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21.

Throttle ADJUST IDLE (900 to 1000 RPM) Oil Pressure CHECK (Ensure the oil pressure gauge reads between 30 to 60 psi.) Auxiliary Power SIGNAL LINE SERVICE TO TURN OFF AND DISCONNECT Crosstie Switch OFF Left and Right Master Switches ON Before Moving CLEAR (Wait for the line service technician to clear you to move.)

AFTER ENGINE START 1. Avionics Master Switch ON 2. Engine Indication Systems CHECK 3. Ammeters CHECK (Ensure alternator annunciation message is not displayed and the ammeters are indicating the left and right batteries are charging.) RC050005 4-8 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

4. MFD Fuel Remaining INITIALIZE 5. Radios and Required Avionics SET AS REQUIRED 5.1. COM Radios SET 5.2. NAV Radios SET 5.3. PFD and Backup Altimeters SET 5.4. FMS Flight Plan LOADED 5.5. Altitude and Heading Bugs SET 5.6. Transponder SET CODE 6. Oxygen Quantity 7. Rudder Hold ON, VERIFY OVERRIDE BY FORCE TO PEDAL, THEN OFF
CROSSTIE OPERATION 1. Air Conditioning OFF 2. Left Master Switch OFF (Ensure the essential and avionics buses are energized.) 3. L BUS OFF Annunciation DISPLAYED 4. Crosstie Switch ON (Ensure the right ammeter is showing charge and load increase for the left and right buses.) 5. L BUS OFF Annunciation CLEARS 6. Crosstie Switch OFF 7. Left Master Switch ON 8. Right Master Switch OFF (Ensure the essential and avionics buses are energized.) 9. R BUS OFF Annunciation DISPLAYED 10. Crosstie Switch ON (Ensure the left ammeter is showing charge and load increase for the left and right buses.) 11. R BUS OFF Annunciation CLEARS 12. Crosstie Switch OFF 13. Right Master Switch ON 14. Air Conditioning USE AS DESIRED SPEEDBRAKE GROUND OPERATIONS 1. SpeedBrake Switch ON/UP POSITION 2. SPEED BRAKES Annunciation DISPLAYED 3. SpeedBrake Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION (Ensure both SpeedBrakesTM are retracted.) 4. SPEED BRAKES Annunciation CLEARS NOTE The SpeedBrake system should be functionally checked for proper operation prior to flight. The independent electrical clutches need to be synchronized by SpeedBrake activation before flight and/or after SpeedBrake circuit breaker pull. If the SpeedBrakes remain slightly extended, this indicates SpeedBrake failure and the SpeedBrake circuit breaker should be pulled. AUTOPILOT AUTOTRIM OPERATIONS 1. Autopilot ENGAGE 2. Control Stick APPLY FORWARD PRESSURE (Ensure trim runs Nose Up after 3 seconds.) 3. Control Stick APPLY AFT PRESSURE (Ensure trim runs Nose Down after 3 seconds.) 4. Electric Trim Switch MOVE UP AND DOWN, ENSURE AUTOPILOT DISCONNECTS (Trim should operate in the commanded direction.) 5. Autopilot ENGAGE 6. HDG Bug SYNC Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-9
TM

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

7. Autopilot SELECT HDG MODE 8. HDG Bug VERIFY CONTROL STICK MOVEMENT 9. Depress Autopilot Disconnect/Trim Interrupt Switch on Control Stick ENSURE AUTOPILOT DISCONNECTS 10. Trim TRIM FOR TAKEOFF (Ensure all controls for freedom of motion and ensure the autopilot is disconnected.)
WARNING If the Autotrim fails any portion of the above check procedures, do not attempt to use the autopilot until the fault is corrected. GROUND OPERATION OF AIR CONDITIONING 1. Control Head SELECT MODE AND TEMPERATURE DESIRED 2. Engine RPM KEEP RPM AT OR ABOVE 1000 RPM 3. Ammeters MONITOR BATTERIES (Decrease electrical load if a discharge is displayed.) BEFORE TAXI 1. Engine Instruments CHECK (Within proper ranges.) 2. Fuel Gauges CHECK PROPER INDICATION 3. Ammeters CHARGING 4. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF, THEN UP (Cruise Position) 5. Radio Clearance AS REQUIRED 6. Taxi Light AS REQUIRED 7. Brakes RELEASE TAXIING 1. Brakes CHECK FOR PROPER OPERATION 2. PFD and Backup Flight Instruments CHECK FOR PROPER OPERATION 3. Turn Coordinator (PFD) CHECK FOR PROPER OPERATION 4. Directional Gyro (PFD) CHECK FOR PROPER OPERATION BEFORE TAKEOFF (Runup) 1. Runup Position MAXIMUM HEADWIND COMPONENT 2. Parking Brake/Foot Brakes SET or HOLD 3. Flight Controls FREE AND CORRECT 4. Crosstie Switch VERIFY OFF 5. Autopilot (A/P) Trim System Switch in Overhead VERIFY ON 6. Autopilot VERIFY DISENGAGED 7. Trim Tabs SET FOR TAKEOFF 8. PFD and Backup Flight Instruments CROSSCHECK AND SET 9. Fuel Selector SET OUT OF DETENT (Ensure that 2 seconds after the annunciation displays the aural warning is played.) 10. Alerts Softkey on PFD PRESS (Ensure aural warning stops.) 11. Fuel Selector SET TO FULLER TANK 12. Cabin Doors CLOSED AND LATCHED (Verify that red annunciation message is not displayed.) 13. Passenger Side Door Lock IN THE UNLOCKED POSITION 14. Engine Runup OIL TEMPERATURE CHECK (Above 100F) 15. Throttle 1700 RPM 16. Ignition Switch L POSITION (25 RPM drop minimum, 150 RPM drop maximum, EGTs should rise.)

RC050005 4-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

17. Ignition Switch R POSITION (25 RPM drop minimum, 150 RPM drop maximum, 50 RPM difference between L and R, EGTs should stay stable.) 18. Ignition Switch R/L POSITION (EGTs should drop.) 19. Propeller CHECK OPERATION (Cycle two or three times with a 300 to 500 RPM drop.) 20. Engine Instruments and Ammeter CHECK (Within proper ranges.) 21. Batteries VERIFY CHARGE CONDITION BEFORE TAKEOFF (At 1700 RPM, the battery charge rate should be less than 10 amps for each battery.) 22. Throttle VERIFY IDLE, THEN 900 TO 1000 RPM 23. Illuminated Switch Bulb Test ALL LAMPS ILLUMINATED 24. Radios SET, CROSSCHECK NAV INDICATORS 25. Flight Director AS REQUIRED 26. Transponder VERIFY CODE 27. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF POSITION 28. Rudder Hold System DISENGAGED 29. SpeedBrake Switch VERIFY OFF/DOWN POSITION 30. Doors LATCHED AND DETENTED 31. PFD Annunciation Window ALL MESSAGES ADDRESSED 32. Door Seals ON 33. Backup Fuel Pump ARMED 34. Oxygen System ON 35. Mask or Cannula DON 36. Flowmeters CHECK AND ADJUST TO PLANNED CRUISE ALTITUDE (Ensure that the internal metering ball moves freely and oxygen is flowing to the delivery devices.) 37. Time NOTE 38. Brakes RELEASE
WARNING The absence of RPM drop when checking magnetos may indicate a malfunction in the ignition circuit resulting in a hot magneto, i.e., one that is not grounding properly. Should the propeller be moved by hand (as during preflight inspection) the engine might start and cause death or injury. This type of malfunction must be corrected before operating the engine. CAUTION Do not underestimate the importance of pre-takeoff magneto checks. When operating on single ignition, some RPM drop should always occur. Normal indications are 25 to 75 RPM and a slight engine roughness as each magneto is switched off. A drop in excess of 150 RPM may indicate a faulty magneto or fouled spark plugs. NOTE When checking the oxygen flowmeter, the reading is taken at the midpoint of the ball. Ensure the flowmeter is held vertically when adjusting flow rate or reading. MINOR SPARK PLUG FOULING (Minor plug fouling can usually be cleared as follows.) 1. Brakes HOLD BRAKES MANUALLY 2. Throttle 2200 RPM 3. Mixture ADJUST FOR MAXIMUM PERFORMANCE (Move towards idle cutoff until RPM peaks, and hold for 10 seconds. Return mixture to full rich.) 4. Throttle 1700 RPM 5. Magnetos RECHECK (50 RPM difference with a maximum drop of 150 RPM.) Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-11

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

6. Throttle IDLE (900 to 1000 RPM)


CAUTION Do not operate the engine at a speed of more than 2000 RPM longer than necessary to test engine operations and observe engine instruments. Proper engine cooling depends on forward speed. Discontinue testing if temperature or pressure limits are approached. NORMAL TAKEOFF 1. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED 2. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF POSITION 3. Mixture FULL RICH 4. Backup Fuel Pump ARMED 5. Pitot Heat and Propeller Heat AS REQUIRED 6. Throttle ADVANCE SLOWLY TO FULL POWER (2600 RPM) (Watch manifold pressure for indication of overboost.) 7. Elevator Control LIFT NOSE AT 75 KIAS 8. Climb Speed ACCELERATE TO BEST RATE OF CLIMB SPEED OF 110 KIAS 9. Wing Flaps RETRACT (At 400 feet AGL and at or above 95 KIAS.) SHORT FIELD TAKEOFF (Complete Before Takeoff checklist first) 1. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED 2. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF POSITION 3. Brakes APPLY 4. Mixture FULL RICH 5. Backup Fuel Pump ARMED 6. Throttle ADVANCE SLOWLY TO FULL POWER (2600 RPM) 7. Brakes RELEASE 8. Elevator Control MAINTAIN LEVEL NOSE ATTITUDE 9. Rotate Speed 64 to 75 KIAS (Speed per Figure 5 - 11. 5 nose up pitch attitude.) 10. Climb Speed 74 to 84 KIAS (Speed per Figure 5 - 11. Until clear of obstacles.) 11. Wing Flaps RETRACT (At 400 feet AGL and at or above 95 KIAS.) NOTE If usable runway length is adequate, it is preferable to use a rolling start to begin the takeoff roll as opposed to a standing start at full power. Otherwise, position the airplane to use all of the runway available. CROSSWIND OPERATIONS Crosswind takeoffs and landings require a special technique but not specific procedures and, as such, do not require a dedicated checklist. Please see the amplified discussion on pages 4-23 and 4-27 for applicable crosswind techniques. NOTE If the cross control method is used during a crosswind approach, the resulting slight sideslip causes the airspeed to read up to 5 kts higher or lower, depending on the direction of the sideslip. NORMAL CLIMB 1. Airspeed ACCELERATE TO BEST RATE OF CLIMB SPEED OF 110 KIAS (See cruise climb discussion of page 4-24.) 2. Power Settings ADJUST AS NECESSARY 3. Fuel Selector SET TO RIGHT OR LEFT TANK (As appropriate.) RC050005 4-12 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

4. 5. 6. 7.

Mixture FULL RICH ABOVE 85% POWER Backup Fuel Pump ARMED Vapor Suppression ON (Above 18,000 ft.) Rudder Hold System SET RUDDER TO DESIRED POSITION AND ENGAGE RUDDER HOLD SYSTEM 8. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED

MAXIMUM PERFORMANCE CLIMB 1. Airspeed 110 KIAS (All altitudes.) 2. Power Settings 2600 RPM AND FULL THROTTLE 3. Fuel Selector SET TO RIGHT OR LEFT TANK (As appropriate.) 4. Mixture FULL RICH 5. Backup Fuel Pump ARMED 6. Vapor Suppression ON (Above 18,000 ft.) 7. Rudder Hold System SET RUDDER TO DESIRED POSITION AND ENGAGE RUDDER HOLD SYSTEM CRUISE 1. Rudder Hold System AS REQUIRED 2. Throttle SET AS APPROPRIATE TO ACHIEVE 85% POWER OR LESS (Refer to the cruise performance charts.) 3. Propeller SET AS APPROPRIATE TO ACHIEVE 85% POWER OR LESS (Refer to the cruise performance charts.) 4. Mixture LEAN AS REQUIRED (Use TIT gauge to set 1625F or performance charts in Section 5. Above 75% power, only rich of peak operation is permitted.) 5. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 6. Changing Fuel Tanks PERFORM STEPS 6.1 AND 6.2. 6.1. Vapor Suppression SET TO ON DURING FUEL TANK CHANGEOVERS 6.2. Fuel Selector CHANGE AS REQUIRED (The maximum permitted fuel imbalance is 10 gallons (38 L).) 7. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED 8. Oxygen Quantity CHECK PERIODICALLY (Approximately every 20 minutes.) 9. Oxygen Outlet Pressure CHECK PERIODICALLY (Approximately every 20 minutes.) 10. Flowmeter or Flow Indicator CHECK PERIODICALLY FOR OXYGEN FLOW (Approximately every 10 minutes.) 11. Altitude Change ADJUST FLOW DEVICES TO NEW ALTITUDE 12. Physiological Requirement ADJUST FLOW DEVICE TO HIGHER ALTITUDE NOTE Do not pull the throttle back to idle without leaning the mixture appropriately above 18,000 ft (Critical altitude, the engine does not produce full manifold pressure above the critical altitude). The reduced air density is causing an over-rich condition at idle, which floods the engine and can make it quit. If it does quit, it is possible to restart the engine at any altitude by leaning the mixture. Above 18,000 ft. the minimum manifold pressure is 15 in. Hg; minimum RPM is 2,200. NOTE The vapor suppression must be turned on before changing the selected fuel tank. After proper engine operations are established, the pump is turned off (except above 18,000 ft. when the pump stays on). When changing power, the sequence control usage is important. Monitor the TIT gauge to avoid exceeding 1750F limit. To increase power, first Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-13

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

increase the mixture (not necessarily to full rich), then increase RPM with the propeller control and then increase manifold pressure with the throttle control. To decrease power, decrease manifold pressure first with the throttle control and then decrease RPM with the propeller control. When engine temperatures have stabilized, lean mixture to desired TIT. WARNING Continuous overboost operation may damage the engine and require engine inspection. DESCENT 1. Fuel Selector RIGHT OR LEFT TANK (As appropriate.) 2. Power Settings AS REQUIRED 3. Mixture AS REQUIRED 4. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 5. Vapor Suppression OFF (Below 18,000 ft.) 6. PFD and Backup Altimeters SET 7. Altitude Bug SET 8. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED EXPEDITED DESCENT 1. Power Setting 2400 RPM and approximately 25 INCHES of MANIFOLD PRESSURE 2. SpeedBrakeTM Switch ON/UP POSITION 3. Airspeed 165 KIAS 4. SpeedBrakeTM Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION (To retract SpeedBrakesTM.) APPROACH 1. Approach LOADED INTO FLIGHTPLAN 2. PFD Baro Min SET 3. GPS Raim/Map Integrity VERIFY 4. PFD OBS/SUSP Softkey REVIEW and BRIEF USAGE DURING APPROACH 5. PFD CDI Button SELECT NAV SOURCE 6. Nav Aids TUNED AND IDENTIFIED 7. Approach Course SET 8. PFD and Backup Altimeters SET 9. Mixture FULL RICH NOTE Passing FAF, new course may be needed. BEFORE LANDING 1. Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses SECURE (Both pilot and passengers.) 2. Mixture FULL RICH 3. Fuel Selector RIGHT OR LEFT TANK (As appropriate.) 4. Backup Fuel Pump OFF 5. Propeller HIGH RPM 6. Rudder Hold System DISENGAGED 7. Autopilot DISENGAGED (If applicable.) NORMAL LANDING 1. Approach Airspeed AS REQUIRED FOR CONFIGURATION Flaps (Cruise Position) ...........................................95 to 100 KIAS Flaps (Takeoff Position)...........................................90 to 95 KIAS RC050005 4-14 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

2. 3. 4. 5.

Flaps (Landing Position) ..........................................85 to 90 KIAS Trim Tabs ADJUST AS REQUIRED Touchdown MAIN WHEELS FIRST Landing Roll GENTLY LOWER NOSE WHEEL Braking AS REQUIRED

SHORT FIELD LANDING (Complete BEFORE LANDING Checklist first.) 1. Wing Flaps LANDING POSITION 2. Initial Approach Airspeed 90 KIAS 3. Minimum Approach Speed 73 to 82 KIAS (Per Figure 5 - 35.) 4. Trim Tabs ADJUST AS REQUIRED 5. Power REDUCE AT THE FLARE POINT 6. Touchdown MAIN WHEELS FIRST 7. Landing Roll LOWER NOSE WHEEL SMOOTHLY AND QUICKLY 8. Braking and Flaps APPLY HEAVY BRAKING AND RETRACT FLAPS (Up position.) BALKED LANDING (Go Around) 1. Throttle FULL (At 2600 RPM.) 2. SpeedBrakes Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION 3. Wing Flaps TAKEOFF POSITION 4. Airspeed 82 KIAS 5. Climb POSITIVE (Establish Positive Rate of Climb.) 6. Backup Fuel Pump ARM 7. Wing Flaps RETRACT (At 400 feet AGL and at or above 95 KIAS.) AFTER LANDING 1. Wing Flaps UP (Cruise Position) 2. SpeedBrakes Switch OFF/DOWN POSITION 3. Door Seal, Pitot Heat, and Propeller Heat OFF 4. Transponder VERIFY STANDBY/GROUND MODE 5. Landing/Taxi Lights AS REQUIRED 6. Time NOTE SHUTDOWN 1. Parking Brake SET 2. Throttle IDLE (900 RPM) 3. Oxygen System OFF 4. ELT CHECK NOT ACTIVATED 5. Trim Tabs SET TO NEUTRAL 6. Time COOLDOWN COMPLETE 7. Avionics Master Switch OFF (Ensure shutdown.) 8. Electrical/Environmental Equipment OFF 9. Mixture IDLE CUTOFF 10. Left and Right Master Switches OFF 11. Ignition Switch OFF (After engine stops.) 12. Anti-Collision/Position Lights OFF CAUTION Allow the engine to idle at 900 RPM for 5 minutes before shutdown in order to cool the turbochargers. Taxi time can be counted as cooling time.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-15

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

AMPLIFIED PROCEDURES
PREFLIGHT INSPECTION The purpose of the preflight inspection is to ascertain that the airplane is physically capable of completing the intended operation with a high degree of safety. The weather conditions, length of flight, equipment installed, and daylight conditions, to mention a few, will dictate any special considerations that should be employed.

For example, in cold weather, the pilot needs to remove even small accumulations of frost or ice from the wings and control surfaces. Additionally, the hinging and actuating mechanism of each control surface must be inspected for ice accumulation. If the flight is initiated in or will be completed at nighttime, the operation of the airplanes lighting system must be inspected. Flights at high altitude have special oxygen considerations for the pilot and passengers. Clearly, a pilot must consider numerous special issues depending on the circumstances and conditions of flight. The preflight checklist provided in this handbook covers the minimum items that must be considered. Other items must be included as appropriate, depending on the flight operations and climatic conditions.
Wing Flaps Extending the wing flaps as part of the preflight routine permits inspection of the attachment and actuating hardware. The pilot can also roughly compare that the flaps are equally extended on each side. The flaps are not designed to serve as a step. Stepping on the flaps places unnatural loads in excess of their design and can cause damage. If the flaps are extended during the preflight inspection, it is unlikely that an uninformed passenger will use them as a step. Aileron Servo Tab The aileron servo tab on the trailing edge of the left aileron assists in movement of the aileron. The servo tab is connected to the aileron in a manner that causes the tab to move in a direction opposite the movement of the aileron. The increased aerodynamic force applied to the tab helps to move the aileron and reduces the level of required force to the control stick. During the preflight inspection, it should be noted that movement of the left aileron, up or down, produces an opposite movement of the servo tab. When the aileron is in the neutral position, the servo tab should be neutral. Fuel Drains The inboard section of each tank contains a fuel drain near the lowest point in each tank. The fuel drain operates with a typical sampling device and can be opened intermittently for a small sample or it can be locked open to remove a large quantity of fuel. The accessory door for the gascolator/fuel strainer is located under the fuselage, on the left side, near the wing saddle. It is a conventional drain device that operates by pushing up on the valve stem. The access door in this area must be opened to access the gascolator.

During the preflight inspection, the fuel must be sampled from each drain before flying to check for the proper grade of fuel, water contamination and fuel impurities. The test must be performed before the first flight of the day and after each refueling. If the system has water contamination, it will form as a bubble in the bottom of the collection reservoir while sediment appears as floating specks. If fuel grades are mixed, the sample will be colorless. If contamination is detected, continue to draw fuel until the samples are clear. If fuel grades were mixed, the entire fuel system may require draining. See page 8-6 for an expanded discussion of fuel contamination.
Stall Warning Vane The stall warning vane located on the leading edge of the left wing should be checked to ensure freedom of movement and that the vane is not bent or otherwise damaged. Fuel Vents The airplane has a fuel vent for each wing tank. The vents are wedge shaped recesses built into an inspection cover. They are located under each wing approximately five feet inboard from the wing tip. The vents are installed to ensure that air pressure inside the tank is the same as the outside atmospheric pressure. The vents should be open and free of dirt, mud, and other types of clogging substances.

RC050005 4-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

FUEL SELECTOR The fuel system design does not favor the use of one fuel tank over the other. The various checklists used in this manual specify Set to Left or Right Tank. During takeoff and landing operations, it is recommended that the fuel selector be set to the fuller tank if there are no compelling reasons to do otherwise. Under low fuel conditions, selecting the fuller tank may provide a more positive fuel flow, particularly in turbulent air. The vapor suppression must be operated while changing the selected fuel tank. However, switching the fuel tanks at low altitudes above the ground is normally not recommended unless there is a compelling reason to do otherwise.

When a tank is selected and the selector is properly seated in its detent, one of two blue dots on the fuel indicator illuminate to indicate which tank is selected. If a dot is not illuminated, then the selector handle is not properly seated in the detent. In addition, if the fuel selector is not seated or is in the OFF position, a red FUEL VALVE indication is displayed on the PFD annunciation window.
FUEL QUANTITY The Columbia 400 fuel quantity measuring system described on page 7-35 provides a fairly accurate indication of the onboard fuel. The system has two sensors in each tank, and flat spots in the indicating system are minimized. Still, the gauges must never be used in place of a visual inspection of each tank. A raised metal tab is installed in the bottom of each tank, directly below the filler neck, which limits inadvertent damage to the bottom of the tank from a fuel nozzle. A cutout in the tab allows observation of fuel level below the tab. For S/N 41501 to 41799, the top of the tab corresponds to a fuel quantity in the tank of approximately 25 gallons US (95 L). For S/N 41800 and on, the tab has two steps, the tops of which correspond to a usable quantity of fuel in the tank of approximately 27 gallons US (102 L) for the lower step and 43 gallons US (163 L) for the upper step, respectively.

These tabs provide the pilot with an approximate indication of fuel quantity. However, the best procedure for establishing the precise quantity of fuel is by having empty tanks filled to the level of the tabs from a metered fuel supply. For fuel quantities above the level of the tabs, a measuring stick can be made that indicates precise quantities. Since the tab is directly below the filler hole, it is suggested that the measuring stick be placed on these tabs when this procedure is used to determine fuel quantity. Of course, this means that it is not possible to visually sample levels less than indicated by the lowest tab. However, setting a sampling device in the tanks at an angle to avoid the tabs will skew indications on the stick. If such a stick is made, it must be of sufficient length to preclude being dropped into the tank. Here are a few final suggestions regarding the measuring stick. (1) Marks on the stick should be etched into the wood or labeled with a paint that is impermeable to aviation fuel. (2) Remember, that sticking the tanks may not be a precise indication, and a margin for safety should be added. (3) It is a good idea to make a reference mark at the top of the measuring device that indicates the position of the top of the filler neck. If the reference mark on the stick goes below the tank neck when it is inserted in the tank, the measuring stick is resting on the bottom of the tank, rather than on the tab.
STATIC WICKS The static wicks are designed to discharge accumulated static electricity created by the airplanes movement through the air. Because the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) cruises at high speeds, the wicks are the solid type with a carbon interior and a plastic exterior. The static wick can be broken without obvious exterior indications. To check the wicks integrity, hold its trailing edge between the thumb and forefinger, and gently move it left and right about two inches. If the unit flexes at point A as shown in Figure 4 - 3, the wick is broken and should be replaced.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-17

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Figure 4 - 3 In some instances, the owners and/or operators prefer to remove the wicks after each flight to prevent breakage during storage. If the wicks are removed, they must be reinstalled before each flight. Flight without the wicks can cause the loss of, or problems with communications and navigation. See Section 7, page 7-54 for more information.
BEFORE STARTING ENGINE Fresh Air Vents The fresh air eyeball vents for all unoccupied seats shall be closed when the pilot is the only person in the airplane. This is because, in the event of an engine fire, all ventilation must be turned off. Turning off inaccessible fresh air ventilation while attending to the demands of the emergency makes the situation more difficult. Three Point Restraints (Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses) The pilot-in-command is usually diligent about securing his or her restraint device; however, it is important to ensure that each passenger has their belt properly fastened. The lower body restraints on all seats are adjustable. However, they may not be similar to airline or automotive restraint devices. A passenger may have the seat belt fastened but not properly adjusted. See page 7-13 for a detailed discussion. The use of seat belts is also explained on the Passenger Briefing Card.

Stow the restraint devices on unoccupied seats to prevent fouling during emergency exiting of the airplane. Unoccupied rear seat restraints should be drawn to the smallest size possible and the male and female ends of the buckle engaged in the rear seat positions. The front seat passenger restraint buckle must not be engaged, even if the seat is unoccupied.
Child Restraints The use of seat belts and child restraint systems (car seats) for children and infants is somewhat more complicated. The FARs state that a child may be held by an adult who is occupying an approved seat, provided that the person being held has not reached his or her. second birthday and does not occupy or use any restraining device. If a restraining device is used, the FARs require a type approved under one of the following conditions.

1.

Seats manufactured to U.S. standards between January 1, 1981, and February 25, 1985 must bear the label: This child restraint system conforms to all applicable federal motor vehicle safety standards. Seats manufactured to U.S. standards on or after February 26, 1985 must bear two labels: This child restraint system conforms to all applicable federal motor vehicle safety standards and This restraint is certified for use in motor vehicles and aircraft in red lettering. Seats that do not meet the above requirements must bear either a label showing approval of a foreign government or a label showing that the seat was manufactured under the standards of the United Nations.

2.

3.

Approved child restraint systems usually limit the maximum child weight and height to 40 lbs. (18 kg) and 40 inches (102 cm), respectively. Placing higher weights in the seat exceeds the intended design of the child restraint system, and the only alternative is use of a passenger seat restraint. However, use of the diagonal torso restraint for a small child presents special issues since the shoulder strap may not fit across the childs shoulder and upper chest. For a child under 55 inches (140 cm) tall, The Academy of Pediatrics (AOP) recommends the use of a lap belt, and to put the shoulder strap behind the child. This is not as protective as an adjustable lap/shoulder combination would be. In fact, use of the lap belt alone has been associated with a
RC050005 4-18 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

number of different injuries. According to the AOP, the least desirable alternative is to put the shoulder strap under one arm.
ENGINE STARTING Normal Starting Under normal conditions there should be no problems with starting the engine. The most common pilot mistake is over priming of the engine. The engine is primed by introducing fuel to the intake ports. The start should then be initiated immediately. As the engine starts it is important to advance the throttle slowly to maintain the proper fuel-air mixture. Abnormal atmospheric conditions require special procedures and techniques for starting the airplane. Please refer to Warm and Cold Weather Operations later in this section, which begins on page 4-30. Under Priming If the engine does not start in three or four revolutions of the propeller, the engine may not be adequately primed. This condition is also characterized by seemingly normal smokeless start of four or five revolutions of the propeller followed by a sudden stop, as though the mixture were in idle cutoff. When the engine first starts to quit, hold the primer switch on for a few seconds until the engine runs smoothly. If this does not work, the cause of the excessively lean mixture after starting may be related to an assortment of atmospheric conditions rather than improper priming procedures. Repeat the starting procedure but allow a few extra seconds of priming. Over Priming If the engine starts intermittently and is followed by puffs of black smoke, over priming is the most likely cause. The black smoke means the mixture is too rich and the engine is burning off the excess fuel. The condition also occurs in hot weather where the decreased air density causes an excessively rich mixture. If this should happen, ensure that the vapor suppression and backup fuel pump are off, set the mixture to idle cutoff, advance the throttle to full, and restart the engine. When the engine starts, advance the mixture to full rich and reduce the throttle setting to idle. CAUTION Over priming can cause a flooded intake resulting in a hydrostatic lock and subsequent engine malfunction or failure. If the engine is inadvertently or accidentally over primed, allow all the fuel to drain from the intake manifold before starting the engine. BATTERY RECHARGING Ground Power Operations A ground power unit can be connected to the airplane in the event the normal battery system is inoperative or inadequate. An inoperative battery could occur if the master switches were not secured at the end of the previous flight or in very cold weather. The battery master and crosstie switches must be turned on when using a ground power unit to charge the batteries. The ammeter must be monitored when recharging the batteries, as damage to the batteries can occur if the voltage from the ground power unit is too high. The battery master and crosstie switches must be turned off before removing the ground power plug; if the switches are on, the cables to the plug will stay energized. If one, or both, of the batteries is completely dead, the master relay will not energize for ground power charging. In this case the battery(ies) must be removed for charging.

A battery charging circuit has been added to the power grid on aircraft built mid 2007, or is available for retrofit, that will energize the battery relays and allow ground power charging of flat or discharged batteries without removing the battery(ies) from the aircraft. The circuit does not affect the operation of the master and crosstie switches. Use the following procedure to charge the batteries using a ground power unit (GPU): 1. Connect the GPU. 2. Both battery master switches then crosstie switch ON 3. Turn on the GPU. 4. Once batteries are charged, both battery master switches and crosstie switch OFF
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-19

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

5.

Disconnect the GPU.


NOTE Batteries that are suspected to be bad must be removed from the aircraft and serviced or replaced. See Chapter 24 of the Maintenance Manual for battery testing and maintenance procedures. CAUTION The ammeter must be monitored when recharging the batteries, as damage to the batteries can occur if the voltage from the ground power unit is too high.

Left Battery Inoperative If the flip lights are inadvertently left on for an extended period of time, the left battery will drain. In this event one of two procedures can be used to recharge the battery. NOTE When observing the recharging progress of a battery, two things should be considered. If the ammeter continuously has a high indication with little or no decrease in the charging amperage, the battery has a short. If the ammeter continuously indicates zero, the battery has an open cell. In either event, the battery needs to be replaced.

1. 2.

Ground Power Available The battery can be recharged using a ground power unit when monitoring the ammeter. This will normally take about 30 minutes. The battery should indicate five amps or less of current draw before charging operations are suspended. Ground Power Not Available If a ground power unit is not available, the airplane can be started using the right battery. Turn off the flip light for 15 to 20 minutes. This time is needed for the battery to bounce back and develop enough charge to energize the left battery relay. If the flip light has been on for several days or the battery is old, it may not bounce back, and the battery must be removed from the aircraft and charged withy a battery charger.

Use the normal starting procedures checklist, which includes turning on the right master switch. It is not necessary to use the crosstie switch to start the airplane. When the starter is engaged, it will only energize the right starter contactor, since there is no battery power to energize the left contactor. Once the engine is running, the crosstie switch must be turned on to charge the left battery. Check the charge condition of the batteries at 1700 RPM. If the battery charging current is less than 10 amps for each battery, the batteries are sufficiently charged.
Right Battery Inoperative It is possible that the right master was not secured and inadvertently left on. In this case, the right battery would be discharged. The right battery may be charged in the same manner as the left battery. CROSSTIE OPERATIONS CHECKLIST The Crosstie Operations Checklist is performed prior to the Before Taxi Checklist. If the crosstie system is not operational, there is no point in completing the remaining checklists. In addition, completing the checklist at this point will limit the time spent in the runup area where other aircraft are waiting to depart. The checklist is important because it checks the integrity of the crosstie system. In particular, it verifies the operation of all four diodes (two on the avionics bus and two on the essential bus), and ensures that these two buses have neither a shorted or open circuit. PASSENGER BRIEFING CARD There are a number of items with which the passengers must be familiar. These items can easily be covered through use of the Passenger Briefing Cards that are included in the airplane as part of the delivery package. It is recommended that passengers be advised of the briefing cards location RC050005 4-20 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

before taxiing the airplane. This will provide ample time for the passengers to review the cards before takeoff. The information contained on the briefing cards is shown below. 1. Seat Belt Federal Aviation Regulations require each passenger to use the installed restraint devices during taxi, takeoff, and landing. Use of the three-point restraint system is accomplished by grasping the male end of the buckle, drawing the lap webbing and diagonal harness across the lower and upper torso, and inserting it into the female end of the buckle. There is a distinctive snap when the two parts are properly connected. To release the belt, press the red button on the female portion of the buckle. 2. Seat Belt and Harness Adjustment Adjusting two devices in the lap-webbing loop varies the length of the lap belt. One end of the adjustment loop contains a dowel, and the other has a small strap. Draw the dowel and strap together to enlarge the lap belt size, and draw them apart to tighten the lap belt. The upper torso restraints are connected to an inertia reel and no adjustment is required. 3. Headsets If there are headsets for the passenger seating positions, their use is recommended. Comfort is enhanced in terms of noise fatigue, and the use of headsets facilitates intercom communications. To use the voice-activated microphone, position the boom mike about one quarter of an inch from the mouth, and speak in a normal voice. 4. Emergency Exit Procedures (Cabin Doors) In most emergencies, the cabin doors are used for exiting the airplane. The interior door handles are located near the bottom-aft portion of the cabin doors. To open a door, pull the handle away from the door and lift up until the handle is slightly past the horizontal position. There are placards on the interior doors labeled Open and Closed with direction arrows. 5. Crash Ax/Hatchet A crash ax is located under the pilots seat for use in the event the normal cabin and the emergency door releases are inoperable. To use the ax, open the Velcro fastener, and remove the ax from its sheath. It generally works best to strike the corner edge of the window near the doorframe. Several smart blows to the window area around the perimeter of the doorframe will remove enough pieces so that the middle portion of the window can be removed with a few heavy blows. Once the major portion of the window is removed and if time and circumstances permit, use the ax blade to smooth down the jagged edges around the doorframe. This will minimize injury when exiting the airplane through the window. 6. Oxygen System Operation The pilot will notify you when use of oxygen is required. The pilot will explain use of the equipment and applicable emergency procedures. 7. No Smoking There is no smoking permitted in the airplane, no ashtrays are provided for smoking, and the airplane is not certified as such. It is a violation of Federal Aviation Regulations to smoke in this airplane.
CONTROL POSITIONS VERSUS WIND COMPONENT The airplane is stable on the ground. The low wing design minimizes the tipping tendency from strong winds while taxiing. Still, the proper positioning of control surfaces during taxiing will improve ground stability in high wind conditions. The following table, Figure 4 - 4, summarizes control positions that should be maintained for a given wind component.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-21

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Wind Component
Left Quartering Headwind Right Quartering Headwind Left Quartering Tailwind Right Quartering Tailwind

Aileron Position
Left Wing Aileron Up (Move Aileron Control to the Left) Right Wing Aileron Up (Move Aileron Control to the Right) Left Wing Aileron Down (Move Aileron Control to the Right) Right Wing Aileron Down (Move Aileron Control to the Left)

Elevator Position
Neutral Hold Elevator Control in Neutral Position Neutral Hold Elevator Control in Neutral Position Down Elevator (Move Elevator Control Forward) Down Elevator (Move Elevator Control Forward)

Figure 4 - 4
TAXIING The first thing to check during taxiing is the braking system. This should be done a few moments after the taxi roll is begun. Apply normal braking to verify that both brakes are operational. The operation of the turn coordinator and directional gyro can be checked during taxiing provided enough time has elapsed for the instruments to become stable, normally two to three minutes. Make a few small left and right S-turns, and check the instruments for proper operation.

When taxiing, minimize the use of the brakes. Since the airplane has a free castoring nose wheel, steering is accomplished with light braking. Avoid the tendency to ride the brakes by making light steering corrections as required and then allowing the feet to slide off the brakes and the heels to touch the floor. Avoid taxiing in areas of loose gravel, small rocks, etc., since it can cause abrasion and damage to the propeller. If it is necessary to taxi in these areas, maintain low propeller speeds. If taxiing from a hard surface through a small area of gravel, obtain momentum before reaching the gravel. The aircraft should never be taxied while the doors are in the full up position. The doors may be opened six to eight inches during taxi, which can be controlled by grasping the arm rest or looping the door strap around the arm.
BEFORE TAKEOFF Engine Temperatures The control of engine temperatures is an important consideration when operating the airplane on the ground. The efficient aerodynamic design and closely contoured cowling around the engine maximizes cooling in flight. However, care must be used to preclude overheating during ground operations. Before starting the engine runup check, be sure the airplane is aligned for the maximum headwind component. Conversely, when the ambient temperature is low, time may be needed for temperatures to reach normal operating ranges. Do not attempt to run up the engine until the oil temperature reaches 100F (38C). Engine Runup The engine runup is performed at 1700 RPM. To check the operation of the magnetos, move the ignition switch first to the L position and note the RPM drop. Return the switch to the R/L position, and then move the switch to the R position to check the RPM drop. Return the switch to the R/L position. The difference between the magnetos when operated individually cannot exceed 50 RPM, and the maximum drop on either magneto cannot be greater than 150 RPM.

To check the propeller operation, move the propeller control to the low RPM position for a few seconds until a 300 to 500 RPM drop is registered on the tachometer. Return the propeller control to the high RPM position and ensure that engine speed returns to 1700 RPM. Repeat this procedure two or three times to circulate warm oil into the propeller hub.

RC050005 4-22

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

While the engine is set to 1700 RPM, check the engine instruments to verify that all indications are within normal limits. Check the charge condition of the batteries at 1700 RPM. If the battery charging current is less than 10 amps, for each battery, the batteries are sufficiently charged.
Door Seals The door seal switch is not turned on until the baggage door and both cabin doors are latched, usually just before takeoff. If the Door Open annunciation is illuminated and/or the aural warning is annunciating that the door is open, then one of the doors is not completely closed and the door seal system will not operate. Oxygen System To assure proper operation of the oxygen system, insert a mask into the overhead distribution manifold. Verify the overhead switch is in the ON position (guard closed.) Verify the overhead master switches and avionics switch are ON. Select the SYSTEM key on the MFD. Select the Oxygen key on the SYSTEM page ON, and verify the PFD displays a white advisory indicating "OXYGEN ON". Open the flowmeter on the oxygen mask and verify steady oxygen flow (flow ball in the mid-position or greater,) for at least 5 seconds. Verify the PFD does not display a caution annunciation for low oxygen manifold pressure (OXYGEN PRES), and oxygen outlet pressure indicates normally. TAKEOFFS Normal Takeoff In all takeoff situations, the primary consideration is to ascertain that the engine is developing full takeoff power. This is normally checked in the initial phase of the takeoff run. The engine should operate smoothly and provide normal acceleration. The engine RPM should read 2600 RPM and the manifold pressure should be near anticipated output. Ensure that the engine is not overboosting (manifold pressure is at or below 35.5 in. of Hg).

Avoid the tendency to ride the brakes by making light steering corrections as required and then allowing the feet to slide off the brakes and the heels to touch the floor. For normal takeoffs (not short field) on surfaces with loose gravel and the like, the rate of throttle advancement should be slightly less than normal. While this extends the length of the takeoff run somewhat, the technique permits the airplane to obtain momentum at lower RPM settings, which reduces the potential for propeller damage. Using this technique ensures that the propeller blows loose gravel and rocks aft of the propeller blade. Rapid throttle advancement is more likely to draw gravel and rocks into the propeller blade.
Short Field Takeoff The three major items of importance in a short field takeoff are developing maximum takeoff power, maximum acceleration, and utilization of the entire runway available. Be sure the mixture is properly set for takeoff if operating from a high altitude airport. During the takeoff run, do not raise the nose wheel too soon since this will impede acceleration. Finally, use the entire runway that is available; that is, initiate the takeoff run at the furthest downwind point available. Use a rolling start if possible, provided there is adequate usable runway. If a rolling start is practicable, any necessary mixture adjustment should be made just before initiating the takeoff run.

The flaps are set to the takeoff position. After liftoff, maintain the speed per Figure 5 - 11 until the airplane is clear of all obstacles. Once past all obstacles, accelerate to the best rate of climb speed (110 KIAS), and raise the flaps. If no obstacles are present, accelerate the airplane to the best rate of climb speed, and raise the flaps when at a safe height above the ground.
Crosswind Takeoff Crosswind takeoffs should be made with takeoff flaps. When the take off run is initiated, the aileron is fully deflected into the wind. As the airplane accelerates and control response becomes more positive, the aileron deflection should be reduced as necessary. Accelerate the airplane to approximately 75 knots, and then quickly lift the airplane off the ground. When airborne, turn the airplane into the wind as required to maintain alignment over the runway and in the climb out corridor. Maintain the best angle of climb speed (82 to 86 KIAS) until the airplane is clear of all obstacles. Once past all obstacles, accelerate to the best rate of climb speed (110 KIAS); Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-23

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

at or above 400 feet AGL, raise the flaps. The maximum demonstrated crosswind component for takeoff is 23 knots.
NORMAL AND MAXIMUM PERFORMANCE CLIMBS Best Rate of Climb Speeds The normal climb speed of the airplane, 110 KIAS, produces the most altitude gain in a given time period while allowing for proper engine cooling and good forward visibility. The best rate of climb airspeed is used in situations which require the most altitude gain in a given time period, such as after takeoff when an initial 2,000 feet or so height above the ground is desirable as a safety buffer. In another situation, ATC might require the fastest altitude change possible. The mixture should always be full rich in climbs. Cruise Climb Climbing at speeds above 115 KIAS is preferable, particularly when climbing to higher altitudes, i.e., those that require more than 6,000 feet of altitude change. A 500 FPM rate climb at cruise power provides better forward visibility and engine cooling. The engine should not be leaned during climb. CAUTION Do not lean the engine during climb. Best Angle of Climb Speeds The best angle of climb airspeed (VX) for the airplane is 82 KIAS at sea level to 86 KIAS at 10,000 feet, with flaps in the up position. The best angle of climb airspeed produces the maximum altitude change in a given distance and is used in a situation where clearance of obstructions is required. When using the best angle of climb airspeed, the rate at which the airplane approaches an obstruction is reduced, which allows more space in which to climb. For example, if a pilot is approaching the end of a canyon and must gain altitude, the appropriate VX speed should be used. Variations in the VX speeds from sea level to 10,000 feet are more or less linear, assuming ISA conditions. Power Settings Use maximum continuous power until the airplane reaches a safe altitude above the ground. Ensure the propeller RPM does not exceed the red line limitation. It is recommended to use full throttle and 2600 RPM in climb because this setting provides the engine with extra fuel for cooling at the slower airspeeds. When changing power, the sequence control usage is important. To decrease power, decrease manifold pressure first with the throttle control and then decrease RPM with the propeller control. The engines turbochargers keep manifold pressure constant from MSL to approximately 18,000 ft. NOTE During normal climb operations above 18,000 feet, a minimum engine condition of 2,200 RPM and 15 in.Hg of manifold air pressure are required to insure proper turbocharger operation is maintained. If engine operation below 15 in.Hg of manifold air pressure is necessary, the fuel mixture must be properly leaned or engine stoppage will result.

WARNING Continuous overboost operation may damage the engine and require engine inspection. Vapor Suppression The vapor suppression switch must be turned on in the following situations:

Operations above 18,000 ft. If TIT is rising above 1460F at full power with the mixture full rich (at any altitude).

RC050005 4-24

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Once engine temperatures have stabilized and if the aircraft is below 18,000 ft, the vapor suppression switch may be turned off. The vapor suppression switch should also be turned on any time the engine is not running smooth or it is suspected there is vapor in the lines. Vapor in the lines is most likely to happen in hot weather or at high altitudes.
NORMAL OPERATIONS ABOVE 18,000 FT During normal climb, cruise and descent operations above 18,000 ft., a minimum engine condition of 2200 RPM and 15 in.Hg of manifold air pressure are required to insure proper turbocharger operation is maintained. If engine operation below 15 in.Hg of manifold air pressure is necessary, the fuel mixture must be properly leaned or engine stoppage will result. CRUISE Flight Planning Several considerations are necessary in selecting a cruise airspeed, power setting, and altitude. The primary issues are time, range, and fuel consumption. High cruise speeds shorten the time en route, but at the expense of decreased range and increased fuel consumption.

Cruising at higher altitudes increases true airspeed and improves fuel consumption, but the time and fuel used to reach the higher cruise altitude must be considered. Clearly, numerous factors are weighed to determine what altitude, airspeed, and power settings are optimal for a particular flight. Section 5 in this manual contains detailed information to assist the pilot in the flight planning process. In general, the airplane cruises at 50% to 85% of available power. The maximum recommended cruise power setting is 85%. The minimum cruise power setting is 40%, but higher power settings may be required in colder weather to maintain minimum engine temperatures.
Mixture Settings In cruise flight and cruise climb, care is needed to ensure that engine instrument indications are maintained within normal operating ranges. After reaching the desired altitude and engine temperatures stabilize (usually within five minutes), the mixture must be adjusted. The engine driven fuel pump references deck pressure and adjusts mixture automatically for deck pressure and altitude effects. The pilot is responsible to lean the mixture in cruise for lower fuel flow. Control by Turbine Inlet Temperature (TIT) When leaning the mixture using TIT, the pilot should use the TIT gauge on the MFD. At power settings below 85% power, starting at full rich mixture, lean slowly while observing the TIT. When changing the mixture to lean of peak, it is acceptable to have TIT indications temporarily in the yellow range, but indications must return to the normal range upon leaning completion. Best power is obtained at 1625F. Above 65% power, the engine must be operated rich of peak to avoid exceeding the TIT limit. Below 65% power the engine can be leaned past peak and be operated 50F lean of peak TIT. Lean of peak operation improves the efficiency of the airplane and provides about 30F lower CHT at the same RPM/MAP combination. Fuel flow can be used as a reference to judge the resulting power setting, but should not be used for leaning. CAUTION Do not lean the engine when operating above 85% power. At power settings above 85%, the mixture must be full rich. Do not lean the engine during climb. CAUTION To prevent detonation, when increasing power, enrich mixture, advance RPM, and adjust throttle setting, in that order. When reducing power, retard throttle, then adjust RPM and mixture. Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-25

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CAUTION When leaning the mixture, it is acceptable to have TIT indications temporarily in the yellow range to detect peak. Once leaning is complete, the temperatures are in the normal range. WARNING Continuous overboost operation may damage the engine and require engine inspection. Door Seals Normally, the door seal switch remains in the On position for the entire flight. If the system pressure drops below 12 psi, the air pump will cycle on until pressure is restored. If the pump runs continuously, it is an indication that a seal is damaged and incapable of holding pressure. In this situation, the door seal system should not be operated until repairs are made. Inoperative Door Seal Dump Valve If the door seal dump valve should fail, the door seal system can still be operated. However, the door seals must not be turned on until after takeoff and must be turned off before landing. This procedure ensures rapid egress from the airplane in an emergency situation. Moreover, opening the doors with the seals inflated can damage the inflatable gaskets. For more information on the door seals and dump valve refer to page 7-15. DESCENT The primary considerations during the descent phase of the flight are to maintain the engine temperatures within normal indications. The descent from altitude is best performed through gradual power reductions and gradual enrichment of the mixture. Avoid long descents at low manifold pressure as the engine can cool excessively and may not accelerate properly when power is reapplied. If long, rapid descents are made, the speed brakes (if installed) should be deployed rather than reducing the power significantly.

The fuel pump switch should only be in the armed position for takeoff and climb. It should be off for descent and landing; during very low power operation and improper fuel system setup it may be possible that the fuel pressure will drop below the 5.5 psi limit at which time the fuel pump will come on. If this happens, the engine will flood and quit. If power must be reduced for long periods, set the propeller to the minimum low RPM setting, and adjust manifold pressure as required to maintain the desired descent. If the outside air temperature is extremely cold, it may be necessary to add drag to the airplane by lowering the flaps so that additional power is needed to maintain the descent airspeed. Do not permit the cylinder head temperature to drop below 240F (116C) for more than five minutes.
WARNING During longer descents it is imperative that the pilot occasionally clear the airplanes engine by application of partial power. This helps keep the engine from over cooling and verifies that power is available. If the engine quits during a glide, there may be no positive instrument indication or annunciation of this condition, and with power reduced, there is no aural indication. APPROACH On the downwind leg, adjust power to maintain 110 KIAS to 120 KIAS with the flaps retracted. When opposite the landing point, reduce power, set the flaps to the takeoff position, and reduce speed to about 90 KIAS. On the base leg, set the flaps to the landing position, and reduce speed to 85 or 90 KIAS. Be prepared to counteract the ballooning tendency which occurs when full flaps are applied. On final approach, maintain airspeed of 80 to 85 KIAS depending on crosswind condition

RC050005 4-26

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

and/or landing weight. Reduce the indicated airspeed to 80 knots as the touchdown point is approached.
Glideslope Flight Procedure with Autopilot Approach the glideslope intercept point (usually the OM) with the flaps set to the takeoff position at 100 to 115 KIAS (recommended approach speed in turbulence is 110 KIAS or greater) and with the aircraft stabilized in altitude hold mode. At the glideslope intercept, adjust power for the desired airspeed. For best tracking results make power adjustment in small, smooth increments to maintain desired airspeed. At 200 feet AGL disconnect the autopilot and continue to manually fly the aircraft to the missed approach point or the decision height (See Limitations Section). If a missed approach is required, the autopilot may be re-engaged after the aircraft has been reconfigured for and established in a stabilized climb above 400 feet AGL.

When making ILS approaches in the Columbia aircraft the pilot should plan to intercept the approach between 100 to 115 KTS. Once established and the glideslope intercept is achieved, the flaps should be placed in the T.O. position and the aircraft slowed to 100 KTS. At the FAF (final approach fix), full flaps should be applied and the aircraft slowed to 90 KTS. This technique will typically require a power setting in excess of 1900 RPM. Power settings resulting in approximately 1800-1850 RPM should be avoided as this propeller speed may intermodulate with the glideslope reception resulting in continuous minor control stick motion during coupled approaches and continuous minor glideslope deviation indications during coupled and non-coupled, or hand-flown, ILS approaches.
LANDINGS Normal Landings Landings under normal conditions are performed with the flaps set to the landing position. The landing approach speed is 85 to 90 KIAS depending on gross weight and wind conditions. The approach can be made with or without power; however, power should be reduced to idle before touchdown. The use of forward and sideslips are permitted if required to dissipate excess altitude. Remember that the slipping maneuver will increase the stall speed of the airplane, and a margin for safety should be added to the approach airspeed. CAUTION Avoid sideslips with full flaps, as there is potential for the aircraft to pitch down unintentionally. CAUTION Avoid rapid throttle movement in order to reduce manifold pressure overboost. Smooth throttle movements allow the turbochargers to keep pace with the engine operating conditions.

The landing attitude is slightly nose up so that the main gear touches the ground first. After touchdown, the back-pressure on the elevator should be released slowly so the nose gear gently touches the ground. Brakes should be applied gently and evenly to both pedals. Avoid skidding the tires or holding brake pressure for sustained periods.
Short Field Landings In a short field landing, the important issues are to land just past the beginning of the runway at minimum speed. The initial approach should be made at 85 to 90 KIAS and reduced to 80 KIAS when full flaps are applied. A low-power descent, from a slightly longer than normal final approach, is preferred. It provides more time to set up and establish the proper descent path. If there is an obstacle, cross over it at the speed indicated in the landing schedule in Figure 5 - 36 on page 5-41. Maintain a power on approach until just prior to touchdown. Do not extend the landing flare; rather, allow the airplane to land in a slight nose up attitude on the main landing gear first. Lower the nose wheel smoothly and quickly, and apply heavy braking. However, do not skid the tires. Braking response is improved if the flaps are retracted after touchdown. Crosswind Landings When landing in a strong crosswind, use a slightly higher than normal approach speed, and avoid the use of landing flaps unless required because of runway length. If Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 4-27

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

practicable, use an 85 to 90 KIAS approach speed with the flaps in the takeoff position. A power descent, from a slightly longer than normal final approach, is preferred. It provides more time to set up and establish the proper crosswind compensation. Maintain runway alignment either with a crab into the wind, a gentle forward slip (upwind wing down), or a combination of both. Touch down on the upwind main gear first by holding aileron into the wind. As the airplane decelerates, increase the aileron deflection. Apply braking as required. Raising the flaps after landing will reduce the lateral movement caused by the wind and also improves braking. The maximum demonstrated crosswind component for landing is 23 knots. Sideslipping the airplane will cause the airspeed to read up to 5 kts higher or lower, depending on the direction of the sideslip. This occurs because the static air source for the airplane is only on one side of the fuselage.
Balked Landings In a balked landing or a go-around, the primary concerns are to maximize power, minimize drag, and establish a climb. Initiate a go-around by the immediate but smooth full application of power. If the flaps are in the landing position, reduce them to the takeoff positions once a positive rate of climb is established at 80 KIAS. Increase speed to VY. When the airplane is a safe distance above the surface and at 106 KIAS or higher, arm the backup fuel pump and retract the flaps to the up position. Heavy Braking After heavy braking, especially when the airplane is near gross weight, allow the brakes to cool for about 20 minutes before additional heavy braking. The brakes may overheat if there is repeated heavy braking without adequate cooling time. Oxygen System After landing, select the Oxygen system OFF, and verify the valve closed by leaving a mask inserted into the overhead outlet, releasing the outlet pressure. If oxygen continues to flow after 5 seconds, the oxygen valve has failed to close. SHUTDOWN The engine should be idled at 900 RPM for five minutes minimum after landing (part of this may be taxi time) in order to give the turbochargers time to cool down while oil is still circulated to the bearings. If the engine is shutdown hot, the oil left in the turbochargers will be heated to the temperature of the turbochargers (in excess of 1000F) and cannot properly lubricate. If engine RPM must be raised above 1200 RPM during the cool down period, the five minute cool down period must be restarted. STALLS The stall characteristics of the airplane are influenced by the stall strips and the leading edge tape on the wings and on the horizontal surface of the tail. If there is any damage to the stall strips or the leading edge tape, do not attempt to stall the airplane.

Airplanes equipped with flat triangular leading edge tape on the wings and/or zig zag tape on the bottom surface of the horizontal tail will have improved stall characteristics at all flap settings. The triangular tape influences the boundary layer at high angles of attack. The zig zag tape influences elevator authority at large elevator up deflections.
Practicing Stalls Stalls and slow flight should be practiced at safe altitudes to allow for recovery. Any of these maneuvers should be practiced at an altitude in excess of 6,000 feet above ground level. As stall attitude is approached, be alert. Take prompt corrective action to avoid the stall or if you are practicing stalls, react the moment the stall buffet occurs. In addition the following is recommended:

1. 2.

Do not carry passengers. Be certain that the aircrafts center of gravity is as far forward as possible without exceeding the approved flight envelope.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-28

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

3. 4. 5. 6.

Be certain that both the student pilot and instructor pilot have a full set of operable controls including toe brakes. Conduct such practice at altitudes in excess of 6,000 ft above ground level. Air conditioning and other nonessential electrical systems should be turned off to prevent battery discharge during low engine RPM operations. Increased fresh air ventilation may be needed to ensure pilot comfort at the lower airspeeds during slow flight or stalls practice.

For unaccelerated stalls (a speed decrease of one knot/second or less), the stall recovery should be initiated at the first indication of the stall or the so-called break that occurs while in the nose high pitch position. A drop in attitude that cannot be controlled or maintained with the elevator control normally indicates this break. The maximum altitude loss during power off stalls is approximately 300 ft. to 400 ft. There are fairly benign stall characteristics when the airplane is loaded with a forward CG. In most cases, there is not a discernable break even though the control stick is in the full back position. In this situation, after two seconds of full aft stick application, stall recovery should be initiated. To recover from a stall, simultaneously release back-pressure, and apply full power; then level the wings with the coordinated application of rudder and aileron. Accelerated stalls can occur at higher-than-normal airspeeds due to abrupt and/or excessive control applications. These stalls may occur in steep turns, pull-ups, or other abrupt changes in flight path. Accelerated stalls usually are more severe than unaccelerated stalls and are often unexpected because they occur at higher-than-expected airspeeds. The recovery from accelerated stalls (a speed change of three to five knots/second) is essentially the same as unaccelerated stalls. The primary difference is the indicated stall speed is usually higher and the airplanes attitude may be lower than normal stalling attitudes. Stalling speeds, of course, are controlled by flap settings, center of gravity location, gross weight, and the rate of change in angle of attack. A microswitch in the left wing, which sounds an aural warning, is actuated when the critical angle of attack is approached. Stall speed data at various configurations are detailed on page 5-7.
Loading and Stall Characteristics The center of gravity location and lateral fuel imbalance affects the airplanes stall handling characteristics. It was noted above that stall characteristics are docile with a forward CG. However, as the center of gravity moves aft, the stall handling characteristics, in terms of lateral stability, will deteriorate. On the Columbia 400, it is particularly noticeable at higher power settings with flaps in the landing position. Lateral loading is also an issue, particularly with an aft CG. When the airplane is at the maximum permitted fuel imbalance of 10 gallons, stall-handling characteristics are degraded.

The loading of the airplane is an important consideration since, for example, most checkouts are performed with two pilots and no baggage, which results in a forward CG and fairly benign stall characteristics. It is recommended, during the checkout and indoctrination phase for the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG), that the pilot investigates stall performance at near gross weight with a CG towards the aft limit of the envelope. This training, of course, should be under the supervision of a qualified and certificated flight instructor.
SPINS Spins may be dangerous and are prohibited in Columbia aircraft.

Spins are preceded by a stall. A prompt and decisive stall recovery protects against inadvertent spins. Should a spin be encountered inadvertently, spin recovery should be initiated immediately.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-29

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This airplane is equipped with a stall warning device which gives advance aural warning of impending stalls. Do not operate this airplane with this system and device not in full operational condition. The airplane, as certified by the Federal Aviation Administration, will recover from a one-turn spin at all weight and CG combinations in the approved weight and balance envelope. Recovery may require up to one additional turn with normal use of controls for recovery: power idle, rudder against the spin, elevator forward, and ailerons against the spin. If the flaps are extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation has stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during recovery. When rotation stops, the airplane will be in a steep nose down attitude. Pulling out of the dive will produce 2 to 3 gs and airspeeds up to 160 KIAS.
WARNING Recovery from a spin may require up to one additional turn with normal use of controls for recovery: power idle, rudder against the spin, elevator forward, and ailerons against the spin. If the flaps are extended, they should be retracted after the spin rotation is stopped to avoid exceeding the flap speed limit during recovery. COLD WEATHER OPERATIONS Engine starting during cold weather is generally more difficult than during normal temperature conditions. These conditions, commonly referred to as cold soaking, causes the oil to become more viscous or thicker. Cold weather also impairs the operation of the batteries. The thick oil, in combination with decreased battery effectiveness, makes it more difficult for the starter to crank the engine. At low temperatures, aviation gasoline does not vaporize readily, further complicating the starting procedure. False starting (failure to continue running after starting) often results in the formation of moisture on spark plugs due to condensation. This moisture can freeze and must be eliminated either by applying heat to the engine or removing and cleaning the spark plugs. Cold starting can be improved if the primer switch is kept depressed during engine start or by arming the backup fuel pump, which turns on high boost until the engine is running. CAUTION Superficial application of preheat to a cold-soaked engine can cause damage to the engine since it may permit starting but will not warm the oil sufficiently for proper lubrication of the engine parts. The amount of damage will vary and may not be evident for several hours of operation. In other situations, a problem may occur during or just after takeoff when full power is applied.

The use of a preheater is required to facilitate starting during cold weather and is required when the engine has been cold soaked at temperatures of 20F (-7C) or below for more than two hours. Be sure to use a high volume hot air heater. Small electric heaters that are inserted into the cowling opening do not appreciably warm the oil and may result in superficial preheating. Apply the hot air primarily to the oil sump, filter, and cooler area for 15 to 30 minutes, and turn the propeller by hand through six to eight revolutions at 5 to 10 minute intervals. Periodically feel the top of the engine, and when some warmth is noted, apply heat directly to the upper portion of the engine for five minutes to heat the fuel lines and cylinders. This will ensure proper vaporization of the fuel when the engine is started. Occasionally transfer the source of heat from the sump to the upper part of the engine. Start the engine immediately after completing the preheating process. Since the engine is warm, use the normal starting procedures.

RC050005 4-30

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

WARNING Failure to properly pre-heat a cold soaked engine could result in oil congealing within the engine, oil hoses, and oil cooler with subsequent loss of oil pressure, possible internal damage to the engine and subsequent engine failure. CAUTION Do not leave engine mounted preheaters on for more than 24 hours prior to flight. Continuous operation of engine mounted preheaters may result in aggressive corrosive attack to the engine internally. WARNING To prevent the possibility of serious injury or death, always treat the propeller as though the ignition switch is set to the ON position. Before turning the propeller by hand, use the following procedures. Verify the magnetos switch is set to off, the throttle is closed, and the mixture is set to idle cutoff. It is recommended the airplane be chocked, tied down, with the pilots cabin door open to allow easy access to the engine controls.

After starting the engine, set the idle to 1000 RPM or less until an increase in oil temperature is noted. Since the oil in the oil pressure gauge line may be congealed, as much as 30 seconds may elapse before oil pressure is indicated. If pressure is not indicated within one minute, shut the engine down and determine the cause. Monitor oil pressure closely, and watch for sudden increases or decreases in oil pressure. If necessary, reduce power below 1000 RPM to maintain oil pressure below 100 psi. If the oil pressure drops suddenly to below 30 psi, shut the engine down, and inspect the lubricating system. If no damage or leaks are noted, preheat the engine for an additional 10 to 15 minutes. Before takeoff, when performing the runup check, it may be necessary to incrementally increase engine RPM to prevent oil pressure from exceeding 100 psi. At 1700 RPM, adjust the propeller control to the full decrease position until minimum RPM is observed. Repeat this procedure three or four times to circulate warm oil into the propeller dome. Check magnetos and other items in the normal manner. When the oil temperature has reached 100F and oil pressure does not exceed 60 psi at 2500 RPM, the engine has warmed sufficiently to accept full rated power. During takeoff and climb, the fuel flow may be high; however, this is normal and desirable since the engine will develop more horsepower in the substandard ambient temperatures.
NOTE In cold weather below freezing, ensure engine oil viscosity is SAE 30, 10W30, 15W50, or 20W50. In case of temporary cold weather, consideration should be given to hangaring the airplane between flights. HOT WEATHER OPERATIONS Flight operations during hot weather usually present few problems. It is unlikely that ambient temperatures at the selected cruising altitude will be high enough to cause problems. The airplane design provides good air circulation under normal flight cruise conditions. However, there are some instances where abnormally high ambient temperatures need special attention. These are:

1. Starting a hot engine 2. Ground operations under high ambient temperature conditions 3. Takeoff and initial climb out. After a hot engine is stopped, the temperature of its various components begins to stabilize. Engine parts with good airflow will cool faster. In some areas, where conduction is high and circulation is low, certain engine parts will increase in temperature. In particular, the fuel injection components

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-31

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

(especially the fuel injection pump) will become heat-soaked and may cause the fuel in the system to become vaporized. During subsequent starting attempts the fuel pump will be pumping a combination of fuel and fuel vapor. Until the entire system is filled with liquid fuel, difficult starting and unstable engine operations can normally be expected. To correct this problem, set the fuel selector to either tank, close the throttle, set the mixture to idle cutoff, and operate the primer for approximately 3 seconds; proceed with normal starting procedures. It may be necessary to leave the vapor suppression on during starting and turn it off approximately one minute after engine start. Ground operations during high ambient temperature conditions should be kept to a minimum. In situations which involve takeoff delays, or when performing the Before Takeoff Checklist, it is imperative that the airplane is pointed into the wind. During climb out, it may be necessary to climb at a slightly higher than normal airspeed and turn the vapor suppression on. Be sure the mixture is set properly to full rich, and do not operate at maximum power for any longer than necessary. Temperatures should be closely monitored and sufficient airspeed maintained to provide cooling of the engine.
NOTE Heat soaking is usually the highest between 30 minutes and one hour after shutdown. At some point after the first hour the unit will stabilize, though it may take as long as two or three hours (total time from shutdown) depending on wind, temperature, and the airplanes orientation (upwind or downwind) when it was parked. Restarting attempts will be most difficult in the period 30 minutes to one hour after shutdown. NOISE ABATEMENT Many general aviation pilots believe that noise abatement is an issue reserved for the larger transport type airplanes. While larger airplanes clearly generate a greater decibel level, the pilot operating a small single or multiengine propeller driven airplane should, within the limits of safe operations, do all that is possible to mitigate the impact of noise on the environment. In some instances, the noise levels of small airplanes operating at smaller general aviation airfields are more noticeable. This is because at larger airports with frequent large airplane activity, there is an expectation of airplane ambient noise.

The general aviation pilot can enhance the opinion of the general public by demonstrating a concern for the environment in terms of noise pollution. To this end, common sense and courteousness should be used as basic guidelines. Part 91 of the Federal Air Regulations (FARs) permit an altitude of 1,000 feet above the highest obstacle over congested areas. However, an altitude of 2,000, where practicable and within the limits of safety, should be used. Similarly, during the departure and approach phases of the flight, avoid prolonged flight at lower heights above the ground. At airports where there are established noise abatement procedures in the takeoff corridor, the short field takeoff procedure should be used. This is a courteous thing to do even though the noise abatement procedure might be applicable only to turbine-powered aircraft. The certificated level for the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) at 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) gross weight is 81.5 dB(A). The FAA has made no determination that these noise levels are acceptable or unacceptable for operations at any airport.
RUDDER HOLD SYSTEM The rudder hold system allows the pilot to hold the rudder at a set deflection. Initially, the pilot provides rudder pedal force required for proper trim, and then activates the rudder hold system. Once active, the pilot can remove pedal pressure, and the system will hold the rudder at the set deflection. When inactive, the rudder hold device will be undetectable by the pilot.

RC050005 4-32

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 4 Normal Procedures

The system is activated by supplying electrical current through a pushbutton switch on the flaps panel. The switch, labeled RUDDER HOLD ENGAGE, will only be active with the trim system on. Once activated, a blue indicator light shows that the system is engaged. The system is turned off by either pushing the autopilot disconnect button on the control stick or by pushing the rudder hold engage switch again. The system is automatically disengaged if the circuit breaker is opened, the master trim switch is turned off, the flaps are lowered, or the stall warning signal is activated. With the system active, the pilot can resume manual control of the rudder by exerting a force exceeding 40 to 50 lbs to the rudder pedals. This activates a microswitch which disengages the rudder hold. If the microswitch fails, the clutch in the rudder hold assembly will supply only a limited torque before slipping. In the unlikely event of a rudder hold assembly brake seizure, a shear pin can be broken, thus disengaging the capstan from the brake, and allowing free movement of the rudder.
NOTE The rudder hold assembly brake will engage while the Press-to-Test button is pressed and disengage when the button is released; system override by pedal pressure will function normally.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 4-33

Section 4 Normal Procedures

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 4-34

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 5 Performance

Section 5 Performance
TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 5-3 Airspeed Calibration (Flaps Up Position) ...................................................................................... 5-4 Airspeed Calibration (Flaps Takeoff Position) .............................................................................. 5-4 Airspeed Calibration (Flaps Landing Position).............................................................................. 5-5 Equivalent Airspeed Calibration 12,000 ft..................................................................................... 5-5 Equivalent Airspeed Calibration 18,000 ft..................................................................................... 5-6 Temperature Conversion................................................................................................................. 5-7 Stall Speeds ..................................................................................................................................... 5-7 Stalling Speeds................................................................................................................................ 5-8 SpeedBrakes................................................................................................................................ 5-8 Crosswind, Headwind, and Tailwind Component.......................................................................... 5-8 Short Field Takeoff Distance (12 - Takeoff Flaps).....................................................................5-11 Short Field Takeoff Speed Schedule ............................................................................................5-13 Maximum Rate of Climb (Without Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape on the Wings).............5-14 Maximum Rate of Climb (With Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape on the Wings)..................5-15 Time, Fuel, and Distance to Climb (No Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape) ............................5-16 Time, Fuel, and Distance to Climb (With Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape) .........................5-17 Cruise Performance Overview......................................................................................................5-18 Cruise Performance Sea Level Pressure Altitude.........................................................................5-19 Cruise Performance 2000 Ft Pressure Altitude ............................................................................5-20 Cruise Performance 4000 Ft Pressure Altitude ............................................................................5-21 Cruise Performance 6000 Ft Pressure Altitude ............................................................................5-22 Cruise Performance 8000 Ft Pressure Altitude ............................................................................5-23 Cruise Performance 10000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-24 Cruise Performance 12000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-25 Cruise Performance 14000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-26 Cruise Performance 16000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-26 Cruise Performance 18000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-28 Cruise Performance 20000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-29 Cruise Performance 22000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-30 Cruise Performance 24000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-31 Cruise Performance 25000 Ft Pressure Altitude ..........................................................................5-32 Lean of Peak Engine Operation....................................................................................................5-33 Range Profile ................................................................................................................................5-34 Endurance Profile..........................................................................................................................5-35 Holding Considerations ................................................................................................................5-36 Time, Fuel, and Distance for Cruise Descend..............................................................................5-37 Short Field Landing Distance (40 - Landing Flaps)....................................................................5-39 Landing Speed Schedule...............................................................................................................5-41 Sample Problem ............................................................................................................................5-41 Oxygen System Duration Charts ..................................................................................................5-43 A4 Flowmeter with Cannula or Masks.......................................................................5-43 A5 Flowmeter with Cannula or Masks.......................................................................5-43 Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS) ...............................................................................5-43

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007

RC050005 5-1

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 5-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) INTRODUCTION

Section 5 Performance

The performance charts and graphs on the following pages are designed to assist the pilot in determining specific performance characteristics in all phases of flight operations. These phases include takeoff, climb, cruise, descent, and landing. The data in these charts were determined through actual flight tests of the airplane. At the time of the tests, the airplane and engine were in good condition and normal piloting skills were employed. There may be slight variations between actual results and those specified in the tables and graphs. The condition of the airplane, as well as runway condition, air turbulence, and pilot techniques, will influence actual results. Fuel consumption assumes proper leaning of the mixture and control of the power settings. The combined effect of these variables may produce differences as great as 10%. The pilot must apply an appropriate margin of safety in terms of estimated fuel consumption and other performance aspects, such as takeoff and landing. Fuel endurance data include a 45-minute reserve at the specified cruise power setting. When it is appropriate, the use of a table or graph is explained or an example is shown on the graph. When using the tables that follow, some interpolation may be required. If circumstances do not permit interpolation, then use tabulations that are more conservative. The climb and descent charts are based on sea level, and some minor subtraction is required for altitudes above sea level.
AIRSPEED CALIBRATION KIAS Less than 70 71 to 112 113 to 154 155 to 200 Greater than 200 ERROR +1 +2 +3 +4 +5 KCAS Less than 71 73 to 114 116 to 157 159 to 204 Greater than 205

Figure 5 - 1

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 5-3

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)


Airspeed Calibration Normal and Alternate Static Source Flaps Up Position (0)

250 240 230 220 210 200 Knots Indicated Airspeed (KIAS) 190 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210 220 230 240 250 Knots Calibrated Airspeed (KCAS)

Example: 157 KIAS is equal to 152 KCAS when using the alternate static source.

Alternate Static Source

Normal Static Source

Figure 5 - 2
Airspeed Calibration Normal and Alternate Static Source Flaps Takeoff Position (12)
140

130

Example: 81 KCAS is equal to 77 KIAS when using the alternate static source.

120 Knots Indicated Airspeed (KIAS)

110

100

Normal Static Source


90

80

Alternate Static Source

70

60

50 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 Knots Calibrated Airspeed (KCAS)

Figure 5 - 3

RC050005 5-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)


Airspeed Calibration Normal and Alternate Static Source Flaps Landing Position (40)
130

Section 5 Performance

120

Example: 70 KIAS is equal to 71 KCAS when using the normal static source.

110 Knots Indicated Airspeed (KIAS)

100

90

Normal Static Source

80

70

Alternate Static Source

60

50 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 Knots Calibrated Airspeed (KCAS)

Figure 5 - 4
Equivalent Airspeed Calibration 12,000 ft
270 260 250 240 Knots Calibrated Airspeed (KCAS) 230 220 210 200 190 180 170 160 150 140 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210 220 230 240 250 260 270 Knots Equivalent Airspeed (KEAS)

Figure 5 - 5

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-5

Section 5 Performance
Equivalent Airspeed Calibration 18,000 ft
270 260 250 240 Knots Calibrated Airspeed (KCAS) 230 220 210 200 190 180 170 160 150 140 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210 220

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

230

240

250

260

270

Knots Equivalent Airspeed (KEAS)

Figure 5 - 6

RC050005 5-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) TEMPERATURE CONVERSION

Section 5 Performance

TEMPERATURE CONVERSION
50

40

30

20

CELSIUS

10

0 --40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 120

-10

-20

-30

-40

FAHRENHEIT

Figure 5 - 7
STALL SPEEDS Figure 5 - 8 shows the stalling speed of the airplane for various flap settings and angles of bank. To provide a factor of safety, the tabulated speeds are established using maximum gross weight and the most forward center of gravity (CG), i.e., 3600 pounds with the CG located 108.8 inches from the datum. This configuration will produce a higher stalling speed when compared with the speed that would result from a more rearward CG or a lesser gross weight at the same CG. While an aft CG lowers the stalling speed of the airplane, the benign stalling characteristics attendant with a forward CG are noticeably diminished. Please see stall discussion on page 4-28. The maximum altitude loss during power off stalls is about 500 feet. Nose down attitude change during stall recovery is

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-7

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

generally less than 5 but may be up to 15. Example: Using the table below, stall speeds of 64 KIAS and 65 KCAS are indicated for 30 of bank with landing flaps.
STALLING SPEEDS
CONDITIONS
Weight 3600 lbs. (1633 kg)

ANGLE OF BANK
(Most Forward Center of Gravity Power Off Coordinated Flight) 0 30 45 60 KIAS KCAS KIAS KCAS KIAS KCAS KIAS KCAS
73* 67* 60* 73 66 60 74* 68* 61* 76 70 64 77* 72* 65* 78 71 65 79* 73* 66* 85 85* 77 79* 70 71* 87 79 72 87* 101 102* 103 104* 81* 73* 92 95* 83 84* 94 85 97* 86*

Flap Setting Flaps - Cruise 72 Flaps - Takeoff 65 Flaps - Landing 59

Flat Triangular leading edge tape applied to the wings. Figure 5 - 8

SPEEDBRAKES

When SpeedBrakes are installed it is important to be aware of the following performance changes that may result when the speed brakes are deployed. 1. 2. 3. During takeoff with the SpeedBrakes inadvertently deployed, expect an extended takeoff roll and reduction in rate of climb until the SpeedBrakes are retracted. During cruise flight with the SpeedBrakes deployed, expect the cruise speed and range to be reduced 20%. In the unlikely event of one SpeedBrake cartridge deploying while the other remains retracted, a maximum of 1/4 to 1/3 of corrective aileron travel, and up to 20 lbs. of additional rudder pressure are required for coordinated flight from stall through VNE. Indication of this condition will be noted by an annunciation message with the SpeedBrakes switch ON. Deployed SpeedBrakes have minor to no effect on stall speed and stall characteristics.

4.

RC050005 5-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) CROSSWIND, HEADWIND, AND TAILWIND COMPONENT


Degrees Wind Off Runway Centerline 10
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

Section 5 Performance

20
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

30
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

40
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

50
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

60
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

70
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

80
Component in knots of Headwind or Tailwind Crosswind

5 WIND VELOCITY KNOTS 10 15 20 25 30 35 40

1 2 3 3 4 5 6 7

5 10 15 20 25 30 34 39

2 3 5 7 9 10 12 14

5 9 14 19 23 28 33 38

2 5 7 10 12 15 17 20

4 9 13 17 22 26 30 35

3 6 10 13 16 19 22 26

4 8 11 15 19 23 27 31

4 8 11 15 19 23 27 31

3 6 10 13 16 19 22 26

4 9 13 17 22 26 30 35

3 5 8 10 13 15 18 20

5 9 14 19 23 28 33 38

2 3 5 7 9 10 12 14

5 10 15 20 25 30 34 39

1 2 3 3 4 5 6 7

This table is used to determine the headwind, crosswind, or tailwind component. For example, a 15-knot wind, 55 off the runway centerline, has a headwind component of 9 knots and a crosswind component of 12 knots. For tailwind components, apply the number of degrees the tailwind is off the centerline and read the tailwind component in the headwind/tailwind column. A 20-knot tailwind, 60 off the downwind runway centerline, has a tailwind component of 10 knots and a crosswind component of 17 knots.

Figure 5 - 9

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-9

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

R050005 5-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SHORT FIELD TAKEOFF DISTANCE (12 - TAKEOFF FLAPS)

Section 5 Performance

ASSOCIATED CONDITIONS
Power Flaps Runway Takeoff Speed Takeoff Power Set Before Brake Release 12 (Takeoff position) Paved, Level, Dry Surface See Speed Schedule in Figure 5 - 11.

EXAMPLE

OAT 25C Pressure Altitude (PA) 4000 ft Takeoff Weight 3500 lbs Headwind Component 10 Knots Ground Roll = 1400 ft (427 m) 50 ft Obstacle = 2050 ft (625 m) Runway Slope Correction: Add 1% to ground roll for every 0.1 (0.2%) of uphill slope. For operation on a known level, smooth, mowed grass runway, which is either wet or dry but does not include standing water, the ground roll distance obtained from this takeoff performance chart must be multiplied by a factor of 1.3 to obtain the correct field length. In the above example, the ground roll distance would be 1.3 x 1400 ft = 1820 ft (555 m). The total distance to clear a 50-ft obstacle would be 2470 ft (753 m) in this instance.

Figure 5 - 10
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 5-11

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 5-12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SHORT FIELD TAKEOFF SPEED SCHEDULE

Section 5 Performance

The following chart should be used in conjunction with the takeoff distance chart in Figure 5 - 10 to determine the proper takeoff speed based on aircraft weight.

Short Field Takeoff Speed Schedule


90 85

80

Speed, KIAS

75

Speed at 50 ft. obstacle


70

65

60

Speed at Rotation
55

50 2800

2900

3000

3100

3200

3300

3400

3500

3600

3700

Takeoff Weight, lb.

Figure 5 - 11

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-13

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

MAXIMUM RATE OF CLIMB (Without Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape On The Wings
RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3000 lb (1361 kg) 106 KIAS ISA -20 C 1920 1920 1925 1925 1925 1930 1930 1930 1935 1935 1935 1940 1940 1940 1945 1945 1905 1865 1825 1770 1715 1665 1590 1515 1420 1325 ISA 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1635 1594 1555 1515 1465 1415 1365 1295 1225 1140 1050 ISA +30 C 1230 1230 1235 1235 1230 1230 1225 1225 1220 1220 1220 1215 1215 1210 1210 1210 1170 1135 1100 1050 1005 955 895 830 750 670 RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3300 lb (1497 kg) 108 KIAS ISA -20 C 1780 1785 1785 1785 1785 1790 1790 1790 1795 1795 1795 1800 1800 1790 1780 1770 1740 1715 1690 1640 1590 1545 1475 1405 1315 1230 ISA 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1515 1517 1506 1495 1485 1460 1435 1410 1360 1315 1270 1205 1140 1055 975 ISA +30 C 1145 1145 1150 1150 1147 1145 1143 1141 1140 1140 1135 1135 1132 1120 1110 1095 1070 1050 1025 980 935 895 835 775 700 625 RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3600 lb (1633 kg) 110 KIAS ISA -20 C 1645 1645 1650 1650 1650 1650 1652 1655 1655 1655 1655 1660 1660 1650 1640 1630 1610 1585 1560 1515 1470 1425 1360 1295 1215 1135 ISA 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1390 1380 1370 1345 1325 1300 1255 1215 1170 1110 1050 975 900 ISA +30 C 1055 1055 1060 1060 1060 1055 1055 1055 1050 1050 1050 1045 1045 1035 1025 1015 990 970 945 905 865 825 770 715 645 580

Pressure Altitude (Feet) 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000 9000 10000 11000 12000 13000 14000 15000 16000 17000 18000 19000 20000 21000 22000 23000 24000 25000

Figure 5 - 12

RC050005 5-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 5 Performance

MAXIMUM RATE OF CLIMB (With Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape On The Wings )
RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3000 lb (1361 kg) 106 KIAS ISA -20 C 1805 1805 1810 1810 1810 1815 1815 1815 1820 1820 1820 1825 1825 1825 1830 1830 1790 1750 1710 1655 1600 1550 1475 1400 1305 1210 ISA 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1479 1440 1400 1350 1300 1250 1180 1110 1025 935 ISA +30 C 1115 1115 1120 1120 1115 1115 1110 1110 1105 1105 1105 1100 1100 1095 1095 1095 1055 1020 985 935 890 840 780 715 635 555 RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3300 lb (1497 kg) 108 KIAS ISA -20 C 1665 1670 1670 1670 1670 1675 1675 1675 1680 1680 1680 1685 1685 1675 1665 1655 1625 1600 1575 1525 1475 1430 1360 1290 1200 1115 ISA 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1402 1391 1380 1370 1345 1320 1295 1245 1200 1155 1090 1025 940 860 ISA +30 C 1030 1030 1035 1035 1032 1030 1028 1026 1025 1025 1020 1020 1017 1005 995 980 955 935 910 865 820 780 720 660 585 510 RATE OF CLIMB (FT/MIN) 3600 lb (1633 kg) 110 KIAS ISA -20 C 1530 1530 1535 1535 1535 1535 1537 1540 1540 1540 1540 1545 1545 1535 1525 1515 1495 1470 1445 1400 1355 1310 1245 1180 1100 1020 ISA 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1275 1265 1255 1230 1210 1185 1140 1100 1055 995 935 860 785 ISA +30 C 940 940 945 945 945 940 940 940 935 935 935 930 930 920 910 900 875 855 830 790 750 710 655 600 530 465

Pressure Altitude (Feet) 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000 9000 10000 11000 12000 13000 14000 15000 16000 17000 18000 19000 20000 21000 22000 23000 24000 25000

Figure 5 - 13

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-15

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

TIME, FUEL, AND DISTANCE TO CLIMB (No Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape)

Pressure Altitude
0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000 9000 10000 11000 12000 13000 14000 15000 16000 17000 18000 19000 20000 21000 22000 23000 24000 25000

Climb Speed Rate of Climb KIAS FPM


110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1390 1380 1370 1345 1325 1300 1255 1215 1170 1110 1050 975

Time Min
0.0 0.7 1.4 2.1 2.9 3.6 4.3 5.0 5.7 6.4 7.1 7.9 8.6 9.3 10.0 10.7 11.5 12.2 13.0 13.8 14.6 15.5 16.4 17.3 18.4

Fuel Used Gal. (L)


0.0 (0.0) 0.5 (1.8) 0.9 (3.5) 1.4 (5.3) 1.9 (7.0) 2.3 (8.8) 2.8 (10.5) 3.3 (12.3) 3.7 (14.1) 4.2 (15.8) 4.6 (17.6) 5.1 (19.3) 5.6 (21.1) 6.0 (22.9) 6.5 (24.6) 7.0 (26.4) 7.5 (28.3) 8.0 (30.1) 8.5 (32.0) 9.0 (34.0) 9.5 (36.0) 10.1 (38.2) 10.7 (40.3) 11.3 (42.7) 11.9 (45.2)

Distance NM
0 1 3 4 5 7 8 10 11 13 14 16 17 19 21 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36 39 42 45

900 19.5 12.7 (47.9) Associated Conditions

Power ..........................................................................................................2600 RPM Flaps................................................................................................................... Cruise Mixture..................................................................At recommended leaning schedule Temp. ........................................................................................... Standard Day (ISA) Wind............................................................................................................Zero Wind Time .......................................Include 45 seconds for takeoff and acceleration to VY. Figure 5 - 14

RC050005 5-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 5 Performance

TIME, FUEL, AND DISTANCE TO CLIMB (With Flat Triangular Leading Edge Tape)

Pressure Altitude
0 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000 9000 10000 11000 12000 13000 14000 15000 16000 17000 18000 19000 20000 21000 22000 23000 24000 25000

Climb Speed Rate of Climb KIAS FPM


110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 110 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285 1275 1265 1255 1230 1210 1185 1140 1100 1055 995 935 860

Time Min
0.0 0.8 1.6 2.3 3.1 3.9 4.7 5.4 6.2 7.0 7.8 8.6 9.3 10.1 10.9 11.7 12.5 13.3 14.2 15.1 16.0 16.9 17.9 19.0 20.2

Fuel Used Gal. (L)


0.0 (0.0) 0.5 (1.9) 1.0 (3.8) 1.5 (5.7) 2.0 (7.7) 2.5 (9.6) 3.0 (11.5) 3.5 (13.4) 4.0 (15.3) 4.6 (17.2) 5.1 (19.1) 5.6 (21.1) 6.1 (23.0) 6.6 (24.9) 7.1 (26.8) 7.6 (28.8) 8.1 (30.8) 8.7 (32.8) 9.2 (34.9) 9.8 (37.1) 10.4 (39.3) 11.0 (41.6) 11.7 (44.1) 12.4 (46.8) 13.1 (49.6)

Distance NM
0 1 3 4 6 7 9 11 12 14 16 17 19 21 22 24 26 28 30 32 35 37 40 43 46 49

785 21.4 13.9 (52.7) Associated Conditions

Power.....................................................................................................................2600 RPM Flaps ............................................................................................................................. Cruise Mixture ............................................................................At recommended leaning schedule Temp....................................................................................................... Standard Day (ISA) Wind ......................................................................................................................Zero Wind Time..................................................Include 45 seconds for takeoff and acceleration to VY. Figure 5 - 15

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-17

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

CRUISE PERFORMANCE OVERVIEW The tables on pages 5-19 through 5-32 contain cruise data to assist in the flight planning process. This information is tabulated for even thousand altitude increments and ranges from Sea Level feet to 25,000 feet. Interpolation is required for the odd number altitudes, i.e., 5000 feet, 7000 feet, etc., as well as altitude increments of 500 feet, such as 7500 and 9500.

The tables assume proper leaning at the various operating horsepowers. Between 65% and 85% of brake horsepower, the mixtures should be leaned through use of the turbine inlet temperature (TIT) gauge. Please refer to page 4-25 in this handbook for proper leaning techniques. KTAS values in the tables are valid without the nose wheel pant installed. If the nose wheel pant is installed add 4 kts to the KTAS values. The maximum recommended cruise setting is 85% of brake horsepower. The mixture must not be leaned above settings that produce more than 85% of brake horsepower. During cruise power settings above 65%, ambient temperature conditions need to be considered. In hot weather and high altitudes, it may be necessary to set the fuel flow to a lower TIT to maintain cylinder head temperatures within the recommended range for cruise. The cruise performance is not affected by the flat triangular leading edge tape.

RC050005 5-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

INITIAL SETTINGS

-5 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

15 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

45 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 26 (97) 24 (90) 19 (72) 23 (85) 18 (68) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (58) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (52) 13 (48) 26 (97) 23 (88) 22 (84) 18 (68) 20 (76) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (49) 12 (45) 25 (93) 23 (89) 21 (81) 18 (67) 20 (74) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 17 (64) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 182 178 176 170 164 161 154 146 182 177 175 170 164 161 154 143 180 178 173 168 163 160 154 143 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 180 176 173 167 160 156 148 140 179 174 172 166 159 156 148 136 177 175 170 165 158 155 148 136 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 23 (87) 21 (81) 18 (66) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (47) 11 (43) 23 (87) 21 (79) 20 (75) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (55) 15 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (44) 11 (41) 22 (83) 21 (80) 19 (73) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 16 (61) 14 (55) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (75) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (66) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (54) 14 (54) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (47) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 20 (74) 18 (68) 17 (65) 15 (57) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 19 (71) 18 (68) 17 (63) 15 (56) 15 (58) 14 (52) 14 (53) 13 (48) 13 (50) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE SEA LEVEL PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 16
Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

182 179 177 172 166 163 157 150 182 178 176 171 166 163 157 146 180 178 174 170 165 162 157 147

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. * As a rule, always round to the more conservative number when using the performance tables in this handbook. EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Solution: % of BHP = 65%; Fuel Consumption = 16 GPH (62 LPH); True Airspeed = 165 Knots*

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-19

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 1000 ft.; Temperature = 13 C; Manifold Pressure = 25 in. Hg.; RPM = 2500, Best Power

RC050005 5-20
11 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 41 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 26 (97) 24 (90) 19 (70) 23 (85) 18 (68) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (58) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (52) 13 (48) 26 (97) 23 (88) 22 (84) 18 (68) 20 (76) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (49) 12 (45) 25 (93) 23 (89) 21 (81) 18 (67) 20 (74) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 17 (64) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 185 182 179 173 167 164 157 149 185 180 178 173 167 164 157 145 183 181 176 172 166 163 157 146 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 183 179 176 170 163 159 151 143 183 178 175 169 162 159 151 139 181 178 173 168 161 158 151 139 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 23 (87) 21 (81) 18 (66) 20 (77) 17(64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (47) 11 (43) 23 (87) 21 (79) 20 (75) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (55) 15 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (44) 11 (41) 22 (83) 21 (80) 19 (73) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 16 (61) 14 (55) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (75) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (66) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (54) 14 (54) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (47) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 20 (74) 18 (68) 17 (65) 15 (57) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 19 (71) 18 (68) 17 (63) 15 (56) 15 (58) 14 (52) 14 (53) 13 (48) 13 (50) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-9 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 2000 FEET PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 17
EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

185 182 180 175 169 166 160 152 185 181 179 174 169 166 160 149 184 182 178 173 168 165 159 149

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. Solution: % of BHP = 73%; Fuel Consumption = 19 GPH (72 LPH); True Airspeed = 178 Knots.

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 2000 ft.; Temperature = 22 C; Manifold Pressure = 29 in. Hg.; RPM = 2500, Best Power

INITIAL SETTINGS

-13 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

7 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

37 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 26 (97) 24 (90) 19 (70) 23 (85) 18 (68) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (58) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (52) 13 (48) 26 (97) 23 (88) 22 (84) 18 (68) 20 (76) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (57) 15 (58 ) 14 (53) 13 (49) 12 (45) 25 (93) 23 (89) 21 (81) 18 (67) 20 (74) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 17 (64) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 189 185 182 177 170 167 160 152 188 184 181 176 170 167 160 148 186 184 180 175 169 166 160 149 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 187 182 179 173 166 162 154 146 186 181 178 172 165 162 154 141 184 182 176 171 165 161 154 142 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 23 (87) 21 (81) 18 (66) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (47) 11 (43) 23 (87) 21 (79) 20 (75) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (55) 15 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (44) 11 (41) 22 (83) 21 (80) 19 (73) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 16 (61) 14 (55) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (75) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (66) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (54) 14 (54) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (47) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 20 (74) 18 (68) 17 (65) 15 (57) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 19 (71) 18 (68) 17 (63) 15 (56) 15 (58) 14 (52) 14 (53) 13 (48) 13 (50) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 4000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 18
Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

189 186 183 178 172 169 162 155 189 185 182 177 172 169 162 152 187 185 181 176 171 168 162 152

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. *89% is above the maximum recommended cruise setting of 85% and does not represent a recommended mixture setting EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Solution: % of BHP = 89%;* Fuel Consumption = 25 GPH (96 LPH); True Airspeed = 189 Knots.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-21

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 4000 ft.; Temperature = -9 C; Manifold Pressure = 33 in. Hg.; RPM = 2400, Best Power

RC050005 5-22
3 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 33 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 26 (97) 24 (90) 19 (70) 23 (85) 18 (68) 20 (77) 17(64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (58 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (52) 13 (48) 26 (97) 23 (88) 22 (84) 18 (68) 20 (76) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (49) 12 (45) 25 (93) 23 (89) 21 (81) 18 (67) 20 (74) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 17 (64) 15 (57) 15 (58) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 192 188 186 180 173 170 163 155 192 187 185 179 173 170 163 151 190 188 183 178 172 169 163 151 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 190 186 183 176 169 165 157 149 190 184 182 175 169 165 157 144 187 185 180 174 168 164 157 145 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 23 (87) 21 (81) 18 (66) 20 (77) 17 (64) 18 (69) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (47) 11 (43) 23 (87) 21 (79) 20 (75) 17 (64) 18 (68) 16 (60) 16 (62) 15 (55) 15 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (44) 11 (41) 22 (83) 21 (80) 19 (73) 17 (63) 18 (67) 16 (59) 16 (61) 14 (55) 15 (58) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (75) 18 (69) 16 (60) 17 (66) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (54) 14 (54) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (47) 12 (45 ) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 20 (74) 18 (68) 17 (65) 15 (57) 16 (59) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (49) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 19 (71) 18 (68) 17 (63) 15 (56) 15 (58) 14 (52) 14 (53) 13 (48) 13 (50) 12 (46) 12 (45) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-17 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 6000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 19
EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

193 189 187 181 175 172 165 158 192 188 186 181 175 172 165 154 191 189 184 180 174 171 165 155

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. Solution: % of BHP = 49%; Fuel Consumption = 13 GPH (48 LPH); True Airspeed = 161 Knots.

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 6000 ft.; Temperature = 33 C; Manifold Pressure = 23 in. Hg.; RPM = 2500, Best Power

INITIAL SETTINGS

-21 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

-1 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

29 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (101) 25 (93) 19 (70) 23 (88) 18 (68) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 26 (100) 24 (91) 23 (86) 18 (68) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (45) 25 (96) 24 (92) 22 (84) 18 (67) 20 (76) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (51) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 199 195 192 186 179 175 168 159 199 194 191 185 178 175 168 155 197 194 189 184 178 174 167 156 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 196 192 189 182 174 170 162 153 196 190 187 181 174 170 162 148 194 191 185 179 173 169 162 149 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 24 (90) 22 (83) 18 (66) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 17 (64) 15 (56) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (48) 11 (43) 24 (90) 22 (82) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 17 (63) 15 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) 23 (86) 22 (82) 20 (75) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (63) 14 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (77) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (58) 16 (61) 14 (54) 14 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (47) 12 (46) 11 (41) 11 (40) 9 (36) 20 (77) 18 (70) 18 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (33) 19 (73) 19 (70) 17 (65) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (52) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 8000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 20
EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

200 196 193 188 181 178 171 163 200 195 192 187 181 177 171 159 197 195 191 186 180 177 170 159

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. Solution: % of BHP = 86%; Fuel Consumption = 25 GPH (93 LPH); True Airspeed = 196 Knots.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-23

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 8000 ft.; Temperature = -2 C; Manifold Pressure = 29 in. Hg.; RPM = 2500

RC050005 5-24
-5 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 25 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (101) 19 (73) 25 (93) 19 (70) 23 (88) 18 (68) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 26 (100) 19 (73) 24 (91) 18 (70) 23 (86) 18 (68) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (45) 25 (96) 19 (71) 24 (92) 18 (70) 22 (84) 18 (67) 20 (76) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (51) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 204 199 196 189 182 178 171 163 203 198 195 188 182 178 171 159 201 198 193 187 181 178 171 159 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 200 195 192 185 178 174 166 157 200 194 191 184 177 174 166 154 197 195 189 183 176 173 166 154 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 24 (90) 18 (69) 22 (83) 18 (66) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 17 (64) 15 (56) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (48) 11 (43) 24 (90) 18 (69) 22 (82) 17 (66) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 17 (63) 15( 55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) 23 (86) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (66) 20 (75) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (63) 14 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (77) 17 (53) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (58) 16 (61) 14 (54) 14 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (47) 12 (46) 11 (41) 11 (40) 9 (36) 20 (77) 17 (63) 18 (70) 16 (59) 18 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (33) 19 (73) 16 (61) 19 (70) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (52) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-25 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 10000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 21
EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

205 201 198 191 185 181 174 166 205 200 197 191 184 181 174 162 203 200 195 189 183 180 173 163

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. Solution: % of BHP = 77%; Fuel Consumption = 21 GPH (79 LPH); True Airspeed = 194 Knots.

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 9000 ft.; Temperature = -9 C; Manifold Pressure = 29 in. Hg.; RPM = 2500

INITIAL SETTINGS

-29 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

-9 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

21 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (101) 25 (93) 19 (70) 23 (88) 18 (68) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 26 (100) 24 (91) 23 (86) 18 (68) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (45) 25 (96) 24 (92) 22 (84) 18 (67) 20 (76) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (51) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 207 203 199 193 186 182 174 166 207 201 198 192 185 182 174 162 204 202 196 191 184 181 174 163 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 204 199 196 189 181 178 170 161 204 198 195 188 181 177 170 157 201 198 193 187 180 177 169 158 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 24 (90) 22 (83) 18 (66) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 17 (64) 15 (56) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (48) 11 (43) 24 (90) 22 (82) 21 (78) 17 (64) 19 (70) 16 (60) 17 (63) 15 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (40) 23 (86) 22 (82) 20 (75) 17 (63) 18 (69) 16 (59) 17 (63) 14 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 20 (77) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (58) 16 (61) 14 (54) 14 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (47) 12 (46) 11 (41) 11 (40) 9 (36) 20 (77) 18 (70) 18 (66) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (33) 19 (73) 19 (70) 17 (65) 15 (56) 16 (59) 14 (52) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (51) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (38) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 12000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 22
EXAMPLE PROBLEM AND SOLUTION Determine: % of BHP; Fuel Consumption (GPH); True Airspeed

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

209 204 201 195 188 184 177 169 209 203 200 194 187 184 177 165 206 204 198 193 187 183 177 166

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak. Solution: % of BHP = 61%; Fuel Consumption = 16 GPH (60 LPH); True Airspeed = 181 Knots.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-25

Conditions: Cruise Altitude = 12000 ft.; Temperature = -9 C; Manifold Pressure = 26 in. Hg.; RPM = 2300

RC050005 5-26
-13 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 17 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (101) 25 (94) 19 (70) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (72) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 27 (101) 24 (92) 23 (87) 18 (68) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (45) 25 (97) 24 (93) 22 (85) 18 (67) 20 (78) 17 (63) 19 (70) 16 (59) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (51) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 212 208 205 198 191 187 179 169 211 206 204 197 191 187 179 165 209 207 202 196 190 186 178 165 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 210 205 202 194 186 181 172 161 210 204 200 193 185 181 172 156 207 204 198 192 184 180 171 157 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 24 (91) 22 (85) 18 (66) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (72) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (56) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (48) 11 (43) 24 (91) 22 (83) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 17 (64) 15 (55) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) 23 (87) 22 (84) 20 (77) 17 (63) 18 (70) 16 (59) 17 (63) 14 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (78) 19 (72) 16 (60) 18 (69) 15 (58) 16 (62) 14 (54) 15 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (47) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 21 (78) 19 (71) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 20 (75) 19 (72) 17 (66) 15 (56) 16 (60) 14 (52) 14 (54) 13 (48) 14 (51) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-33 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 14000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 23

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

211 208 205 199 193 190 182 173 211 206 204 199 193 189 182 169 209 207 203 198 192 189 182 170

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

INITIAL SETTINGS

-37 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

-17 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

13 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (101) 25 (94) 19 (70) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (72) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (58) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (53) 13 (48) 27 (101) 24 (92) 23 (87) 18 (68) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 18 (68) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (50) 12 (45) 25 (97) 24 (93) 22 (85) 18 (67) 20 (78) 17 (63) 19 (70) 16 (59) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (60) 14 (53) 13 (51) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 216 212 209 203 196 192 184 175 216 211 208 202 196 192 184 171 214 212 207 201 195 191 184 171 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 215 210 207 200 192 188 178 168 215 209 206 199 191 187 178 164 212 210 204 197 190 186 178 164 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 24 (91) 22 (85) 18 (66) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (72) 16 (60) 17 (65) 15 (56) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 13 (48) 11 (43) 24 (91) 22 (83) 21 (79) 17 (64) 19 (71) 16 (60) 17 (64) 15 (55) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) 23 (87) 22 (84) 20 (77) 17 (63) 18 (70) 16 (59) 17 (63) 14 (55) 16 (60) 14 (53) 14 (54) 13 (48) 12 (45) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (78) 19 (72) 16 (60) 18 (69) 15 (58) 16 (62) 14 (54) 15 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (47) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (40) 9 (36) 21 (78) 19 (71) 18 (67) 15 (57) 16 (61) 14 (53) 14 (55) 13 (49) 14 (52) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (33) 20 (75) 19 (72) 17 (66) 15 (56) 16 (60) 14 (52) 14 (54) 13 (48) 14 (51) 12 (46) 12 (46) 11 (41) 10 (37) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 16000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 24

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

216 212 210 204 198 194 187 178 215 211 209 203 197 194 187 174 213 212 207 202 196 193 187 175

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-27

RC050005 5-28
-21 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 9 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (103) 25 (96) 19 (70) 24 (91) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (64) 19 (74) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (58) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (56) 13 (48) 27 (103) 25 (93) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (81) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (45) 26 (98) 25 (94) 23 (87) 18 (67) 21 (79) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 219 216 213 208 202 198 191 184 219 214 212 207 201 198 191 180 217 215 211 206 200 197 191 180 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 220 216 213 207 200 196 189 180 220 215 212 206 199 196 189 176 217 215 210 205 199 195 188 177 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 25 (93) 23 (86) 18 (66) 22 (82) 17 (64) 20 (74) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (56) 17 (64) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (51) 11 (43) 24 (92) 22 (84) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (66) 15 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) 23 (89) 22 (85) 21 (78) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 17 (66) 14 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (80) 20 (74) 16 (60) 19 (71) 15 (58) 17 (64) 14 (54) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (47) 13 (49) 11 (41) 12 (44) 9 (36) 21 (79) 19 (73) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (33) 20 (76) 19 (73) 18 (68) 15 (56) 16 (62) 14 (52) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (54) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-41 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 18000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 25

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

217 214 212 207 201 198 192 185 217 213 211 206 201 198 192 182 215 214 210 205 200 198 192 182

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

INITIAL SETTINGS

-45 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

-25 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

5 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (103) 25 (96) 19 (70) 24 (91) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (64) 19 (74) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (58) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (56) 13 (48) 27 (103) 25 (93) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (81) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (45) 26 (98) 25 (94) 23 (87) 18 (67) 21 (79) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 222 219 216 211 205 201 195 188 222 218 215 210 204 201 195 184 220 218 214 209 203 201 195 185 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 223 219 216 210 204 201 194 186 223 218 215 210 204 200 194 182 221 218 214 208 203 200 193 183 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 25 (93) 23 (86) 18 (66) 22 (82) 17 (64) 20 (74) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (56) 17 (64) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (51) 11 (43) 24 (92) 22 (84) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (66) 15 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) 23 (89) 22 (85) 21 (78) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 17 (66) 14 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (80) 20 (74) 16 (60) 19 (71) 15 (58) 17 (64) 14 (54) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (47) 13 (49) 11 (41) 12 (44) 9 (36) 21 (79) 19 (73) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (33) 20 (76) 19 (73) 18 (68) 15 (56) 16 (62) 14 (52) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (54) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 20000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 26

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

221 217 215 210 204 201 195 188 221 216 214 209 204 201 195 185 219 217 213 208 203 201 195 185

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-29

RC050005 5-30
-29 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) 1 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (103) 25 (96) 19 (70) 24 (91) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (64) 19 (74) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (58) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (56) 13 (48) 27 (103) 25 (93) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (81) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (45) 26 (98) 25 (94) 23 (87) 18 (67) 21 (79) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 228 224 221 216 210 206 200 193 227 223 220 215 209 206 200 189 225 223 219 214 208 206 200 190 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 229 225 222 216 209 206 199 191 228 223 221 215 209 206 199 188 226 224 219 214 208 205 199 188 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 25 (93) 23 (86) 18 (66) 22 (82) 17 (64) 20 (74) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (56) 17 (64) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (51) 11 (43) 24 (92) 22 (84) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (66) 15 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) 23 (89) 22 (85) 21 (78) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 17 (66) 14 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (80) 20 (74) 16 (60) 19 (71) 15 (58) 17 (64) 14 (54) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (47) 13 (49) 11 (41) 12 (44) 9 (36) 21 (79) 19 (73) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (33) 20 (76) 19 (73) 18 (68) 15 (56) 16 (62) 14 (52) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (54) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-49 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 22000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 27

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

226 222 220 215 209 206 200 193 226 221 219 214 209 206 200 190 224 222 218 213 208 205 199 190

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

INITIAL SETTINGS

-53 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

-33 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE)

-3 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP KTAS KTAS

KTAS

% BHP

% BHP

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (103) 25 (96) 19 (70) 24 (91) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (64) 19 (74) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (58) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (56) 13 (48) 27 (103) 25 (93) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (81) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (45) 26 (98) 25 (94) 23 (87) 18 (67) 21 (79) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 232 229 226 221 216 212 206 198 232 228 226 221 215 212 206 194 230 228 224 220 215 212 205 194 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 235 231 228 222 215 212 204 195 235 230 227 221 215 211 204 190 233 230 226 220 214 211 203 191 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 25 (93) 23 (86) 18 (66) 22 (82) 17 (64) 20 (74) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (56) 17 (64) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (51) 11 (43) 24 (92) 22 (84) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (66) 15 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) 23 (89) 22 (85) 21 (78) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 17 (66) 14 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (80) 20 (74) 16 (60) 19 (71) 15 (58) 17 (64) 14 (54) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (47) 13 (49) 11 (41) 12 (44) 9 (36) 21 (79) 19 (73) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (33) 20 (76) 19 (73) 18 (68) 15 (56) 16 (62) 14 (52) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (54) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (34)

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 24000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 28

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

228 225 223 219 214 211 205 198 228 224 223 219 214 211 205 195 226 225 222 218 213 211 205 195

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-31

RC050005 5-32
-35 C (STANDARD TEMPERATURE) -5 C (30 C ABOVE STANDARD TEMP) % BHP KTAS KTAS % BHP FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 27 (103) 25 (96) 19 (70) 24 (91) 18 (68) 22 (82) 17 (64) 19 (74) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (58) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (56) 13 (48) 27 (103) 25 (93) 24 (89) 18 (68) 21 (81) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (70) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (45) 26 (98) 25 (94) 23 (87) 18 (67) 21 (79) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 14 (54) 12 (46) 85 80 77 71 65 62 55 48 84 79 76 71 64 61 55 45 82 80 75 69 64 61 55 45 235 232 229 224 218 215 208 200 235 231 228 224 218 215 208 196 233 231 227 222 217 214 208 197 76 71 68 62 56 53 46 39 75 70 67 62 55 52 46 36 73 71 66 60 55 52 46 36 238 234 231 225 218 214 206 197 238 233 230 224 218 214 206 193 236 233 228 223 217 213 206 194 FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 25 (93) 23 (86) 18 (66) 22 (82) 17 (64) 20 (74) 16 (60) 18 (67) 15 (56) 17 (64) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (51) 11 (43) 24 (92) 22 (84) 21 (80) 17 (64) 19 (73) 16 (60) 18 (66) 15 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) 23 (89) 22 (85) 21 (78) 17 (63) 19 (72) 16 (59) 17 (66) 14 (55) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (57) 13 (48) 13 (49) 11 (41) FUEL FLOW GAL/HR (L/HR) BEST -50 POWER LOP 21 (80) 20 (74) 16 (60) 19 (71) 15 (58) 17 (64) 14 (54) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (47) 13 (49) 11 (41) 12 (44) 9 (36) 21 (79) 19 (73) 18 (69) 15 (57) 17 (63) 14 (53) 15 (58) 13 (49) 15 (55) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (33) 20 (76) 19 (73) 18 (68) 15 (56) 16 (62) 14 (52) 15 (57) 13 (48) 14 (54) 12 (46) 13 (49) 11 (41) 11 (41) 9 (34)

INITIAL SETTINGS

-55 C (20 C BELOW STANDARD TEMP)

Section 5 Performance

RPM

MAP -50 LOP

% BHP

KTAS

32.0 29.5 27.5 26.0 23.5 21.0

CRUISE PERFORMANCE 25000 FT PRESSURE ALTITUDE

Figure 5 - 29

2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300 2300

MAP BEST POWER 31.5 30.0 29.0 27.0 25.0 24.0 22.0 20.0 33.0 31.0 30.0 28.0 26.0 25.0 23.0 20.0 34.0 33.0 31.0 29.0 27.0 26.0 24.0 21.0

30.5 28.5 27.0 25.0 21.0

31.5 29.5 28.5 26.5 23.5

91 86 83 77 71 68 61 54 90 85 82 77 70 67 61 51 88 86 81 75 70 67 61 51

231 228 226 222 217 214 208 201 231 227 226 221 217 214 208 197 229 228 224 221 216 213 208 198

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Gross Weight. Flaps Up. Recommended Mixture Setting. Data in these charts are based on this leaning schedule discussed on page 4-25. Best Power or Lean of Peak.

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 5 Performance

LEAN OF PEAK ENGINE OPERATION The TSIO-550C engine can be operated lean of peak at lower power settings. At higher power settings the TIT limit could be exceeded during the leaning process, in general leaning past peak TIT is only possible below about 65% power (varies with ambient conditions). Starting from full rich, the power increases about 1% as Best Power mixture is reached. For cruise operation, best power is at or near 1625F TIT rich of peak. If the mixture is leaned further past peak EGT (TIT), the power drops 8-12%. Best Economy is reached at about 50F lean of peak. Because of the drop in power, speed will be reduced. Once a lean of peak mixture setting is reached, the RPM and manifold pressure can be increased carefully. By increasing the manifold pressure while operating lean of peak (do not exceed 29 in.Hg), the power loss from leaning can be compensated. For continuous operation, TIT should be at or below 1625F. Figure 5 - 31 below shows a comparison of fuel flows for best power and best economy and is valid for one RPM (about 2400 RPM). At higher RPM the fuel flow is slightly higher or slightly lower at lower RPM respectively. The power setting in Figure 5 - 31 is actual power.

Columbia 400 Fuel Flow over Power Setting


25 23 21 19

Best Power TSIO-550C

Lean of Peak TSIO-550C

Fuel Flow [gph]

17 15 13 11 9 7 5 40 45 50 55 60 65

x x x x

Power Setting [%]


70 75 80 85 90

Figure 5 - 30

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-33

ALTITUDE - FEET

RC050005 5-34 RANGE PROFILE


80% 75% 70% 65% 60% 55% 45%

Section 5 Performance

85%

Figure 5 - 31
750 800 850 900 950 1000 1050 RANGE - NAUTICAL MILES

25000 24000 23000 22000 21000 20000 19000 18000 17000 16000 15000 14000 13000 12000 11000 10000 9000 8000 7000 6000 5000 4000 3000 2000 1000 0
1100 1150 1200

600

650

700

Conditions

Assumptions Chart assumes applicable BHP is maintained to maximum flight altitude

Note The chart includes fuel for starting the engine, taxi, takeoff, and climb to altitude. The 45 minute reserve allowance is based on the applicable percentage of BHP for 45 minutes.

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Max. Gross Weight Standard Temperature Proper Leaning Fuel Tanks Filled To 98 Gallons (371 L)

Example: At a pressure altitude of 11,000 feet, with an 85% BHP best power setting, the range is approximately 675 nm.

85%

ENDURANCE PROFILE

80% 70% 65% 60% 55% 45%

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007


5
ENDURANCE - HOURS

ALTITUDE - FEET

75%

Figure 5 - 32
6
Assumptions Chart assumes applicable BHP is maintained to maximum flight altitude

25000 24000 23000 22000 21000 20000 19000 18000 17000 16000 15000 14000 13000 12000 11000 10000 9000 8000 7000 6000 5000 4000 3000 2000 1000 0 7 8

Conditions

Note The chart includes fuel for starting the engine, taxi, takeoff, and climb to altitude. The 45 minute reserve allowance is based on the applicable percentage of BHP for 45 minutes.

3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Max. Gross Weight Standard Temperature Proper Leaning Fuel Tanks Filled To 98 Gallons (371 L)

Section 5 Performance

RC050005 5-35

Example: At a pressure altitude of 9,000 feet, with a 75% BHP best power setting, the endurance is approximately 4.05 hours.

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

HOLDING CONSIDERATIONS When holding is required, it is recommended that takeoff flaps be used with an indicated airspeed of 120 knots. Depending on temperature, gross weight, and RPM, the manifold pressure will range from about 13 to 17 inches. The fuel consumption has wide variability as well and can range from about 8 to 10 GPH (30.3 to 37.9 LPH). The graph below, Figure 5 - 33, provides information to calculate either fuel used for a given holding time or the amount of holding time available for a set quantity of fuel.

The graph is based on a fuel consumption of 9 GPH (34.1 LPH) and is included here to provide a general familiarization overview. Under actual conditions, most pilots can perform the calculation for fuel used or the available holding time without reference to the graph. Moreover, the graph is only an approximation of the average anticipated fuel consumption. There will be wide variability under actual conditions. In the example below, a 35-minute holding time will use about 5.2 gallons (19.7 L) of fuel. Conversely, if only 8 gallons (30.3 L) of fuel are available for holding purposes, the maximum holding time is 53 minutes before other action must be taken. Note that this is about the amount of fuel remaining in a tank when the low-level fuel warning light illuminates.

HOLDING TIME (9.0 GPH)


12.0

10.0

FUEL USED - GALLONS

8.0

6.0

4.0

2.0

0.0 0 10 20

TIME - MINUTES

30

40

50

60

70

Figure 5 - 33

RC050005 5-36

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 5 Performance

TIME, FUEL, AND DISTANCE FOR CRUISE DESCENT The table below, Figure 5 - 34, has information to assist the pilot in estimating cruise descent times, fuel used, and distance traveled from cruise altitude to sea level or to the elevation of the destination airport. For descents from cruise altitude to sea level, locate the cruise altitude for the descent rate in use, and read the information directly. These data are determined for a weight of 3600 lb. (1633 kg), flaps up, 2600 RPM, standard temperature, and zero winds.

For example, a descent at 500 FPM from 9000 feet to sea level will take approximately 18 minutes (50 32 = 18), consume 5 gallons of fuel (14 - 9 = 5), and 57 miles (175 118 = 57) will be traveled over the ground under no wind conditions. For descent from cruise altitude to a field elevation above seal level, subtract the performance data numbers for the field elevation data from the cruise altitude. Pressure Altitude 25000 24000 23000 22000 21000 20000 19000 18000 17000 16000 15000 14000 13000 12000 11000 10000 9000 8000 7000 6000 5000 4000 3000 2000 1000 0 Descent Speed Rate of Descent KIAS FPM 159 500 160 500 161 161 162 163 164 164 165 166 167 167 168 169 170 170 171 172 173 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 Fuel Flow GPH (LPH) 19.0 (72.0) 18.8 (71.2) 18.6 (70.4) 18.3 (69.3) 18.1 (68.5) 17.9 (67.8) 17.7 (67.0) 17.4 (65.9) 17.2 (65.1) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 17.0 (64.3) 16.8 (63.6) 16.7 (63.2) 16.5 (62.5) 16.3 (61.7) 16.2 (61.3) 16.0 (60.6) 16.0 (60.6) 16.0 (60.6) 16.0 (60.6) 16.0 (60.6) Time Min 0.0 2.0 4.0 6.0 8.0 10.0 12.0 14.0 16.0 18.0 20.0 22.0 24.0 26.0 28.0 30.0 32.0 34.0 36.0 38.0 40.0 42.0 44.0 46.0 48.0 50.0 Fuel Used Distance Gal. (L) NM 0 (0) 0 1 (4) 8 1 (4) 2 (8) 2 (8) 3 (11) 4 (15) 4 (15) 5 (19) 5 (19) 6 (23) 7 (26) 7 (26) 8 (30) 8 (30) 9 (34) 9 (34) 10 (38) 10 (38) 11 (42) 12 (45) 12 (45) 13 (49) 13 (49) 14 (53) 14 (53) 16 24 32 39 47 54 62 69 76 83 90 97 104 111 118 124 131 137 144 150 157 163 169 175

Figure 5 - 34

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-37

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally left Blank

RC050005 5-38

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SHORT FIELD LANDING DISTANCE (40 - LANDING FLAPS)

Section 5 Performance

ASSOCIATED CONDITIONS
Power Flaps Runway Approach Speed Braking As required to maintain 3 approach 40 Paved, Level, Dry Surface See Speed Schedule Maximum OAT

EXAMPLE
25C

Pressure Altitude (PA) 4000 ft Takeoff Weight 3200 lb. Headwind Component 10 Ground Roll = 1240 ft (378 m) 50 ft Obstacle = 2600 ft (793 m) Runway Slope Correction: Add 1% to ground roll for every 0.1 (0.2%) of downhill slope. For operation on a known level, smooth, mowed grass runway, which is either wet or dry but does not include standing water, the ground roll distance obtained from this landing performance chart must be multiplied by a factor of 1.6 to obtain the correct field length. In the above example, the ground roll distance would be 1.6 x 1240 ft = 1984 ft (605 m). The total distance to clear a 50-ft obstacle would be 3344 ft (1020 m) in this instance.

Figure 5 - 35
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 5-39

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 5-40

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) LANDING SPEED SCHEDULE The following chart should be used in conjunction with the landing distance chart in Figure 5 - 35 to determine the proper landing speed based on aircraft weight.

Section 5 Performance

Landing Speed Schedule


95
Speed at 50 ft. obstacle (VREF) for Normal Landing

90

85

80
Speed at 50 ft. obstacle (VREF) for Short Field Landing

75

Speed, KIAS

70

65
Speed at Touchdown

60

55
Stall Speed

50

Maximum Landing Weight: 3420 lb.

45 2600 2700 2800 2900 3000 3100 3200 3300 3400 3500

Landing Weight, lb.

Figure 5 - 36

SAMPLE PROBLEM
Airplane Configuration
Takeoff Weight ... 3600 lbs. (1633 kg) Maximum Gross Weight Usable Fuel .................................................. 98 Gallons (371 L)

Cruise Environment
Distance of Trip .........................................412 Nautical Miles Pressure Cruise Altitude .......................................... 8000 Feet Cruise Power..........................................80% BHP/2500 RPM Ambient Air Temperature ............................. -1C (Standard) En Route Winds ....................................... 30 Knot Headwind

Takeoff Environment
Airport Pressure Altitude......................................... 3500 Feet Ambient Air Temperature ......... 25C (17C above standard) Headwind Component ............................................. 30 Knots Runway Length ...................................................... 3000 Feet Obstacle at the end of the runway................................ 50 Feet Climb to Cruise Altitude....................Max. Continuous Power

Landing Environment
Airport Pressure Altitude ....................................... 2000 Feet Ambient Air Temperature ...... 30C (16.5C above standard) Landing Runway Number .................................................. 36 Wind Direction & Velocity ......................... 040 at 25 Knots Runway Length ...................................................... 3000 Feet Obstacle at approach end of the runway ......................... None

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 5-41

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SOLVE FOR THE FOLLOWING ITEMS

No.

Item

Solution

Comments

1.

2.

What is the takeoff ground run distance at the departure airport? What is the total takeoff distance at the departure airport (ground run and obstacle clearance)? Assume a climb to cruise altitude is started at a pressure altitude of 4000 feet. What is the approximate fuel used to reach cruise altitude? What distance over the ground is covered in the climb under no wind conditions.? What is the approximate time? What is the fuel flow at the 8000 foot cruise altitude? What is the true airspeed at the 8000 foot cruise altitude (to the nearest whole knot)? Using the cruise and range profiles, what are the approximate miles covered and time aloft at 80% BHP? Assume a 500 FPM descent is used for arrival at the destination airport. At what distance from the airport should the descent begin to arrive at 1000 feet above the surface? What are the crosswind and headwind components at the destination airport? What is the landing distance required at the destination airport, with landing flaps, at maximum landing weight?

1150 Feet

Problem is different than example arrows, i.e., takeoff weight - 3600 lbs. and headwind - 30 knots. Major indices are 200 feet and minor indices (not printed on the graph) are 100 feet. The fuel required to reach a pressure altitude of 4000 and 8000 feet is 1.7 and 3.4 gallons, respectively. The difference between these two altitudes yields 1.7 gallons. No adjustment for nonstandard temperature is possible. Using the technique described in No. 3 subtract the 4000 pressure altitude distance/time from the 8000 pressure altitude distance/time. Taken directly from chart. Taken directly from chart. Notice that range and endurance are significantly reduced when operating at higher power settings. The airport elevation is 2000 feet and the descent is from 8000 feet; hence, calculations should compare 8000 feet with 3000, which is 1000 feet above the surface. See the instruction on page 5-37 for descents to airports above sea level. The wind is 40 off the runway centerline. See Figure 5 - 9 for a detailed explanation. In No. 10 above, the headwind component is 19 knots. Insert this information along with the airport elevation and temperature into Figure 5 - 35.

1750 Feet

3.

1.7 Gallons (6.4 L)

4.

6 NM 2.9 Minutes 22 GPH (83 LPH) 195 knots 715 NM 3.6 Hours

5. 6.

7.

8.

33 NM

9.

16 kts xwind 19 kts hdwnd 1100 Feet

10.

RC050005 5-42

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) OXYGEN SYSTEM DURATION CHARTS

Section 6 Weight & Balance - Equipment List

The charts shown in Figure 5 - 37 or Figure 5 - 38 should be used to determine the amount of oxygen available when using the A4 or A5 Flowmeter with cannulas or masks.
A4 FLOWMETER WITH CANNULA OR MASKS

Oxygen System Usage Duration - A4 FlowMeter - STD Cannula


(42 Cu. Ft. Serviced to 1,800 PSIG)

24
Usage Altitude (Ft * 1,000)

22 20 18 16 14 12 10
6. 00 7. 00 8. 00 3. 00 0. 00 1. 00 2. 00

MASK ONLY ABOVE 18,000 ft

MASK OR CANNULA BELOW 18,000 ft

10 .0 0

11 .0 0

13 .0 0

12 .0 0

Hours of Available O2 1 PERSON 2 PERSONS 3 PERSONS 4 PERSONS

Figure 5 - 37
A5 FLOWMETER WITH CANNULA OR MASKS

Oxygen System Usage Duration - A5 FlowMeter - STD Cannula


(42 Cu. Ft. Serviced to 1,800 PSIG)

24 22
Usage Altitude (Ft * 1,000)

MASK ONLY ABOVE 18,000 ft

20 18 16 14 12 10
0.00 5.00 10.00 15.00 20.00 25.00 30.00 35.00 40.00 45.00

MASK OR CANNULA BELOW 18,000 ft

Hours of Available O2 1 PERSON - STD 2 PERSONS - STD 3 PERSONS - STD 4 PERSONS - STD

Figure 5 - 38
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (ACCS)

When Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS) is installed it is important to be aware of the following performance changes that may result. If the Automatic Climate Control System is not operating properly, all or any of the following factors may change. It is the pilots responsibility to monitor fuel burn, time in flight and time to destination during all flight operations and make appropriate decisions to maintain a safe flight.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007 RC050005 5-43

14 .0 0

15 .0 0

9. 00

4. 00

5. 00

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Takeoffs Brake Horsepower (BHP) reduction, with the ACCS operating the compressor, during takeoff, has been determined to be 5 BHP or less than 2% of total BHP. If runway conditions are short, soft or grass, and if pressure altitude, temperature or humidity is high, it is recommended that the ACCS be switched to the Compressor Off mode during the takeoff portion of the flight by pressing the button until the adjacent indicator light is out. Normal and Maximum Performance Climbs The Maximum Rate of Climb performance has been determined to be approximately 14 ft. per minute lower with the air conditioning compressor operating and the system operating properly. The pilot should compute fuel burn, range, and endurance data based on this reduced rate of climb factor. For maximum performance the ACCS should be switched to the Compressor Off mode during the climb portion of the flight by pressing the button until the adjacent indicator light goes out. Cruise Flight tests have determined that the cruise performance with the air conditioning compressor operating is reduced by 2%. The pilot should compute fuel burn, range, and endurance data based on this reduced cruise factor. If maximum performance is desired, the ACCS should be switched to the Compressor Off mode during the cruise portion of the flight by pressing the button until the adjacent indicator light is out.

RC050005 5-44

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: D/01-24-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance - Equipment List

Section 6 Weight & Balance and Equipment List


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 6-3 Weight and Balance Procedures ............................................................................................ 6-3 Equipment List....................................................................................................................... 6-3 PROCEDURES FOR WEIGHING & DETERMINING EMPTY CG General ................................................................................................................................... 6-4 Airplane Configuration.......................................................................................................... 6-4 Airplane Leveling .................................................................................................................. 6-5 Using the Permanent Reference Point................................................................................... 6-6 Measurements ........................................................................................................................ 6-7 Converting Measurements to Arms....................................................................................... 6-8 Weights and Computations.................................................................................................... 6-8 Example of Empty Center of Gravity (CG) Determination .................................................. 6-9 Changes in the Airplanes Configuration ............................................................................6-10 Determining Location (FS) of Installed Equipment in Relation to Datum.................................................................................................6-10 Weight and Balance Forms.........................................................................................6-10 Updating the Form......................................................................................................6-10 PROCEDURES FOR DETERMINING GROSS WEIGHT AND LOADED CG Useful Load and Stations.....................................................................................................6-11 Baggage ...............................................................................................................................6-11 Baggage Configuration Table..............................................................................................6-12 Baggage Nets .......................................................................................................................6-12 Summary of Loading Stations .............................................................................................6-13 Computing the Loaded Center of Gravity (CG)..................................................................6-13 Sample Problem Calculator Method .......................................................................6-14 Sample Problem Graphical Method ........................................................................6-14 Weight and Balance Limitations .........................................................................................6-15 Other Weight Limitations ....................................................................................................6-16 Maximum Empty Weight ....................................................................................................6-16 Front Seat Moment Computations Graph ...........................................................................6-17 Rear Seat Moment Computations Graph.............................................................................6-17 Fuel Moment Computations Graph .....................................................................................6-18 Baggage Moment Computations Graph ..............................................................................6-18 Center of Gravity Envelope.................................................................................................6-19 EQUIPMENT LIST GENERAL ................................................................................................. 6A-1 Install Code ......................................................................................................................... 6A-1 Chapter Numbers ................................................................................................................ 6A-1 Flight Operations Requirements......................................................................................... 6A-1 Headsets ............................................................................................................................. 6A-1 EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST -APPENDIX A ..................................... 6A-3
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 6-1

Section 5 Performance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Chapters 21-24 .................................................................................................................... 6A-3 Chapter 25 ........................................................................................................................... 6A-7 Chapters 26-31 .................................................................................................................... 6A-9 Chapter 32 .........................................................................................................................6A-11 Chapter 33 .........................................................................................................................6A-12 Chapter 34 .........................................................................................................................6A-13 Chapter 35 .........................................................................................................................6A-17 Chapters 52-77 ..................................................................................................................6A-18 INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) - APPENDIX B......................................................... 6B-1 TABULATED AFTER-MARKET EQUIPMENT LIST (TAMEL) Follows IEL WEIGHT & BALANCE RECORD ........................................................................ Follows TAMEL

RC050005 6-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance - Equipment List

Section 6 Weight & Balance and Equipment List INTRODUCTION


Weight and Balance Procedures This section, after the introduction, is divided into three parts. The first part contains procedures for determining the empty weight and empty center of gravity of the airplane. Its use is intended primarily for mechanics and companies or individuals who make modifications to the airplane. While the procedures are not directly applicable for day-to-day pilot use, the information will give the owner or operator of the airplane an expanded understanding of the weight and balance procedures.

The procedures for determining the empty weight and empty CG are excerpted from the maintenance manual and included in this manual to aid those who need to compute this information but do not have access to a maintenance manual. This section also contains procedures for maintaining and updating weight and balance changes to the airplane. While a mechanic or others who make changes to the airplanes configuration normally update the section, the pilot, owner, and/or operator of the airplane are responsible for ensuring that the information is maintained in a current status. The last entry on this table should contain the current weight and moments for this airplane. The second part of this section is applicable to pilots, as it has procedures for determining the weight and balance for each flight. This part details specific procedures for airplane loading, how loading affects the center of gravity, plus a number of charts and graphs for determining the loaded center of gravity. For pilot purposes, in the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG), the zero datum point is one inch aft of the tip of the propeller spinner. All measurements from this point are positive or aft of the datum point and are expressed in inches. The tip of the propeller is at -1 inch. It is important to remember that the weight and balance for each airplane varies somewhat and depends on a number of factors. The weight and balance information detailed in this manual only applies to the airplane specified on the cover page. This weight and balance information is part of the FAA Approved Airplane Flight Manual (AFM). Under the provision of Part 91 of the Federal Aviation Regulations no person can operate a civil aircraft unless there is available in the aircraft a current AFM. It is the responsibility of the pilot-incommand to ensure that the airplane is properly loaded.
Equipment List The final portion of this section contains the equipment list. The equipment list includes standard and optional equipment and specifies both the weight of the installed item and its arm, i.e., distance from the datum. This information is useful in computing the new empty weight and CG when items are temporarily removed for maintenance or other purposes. In addition, equipment required for a particular flight operation is tabulated. The equipment is generally organized and listed in accordance with ATA maintenance manual chapter numbering specifications.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-3

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

PROCEDURES FOR WEIGHING & DETERMINING EMPTY CG


GENERAL To determine the empty weight and center of gravity of the airplane, the airplane must be in a level area and in a particular configuration. AIRPLANE CONFIGURATION (Empty Weight) 1. The airplane empty weight includes eight quarts of oil (dipstick reading), unusable fuel, hydraulic brake fluid, and installed equipment.

2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.

Defuel the airplane per instructions in Chapter 12 of the maintenance manual. Ensure the oil sump is filled to eight quarts (cold engine). Check the reading on the dipstick and service as necessary. Place the pilots and front passengers seat in the full aft position. Retract the flaps to the up or 0 position. Center the controls to the neutral static position. Ensure all doors, including the baggage door, are closed when the airplane is weighed.
CAUTION It is not recommended to weigh an airplane with full fuel and subtract the weight of the fuel to obtain empty weight because the weight of fuel varies with temperature. If this method of weight determination is used, fuel weight should be calculated conservatively. Use the specific weight of fuel at ambient temperature. See table and example below.

6.4
Specific Weight, Lbs./U.S.

6.2 6 5.8 5.6 5.4 5.2 5 4.8 -60 -40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160
Temperature, F Average Specific Weight of Aviation Gasoline (Mil-F-5572 Grade 100/130 Type) Versus Temperature

The following is offered as an example only. It is important to remember that the aircraft weight in the example does not apply to a specific airplane.

RC050005 6-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Example: Unconservative Calculation Conventionally used fuel specific weight (6 lbs./U. S. gal.) Total Aircraft weight with fuel Weight of fuel (98 gal. x 6 lbs./U. S. gal.) Airplane empty weight (3038 lbs 588 lbs.) Conservative Calculation Fuel specific weight at 60 F (5.83 lbs./U. S. gal.) Total Aircraft weight with fuel Weight of fuel (98 gal. x 5.83 lbs./U. S. gal.) Airplane empty weight (3038 lbs 571 lbs.)

= 3038 lbs. = 588 lbs. = 2450 lbs.

= 3038 lbs. = 571 lbs. = 2467 lbs.

AIRPLANE LEVELING Because there are no perfectly level reference areas on the airplane and the use of Smart Levels is not common, the airplane is leveled by use of a plumb bob suspended over a fixed reference point under the rear seats. Moreover, since the use of jacks with load cells is not prevalent, the wheel scales method is described in this manual. The following steps specify the procedures for installing the plumb bob and leveling the airplane. These steps must be completed before taking readings from the wheel scales.

1. 2.

The airplane must be weighed in a level area. Remove the left rear seat cushion and place in the footwell. When the cushion is removed, a small washer, which is bonded to the bottom of the seat frame, will be exposed.

Figure 6 - 1 3. Using a string with a plumb bob attached to it, run the string over the gas strut door flange between the flange ball and the point where the gas strut attaches to the ball, and tie the string off around the front seatbelt bracket. See Figure 6 - 1. Using the two jack method (Raising Both Wings) discussed in Chapter 7 of the maintenance manual, position the two main tires and the nose tire of the airplane on three scales. Ensure the brakes are set before raising the airplane off the floor. When all of the airplanes weight is on the three scales, move the jacks to a location that is not under the wings. The pointed end of the plumb bob, in a resting state, will be near a 3/16-inch washer bonded into the seat frame. It will be necessary to either deflate the nose tire or strut and/or main tires to center the plumb bob point over the washer. When the pointer of the plumb bob is over any part of the washer, the airplane is level. Once the airplane is level, be sure to release the brakes.

4.

5.

6.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-5

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

USING THE PERMANENT REFERENCE POINT 1. To determine the empty weight center of gravity of the airplane, it is more convenient to work with the permanent reference. The permanent reference point on the airplane is located at the forward part of the wing bottom, in the center of the wing saddle and is 97.05 inches aft of the datum. The location is shown in Figure 6 - 2. There is a pronounced seam at the point where the fuselage is attached to the wing, and the leading edge of the wing bottom is easy to identify. Suspend a plumb bob from the permanent reference point in the exact center as shown in Figure 6 - 2 through Figure 6 - 4.

Reference Point 97.05

Figure 6 - 2 2. Determine the center point on each tire, and make a chalked reference mark near the bottom where the tire touches the floor. On the main gear tires, the mark should be on the inside, near where the arrows point in Figure 6 - 3.

RC050005 6-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

NOSE GEAR TIRE

LATERAL REFERENCE LINE BETWEEN MARKS ON THE MAIN GEAR TIRES

(MEASUREMENT B)

FUSELAGE STATION 97.05 LOCATION OF PLUMB BOB (MEASUREMENT A)

MAIN GEAR TIRES CHALK MARKS

Figure 6 - 3 3. Create a lateral reference line between the two main gear tires. This can be accomplished by stretching a string between the two chalk marked areas of the tires, snapping a chalk line between these two points, or laying a 7.3 foot board between the points.

B Measmnt.

A Measmnt.

Figure 6 - 4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-7

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

MEASUREMENTS
Measure the distance along the longitudinal axis from the permanent reference point (tip of the plumb bob) to the lateral reference line between the main gear tires. This is Measurement A in Figure 6 - 3 and Figure 6 - 4. Measure the distance along the longitudinal axis between the plumb bob to the mark on nose tire. This is Measurement B in Figure 6 - 3 and Figure 6 - 4.
CONVERTING MEASUREMENTS TO ARMS To convert Measurement A and B distances to an arm, use the formulas shown in Figure 6 - 5 and Figure 6 - 6, respectively. MAIN GEAR Measurement A Distance + 97.05 inches = Main Gear Arm

Figure 6 - 5

NOSE GEAR 97.05 inches - Measurement B Distance = Nose Gear Arm

Figure 6 - 6
WEIGHTS AND COMPUTATIONS Each main gear scale should be capable of handling weight capacities of about 1200 lbs., while the nose gear scale needs a capacity of at least 750 lbs. Computing the total weight and moments requires seven steps or operations. These seven operations are discussed below and also shown in Figure 6 - 7.
Operation No. 1 Operation No. 2 Operation No. 3 Operation No. 4 Arm (Inches)
Main Gear Arm Main Gear Arm Nose Gear Arm

Operation No. 5 =
= = =

Scale Weight Reading Tare or Scale Corrected (lbs.) Error Weight (lbs.) X Location
Right Main Gear Left Main Gear Nose Gear Right Scale Reading Left Scale Reading Nose Scale Reading Scale Error Scale Error Scale Error Right Scale Wt. X Error Left Scale Wt. X Error Nose Scale Wt. X Error Total Corrected Weight Operation No. 6

Moments (lbs.- inches)


Right Gear Moments Left Gear Moments Nose Gear Moments Total Moments Operation No. 7

Total Empty Weight and Empty Moments

Figure 6 - 7 1. Operation No. 1 - Enter the weight for each scale into the second column. 2. Operation No. 2 - Enter the scale error. The scale error is sometimes referred to as the tare and is entered in the third column for each scale. 3. Operation No. 3 - Add or subtract the respective tare for each scale, and enter the result into the fourth column. This is the correct weight.

RC050005 6-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

4. Operation No. 4 - Using the formulas shown in Figure 6 - 5 and Figure 6 - 6, determine the arm for the main gear and nose gear. Enter this information into the fifth column. 5. Operation No. 5 - Multiply the corrected scale weights times their respective arms to determine the moments for each location. Enter the moments for each computation in the sixth column. 6. Operation Nos. 6 and 7 Sum the weights in the fourth column and the moments in the sixth column. Note: The areas of primary calculations have a double outline. 7. The final step, which is to determine the empty center of gravity, is to divide the total moments by the total corrected weight. A detailed example of this computation is shown in Figure 6 - 9.
EXAMPLE OF EMPTY CENTER OF GRAVITY (CG) DETERMINATION The following is offered as an example problem to aid in understanding the computation process. It is important to remember that the weights, arms, and moments used in the example problem are for demonstration purposes only and do not apply to a specific airplane. For the example problem, assume the following.

1. Scale Weights a. Right Main Gear 992 pounds b. Left Main Gear 991 pounds c. Nose Gear 502 pounds 2. Scale Error (Tare) a. Right Main Gear Scale is 1 pounds b. Left Main Gear Scale is 2 pound c. Nose Gear Scale is + 3 pounds 3. Measurements a. Measurement Distance A is 24.05 inches b. Measurement Distance B is 56.15 inches c. These uncorrected scale weights and tares are shown in Figure 6 - 8. Note that after correcting for scale error, the right, left, and nose gear weights are 991, 989, and 505 pounds, respectively. The arm for the main gear is computed as follows using the formula in Figure 6 - 5.
Measurement distance A + 97.05 inches = Main Gear Arm (MGA) or 24.05 inches + 97.05 inches = 121.1 inches MGA

d.

4. The arm for the nose gear is computed as follows using the formula in Figure 6 - 6.
97.05 inches Measurement Distance B = Nose Gear Arm (NGA)

or
97.05 inches 56.15 inches = 40.9 inches NGA

5. The main and nose gear arms, as computed, are shown in Figure 6 - 8. 6. The corrected weights of 992 and 991 pounds are then multiplied with the 121.1 inch main gear arm, which produces total moments of 120,010.1 lbs.-inches and 119,767.9 lbs.-inches, respectively. It is not uncommon for the right and left gear weights to vary a few pounds. 7. Next, the corrected 502 pound nose gear weight is multiplied times its 40.9 inch arm, which produces a moment value of 20,654.5 lbs.-inches. 8. Finally, the total moments and corrected weights are summed. In the example below, the total weight is 2,485 pounds and the total moments are 260,432.5 lbs.-inches. All this information
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 6-9

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

is summarized in Figure 6 - 8. All required data for determining the empty center of gravity are now available.
Scale Weight Tare or Scale Corrected Arm Moments Error Weight (lbs.) X (Inches) = (lbs.- inches) Location Reading (lbs.)
Right Main Gear Left Main Gear Nose Gear 992 991 502 -1 -2 +3 991 989 +505 2485.0 X X X 121.1 121.1 40.9 = = = 120,010.1 119,767.9 +20,654.5 260,432.5

Total Empty Weight and Empty Moments

Figure 6 - 8 9. The formula for determining empty weight center of gravity is shown in Figure 6 - 9; in the example below, the empty center of gravity of the airplane is at fuselage station (FS) 104.8.
Total Moments = Empty Weight Center of Gravity

or

260,432.5 lbs.-inches 2695

104.8

Figure 6 - 9
CHANGES IN THE AIRPLANES CONFIGURATION 1. Determining Location (FS) of Installed Equipment in Relation to the Datum If equipment is installed in the airplane, the weight and balance information must be updated. Individuals and companies who are involved with equipment installations and/or modifications are generally competent and conversant with weight and balance issues. These individuals or companies must be aware that the fixed reference point is located at fuselage station (FS) 97.05. Please see Figure 6 - 2 on page 6-6 for more information.

2. Weight and Balance Forms There is a form that is inserted after Appendix A of Chapter 6 of the AFM/POH that is used to track changes in the configuration of the airplane. When equipment is added or removed, these pages or an appropriate approved form must be updated. In either instance the required information is similar. 3. Updating the Form Fill in the date the item is added or removed, a description of the item, the arm of the item, its weight, and the moment of the item. Remember, multiply the weight times the arm of the item to obtain the moment. Finally, compute the new empty weight and empty moment by adjusting the running totals. If an item is removed, subtract the weight and moment of the item from the running totals. If an item is added, add the weight and moment of the item to the running totals.

RC050005 6-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

PROCEDURES FOR DETERMINING GROSS WEIGHT AND LOADED CENTER OF GRAVITY (CG)
USEFUL LOAD AND STATIONS The useful load is determined by subtracting the empty weight of the airplane from the maximum allowable gross weight of 3600 pounds. The current information obtained from the Weight & Balance Record in the previous discussion contains the empty weight and empty moments for this airplane. The useful load includes the weight of pilot, passengers, usable fuel, and baggage.

The objective in good weight and balance planning is to distribute the useful load in a manner that keeps the loaded center of gravity within prescribed limits and near the center of the CG range. The center of gravity is affected by both the amount of weight added and the arm or distance from the datum. The arm is sometimes expressed as a station. For example, if weight is added at station 110, this means the added weight is 110 inches from the datum or zero reference point. The drawing below, Figure 6 - 10, shows the location of passenger and baggage loading stations. The fuel is loaded at station 118 and is not shown in the figure. These loading stations are summarized in Figure 6 - 12.

Figure 6 - 10
BAGGAGE The space between the rear seat and the aft bulkhead is referred to as the main baggage area, and the shelf aft of this area is called the hat rack or simply the shelf. In Figure 6 - 10 and Figure 6 - 12 there are listings for three main area baggage stations, which are labeled A, M, and B. Area A is the forward baggage zone and area B is the aft baggage zone. Point M is the middle point of the baggage compartment. The arm for the shelf is measured from the datum point to the center portion of the shelf.

Since the main baggage area, exclusive of the hat rack, is about three and one half feet in length, consideration must be given to the arm of weights placed within this area. The use of multiple baggage loading stations contribute to more precise center of gravity computations and facilitate redistribution of baggage when the aft CG limit is exceeded. If no weight is placed on the hat rack, then up to 120 lbs. can be placed in either zone or distributed evenly over the main baggage area. This, of course, assumes that the placement of such weight does not exceed the maximum gross weight or the center of gravity limitations.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-11

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

The floor attachment points define the physical limits of each zone. That is, the area between the forward and middle cross strap defines Zone A, and the middle cross strap and aft attachment points define Zone B. There is a cargo net in the airplane that secures the contents in the baggage compartment in three basic configurations. The table below, Figure 6 - 11, summarizes the three different arrangements. The term bubble refers to the shape of the cargo net.
BAGGAGE CONFIGURATION TABLE NO. ZONE CONFIGURATION OF CARGO NET APPLICABLE ARM

1. 2.

A Only A and B

Single forward bubble, anchored at the forward and middle attachment points. Double bubble, anchored at forward, middle, and aft attachment points Weight is evenly distributed over the main baggage area. There can be one or two bubbles depending on the shape of the baggage. Figure 6 - 11

155.7 inches 155.7 and 177.4 inches times respective weights

3.

Main Area

166.6 inches

Baggage is always loaded in the forward area first (Zone A). Heavier items, of course, should be placed near the floor, regardless of loading area, and never load the baggage compartment to a level higher than the top of the hat rack. If only Zone A is utilized, the computations are based on an arm of 155.7 inches. If both Zones A and B are utilized, with defined weights in each area as shown in Configuration No. 2 in Figure 6 - 11, two computations will be made to determine the total baggage weight and moments. In this situation, each zone will have a significantly different quantifiable weight. For example, assume that 100 lbs. are loaded in Zone A and 20 lbs. in Zone B. These combined weights and respective arms produce a baggage CG of 159.3, over seven inches forward of the middle point of the baggage area. Conversely, if the respective Zone A and B weights are 55 and 65 lbs., the baggage CG moves less than one inch from the middle CG point. As a general rule, if the weights placed in Zones A and B do not vary more than 15%, then the middle CG arm of 166.6 can be used to compute the main baggage area moment.
BAGGAGE NETS The airplane has two baggage nets. The hat rack net secures items placed on the hat rack. The floor net secures items in the main baggage area. A summary of the two nets follows. 1. The floor net provides a total of four anchoring points. The points are all on the floor with two behind the back seat and two just below the hat rack bulkhead. In addition, the floor net can be adjusted at any one of the four straps at the attachment points by pressing on the cinch and sliding the strap. The net can be removed by releasing each of the four attachments by pressing down and holding on the button on the top of the attachment and sliding it out of its mount. The net can be reinstalled by reversing the removal process. The floor net must be used any time baggage is carried in the main baggage compartment area. 2. The hat rack net is attached at four points, two in the overhead and two on the face of the hat rack bulkhead. The net is not adjustable. To remove the net, unhook each of the four hook attachments from the mounting slot. To attach the net, hook each of the four hook attachments into the mounting slot. This net must be used anytime items are stored in the hat rack area.

RC050005 6-12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SUMMARY OF LOADING STATIONS Arm (Inches From Datum)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Description

Maximum Weight

Front Seat Pilot and Passenger Rear Seat Passenger(s)

110.0 inches 141.4 inches

N/A N/A S/N 41501 to 41799:

Fuel

118.0 inches

588 Lbs. (98 Gallons)* S/N 41800 and on: 612 Lbs. (102 Gallons)*

Forward Baggage Area (Zone A) Middle of Baggage Area (Point M) Aft Baggage Area (Zone B) Center Rear Baggage Shelf

155.7 inches 166.6 inches 177.4 inches 199.8 inches

120 Lbs. 120 Lbs. 120 Lbs. 20 Lbs.

*Usable Fuel (The unusable fuel is included in the empty weight.) The maximum total allowed baggage weight is 120 lbs., and only 20 lbs. of this total allowable weight can be placed on the rear baggage shelf. The weight of items placed on the rear shelf must be subtracted from 120 lbs. of total allowable baggage weight. Figure 6 - 12
COMPUTING THE LOADED CENTER OF GRAVITY (CG) All information required to compute the center of gravity as loaded with passengers, baggage, and fuel is now available. Refer to the sample-loading problem in Figure 6 - 13. This table is divided into two sections; the first section contains a sample-loading problem with computations, and the second section provides space for actual calculations. It is recommended that the second section of this table be copied or otherwise duplicated so that the pilot has an unmarked document with which to perform the required calculations.

In the sample problem, multiplying the weight of a particular item, i.e., pilot, passengers, baggage and fuel, times its arm, computes the moment for that item. The moments and weight are then summed with the basic empty weight and the empty moment of the airplane. In the example, these totals are 3,450 pounds and 377,788 moments. The loaded center of gravity of 109.5 inches is then determined by dividing the total moments by the gross weight.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6-13

Section 6 Weight & Balance CALCULATOR METHOD


Sample Problem

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Calculator Method
ITEM WT. (Lbs.) ARM (Inches) MOMENTS (lbs.-in.) ITEM

Actual Calculation For This Airplane


WT. (Lbs.) ARM (Inches) MOMENTS (lbs.-in.)

Basic Empty Wt.** Front Seat Wts. Rear Seats Wts. Baggage (Main) Baggage (Zone A) Baggage (Zone B) Baggage (Shelf) Fuel (At 6 lbs./gal.) Totals

2,485 380 175 50 0 0 0 360 3,450 110.0 141.4 166.6 155.7 177.4 199.8 118.0

260,433 41,800 24,745 8,330 0 0 0 42,480 377,788

Basic Empty Wt. Front Seats Rear Seats Baggage (Main)* Baggage (Zone A)* Baggage (Zone B)* Baggage (Aft) Fuel (At 6 lbs./gal.) Totals 110.0 141.4 166.6 155.7 177.4 199.8 118.0

377,788 lbs. in. =109.5 inches 3,450 lbs.

lbs.in. = lbs.

inches

*When computing baggage moment, use the arm for either the Main Baggage Area, Zone A, or Zones A and B as applicable. Refer to the Baggage discussion on page 6-76 for more information. In this example, the weight is evenly distributed over the main baggage area.

**NOTE The basic empty weight used in this example will vary for each airplane. Refer to the Weight and Balance Record, which follows Appendix A of this section.

Figure 6 - 13
GRAPHICAL METHOD The multiplying graphs, which begin on page 6-17, can be used to determine the moments for each weight location. The answer is not as accurate as doing the calculation with a calculator; however, the margin of error is not significant and within acceptable parameters of safety. The example arrows in the graphs on pages 6-17 and 6-18 use the data from the sample problem in Figure 6 - 13.

When using the multiplying graphs, it is more convenient to divide the moments on the Y or vertical axis by 1000. For example, 70,000 lbs.-in. is read as 70.0 (x 1000) lbs.-in. Once all the calculations are made, the answer can then be multiplied by 1000. The numbers shown in Figure 6 - 14 are moment values obtained by reading directly from the graphs and are expressed as 1000 lbs.-in. It should be noted that there is a nominal difference in center of gravity location between the two procedures.

RC050005 6-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) SAMPLE PROBLEM GRAPHICAL METHOD (Using moments obtained from the Graphs)* ITEM Basic Empty Wt. Front Seat Wts. Rear Seats Wts. Baggage (Main) Baggage (Shelf) Fuel (At 6 lbs./gal.) Totals

Section 6 Weight & Balance

WT. (Lbs.)
2,485 380 175 50 0 360 3,450

MOMENTS (1000 lbs.-in. )


260.4 (Figure 6 - 8) 42.0* (Figure 6 - 15) 25.0* (Figure 6 - 17) 8.3* (Figure 6 - 19) 0.0* (Figure 6 - 19) 42.0* (Figure 6 - 18)

377.7 x 1000 = 377,700

377,700 lbs. in, =109.5 inches 3,450 lbs.


Figure 6 - 14
WEIGHT AND BALANCE LIMITATIONS As its name suggests, weight and balance limitations have two components, a weight limitation and a balance or center of gravity limitation. The maximum gross weight of the airplane is 3600 pounds. This is the first limitation that must be considered in weight and balance preflight planning. If the gross weight is more than 3600 pounds, then fuel, baggage, and/or passenger weight must be reduced. Once the gross weight is at or below 3600 pounds, consideration is then made for distribution of the weight.

The objective in dealing with the balance limitation is to ensure that the center of gravity is within prescribed ranges at the specified gross weight. The center of gravity range is referred to as the envelope. The center of gravity envelope graph on page 6-19 shows the envelope for the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG). Using data from the sample problem in Figure 6 - 14, a CG of 109.5 inches at 3450 lbs. gross weight indicates the airplane, as loaded, is within the envelope. If the center of gravity is outside the envelope, the airplane is not safe to fly. If the range is exceeded to the left of the envelope, then the airplane is nose heavy and weight must be redistributed with more to the aft position. Conversely, if the range is exceeded to the right of the envelope, then the airplane is tail heavy and weight must be redistributed with more to the forward position. Notice that the range of the envelope decreases as weight increases. At 3600 lbs. maximum gross weight, the range of the envelope is 108.8 inches to 112 inches, a range of 3.2 inches. At 2900 lb. gross weight, the range increases to 7 inches.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-15

Section 6 Weight & Balance OTHER WEIGHT LIMITATIONS


TYPE OF WEIGHT LIMITATION
Minimum Flying Weight Maximum Zero Fuel Weight

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

FORWARD DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT


105 inches and 2600 lbs. 107.2 inches and 3300 lbs.

AFT DATUM POINT AND WEIGHT


112 inches and 2900 lbs. 112 inches and 3300 lbs.

VARIATION
Straight Line Straight Line

Reference Datum: The reference datum is located one inch aft of the tip of the propeller spinner. As distance from the datum increases, there is an increase in weight for each of the two limitation categories. The variation is linear or straight line from the fore to the aft positions.

Figure 6 - 15
MAXIMUM EMPTY WEIGHT The maximum empty weight of the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) is 2708 pounds. The FAA requires the determination of this weight for FAA certification. For airplanes certified in the IFR utility category, a passenger weight of 190 pounds for each seat plus the fuel weight for 45 minutes of flight are used for this computation. This equates to 132 pounds of fuel and 760 pounds of passenger weight for a total of 892 pounds. For the purpose of this discussion, the 892 pounds is referred to as the minimum useful load. Subtracting the minimum useful load from the maximum gross weight of 3600 pounds produces the maximum empty weight of 2708 pounds.

The maximum empty weight is not an abstract concept as it has practical applications. For example, assuming an empty weight of 2485 pounds, the 223 pound difference between the empty weight and the maximum empty weight defines the maximum additional weight of optional equipment that can be added to the airplane.

RC050005 6-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Front Seat Moment Computations


50000

Moments (lbs.-in.)

40000

30000

20000 10000

0 100

150

200

250

300

350

400

Weight (lbs.)

Figure 6 - 16

Rear Seat Moment Computations


60000

Moments (lbs.-in.)

50000 40000 30000 20000 10000 0

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

Weight (lbs.)

Figure 6 - 17

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-17

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Fuel Moment Computations 80000 Moments (lbs.-in.) 70000 60000 50000 40000 30000 20000 10000 0 100 150 200 40 Gals. 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 60 Gals. 80 Gals.

Weight (lbs.)

Figure 6 - 18
Baggage Moment Computations 25000 Zone B Baggage

20000 Moments (lbs.-in.)

15000 Zone A Baggage 10000 Shelf 5000 Main Baggage

25

50 Weight (lbs.)

75

100

Figure 6 - 19

RC050005 6-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 Weight & Balance

COLUMBIA 400 (LC41-550FG) WEIGHT AND BALANCE ENVELOPE

WEIGHT AND CG ENVELOPE LC41-550FG


3900 3800 3700 3600 3500 3400
2
Max. Landing Weight Max Zero Fuel Weight

3300 WEIGHT (LBS) 3200 3100 3000 2900 2800 2700 2600 2500 2400 2300 103 104 105 106 107 108
1 M.E.W. 3

M.F.W.

109

110

111

112

113

114

CG FS (INCH)

Figure 6 - 20 1. Airplane basic empty weight must be below Maximum Empty Weight (M.E.W.). 2. Weight must be below Maximum Landing Weight (M.L.W.) for landing. (If overweight landing occurs, see maintenance manual for required inspection prior to further flight.) 3. Weight and Center of Gravity (CG) without fuel must be below the Maximum Zero Fuel Weight (M.Z.F.W.) line. 4. See Section 2 for a listing of weight limitations.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6-19

Section 6 Weight & Balance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 6-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION


Install Code The following pages contain a listing of equipment that can be installed in the airplane; this is indicated in the Install Code column by the letters B and O. The meaning of each letter code follows. B (Basic Equipment) The equipment is installed in all airplanes. O (Optional Equipment) This equipment can be installed at the factory at the option of the purchaser. Chapter Numbers The chapter numbers listed in the equipment list correspond to the maintenance manual chapter where information regarding the maintenance of the part can be found. Flight Operation Requirements There is certain minimum equipment for IFR and night operations. Some equipment is required for all flight operations, while other items are optional. Columns four through seven, under the subheading Flight Operation Requirements, identifies which equipment must be installed and functioning for the various flight conditions. Headsets Use of the communications equipment requires a headset with a boom mike. Headsets are optional items and not provided by the manufacturer since personal preference is a significant issue. The pilot should add the actual weight of the headset to his or her weight and, when applicable, to each passengers weight for weight and balance calculations.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 6A-1

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 6A-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All CHAPTERS 21-24

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

21-01 21-02 21-03 21-04 21-05 21-06 21-07 21-08 21-09 21-10 21-11

B B B B B O O O O O O

Front Seat Eyeball Vents Rear Seat Eyeball Vents ECS Cabin Fan ECS Heat Box ECS Servomotor Automatic Climate Control System Control Panel/ECS Control Panel Compressor Belt Guard Compressor to Firewall Refrigerant Hoses Compressor Assembly (Engine Driven) Compressor Assembly (Electrically Driven) Fuselage Wire Harness

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6A-3

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All CHAPTERS 21-24

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

21-12 21-13 21-14 21-15 21-16 21-17 21-18 21-19 21-20 21-21 21-22 21-23
RC050005 6A-4

O O O O O O O O O O O O

Evaporator Assembly A/C Bay Access Panel Firewall to Condenser and Evaporator Hoses Condenser to Expansion Valve Hoses Condenser Assembly and Seals ECU/Blower Module Rear Mounted Relays Interlock Assembly Receiver Dryer and associated hoses Cabin Temperature Sensor and Wiring Outside Temperature Sensor Defog/Floor Vent Valve Assembly


Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All CHAPTERS 21-24

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

21-24 22-01 22-02 22-03 22-04 22-05 23-01 23-02 23-03

O O O O O O B B B

ECS Shut-off Valve Assembly GSM 85 Pitch Servo Mount GSA 81 Pitch Servo GSM 85 Roll Servo Mount GSA 81 Roll Servo GTA 82 Pitch Trim Adapter Static Wicks Ailerons/Wings (4) Static Wicks Elevator/Horizontal Stabilizer (4) Static Wick Rudder (1)

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6A-5

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

23-04 23-05 23-06 23-07 23-08 24-01 24-02 24-03 24-04 24-05 24-06

B B B B B B B O O O O

GMA 1347 Audio Panel GMA 1347 Mounting Rack with Connector G1000 Fan Rack, (2) (Each) GCF 328 Cooling Fan (2) (Each) GCF 328 Cooling Fan (Avionics) Belt-driven Alternator 65 Amp 28 Volt Gear-driven Alternator 52 Amp 28 Volt Accessories Alternator Battery, 28 Volt, 6.5 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Battery, 28 Volt, 8.5 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Battery, 28 Volt, 13.0 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each)

See1

1 If an ILS approach will be used during IFR operations, then the audio panel and PFD must be operative.
RC050005 6A-6 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

24-07 24-08 24-09 24-10 24-11 24-12 25-01 25-02 25-03 25-04 25-05 25-06

O B B B B B B B B B B B

Battery, 28 Volt, 13.6 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Voltage Regulators, 28 Volt (2) (Each) Ground Power Plug Relay Ground Power Plug Socket Ground Power Plug Wiring Power Grid Panel
CHAPTERS 25


RC050005 6A-7

Artex ELT-200 Emergency Locator Transmitter Unit Artex ELT-ME406 Emergency Locator Transmitter Unit ELT Antenna Circuit Breaker Panel Flap/Rocker Switch Panel Ignition Switch/Primer Switch Panel

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400

All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations

IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements All Night IFR Opt.

25-07 25-08 25-09 25-10 25-11 25-12 25-13 25-14 25-15 25-16 25-17

B B B B B B O O O O O

Light Dimmer Switch Panel GCU 476 Keypad Controller Pilots Adjustable Seat Copilots Adjustable Seat Rear Seat Cushion Rear Seatback Cushion Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Thin Bottom Cushion2 Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Medium Bottom Cushion2 Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Thick Bottom Cushion2 Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Thin Bottom Cushion2 Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Medium Bottom Cushion2

2 If installed, must be installed via STC SA01597SE. Only one pilots and copilots seat assembly per aircraft.
RC050005 6A-8 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

25-18 25-19 25-20 25-21 25-22 25-23 25-24 25-25 25-26 25-27 25-28

O O O B B B B B O B B

Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Thick Bottom Cushion2 Oregon Aero Rear Seat Cushion (2) (Each) 2 Oregon Aero Rear Seatback Cushion (2) (Each) 2 Pilots and Copilots Three-Point Restraint (Each) Rear Seat Passengers Three-Point Restraint (Each) Baggage Tie Downs and Restraining Net POH and FAA AFM (Stowed in Copilots Seatback) Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide (Latest Revision) Carbon Monoxide Detector Instrument Panel G1000 System Racks (2) (Each)

See3

See3

3 Baggage tie downs and a restraining net are required if baggage is carried in the baggage compartment.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 6A-9

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400

All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations

IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements All Night IFR Opt.

25-29 25-30 27-01 27-02 27-03 27-04 27-05 30-01 30-02

B B B B B B O O O

CHIPS Harness Assembly (2) (Each) Sandia Relay


CHAPTER 26-31

See 4 See 4

Pilots Control Stick Pilots Rudder Pedals (2) (Each) Copilots Control Stick Copilots Rudder Pedals (2) (Each) Rudder Hold Assembly Propeller Heat Module with Harness Brush Block Assembly

4 The right side controls may be removed provided permanent-type covers are placed over all openings from which the controls were removed and the procedure is approved and documented in the airframe logbooks by an appropriately certificated A & P mechanic.
RC050005 6A-10 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

30-03 31-01 32-01 32-02 32-03 32-04 32-05 32-06 32-07 32-08 33-01

O B B B B B B B B B B

Blade Heaters and Hardware Flight Hour Meter


CHAPTER 32


RC050005 6A-11

Main Wheel, Brake and Tire 15x6.00-6 (6-Ply)/Side Main Gear Fairings (Each) Main Wheel Fairings (Each) Main Wheel Fairings Mounting Plate (2) (Each) Nose Strut Fairing Nose Wheel Fairing Nose Gear Assembly Nose Wheel, Tire and Tube 5.00-5 (10-Ply)
CHAPTER 33

Flip Lights

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400

All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations

IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements All Night IFR Opt.

33-02 33-03 33-04 33-05 33-06 33-07 33-08 33-09 33-10 33-11 33-12

B B B O O O O O O O O

Step Lights Overhead Reading Lights (4) Strobe Lights/ Position Lights Whelen Landing Light Xenon Landing Light Xenon Landing Light Ballast Precise Flight Landing Light Precise Flight Landing Light Ballast Precise Flight Taxi Light Precise Flight Taxi Light Ballast Taxi Light

See 5 See 5 See 5 See 5 See 5

5 A landing light is required if the airplane is used to carry passengers for hire.
RC050005 6A-12 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All CHAPTER 34

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

34-01 34-02 34-03 34-04 34-05 34-06 34-07 34-08 34-09 34-10

B B B B B B B B B B

Garmin GPS Antenna (2) (Each) GA 35 GPS Antenna GA 37 GPS and XM Satellite Radio Antenna Marker Beacon Antenna COMM 1 Antenna COMM 2 Antenna NAV Antenna Transponder Antenna Magnetic Compass Stall Warning Lift Transducer

See 6 See 6 See 6 See 6

See 6 See 6 See 6 See 6

6 If an ILS approach will be used during IFR operations, then the GMA 340 audio panel and remote marker beacon lights must be operative.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 6A-13

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400

All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations

IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements All Night IFR Opt.

34-11 34-12 34-13 34-14 34-15 34-16 34-17 34-18 34-19 34-20 34-21 34-22 34-23

B B B B O O O O B B B B B

Stall Warning Horn Heated Pitot Tube Precise Flight Speed Brake 2000 System Wing Units ( 2) (Each) Precise Flight Speed Brake 2000 System Computer TCAD Processor TCAD Transponder Coupler TCAD Top Antenna TCAD Bottom Antenna GTP 59 OAT Probe GRS 77 mounting rack and connectors GRS 77 AHRS GMU 44 Magnetometer with mounting and connectors GDU 1040 PFD with connector

RC050005 6A-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

34-24 34-25 34-26 34-27 34-28 34-29 34-30 34-31 34-32 34-33 34-34

B B B B B B B B B B B

GDU 1042 MFD with connector GDU 1044 MFD with connector GIA 63/GIA 63W Mounting Rack with connectors (2) (Each) GIA 63/GIA 63W No. 1 Comm/Nav/GPS/AP Computer GIA 63/GIA 63W No. 2 Comm/Nav/GPS/AP Computer GDC 74A Mounting Rack with Connectors GDC 74A Air Data Computer GEA 71 Mounting Rack with Connectors GEA 71 Engine Airframe Unit GDL 69A Mounting Rack with Connectors GDL 69A Data Link

See 7 See 7

See 7 See 7

7 A single GIA 63 is acceptable for VFR operations, however the autopilot will not be functional unless both units are operating.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 6A-15

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

34-35 34-36 34-37 34-38 34-39 34-40

B B B B B B

GA 55 XM Antenna GTX 33 Mounting Rack with Connectors GTX 33 Transponder Standby Airspeed Indicator Standby Altimeter Standby Electric Attitude Indicator

See 8 See 8

8 At least one airspeed indicator and altimeter must be operational, i.e., either the PFD or the standby indicator.
RC050005 6A-16 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All CHAPTER 35

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

35-01 35-02 35-03 35-04 35-05 35-06 35-07 35-08

B B B B B B B B

Regulator Valve Assembly Cabin Distribution Manifold Assembly Face Mask (Rear Passengers) (2) Face Mask with microphone (1) Face Mask (Front Passenger) (1) Bottle 1 with manifold Bottle 2 with manifold Bottle 3 with manifold

See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See


9

See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9

See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9

See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9 See 9

9 Oxygen is required for the pilot above 12,500 ft for flight time exceeding 30 minutes and above 14,000 ft for the duration of the flight above 14,000 ft. Oxygen is required for passengers above 15,000 ft.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 6A-17

Section 6 (Appendix A) Equipment Types of Operation

(APPENDIX A) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

EQUIPMENT FOR TYPES OF OPERATION LIST Columbia 400 All Required for all flight operations Night Required for night flight operations IFR Required for IFR flight operations Opt. Optional, not required for flight operations Item All

A check mark in one of the four Flight Operation Requirements columns indicates the requirement for that item.

Item No.

Install Code

Flight Operation Requirements Night IFR Opt.

CHAPTER 52-77 52-01 53-01 53-02 61-01 61-02 61-03 71-02 77-01 O B O B B B B B Remote Keyless Entry System Cabin Entry Steps (Each) 10 Cabin Entry Handles (Each) Propeller Propeller Spinner Propeller Governor Engine Intake Filter TSIO-550-C TCM Engine Complete

10 The step is included in the basic package; however, some owners/operators elect to not have it installed since it lowers cruise speed slightly.
RC050005 6A-18 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
21-01 21-02 21-03 21-04 21-05 21-06 21-07 21-08 21-09 21-10 21-11 21-12 21-13 21-14 21-15 21-16 21-17

Installed

Item
Front Seat Eyeball Vents (2) (Each) Rear Seat Eyeball Vents (2) (Each) ECS Cabin Fan ECS Heat Box ECS Servomotor Automatic Climate Control System Control Panel Compressor Belt Guard Compressor to Firewall Refrigerant Hoses Compressor Assembly (Engine Driven) Compressor Assembly (Electrically Driven) Fuselage Wire Harness Evaporator Assembly A/C Bay Access Panel Firewall to Condenser and Evaporator Hoses Condenser to Expansion Valve Hoses Condenser Assembly and Seals ECU/Blower Module

Weight
0.22 0.18 2.05 2.44 0.26 0.30 0.33 2.26 14.92 14.2 3.52 10.68 2.04 3.69 0.62 11.14 0.44

Arm
79.0 130.4 63.43 63.43 63.43 84.0 60.0 60.0 56.5 194.02 109.48 186.0 174.0 125.56 164.2 174.0 188.0
RC050005 6B-1

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
21-18 21-19 21-20 21-21 21-22 21-23 21-24 22-01 22-02 22-03 22-04 22-05 23-01 23-02 23-03 23-04 23-05
RC050005 6-B2

Installed

Item
Rear Mounted Relays Interlock Assembly Receiver Dryer and associated hoses Cabin Temperature Sensor and Wiring Outside Temperature Sensor Defog/Floor Vent Valve Assembly ECS Shut-off Valve Assembly GSM 85 Pitch Servo Mount GSA 81 Pitch Servo GSM 85 Roll Servo Mount GSA 81 Roll Servo GTA 82 Pitch Trim Adapter Static Wicks Ailerons/Wings (4) (Each) Static Wicks Elevator/Horizontal Stabilizer (4) (Each) Static Wick Rudder (1) GMA 1347 Audio Panel GMA 1347 Mounting Rack with Connector

Weight
0.28 8.1 1.7 0.08 0.2 0.83 0.93 1.41 2.23 1.41 2.23 1.3 .018 .018 .018 1.7 0.7

Arm
188.0 195.44 149.0 82.0 168.0 69.0 68.0 206.0. 206.0 133.0 133.0 83.5 140 279.4 301.3 80.84 80.84

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
23-06 23-07 23-08 24-01 24-02 24-03 24-04 24-05 24-06 24-07 24-08 24-09 24-10 24-11 24-12 25-01 25-02

Installed

Item
G1000 Fan Rack, (2) (Each) GCF 328 Cooling Fan (2) (Each) GCF 328 Cooling Fan (Avionics) Belt-driven Alternator 65 amp 28 volt Gear-driven Alternator 52 amp 28 volt Accessories Alternator Battery, 28 Volt, 6.5 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Battery, 28 Volt, 8.5 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Battery, 28 Volt, 13.0 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Battery, 28 Volt, 13.6 Amp-hour, Lead-acid (2) (Each) Voltage Regulator, 28 Volt (2) (Each) Ground Power Plug Relay Ground Power Plug Socket Ground Power Plug Wiring Power Grid Panel Artex ELT-200 Emergency Locator Transmitter Unit Artex ELT-ME406 Emergency Locator Transmitter Unit

Weight
0.58 1.40 0.70 13.02 12.8 18.16 18.0 22.0 29.55 29.5 3.0 0.9 0.8 1.2 10.6 2.47 2.46

Arm
79.48 79.48 84.0 22.6 28.0 57.87 204.5 204.5 204.5 204.5 70.0 159.0 153.0 156.0 159.20 215 215

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6B-3

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
25-03 25-04 25-05 25-06 25-07 25-08 25-09 25-10 25-11 25-12 25-13 25-14 25-15 25-16 25-17 25-18 25-19
RC050005 6-B4

Installed

Item
ELT Antenna Circuit Breaker Panel Flap/Rocker Switch Panel Ignition Switch/Primer Switch Panel Light Dimmer Switch Panel GCU 476 Keypad Controller Pilots Adjustable Seat Copilots Adjustable Seat Rear Seat Cushion (2) (Each) Rear Seatback Cushion (2) (Each) Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Thin Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Medium Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Pilots Seat w/Thick Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Thin Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Medium Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Copilots Seat w/Thick Bottom Cushion* Oregon Aero Rear Seat Cushion (2) (Each)*

Weight
0.11 3.9 0.7 0.5 0.14 0.72 24.0 24.0 5.7 11.3 27.25 28.07 28.62 27.25 28.07 28.62 6.15

Arm
217.1 89.5 89.50 89.0 110.36 99.75 106.6 106.6 134.9 150.2 106.6 106.6 106.6 106.6 106.6 106.6 134.9

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
25-20

Installed

Item
Oregon Aero Rear Seatback Cushion (2) (Each)* * If installed, must be installed via STC SA01597SE. Only one Pilots and copilots seat assembly per aircraft Pilots and Copilots Three Point Restraint (2) (Each) Rear Seat Passengers Three Point Restraint (2) (Each) Baggage Tie Downs and Restraining Net POH and FAA AFM (Stowed in Copilots Seatback) Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide (Latest Revision) Carbon Monoxide Detector Instrument Panel G1000 System Racks (2) (Each) CHIPS Harness Assembly (2) (Each) Sandia Relay Fire Extinguisher Unit Fire Extinguisher Mounting Bracket Pilots Control Stick Pilots Rudder Pedals (2) (Each)

Weight
12.25

Arm
150.2

25-21 25-22 25-23 25-24 25-25 25-26 25-27 25-28 25-29 25-30 26-01 26-02 27-01 27-02

1.82 1.76 1.51 1.34 1.6 0.22 8.94 0.84 1.60 1.38 3.56 0.32 1.59 1.0

128.5 145.7 175.0 128.5 128.5 68.19 87.0 80.86 79.87 84.25 88.0 89.8 91.4 71.6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6B-5

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
27-03 27-04 27-05 30-01 30-02 30-03 31-01 32-01 32-02 32-03 32-04 32-05 32-06 32-07 32-08 33-01 33-02
RC050005 6-B6

Installed

Item
Copilots Control Stick Copilots Rudder Pedals (2) (Each) Rudder Hold Assembly Propeller Heat Module with Harness Brush Block Assembly Blade Heaters and Hardware Flight Hour Meter Main Wheel, Brake and Tire 15x6.00-6 (6-Ply)/Side Main Gear Fairings (2) (Each) Main Wheel Fairings (2) (Each) Main Wheel Fairings Mounting Plate (Each) Nose Strut Fairing Nose Wheel Fairing Nose Gear Assembly Nose Wheel, Tire, and Tube 5.00-5 (10-ply) Flip Lights (2) (Each) Step Lights (2) (Each)

Weight
1.59 1.0 2.5 0.97 0.25 1.0 0.13 18.4 2.4 3.9 0.4 0.76 1.89 12.0 14.8 .02 0.05

Arm
91.4 71.6 68 75.0 22.6 14.0 78.0 122.1 131.7 122.1 122.1 40.89 40.89 40.89 40.89 116.0 150.0

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
33-03 33-04 33-05 33-06 33-07 33-08 33-09 33-10 33-11 33-12 34-01 34-02 34-03 34-04 34-05 34-06 34-07

Installed

Item
Overhead Reading Lights (4) (Each) Strobe Lights/ Position Lights Whelen Landing Light Xenon Landing Light Xenon Landing Light Ballast Precise Flight Landing Light Precise Flight Landing Light Ballast Precise Flight Taxi Light Precise Flight Taxi Light Ballast Taxi Light Garmin GPS Antenna (2) (Each) GA 35 GPS Antenna GA 37 GPS and XM Satellite Radio Antenna Marker Beacon Antenna COMM 1 Antenna COMM 2 Antenna NAV Antenna

Weight
0.12 0.54 0.29 0.52 0.84 0.72 0.31 0.72 0.31 0.29 0.36 0.47 0.50 0.45 0.56 0.56 0.41

Arm
102.62 135.9 102.4 102.4 111.08 102.4 111.08 102.4 111.08 102.4 226.4 185.51 222.80 120.5 164.0 199.0 276.5
RC050005 6B-7

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
34-08 34-09 34-10 34-11 34-12 34-13 34-14 34-15 34-16 34-17 34-18 34-19 34-20 34-21 34-22 34-23 34-24
RC050005 6-B8

Installed

Item
Transponder Antenna Magnetic Compass Stall Warning Lift Transducer Stall Warning Horn Heated Pitot Tube Precise Flight SpeedBrakeTM 2000 System - Wing Units (2) (Each) Precise Flight SpeedBrakeTM 2000 System Computer TCAD Processor TCAD Transponder Coupler TCAD Top Antenna TCAD Bottom Antenna GTP 59 OAT Probe GRS 77 mounting rack and connectors GRS 77 AHRS GMU 44 Magnetometer with mounting and connectors GDU 1040 PFD with connector GDU 1042 MFD with connector

Weight
0.3 0.75 0.24 0.19 0.39 4.0 0.5 6.8 0.5 0.66 0.75 0.23 0.63 2.40 0.50 6.70 6.70

Arm
111.5 76.0 99.5 129.74 117.7 124.0 147.0 153.42 75.0 142.87 129.74 119.5 70.0 70.0 118.0 83.82 83.82

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
34-25 34-26 34-27 34-28 34-29 34-30 34-31 34-32 34-33 34-34 34-35 34-36 34-37 34-38 34-39 34-40 35-01

Installed

Item
GDU 1044 MFD with connector GIA 63/GIA 63W Mounting Rack with connectors (2) (Each) GIA 63/GIA 63W No. 1 Comm/Nav/GPS/AP Computer GIA 63/ GIA 63W No. 2 Comm/Nav/GPS/AP Computer GDC 74A Mounting Rack with Connectors GDC 74A Air Data Computer GEA 71 Mounting Rack with Connectors GEA 71 Engine Airframe Unit GDL 69A Mounting Rack with Connectors GDL 69A Data Link GA 55 XM Antenna GTX 33 Mounting Rack with Connectors GTX 33 Transponder Standby Airspeed Indicator Standby Altimeter Standby Electric Attitude Indicator Regulator Valve Assembly

Weight
6.70 1.80 4.90 4.90 0.35 1.69 0.78 1.75 0.97 1.86 0.36 0.8 3.10 1.00 0.81 1.75 2.07

Arm
83.82 77.92 77.92 77.92 78.25 78.25 78.38 78.38 78.38 78.38 226.4 77.73 77.73 82.55 82.40 78.38 119.0

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 6B-9

Section 6 (Appendix B) Installed Equipment List

(APPENDIX B) Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

INSTALLED EQUIPMENT LIST (IEL) Equipment List NXXXX S/N 41XXX Date A/C was weighed XXXX
Item No
35-02 35-03 35-04 35-05 35-06 35-07 35-08 52-01 53-01 53-02 61-01 61-02 61-03 71-01 71-02 77-01

Installed

Item
Cabin Distribution Manifold Assembly Face Mask (Rear Passengers) (2) Face Mask with Microphone (1) Face Mask (Front Passenger) (1) Bottle 1 (Fwd) with Manifold Bottle 2 (Center) with Manifold Bottle 3 (Aft) with Manifold Remote Keyless Entry System Cabin Entry Step (2) (Each) Cabin Entry Handle (2) (Each) Propeller Propeller Spinner Propeller Governor Starter Motor Engine Intake Filter TSIO-550-C TCM Engine Complete

Weight
0.54 0.23 0.58 0.12 7.2 7.1 7.2 0.65 2.15 .05 70.0 7.3 2.80 6.4 0.80 565.5

Arm
130.6 140.0 140.0 140.0 111.0 116.5 122.0 114.5 160.2 162.0 15.0 14.0 28.0 58.0 28.0 44.45

RC050005 6-B10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

The use of this page is optional and is provided for listing items that were added to the airplane via a Supplemental Type Certificate (STC) or other FAA approved procedures. This page is included in this section as a convenience to provide consistency in presentation. The page does not replace or amend any required documentation attendant with the after-market installation and/or modification. TABULATED AFTER-MARKET EQUIPMENT LIST (TAMEL) Columbia 400 Item No. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Serial/Part No. ATA Chapter Item Weight (lbs.) Arm (ins.)

TABULATED AFTER-MARKET EQUIPMENT LIST (TAMEL) Columbia 400 Item No. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. Serial/Part No. ATA Chapter Item Weight (lbs.) Arm (ins.)

WEIGHT & BALANCE RECORD


(Continuing History of Changes in Structure or Equipment Affecting Weight and Balance)

AIRPLANE MODEL: COLUMBIA 400 (LC41-550FG)


Date Airplane Weighed May 21, 1927(Initial)

SERIAL NUMBER: 1

PAGE NO. 1
RUNNING TOTALS

ITEM DESCRIPTION OF ARTICLE OR MODIFICATION WEIGHT ADDED


(Lbs.) BASIC AIRPLANE AS DELIVERED N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A (Inches) (Lbs. in.) (Lbs.) (Inches)

WEIGHT /MOMENT CHANGE WEIGHT REMOVED


(Lbs. in.) N/A

DATE

MOVED

MOVED

IN

OUT

(Lbs.) 2,268.0

(Lbs. in.) 244,241.00

N/A

N/A

WEIGHT & BALANCE RECORD


(Continuing History of Changes in Structure or Equipment Affecting Weight and Balance)

AIRPLANE MODEL: COLUMBIA 400 (LC41-550FG)


Date Airplane Weighed May 21, 1927(Initial)

SERIAL NUMBER: 1 PAGE NO. 2


RUNNING TOTALS

ITEM DESCRIPTION OF ARTICLE OR MODIFICATION WEIGHT ADDED


(Lbs.) (Inches) (Lbs. in.) (Lbs.) (Inches) (Lbs. in.)

WEIGHT /MOMENT CHANGE WEIGHT REMOVED


(Lbs.)

DATE

MOVED

MOVED

IN

OUT

(Lbs. in.)

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Section 7 Description of Airplane and Systems


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 7-5 AIRFRAME AND RELATED ITEMS.......................................................................................... 7-6 Basic Construction Techniques ............................................................................................. 7-6 Fuselage ........................................................................................................................ 7-6 Wings and Fuel Tanks .................................................................................................. 7-6 Horizontal Stabilizer..................................................................................................... 7-6 Flight Controls ....................................................................................................................... 7-6 Ailerons......................................................................................................................... 7-6 Aileron Servo Tab......................................................................................................... 7-6 Elevator ......................................................................................................................... 7-6 Rudder........................................................................................................................... 7-7 Rudder Hold System..................................................................................................... 7-7 Flight Control System Diagram.................................................................................... 7-7 Trim System........................................................................................................................... 7-9 Elevator and Aileron..................................................................................................... 7-9 Trim System Diagram .................................................................................................. 7-9 Hat Switches ................................................................................................................. 7-9 Simultaneous Trim Application ................................................................................... 7-9 Trim Position Indicator................................................................................................. 7-9 Autopilot/Trim Master Switch (A/P Trim) ................................................................7-10 Rudder Trim................................................................................................................7-10 Instrument Panel and Cockpit Layout Diagram..................................................................7-11 Wing Flaps ...........................................................................................................................7-12 Landing Gear .......................................................................................................................7-12 Main Gear ...................................................................................................................7-12 Nose Gear ...................................................................................................................7-12 Seats .....................................................................................................................................7-13 Front Seats (General)..................................................................................................7-13 Front Seat Adjustment ................................................................................................7-13 Rear Seats ...................................................................................................................7-13 Seat Belts and Shoulder Harnesses......................................................................................7-13 Doors....................................................................................................................................7-14 Gull Wing Cabin Doors..............................................................................................7-14 Latching Mechanism ..................................................................................................7-14 Door Locks .................................................................................................................7-14 Remote Keyless Entry System (Optional)..................................................................7-15 Door Seal System .......................................................................................................7-15 Baggage Door .............................................................................................................7-15 Step (Installed)............................................................................................................7-16 Step (Not Installed).....................................................................................................7-16 Handles .......................................................................................................................7-16 Brake System .......................................................................................................................7-16 Parking Brake .............................................................................................................7-16 Steering .......................................................................................................................7-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-1

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

ENGINE........................................................................................................................................ 7-17 Engine Specifications .......................................................................................................... 7-17 Turbochargers ...................................................................................................................... 7-17 Engine Controls ................................................................................................................... 7-17 Throttle........................................................................................................................ 7-17 Propeller...................................................................................................................... 7-17 Mixture ....................................................................................................................... 7-17 Engine Sub-systems 7-17 Starter and Ignition ..................................................................................................... 7-17 Propeller and Governor .............................................................................................. 7-18 Induction ..................................................................................................................... 7-18 Cooling ....................................................................................................................... 7-19 Engine Oil................................................................................................................... 7-19 Exhaust ....................................................................................................................... 7-20 INSTRUMENTS .......................................................................................................................... 7-21 Garmin G1000 Integrated Cockpit System ......................................................................... 7-21 System Description..................................................................................................... 7-21 GDU 1040 PFD and GDU 1042/GDU 1044 MFD.................................................... 7-21 Reversionary Mode ................................................................................................ 7-22 MFD Map Scale...................................................................................................... 7-22 MFD Holding Pattern Depiction ............................................................................ 7-22 VOR Frequency Display on the MFD.................................................................... 7-22 GMA 1347 Audio Panel............................................................................................. 7-22 GCU 476 Remote Keypad.......................................................................................... 7-23 GIA 63/GIA 63W ....................................................................................................... 7-23 GDL 69A Data Link Receiver.................................................................................... 7-24 GRS 77........................................................................................................................ 7-24 GMU 44 ...................................................................................................................... 7-25 GDC 74A .................................................................................................................... 7-25 GEA 71 ....................................................................................................................... 7-25 GTX 33 ....................................................................................................................... 7-26 Annunciations and Alerts ........................................................................................... 7-27 Annunciation Window............................................................................................ 7-27 Alerts Window........................................................................................................ 7-27 ALERTS Softkey Annunciation............................................................................. 7-27 System Annunciations ............................................................................................ 7-27 Alert Level Definitions........................................................................................... 7-27 Aircraft Alerts......................................................................................................... 7-28 Audio Alert/Voice Message ................................................................................... 7-29 AFCS Alerts ........................................................................................................... 7-30 TAWS Alerts .......................................................................................................... 7-31 TAWS System Status Annunciations..................................................................... 7-31 Other Annunciations............................................................................................... 7-31 ChartView................................................................................................................... 7-31 FliteCharts................................................................................................................... 7-32 SafeTaxi ...................................................................................................................... 7-32 Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) .............................................................. 7-32 Flight Instruments................................................................................................................ 7-32 Magnetic Compass ..................................................................................................... 7-32 Backup Airspeed Indicator ......................................................................................... 7-33 Backup Attitude Indicator .......................................................................................... 7-33 Picture of Attitude Indicator....................................................................................... 7-33 Backup Altimeter........................................................................................................ 7-34 Hour Meter........................................................................................................................... 7-34
RC050005 7-2 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Pitot-Static System .............................................................................................................. 7-34 ENGINE RELATED SYSTEMS ................................................................................................. 7-35 Fuel System ......................................................................................................................... 7-35 Fuel Quantity Indication............................................................................................. 7-35 Fuel Selector ............................................................................................................... 7-35 Fuel System Diagram ................................................................................................. 7-36 Fuel Low Annunciation Messages ............................................................................. 7-36 Fuel Vents................................................................................................................... 7-37 Fuel Drains and Strainer............................................................................................. 7-37 Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression............................................................... 7-37 Primer ......................................................................................................................... 7-37 Fuel Injection System ................................................................................................. 7-37 Environmental Control System (ECS) ................................................................................ 7-37 Airflow........................................................................................................................ 7-38 Floor Vent System...................................................................................................... 7-38 Defrosting System ...................................................................................................... 7-38 Individual Eyeball Vents ............................................................................................ 7-38 Environmental Control System Diagram and Panel .................................................. 7-39 ELECTRICAL AND RELATED SYSTEMS.............................................................................. 7-40 Electrical System ................................................................................................................. 7-40 General Description.................................................................................................... 7-40 Avionics Bus............................................................................................................... 7-40 Left Bus ...................................................................................................................... 7-40 Right Bus .................................................................................................................... 7-40 Essential Bus............................................................................................................... 7-40 Battery Bus ................................................................................................................. 7-40 Master Switches.......................................................................................................... 7-40 Crosstie Switch ........................................................................................................... 7-41 Avionics Master Switch ............................................................................................. 7-41 Battery Charging Circuit ............................................................................................ 7-41 Summary of Buses...................................................................................................... 7-42 Electrical System Diagram......................................................................................... 7-43 Airplane Interior Lighting System ...................................................................................... 7-44 Flip and Access Lights ............................................................................................... 7-44 Overhead Reading Lights........................................................................................... 7-44 Instrument Flood Bar.................................................................................................. 7-44 Upper Instrument and Master Switches Panels.......................................................... 7-44 Lower Instrument and Circuit Breaker Panels ........................................................... 7-44 Summary of Interior Lights and Switches ................................................................. 7-45 Press-to-Test PTT Button........................................................................................... 7-45 Interior Light Protection............................................................................................. 7-46 Airplane Exterior Lighting System ..................................................................................... 7-46 Position and Anti-collision Lights.............................................................................. 7-46 Taxi and Landing Lights ............................................................................................ 7-46 Stall Warning System .......................................................................................................... 7-46 Stall Warning.............................................................................................................. 7-46 Stall Warning System (Electrical).............................................................................. 7-46 Ground Power Plug ............................................................................................................. 7-46 12 VDC Auxiliary Power Outlets ....................................................................................... 7-47 STANDARD AVIONICS INSTALLATION.............................................................................. 7-48 Control Stick Switches and Headset Plug Positions ........................................................... 7-48 Autopilot Disconnect /Trim Interrupt Switch (A/P Disc).......................................... 7-48
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 7-3

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Push-to-Talk (PTT) Switch ........................................................................................ 7-48 Plug Positions ............................................................................................................. 7-48 Headsets ...................................................................................................................... 7-49 MISCELLANEOUS ITEMS........................................................................................................ 7-50 Emergency Locator Transmitter (ELT)............................................................................... 7-50 General........................................................................................................................ 7-50 Artex 200 ELT............................................................................................................ 7-50 Switches ................................................................................................................. 7-50 Testing and Reset Functions .................................................................................. 7-50 Artex ME406 ELT...................................................................................................... 7-51 Accuracy ................................................................................................................ 7-51 Switch Operation.................................................................................................... 7-51 Self Test Mode ....................................................................................................... 7-52 Testing.................................................................................................................... 7-52 Fire Extinguisher ................................................................................................................. 7-53 General........................................................................................................................ 7-53 Temperature Limitations ............................................................................................ 7-53 Operation and Use ...................................................................................................... 7-54 Lightning Protection/Static Discharge ................................................................................ 7-54 Precise Flight Fixed Oxygen System .................................................................................. 7-54 Oxygen Flow Controls ............................................................................................... 7-55 Oxygen Display .......................................................................................................... 7-55 Oxygen Annunciation Messages ................................................................................ 7-56 Breathing Devices (Masks and Cannulas) ................................................................. 7-56 Flowmeter ................................................................................................................... 7-56 Filler Port .................................................................................................................... 7-57 Preflight Testing ......................................................................................................... 7-57 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT .......................................................................................................... 7-58 Precise Flight SpeedBrake 2000 System......................................................................... 7-58 System Overview........................................................................................................ 7-58 CO Guardian Carbon Monoxide Detector........................................................................... 7-58 XM Weather (Wx) Data System ......................................................................................... 7-59 Ryan Model 9900BX TCAD (Traffic and Collision Alerting Device) .............................. 7-59 General........................................................................................................................ 7-59 Advisory Levels.......................................................................................................... 7-60 Audible Advisories ..................................................................................................... 7-61 TCAD Display on the G1000 ..................................................................................... 7-61 Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS) ...................................................................... 7-62 General........................................................................................................................ 7-62 System Operation ....................................................................................................... 7-63 System Operation Using Ground Power Supply........................................................ 7-63 Control Buttons........................................................................................................... 7-64 General Hints for ACCS Operation............................................................................ 7-67 Garmin GFC 700 Automatic Flight Control System (AFCS)............................................. 7-67 Flight Director ............................................................................................................ 7-67 Autopilot ..................................................................................................................... 7-67 GIA 63/GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Units ............................................................ 7-68 GSA 81 AFCS Servos (2)........................................................................................... 7-68 GSM 85 Servo Mounts (2) ......................................................................................... 7-68 GTA 82 Trim Adapter ................................................................................................ 7-69 Dedicated AFCS Controls .......................................................................................... 7-69 Additional AFCS Controls ......................................................................................... 7-70

RC050005 7-4

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Section 7 Description of Airplane and Systems INTRODUCTION


Section 7 provides a basic understanding of the airplanes airframe, powerplant, systems, avionics, and components. The systems include: electrical and lighting system; flight control system; wing flap system; fuel system; braking system; heating and ventilating system; door sealing system; pitot pressure system; static pressure system; and the stall warning system. In addition, various nonsystem components are described. These include: doors and exits; baggage compartment; seats, seat belts and shoulder harnesses; and the instrument panel. Terms that are not well known and not contained in the definitions in Section 1 are explained in general terms. The description and discussion on the following pages assume a basic understanding of airplane nomenclature and operations.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 7-5

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

AIRFRAME AND RELATED ITEMS


The Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) is a pre-molded, composite built, semi-monocoque, four seat, single engine, low wing, tricycle design airplane. The airplane is certified in the utility category and is used primarily for transportation and related general aviation uses.
BASIC CONSTRUCTION TECHNIQUES The construction process used to build the shell or outer surfaces of the fuselage, wing, and most control surfaces involves creating a honeycomb sandwich. The sandwich consists of outer layers of pre-preg fiberglass around a honeycomb interior. The term pre-preg fiberglass means the manufacturer impregnates the fibrous material with catalyzed epoxy resin. This process ensures consistency in surface thickness and strength. The honeycomb sandwich is assembled in molds of the wing, fuselage, and control surfaces. Air pressure is used during the heat curing procedure to ensure a tight bond. Other structural components of the airplane, like ribs, bulkheads, and spars, are constructed in the same manner. In areas where added structural strength is needed, such as the wing spars, carbon fibers are added to the honeycomb sandwich. Fuselage The fuselage is built in two halves, the left and right sides; each side contains the area from the firewall back to and including the vertical stabilizer. The bulkheads are inserted into the right side of the fuselage through a process known as bonding. The two fuselage halves are bonded together, and the floors are bonded in after fuselage halves are joined. Before the fuselage is assembled into one unit, cables, control actuating systems, and conduits are added because of the ease in access. To prevent damage to the leading edge of the vertical stabilizer, anti-erosion tape may be installed. Wings and Fuel Tanks The bottom of the wing is one continuous piece. The spars are placed in the bottom wing and bonded to the bottom inside surface. Next, the ribs are inserted and bonded to the inside surfaces of the bottom wing and to the spars. Finally, after wires, conduits, and control tubes are inserted, the two top wing halves are bonded to the bottom wing and all the spars and ribs. The airplane has integral fuel tanks, commonly referred to as a wet wing. The ribs, spars, and wing surfaces are the containment walls of the fuel tanks. All interior seams and surfaces within the fuel tanks are sealed with a fuel impervious substance. The wing cuffs (specially shaped pieces of composite material) are bonded to the outboard leading edge of the wing to increase the camber, or curvature, of the airfoil. This improves the slow-flight and stall characteristics of the wing. To prevent damage to the leading edge of the wing, anti-erosion tape may be installed. Horizontal Stabilizer The horizontal stabilizer is two separate halves bonded to two horizontal tubes that are bonded to the fuselage. The shear webs and ribs are bonded into the inside surface of the lower skin and the upper skin is then bonded to the lower assembly. To prevent damage to the leading edge of the horizontal stabilizer, anti-erosion tape may be installed. FLIGHT CONTROLS Ailerons The ailerons are of one-piece construction with most of the stresses carried by the control surface. The end caps and drive rib that are used to mount the controls actuating hardware provide additional structural support. The aileron control system is operated through a series of actuating rods and bellcranks that run between the control surface and the control stick in the cockpit. See Figure 7 1 for an illustration of the flight control systems. Aileron Servo Tab The aileron servo tab on the trailing edge of the left aileron assists in movement of the aileron. The servo tab is connected to the aileron in a manner that causes the tab to move in a direction opposite the movement of the aileron. The increased aerodynamic force applied to the tab helps to move the aileron and reduces the level of required force applied to the control stick.

RC050005 7-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Elevator The elevator is a two part control surface with each half connected by a torque tube. Like the ailerons, most of the stresses are carried by the control surface. The end caps and drive rib used to mount the controls actuating hardware provide additional structural support. The elevator control system is operated through a series of actuating rods and bellcranks that run between the control surface and the control stick in the cockpit. See Figure 7 1 for an illustration of the flight control systems. Rudder The rudder is of one-piece construction with most of the stresses carried by the control surface. The drive rib that is used to mount the controls actuating hardware provides additional structural support. The rudder control system is operated through a series of cables and mechanical linkages that run between the control surface and the rudder pedals in the cockpit. See Figure 7 1. A rudder pedal to rudder cable connector that allows positioning of the rudder pedals in a forward or aft position (approximately 1 inch difference) may be installed on the aircraft: if installed re-rigging of the rudder is required to alter the pedal position. Contact Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation for applicability. Rudder Hold System The rudder hold system is standard on aircraft built mid 2007 or is available for retrofit. The rudder hold system is comprised of an activation switch, a rudder hold mechanism, and a blue indicator light. The rudder hold mechanism is an electrically actuated rotary brake, affixed to a capstan winch drum; an intermediate friction clutch allows the rotary brake to be overridden if necessary. When activated via an instrument panel control switch, the brake engages and the clutch provides a limited torque resistance to the capstan, which is linked to the rudder control cables via the rudder pedal interconnect cable. Once set, the rudder hold mechanism can be manually over-ridden through application of force to the rudder pedals. Under normal conditions, a microswitch will disengage the rudder hold when the pilot tries to overpower it. If the microswitch fails, the friction clutch will slip instead of disengage. The clutch on the rotary brake supplies only a limited torque before slipping. In the unlikely event of a rotary brake seizure, a shear pin in the mechanism can be broken with applied force to the rudder pedals; thus disengaging the capstan from the brake allowing free movement of the rudder.

After trimming the airplane, the rudder hold system may be activated by pushing the Rudder Hold button. Application of force to the pedals can then be ceased and the system will hold the rudder at the set deflection. A blue light illuminates indicating the system is in operation. The rudder hold button will only be active with the trim system on. The rudder hold system is turned off by either pushing the rudder hold button or by pushing the autopilot disconnect button on the control stick. The system is automatically disengaged if the circuit breaker is opened, the master trim switch is turned off, the flaps are lowered, or the stall warning signal activates.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-7

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems Flight Control System Diagram
Rudder Pedals Control Sticks Right Elevator Control Rod

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Aileron Crossover Control Rod

Control Rod Guide Rudder Cables Left Side Aileron Control Rod Left Elevator Control Rod Aileron Torque Tube Bellcrank

Right Side Aileron Control Rod Elevator Actuating Control Rod

Elevator Interconnect Assembly

Figure 7 1

RC050005 7-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

TRIM SYSTEM Elevator and Aileron The airplane has a two axis trimming system. The elevator trim tab is located on the right side of the elevator, and the aileron trim tab is on the right aileron. A hat switch on each control stick electrically controls both tabs, and the trim position is annunciated on various pages of the MFD. The trim servos are protected by two-amp circuit breakers. See Figure 7 2 for an illustration of the trim system. Trim System Diagram
Control Stick Hat Switch Autopilot/Trim System Master Switch in Overhead console

Aileron Trim Elevator Trim

Aileron Trim Elevator Trim

Autopilot Disconnect /Trim Interrupt Switch

Press-To-Test Switch

Push-Pull Rods

Elev. Trim Tab

Ail. Trim Tab

Figure 7 2 The trim surfaces are moved by push rods connected between each tab and a servomotor. The aileron tab has one actuating rod and the elevator tab has two. The second actuating rod on the elevator is a redundant system and is provided for the more critical tab in the system. The frictional device installed on the aileron tab should never be lubricated.
Hat Switches The trim tabs are controlled through use of a hat switch on the top portion of the pilot and copilots control stick. Moving the switch forward will correct a tail heavy condition, and moving it back will correct a nose heavy condition. Moving the hat switch left or right will correct right wing heavy and left wing heavy conditions, respectively. Simultaneous Trim Application If both switches, pilots and copilots, are moved in the same direction at the same time, the trim will operate in the direction selected. For example, nose down trim is selected on both hat switches. If the switches are simultaneously moved in opposite directions, e.g., pilots is nose down and copilots is nose up, the trim will not move. Finally, if trim is simultaneously selected in different directions, e.g., elevator trim is input by one pilot and aileron trim is input by the other, each trim tab will move in the direction selected. Trim Position Indicator The trim position is displayed in the Trim Group on the System page of the MFD. Other pages on the MFD also display the elevator trim position. The vertical mark Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007 RC050005 7-9

Push-Pull Rod

Note: Pushing the Autopilot Disconnect /Trim Interrupt Switch stops trim

Elev. Servo

Aileron Servo

ESSENTIAL BUS

LEFT BUS

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

indicates the position of the elevator trim and the horizontal mark shows the position of the aileron trim. The green band for each axis indicates the approved takeoff ranges.
Autopilot/Trim Master Switch (A/P Trim) The autopilot/trim master switch, to the right of the avionics master switch in the overhead console, turns off power on all the trim tabs. This switch is used if a runaway trim condition is encountered. The switch can be cycled to reset or restore normal trim operations. See page 3-19 for an expanded discussion of this issue. Rudder Trim The airplane has a manually adjustable tab on the lower portion of the rudder. The tab is adjusted at the factory to produce near neutral rudder pressures at typical cruise altitude and power settings. At other power settings and/or altitudes a slight amount of rudder pressure or aileron trim may be required. The owner or operator of the airplane may wish to adjust this tab to accommodate the most frequently used cruise configuration. The procedures for adjusting the manual tab are contained in Chapter 27 of the Columbia 400 Airplane Maintenance Manual. NOTE Do not adjust the manual rudder tab by hand since this can produce an uneven deflection or warping of the tab. Refer to the procedures in Chapter 27 of the Maintenance Manual for adjustment of the manual tab.

RC050005 7-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND COCKPIT LAYOUT DIAGRAM


15 14 16 17 18 19

4 13 12 9 8 10 11 7 6 5 2 3 1 9

1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19.

Instrument Panel and Cockpit Flap Panel Flap Switch and Annunciator Engine Controls Environmental Control System (ECS) Panel or Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS) Panel ELT Remote Switch Heated Induction Air Alternate Static Air Go Around Switch Rocker Switches: Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression Air Vents Primer Switch Ignition Switch Altimeter Pitot Heat, Door Seals, and Optional Switches Attitude Indicator Airspeed Indicator Primary Flight Display (PFD) Audio Panel Multi-Function Display (MFD) Autopilot Controls

Figure 7 3

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-11

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

WING FLAPS The airplane is equipped with electric Fowler-type flaps. During flap extension, the flaps move out from the trailing edge of the wing, which increases both the camber and surface area of the wing. A motor located under the front passengers seat and protected by a 10-amp circuit breaker powers the flaps. A flap-shaped switch located in the flap switch panel, which is to the right of the engine controls, operates the flaps.

The flap switch is labeled with three positions: UP (0), T/O (12), and LANDING (40). Rotating the flap switch clockwise retracts the flaps, and moving it counterclockwise extends the flaps. A light bar on the flap knob flashes, at approximately 2 hertz, while the flaps are in motion. When the flaps reach the selected position the flashing light stops. When landing flaps is selected, the in-transit light will not extinguish until the airspeed drops below 100 KIAS. The load caused by the higher airspeed prevents the flaps from going past approximately 37 until the speed drops below 100 KIAS, and thus the load on the flaps is reduced. The illumination of the flaps switch does not change with adjustments to the dimmer switch. Controlling light intensity and testing of the lights is discussed later in this section on page 7-45. See Figure 7 3 for a drawing of the instrument panel and cockpit layout. When the flaps are in the up position, the knob is in a position parallel to the floor and points to the UP label on the panel overlay. When flaps are in the takeoff position the knob is rotated 30 counterclockwise from UP, and pointed to the T/O label. When flaps are in the down position, the knob is rotated 30 more and points to the LANDING label. Flap extension speed placards are posted on the flap switch panel overlay. See Figure 7 4 for a drawing of the flap panel.

Figure 7 4
LANDING GEAR Main Gear The airplane has tricycle landing gear with the two main wheels located behind the center of gravity (CG) and a nose wheel well forward of the CG point. The main gear is made from high quality rod steel that has been gun-drilled (drilled through the center like the bore of a gun barrel). The main gear is attached to a tubular steel gearbox that is bolted to the bottom of the fuselage, just aft of the wing saddle. There are 15x6.00-6 tires (tire width and rim diameter in inches) that are inflated to 55 psi and mounted to the gear with Cleveland disc brakes. Composite wheel fairings are mounted over each tire to reduce drag. Nose Gear The nose gear has a nitrogen and oil-filled oleo-type strut that is bolted to the engine mount and serves as a shock absorber. Forcing oil through orifices in the piston and an internal plug or barrier absorbs landing or vertical impact. A rotation key or vane working within an oil-filled pocket contains rotational movements (shimmy dampening). Both of these movements, vertical and rotational, are fully contained within the main cylinder body and under normal usage will require little maintenance. Pressurized (250 psi) nitrogen supports the aircraft weight, absorbs small shocks from taxiing, and returns the oleo to full extension. RC050005 7-12 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

When the airplane is on the ground, with pressure on the nose strut, the nose wheel is free castoring and has rotational travel through about 120, 60 to the left and 60 to the right. When the airplane is in flight with pressure off the nose strut, the nose wheel will self-center, which is accomplished by a key in the cylinder rod and a fixed cam. The nose tire is 5.00-5 and should be filled to 88 psi.
SEATS Front Seats (General) Two individual, adjustable, tubular frame seats provide the front seating for the pilot and passenger. The base of the tubular seat frame is covered with sheet aluminum, and the seat cushions are attached to the aluminum through a series of Velcro strips. The seatbacks on the front seats fold forward to permit access to the aft seating area. The seat cushions and seatbacks are foam filled and covered with natural leather and ultra-leather. For added protection, both the front and rear seats incorporate a special rigid, energy absorbing foam near the bottom of the cushion. The cushion is designed for the loads applied by a seated passenger, and it is possible to damage the seat if concentrated loads are applied. Care must be taken to avoid stepping on the seats with high-heeled shoes or placing heavy objects on the seat that have small footprints. Front Seat Adjustment The front seats are adjustable fore and aft through a range of approximately seven inches. The adjustment control for the seats is located below the seat cushion at the front. To adjust the position of either seat, move the control lever towards the middle until the seat unlocks from the seat track, and adjust the seat to the desired position. Release the adjustment control when the seat is in the desired position, and test for positive seat locking by applying a slight fore and aft movement to the seat cushion. The tilt of the front seat backs is adjustable on the ground by loosening the jam nut on the coarse-threaded bolts on each side of the seatback and then raising or lowering the bolts that control the tilt of the seat. See Chapter 25 in the maintenance manual for specific limitations. Rear Seats The rear seats are a split bench-type design and are nonadjustable. The bench seat frame is composite construction and bolted to the interior of the fuselage. The foam-filled seat and seatback cushions are covered with natural leather and ultra-leather and attached to the seat bench with Velcro fasteners. The seatbacks are attached to a metal crossbar and secured with quick release pins; however, removal of the rear seat back is not permitted for normal operations. SEAT BELTS AND SHOULDER HARNESSES The seat belts and shoulder harnesses are an integrated three-point restraint type of design. With this type of restraint, the lap belt and diagonal harness are incorporated using one continuous piece of belt webbing. The webbing is anchored on each side of the seat for the lap belt restraint and then in the overhead for the harness restraint.

Use of the three-point restraint system is accomplished by grasping the male end of the buckle, drawing the lap webbing and diagonal harness across the lower and upper torso, and inserting it into the female end of the buckle. There is a distinctive snap when the two parts are properly connected. Adjusting two devices in the lap-webbing loop varies the length of the lap belt. One end of the adjustment loop contains a dowel, and the other has a small strap. Draw the dowel and strap together to enlarge the lap belt size, and draw them apart to tighten the lap belt. To release the belt, press the red button on the female portion of the buckle. The torso part of the webbing is on inertial reels that permit the freedom of movement required for piloting operations and passenger comfort. In case of rapid deceleration, the inertial reel will engage a locking mechanism and provide positive restraint.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-13

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems DOORS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

WARNING Do not open any of the airplane doors in flight. The doors are not designed to be opened in flight; subsequent airloads on an opened door will forcefully pull it completely open and detach it from the airplane. Gull Wing Cabin Doors The airplane has entrance doors on each side, which permits easy access to front and rear seat positions. The doors are hinged at the top and open to an almost vertical position above the fuselage. The doors are part of the fuselage contour and when both are fully opened, have a gull wing type of appearance. In the full up or full open position, each door is supported and kept open by a gas strut. The strut will only hold the door open when the door is in the vertical or near vertical position.

The hinges, in conjunction with the dual slide bolts of the door latching mechanism, which extend through the fore and aft door jam, keep the door secure with four points of contact. A distinction is made here between the latching mechanism and the security door locks. The latching mechanism ensures that the doors will remain secured during flight. The door locks are primarily antitheft devices and restrict use of the latching mechanism. The aircraft should never be taxied while the doors are in the full up position. The doors may be opened 6 to 8 inches during taxi, which can be controlled by grasping the armrest or use of the door strap.
Latching Mechanism From the exterior, the latching mechanism on each cabin door is operated through movement of the exterior door handle. The handle is mounted on the side of the door in the bottom-aft position and has two ranges of movement. The handle is recessed into the door with adequate room for a handhold. A safety release on the handle must be disengaged before the door will open. Pulling the handle away from the door activates the release. Moving the forward end of the handle from its normal middle position to the six oclock position disengages the latching mechanism. To secure the door, return the handle to the middle position.

From the interior, both latching mechanisms are engaged and disengaged through use of a handle near the bottom-aft position of the interior door. Again, pulling the handle away from the door disengages the safety release. To activate the latching mechanism, move the door handle down from its near horizontal position until the slide bolts are fully engaged and the curved end of the handle is resting in the safety detent. There are placards on the interior doors labeled Open and Closed with direction arrows. When both doors are properly closed with the latching mechanism and the baggage door is secured and locked, the DOOR OPEN annunciation on the PFD will not be displayed. If the DOOR OPEN annunciation is present, an associated aural warning will be heard when the engine RPM exceeds 1800.
WARNING If the red Door Open annunciation message on the PFD is displayed or the aural warning is playing, then one or more doors are not properly secured, and the airplane is unsafe to fly. Door Locks There are door locks for each door that restrict use of the latching mechanism and are intended as antitheft devices. The door lock on the pilots side is a tube-type lock and is operated with a key. On the passengers side, there is an interior latch control for locking the door. The keyed lock and the latch are moved counterclockwise to lock the door.

RC050005 7-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

To lock the airplane, first engage the door latching mechanism on the passenger side, and then activate the door lock by moving the interior latch. Next, close and latch the pilots door, and use the key to activate the door lock. Ensure that the baggage door is locked.
CAUTION The passengers door must not be locked during flight operations. Locking the door would inhibit rescue operations in case of an emergency. Remote Keyless Entry System (Optional) An optional remote keyless entry system allows unlocking of the pilots door through use of a remote transmitter. The door lock has three key operated positions; LOCK, AUTO, and UNLOCK. The system is armed by turning the key to LOCK then to AUTO. An LED located in the left edge of the overhead console illuminates when the door lock is in the AUTO position indicating the door is locked and the remote keyless entry system is active. When the pilots door is unlocked using the remote transmitter an overhead light in the cockpit will illuminate and the LED will extinguish.. Door Seal System The airplane is equipped with a pneumatic door seal system that limits air leakage and improves soundproofing. An inflatable gasket around each main door expands when the door seal system is turned on. An electric motor near the pilots rudder pedals operates the system, which maintains a differential pressure of 12 to 15 psi. The system is activated by a switch to the left of the PFD labeled Door Seals and is protected by a five-amp circuit breaker. The cabin and baggage doors must be closed for the door seal system to operate. The latching mechanism of each door moves a microswitch, which clears the DOOR OPEN annunciation message. The DOOR OPEN annunciation message must be cleared for the door seal system to operate.

The cabin door latching mechanism also controls the dump door seal valve. When either cabin door latching mechanism is moved more than a half inch towards the open position, the dump valve is engaged, and the pressure in the seals is dumped. This prevents inadvertent operation of the doors when they are sealed; however, setting the door seal switch to the off position after landing is recommended.
NOTE It is difficult to open a door with the door seal inflated. If rapid egress is necessary, turn the door seal off.

Normally, the door seal switch remains in the On position for the entire flight. If the system pressure drops below 12 psi, the air pump will cycle on until pressure is restored. If the pump runs continuously, it is an indication that a seal is damaged and incapable of holding pressure. In this situation, the door seal system should not be operated until repairs are made.
Baggage Door The baggage access door is located on the left side of the airplane, approximately two and one half feet from the left cabin entrance door. The door has Ace type locks on each side of the door, and both locks are used to secure and unsecure the door. There is a piano hinge at the top, and the door is held open by a gas strut during loading and unloading operations.

To open the baggage door, insert the key into each lock and rotate 90 clockwise. The key cannot be removed from the forward baggage door lock when unlocked; hence, when opening it, release the aft lock first. Once the aft lock is unlatched, remove the key and open the forward lock. This design reduces the possibility of taking off with the baggage door open, provided the ignition and baggage door keys are on the same key ring. When the second lock is unlatched, the gas strut will raise the door. The baggage door is part of the door annunciation system. If the baggage door is not properly closed and the forward latch secured, the Door Open annunciation message on the PFD will display and the aural warning will sound at engine RPM greater than 1800 RPM.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-15

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Step (Installed) On each side of the airplane there is an entrance step mounted to the fuselage and located aft of the flaps. The entrance step is used for access to the airplane; however, the flaps cannot be stepped on during ingress and egress operations. Placing weight on the top of the flaps imposes unnatural loads on the controls surface and hardware and may cause damage. Both flaps are placarded with the words No Step. Step (Not Installed) Some owners prefer to not have the step installed since it lowers cruise speed by about two knots. Some of these owners may prefer to carry a small step ladder/stool to assist passengers in entering and exiting the airplane. The pilot must, in this instance, enter and exit the airplane without the use of a portable device. If a portable step is not used, it is recommended that entering and exiting the airplane be made from the front of the wing. The easiest method of ingress or egress is to sit on the wing facing forward and then stand up. Handles Optional fuselage handles are available with some aircraft to assist entering the aircraft. The handles are located behind the passenger windows. Do not hang or otherwise put your full weight on the handles. BRAKE SYSTEM The airplane braking system is hydraulically operated by a dedicated braking system. Each rudder pedal has a brake master cylinder built into it. Depressing the top portion of the rudder pedals translates this pressure into hydraulic pressure. This pressure is transmitted through a series of hard aluminum and steel grade Teflon lines to pistons in the brake housing of each brake. The piston activates the brake calipers that apply friction to the chrome steel discs. Each disc is connected to a wheel on the main landing gear, and when the caliper clamps onto the disc, it creates friction, which impedes its rotation. Since the disc is part of the wheel, the friction on the disc slows or stops the forward momentum of the airplane. Parking Brake The parking brake is near the floor, forward of the circuit breaker panel on the pilots side of the airplane. When disengaged, the handle is flush with the side panel. The black handle is placarded with the red lettered statement, Brake Engaged, which is only visible when the brake is engaged. To operate, apply and maintain brake pressure to both brakes, and move the parking brake control 90 inboard by grasping the forward portion of the handle. Once the parking brake handle is set, release pressure on the brake pedals.

Moving the parking brake control to the On position causes a valve to close the line between the master cylinders and the parking brake. The pressure introduced by the foot pedals before the brake was set is maintained in the system between the parking brake handle and the brake housing. To release the parking brake, apply pressure to the brake pedals, and move the parking brake selector back to the flush position. When the parking brake is on, the position of the handle restricts access to the left rudder pedal and limits inadvertent operation with the parking brake system engaged.
Steering Directional control of the airplane is maintained through differential braking. Applying pressure to a single brake introduces a yawing moment and causes the free castoring nose wheel to turn in the same direction. As is the case with most light aircraft, turning requires a certain amount of forward momentum. Once the airplane is moving forward, applying right or left brake will cause the airplane to steer in the same direction. There are two important considerations. First, use enough power so that forward momentum is maintained, otherwise the differential braking will stop the airplane. Second, avoid the tendency to ride the brakes since this will increase wear. Some momentary differential braking may be required for takeoff until the control surfaces become effective.

RC050005 7-16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

ENGINE
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS The airplane engine is a Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Engine Model TSIO-550-C. It is a twin-turbocharged, horizontally opposed, six-cylinder, fuel injected, air-cooled engine that uses a high-pressure, wet-sump type of oil system for lubrication. There is a full flow, spin-on, disposable oil filter. The engine has top air induction, an engine mounted throttle body, and a bottom exhaust system. On the front of the engine, accessories include a hydraulically operated propeller governor, a gear driven alternator, and a belt driven alternator. Rear engine accessories include a starter, geardriven oil pump, gear-driven fuel pump, and dual gear-driven magnetos. TURBOCHARGERS The TSIO-550-C has twin turbochargers, which use exhaust gas flow to provide high pressure air to the engine for increased power. There is one turbocharger on each side of the engine. The hot gas flow from the left side exhaust drives the left turbocharger and the hot gas flow from the right side exhaust drives the turbocharger on the right side. The turbocharger compresses and raises the temperature of the incoming air before going to the intercoolers. The compressed air is then run through the intercoolers where it is cooled down before entering the throttle body and cylinders. The dual turbochargers are lubricated from external oil lines supplied from a source at the bottom of the oil cooler. There is one mechanical wastegate on the left side of the engine. The wastegate controls the amount of high pressure air to the engine by automatically sensing manifold pressure. An overboost valve in the induction system provides protection from too much pressure. ENGINE CONTROLS Throttle The throttle controls the volume of air that enters the cylinders. The control has a black circular knob and is located below and to the left of the flap switch. The control has a vernier feature, which permits small adjustments by rotating the knob either clockwise (increase) or counterclockwise (decrease). Changes in throttle settings are displayed on the manifold pressure indicator. Moving the throttle forward increases engine power and manifold pressure, while moving it back will reduce power and manifold pressure. Propeller The propeller control allows the pilot to vary the speed or RPM of the propeller. The control has a blue knob with large raised ridges around the circumference and is located between the throttle and the mixture controls. The control has a vernier feature, which permits small adjustments by rotating the knob either clockwise (increase) or counterclockwise (decrease). Large adjustments, such as exercising the prop (moving the control to the full aft position), can be made by pressing in the locking button in the center of the knob and moving the control as desired. The high-speed position is with the control full forward. Mixture The mixture control allows the pilot to vary the ratio of the fuel-air mixture. The control has a red knob with small raised ridges around the circumference and is located below the flap switch. The control has a vernier feature, which permits small adjustments by rotating the knob either clockwise (increase) or counterclockwise (decrease). Large adjustments, such as when the control is set to idle cutoff (moving the control to the full aft position), can be made by pressing in the locking button in the center of the knob and moving the control as desired. The richest position is with the control full forward. ENGINE SUB-SYSTEMS Starter and Ignition Turning the keyed ignition switch, which is located by the pilots left knee, activates the starter. The key rotates in a clockwise direction and is labeled: Off R L R/L Start. The R and L items of this label relate to which magneto (left or right) is turned on or not grounded. Turning the key to R/L will cause both magnetos to be ungrounded or Hot.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-17

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

The airplane engine is equipped with Slick 6320, pressurized magnetos with impulse couplings on each magneto. The left magneto fires the three upper left and lower right set of spark plugs, and the right magneto fires the three upper right and lower left set of spark plugs. Turning the switch to the L or left magneto grounds the right magneto and makes it non-functioning. Conversely, turning the switch to the R or right magneto position grounds the left magneto and makes it nonfunctioning. The key will turn with minimum resistance to the R/L position and is spring-loaded (provides greater resistance) from the R/L to the Start position. Starting is initiated from the R/L position with the master switch on. Rotating the key to the start position will engage the starter. Once the engine starts, release the key, and the spring loading mechanism will return it to the R/L position. A geared right-angle drive starter adapter and a direct current starter motor accomplish engine cranking.
Propeller and Governor The airplane is equipped with a Hartzell three-bladed constant speed propeller with a McCauley governor. In a constant speed propeller system, the angle of the propeller blade changes automatically to maintain the selected RPM. For this to happen the angle of the propeller blade must change as power, air density, or airspeed changes. A decrease in blade angle decreases the air loads on the propeller, while an increase in blade angle increases air loads. If, for example, the manifold pressure is reduced, the angle of the blade will decrease (decreased air loads) to maintain a constant RPM. When operating at high altitudes with reduced air resistance, the blade angle will increase (increased air loads) to maintain a constant RPM.

An oil-driven piston in the propeller hub uses oil from the engine oil system to operate the propeller governor. If a greater blade angle is needed to maintain a constant RPM, the valve in the governor pumps oil into the propeller hub to increase the propeller blades angle of attack. If a smaller blade angle is needed to maintain a constant RPM, the governor diverts oil away from the piston. With oil pressure removed, spring pressure and a centrifugal blade twisting moment cause the propeller blades angle of attack to decrease. The propeller is connected directly to the drive shaft of the engine; hence, propeller and engine RPM indications are the same. There are limits at which the propeller can no longer maintain a constant RPM. As power is reduced, the blade angle decreases to maintain a constant RPM. When the propeller reaches its lowest angle of attack position, approximately 16.5, further reductions in power will result in decreased RPM. There is a theoretical high angle position, approximately 42.0, at which further applications of power and speed will cause an increase in RPM. However, this latter condition is only theoretical since a high manifold pressure setting, in conjunction with a low RPM setting, can cause engine damage. The sequence in which power changes are made is important. The objective is to not have a high manifold pressure setting in conjunction with a low RPM setting. When increasing power settings, increase RPM first with the propeller control, and then increase manifold pressure with the throttle. When decreasing power settings, decrease the manifold pressure first and then decrease the RPM setting.
Induction The induction system routes outside air through an air filter to the left and right side turbocharger and then to each individual cylinder where fuel from the injector nozzle of the cylinder is mixed with the induction air. The components of the induction system include the air filter and the left and right heated induction air valves. Ram air enters through both the left and right intake holes in the front of the cowling and passes through the air filter where it is sent on to the compressors and then the intake manifold.

In the event the normal induction system is obstructed by ice, there is a control, which permits introduction of heated air into the induction system. This control is below the rocker switch panel near the pilots right knee and labeled Induction Heat. Heated induction air is routed through the
RC050005 7-18 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

induction system when the knob is pulled out. The heated induction air valves are located next to the right and left side turbochargers. When the induction heat control is pulled out, it moves a butterfly inside the valves that opens the airflow for heated air from the lower engine area. There is no need for an air-to-air heat exchanger manifold. The ambient air that circulates around the engine provides a sufficient temperature rise for the heated induction air. If the filter is not clogged, alternate induction air can be used any time. If the filter is clogged and alternate induction air is selected, the engine is drawing hot air into the induction system. This increases the chance for engine detonation. To limit the chance for engine detonation, set the mixture to full rich and do not use more than 85% power if the outside air temperature is greater than 32F.
Cooling The airplane has a pressure cooling system. The basic principle of this design is to have high pressure at the intake point and lower pressure at the exit point. This type of arrangement promotes a positive airflow since higher pressure air moves towards the area of low pressure. The high pressure source is provided by ram air that enters the left and right intake openings in the front of the cowling. The low pressure point is created at the bottom of the cowling near the engine exhaust stacks. The flared cowl bottom causes increased airflow, which lowers pressure.

Within the cowling, the high-pressure intake air is routed around and over the cylinders through an arrangement of strategically placed baffles as it moves towards the lower pressure exit point. In addition, fins on the cylinders and cylinder heads, which increase the surface area and allow greater heat radiation, promote increased cooling. The system is least efficient during ground operations since the only source of ram air is from the propeller or possibly a headwind.
Engine Oil The TSIO-550-C has a wet sump, high pressure oil system. The system provides lubrication for the moving parts within the engine and is the oil source for operation of the propeller governor. In addition, a squirt nozzle that directs a stream of oil on the inner dome of each piston cools each piston. The engine has an oil cooler with a pressure-temperature bypass. The oil bypasses the oil cooler if the oil temperature is below 170F (77C) or a pressure differential greater than 18 psi is detected. If the oil temperature is above 170F (77C), oil is sent through the oil cooler before entering the engine. This type of arrangement keeps the oil at constant temperature of about 180F (82C). Ram air for the oil cooler is provided by the engines pressure cooling system.

The term wet sump means the oil is stored within the engine sump as opposed to a separate oil tank. The oil is drawn out of the sump by the engine-driven oil pump where it is sent to a full flow oil filter, i.e., a filter that forces all the oil to pass through the filter each time it circulates. The system pressure is kept constant by a spring-loaded pressure relief valve that is between the pump and the filter. From the oil filter, the oil flows into the oil cooler if the temperature is high enough and then is routed to the left oil gallery (an oil dispersal channel or passage). The oil in the left gallery flows forward to the front of the engine and a portion of the flow is sent to the propeller governor. The oil flow is then directed to the right engine gallery and flows towards the rear of the engine and back to the oil sump. Oil within the left and right galleries is injected onto the crankshaft, camshaft, propshaft bearing, accessory drive bearings, cylinder walls, and other various parts within the engine. After lubricating the engine, gravity causes the oil to flow downward through transfer tubes and drain holes where it is returned to the oil sump. If the filter becomes clogged and prevents oil from moving through the system, a bypass valve reroutes the oil around the filter. In this event, the lubricating oil is, of course, unfiltered. However, rerouting the oil will prevent engine failure. It is important to note that the pilot will have no indication that the oil filter has clogged, and this situation compounds the problem. Since the filter failure was most likely caused by contaminated oil, the oil system will be lubricated with contaminated oil. The best solution is timely and frequent oil changes.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-19

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

The dipstick and oil filler cap access door are located on the top left engine cowl about two feet from the propeller hub. The engine should not be operated with less than six quarts of oil and must not be filled above eight quarts. For extended flights, the oil should be brought up to full capacity. Information about oil grades, specifications, and related issues are covered in Section 8 of this handbook.
Exhaust Gases that remain after combustion flow from the cylinders through the exhaust valves and into the exhaust manifold (a series of connected pipes) and are expelled into the outside atmosphere. There is an exhaust manifold on each side of the engine, and each of the manifolds is connected to three cylinders. The manifolds are connected to a turbocharger and tail pipe that extend out the bottom of the engine cowling. A crossover pipe allows the exhaust gas from the right side to flow to the left side wastegate.

RC050005 7-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

INSTRUMENTS
GARMIN G1000 INTEGRATED COCKPIT SYSTEM The following is a general description of the Garmin G1000 Integrated Cockpit System. For operating instructions on the features of the G1000 system, refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01. NOTE The G1000 may provide erroneous messages indicating to the pilot that airspace has been penetrated when the airplane is only close to that airspace. This generally occurs when there is a substantial difference between GPS altitude and baro-corrected altitude. Ensure your baro-correction is accurate to the nearest reporting station. WARNING In the event of an AHRS failure where heading information is no longer provided on the G1000, it is recommended that the pilot make use of the digital TRK readout in the waypoint data field - located at the top center of the PFD, and the information on the moving map display to supplement the wet compass heading information. This will reduce the need for excessive head and eye movement and aid in the prevention of spatial disorientation of the pilot. System Description The Garmin G1000 includes the following Line Replaceable Units (LRUs): GDU 1040 Primary Flight Display (PFD) GDU 1042/GDU 1044 Multi Function Display (MFD) GCU 476 Remote Keypad GIA 63/GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Units (2) GDL 69A Data Link Receiver GEA 71 Engine/Airframe Unit GDC 74A Air Data Computer (ADC) GRS 77 Attitude & Heading Reference System (AHRS) GMU 44 Magnetometer GMA 1347 Audio System with Integrated Marker Beacon Receiver GTX 33 Mode S Transponder

All LRUs have a modular design, which greatly eases troubleshooting and maintenance of the G1000 system.
GDU 1040 PFD and GDU 1042/GDU 1044 MFD The GDU 1040 and GDU 1042/GDU 1044 each have a 10.4-in. LCD display with 1024x768 resolution. The displays are located side-by-side, with the GMA 1347 Audio Panel located in-between. Both displays provide control and display of nearly all functions of the G1000 integrated cockpit system. They communicate with each other through a High-Speed Data Bus (HSDB) Ethernet connection. Each display is also paired with an Ethernet connection to a GIA 63/GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Unit. The GDU 1044 MFD and the GIA 63W are used for aircraft equipped to utilize the Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS). See Figure 7 5.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-21

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Reversionary Mode Should a system detected failure occur in either display, the G1000 automatically enters reversionary mode. In reversionary mode, critical fight instrumentation is combined with engine instrumentation on the remaining display. Minimal navigation capability is available on the reversionary mode display.

Reversionary display mode can also be manually activated by the pilot if the system fails to detect a display problem. The reversionary mode is activated manually by pressing the red DISPLAY BACKUP button on the bottom of the audio panel (GMA 1347). Pressing the red DISPLAY BACKUP button again deactivates reversionary mode.
MFD Map Scale The MFD map scale shown in the lower right corner of the display represents the total distance from the bottom of the moving map to the top of the map. It does not represent the distance from the airplane symbol to the top of the moving map. MFD Holding Pattern Depiction The depiction of the holding pattern on the MFD is sized according to the airplanes groundspeed. The G1000 will calculate the appropriate size of the hold to provide 1 minutes legs in the hold. Changes in the airplanes groundspeed will cause the size of the holding pattern to change in size. VOR Frequency Display on the MFD If the Nearest VOR page is selected, the fields on the page may be highlighted to select data. The VOR frequency displayed may be selected and changed on the page. However, changing this field will not replace the information in the database and subsequent use of the VOR data page will show the correct database frequency.

Figure 7 5
GMA 1347 Audio Panel The GMA 1347 integrates NAV/COM digital audio, intercom system, and marker beacon controls. The GMA 1347 also controls manual display reversionary mode (red DISPLAY BACKUP button) and is installed between the MFD and the PFD. The GNA 1347 communicates with both GIA 63/GIA 63Ws using a RS-232 digital interface. See Figure 7 5.

RC050005 7-22

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

GCU 476 Remote Keypad The GCU 476 interfaces with the GDU 104x PFD/MFD. The GCU 476 Remote Keypad provides alphanumeric, softkey, and flight planning function keys used to interface with the G1000. In addition to alphanumeric, softkey, and flight planning function keys the GCU 476 provides COM/NAV tuning capabilities. The GCU 476 mounts on the center console using a single jackscrew. See Figure 7 6.

Figure 7 6
GIA 63/GIA 63W The GIA 63/GIA 63W is the Integrated Avionics Unit (IAU) of the G1000 system. The GIA 63/GIA 63W is the main communications hub, linking all LRUs with the PFD and the MFD displays. Each GIA 63/GIA 63W contains a GPS receiver, VHF COM/NAV/GS receivers, and system integration microprocessors. Each GIA 63/GIA 63W is paired with either the 1040 GDU, 1042 GDU, or 1044 GDU, respectively. The GIA 63W and the 1044 GDU are used on aircraft equipped to utilize the Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS). Only one type of GIA, either GIA 63 or GIA 63W will be installed. GIAs do not communicate with each other directly. See Figure 7 7.

Figure 7 7

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-23

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

GDL 69A Data Link Receiver The GDL 69A is an XM Satellite Radio data link receiver with the addition of XM Satellite Radio audio entertainment. For display of weather information and control of audio channel and volume, the GDL 69A is interfaced to the GDU 1042/GDU 1044 via an Ethernet link. Audio volume and channel changes may also be controlled with remotely mounted switches located in the center console. The GDL 69A is also interfaced to a Garmin audio panel for amplification and distribution of the audio signal. The GA 55 XM Satellite Radio antenna (aircraft not equipped for WAAS) or the GA 37 GPS and XM Satellite Radio antenna (aircraft equipped for WAAS) receives the XM Satellite Radio data signal and passes it to the GDL 69A. See Figure 7 8.

Figure 7 8
GRS 77 The GRS 77 is an Attitude and Heading Reference System (AHRS) that provides aircraft attitude and heading information to both the G1000 displays and the GIA 63/GIA 63Ws. The unit contains advanced sensors, accelerometers, and rate sensors. In addition, the GRS 77 interfaces with the GDC 74A Air Data Computer and the GMU 44 Magnetometer. The GRS 77 also utilizes two GPS signal inputs sent from the GIA 63/GIA 63Ws. Attitude and heading information is sent using an ARINC 429 digital interface to the GDU 1040, GDU 1042/GDU 1044, and GIA 63/GIA 63Ws. See Figure 7 9.

Figure 7 9

RC050005 7-24

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

GMU 44 The GMU 44 Magnetometer measures local magnetic field information. Data is sent to the GRS 77 AHRS for processing to determine aircraft magnetic heading. This unit receives power directly from the GRS 77 and communicates with the GRS 77 using a RS-485 digital interface. See Figure 7 10.

Figure 7 10
GDC 74A The GDC 74A Air Data Computer processes information received from the pitot/static system and the outside air temperature (OAT) sensor. The GDC 74A provides pressure altitude, airspeed, vertical speed, and OAT information to the G1000 system. The GDC 74A communicates with both GIA 63/GIA 63Ws, GDU 1040, GDU 1042/GDU 1044, and GRS 77 using an ARINC 429 digital interface. See Figure 7 11.

Figure 7 11

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-25

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

GEA 71 The GEA 71 receives and processes signals from engine and airframe sensors. Sensor types include engine temperature and pressure sensors as well as fuel measurement and pressure sensors. The GEA 71 communicates with both GIA 63/GIA 63Ws using a RS-485 digital interface. See Figure 7 12.

Figure 7 12
GTX 33 The GTX 33 is a solid-state Mode S transponder providing Modes A, C, and S operation. The GTX 33 is controlled through the PFD, and communicates with both GIA 63/GIA 63Ws through a RS-232 digital interface. See Figure 7 13.

Figure 7 13

RC050005 7-26

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Annunciations and Alerts For a more detailed description of annunciations and alerts displayed on the PFD and/or MFD, refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01. Annunciation Window: The annunciation window displays abbreviated annunciation text. The annunciation window is located to the right of the Altitude and Vertical Speed windows on the PFD display (or the MFD if system is in reversionary mode). Up to 12 annunciations can be displayed simultaneously. A white horizontal line separates annunciations that are acknowledged from annunciations that are not yet acknowledged. Acknowledged annunciations are always above the line. Annunciations are displayed in order of priority from top to bottom. The highest priority annunciation is displayed at the top of the annunciation window. Alerts Window: The Alerts window displays alert text messages. Up to 64 alerts can be displayed in the Alerts window. New alerts are placed on top of the stack and older ones are pushed down. Alerts that are no longer valid are grayed out and then subsequently removed after the window is refreshed. Pressing the ALERTS softkey displays the Alerts window. Pressing the ALERTS softkey again removes the Alerts window from the display. When the Alerts window is displayed, the pilot may use the large FMS knob to scroll through the alert list. Higher priority alerts are displayed at the top of the window. Lower priority alerts are displayed at the bottom of the window. ALERTS Softkey Annunciation: When the Alerting System issues an alert, the ALERTS softkey is used as a flashing annunciation to accompany an alert. During the alert, the ALERTS softkey assumes a new label consistent with alert level (WARNING, CAUTION, or ADVISORY). Pressing the softkey annunciation acknowledges that the pilot is aware of the alert. The softkey then returns to the previous ALERTS label. The pilot can then press the ALERTS softkey again to view alert text messages. System Annunciations: Typically, a large red X appears in a window when a related LRU fails or detects invalid data. Alert Level Definitions The G1000 Alerting System, as installed in Columbia 400 aircraft, uses three alert levels. WARNING: This level of alert requires immediate pilot attention. A warning alert is accompanied by an annunciation in the annunciation window. Warning text appearing in the annunciation window is RED. A warning alert is also accompanied by a flashing WARNING softkey annunciation. Pressing the WARNING softkey acknowledges the presence of the warning alert and stops the aural tone, if applicable. CAUTION: This level of alert indicates the existence of abnormal conditions on the aircraft that may require pilot intervention. A caution alert is accompanied by an annunciation in the annunciation window. Caution text appearing in the annunciation window is YELLOW. A caution alert is also accompanied by a flashing CAUTION softkey annunciation. Pressing the CAUTION softkey acknowledges the presence of the caution alert. MESSAGE ADVISORY: This level of alert provides general information to the pilot. A message advisory alert does not issue annunciations in the annunciation window. Instead, message advisory alerts only issue a flashing ADVISORY softkey annunciation. Pressing the ADVISORY softkey acknowledges the presence of the message advisory alert and displays the alert text message in the Alerts window.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 7-27

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems Aircraft Alerts

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

1. WARNING Alerts a. If the DOOR OPEN message is displayed, one or more of the airplanes doors is not properly secured. b. If the FUEL VALVE message is displayed, the fuel selector is not set to either the left or right tank, or is not properly seated in the detent of the selected tank. c. If the L BUS OFF or R BUS OFF message is displayed, the electrical bus is either not turned on or is damaged. d. If the CO LVL HIGH message is displayed, the carbon monoxide level has reached 50 parts per million by volume or greater. e. If the OIL PRES LOW message is displayed, the engine oil pressure is less than 5 psi.
Annunciation Window Text DOOR OPEN FUEL VALVE L BUS OFF R BUS OFF CO LVL HIGH OIL PRES LOW Alerts Window Message Door not secured Fuel tank is not correctly selected or is in the OFF position No power on the left bus No power on the right bus Carbon Monoxide level is too high Low oil pressure Audio Alert/Voice Message (Repeating) Chime/Door Open Chime/Fuel Valve Chime Chime Chime/Carbon Monoxide Chime/Oil Pressure Low

2. CAUTION Alerts a. If the L ALT OFF or R ALT OFF message is displayed, then either the alternator is not turned on, the alternator was tripped off-line by an over voltage condition, or low voltage conditions exist. In either case, the corresponding battery is in a state of discharge. b. If the FUEL PUMP message is displayed, the engine driven fuel pump has malfunctioned and the fuel pressure is less than about 5.5 psi. c. If either the L LOW FUEL or R LOW FUEL message is displayed, the indicated tank has less than eight gallons of usable fuel remaining in that tank. d. The STARTER ENGD message is displayed, when the starter is activated. e. If the OXYGEN message is displayed, the system has not been activated above approximately 12,000 ft PA, there is inadequate quantity of oxygen, or the oxygen outlet pressure is not within range for proper operation. f. The OXYGEN QTY message is displayed when the oxygen quantity is below 250 psi. g. If the OXYGEN PRES message is displayed, pressure altitude is above 12,000 ft and the oxygen system is off.
Annunciation Window Text L ALT OFF R ALT OFF FUEL PUMP L LOW FUEL R LOW FUEL STARTER ENGD OXYGEN OXYGEN QTY OXYGEN PRES Alerts Window Message Left Alternator offline Right Alternator offline Fuel pump is operating Low fuel in the left tank Low fuel in the right tank Starter relay has power applied Oxygen system needs attention or is off Oxygen quantity below 250 psi Pressure above 12000 ft and oxygen system off Audio Alert/Voice Message Single Chime/ Left Alternator Out Single Chime/ Right Alternator Out Single Chime/ Fuel Pump On Single Chime/None Single Chime/None Single Chime/None Single Chime/None Single Chime/None Single Chime/None

RC050005 7-28

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

3. Annunciation Advisory a. If the OXYGEN ON message is displayed, this is a reminder to turn off oxygen. b. If the SPEED BRAKES message is displayed, the speedbrakes are deployed. When deploying the speedbrakes, the message stays off until they are full deployed. When retracting the speedbrakes, the message stays on until fully retracted. c. If the RUDR HOLD message is displayed, the rudder hold system is active.
Annunciation Window Text OXYGEN ON SPEED BRAKES RUDR HOLD Alerts Window Message Reminder: Turn off oxygen Speed brakes are active None Audio Alert/Voice Message None None None

4. Message Advisory Alerts d. If the PFD FAN FAIL message is displayed, the cooling fan for the PFD is inoperative. a. If the MFD FAN FAIL message is displayed, the cooling fan for the MFD is inoperative. b. If the AVIONICS FAN message is displayed, the cooling fan for the remote avionics is inoperative. c. If the TIMER ZERO message is displayed, the timer has counted down to zero. d. If the FUEL IMBAL message is displayed, fuel imbalance is greater than 10 gallons. e. If the LOW MAN PRES message is displayed, pressure altitude is above 18,000 ft and the manifold pressure is below 15 in. f. If the VAPOR SUPPR message is displayed, turn on vapor suppression.
Alerts Window Message PFD FAN FAIL The cooling fan for the PFD is inoperative MFD FAN FAIL The cooling fan for the MFD is inoperative AVIONICS FAN the cooling fan for remote avionics is inoperative TIMER ZERO Timer has counted down to zero FUEL IMBAL Fuel imbalance is greater than 10 gallons LOW MAN PRES Manifold pressure is below 15 in. VAPOR SUPPR Turn on Vapor Suppression Audio Alert None None None Timer Expired None None None

Audio Alert/Voice Message The audio alert/voice message warning system activates in coordination with some of the annunciation messages. The audio alert/voice message warnings consist of a female voice speaking in English and/or a chime. If the Ryan TCAD is installed, the audio alert/voice message system will provide a traffic advisory for aircraft detected in the vicinity. Additionally, a voice message will provide a reminder when the count down timer reaches zero.

The audio alert/voice message system operates when the avionics master is on and there is engine oil pressure. This feature prevents the warning system from going through all the commands when power is first applied. There is also a two second delay to allow fuel tank selection without a nuisance warning. The audio alert/voice message will be played over the cabin speaker and the headsets regardless of the audio panel switch positions. The voice message warnings that play are: 1. 2. 3. 4. Door Open this warning is activated when any of the doors are unlatched and the engine RPM is over 1800 RPM. Fuel Valve this warning is activated when the fuel valve is not in the left or right tank detents. Carbon Monoxide this warning is activated by the carbon monoxide detector. Oil Pressure Low this warning is activated when oil pressure is less than 5 psi.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-29

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

5.

6. 7.

8.

Left Alternator Out or Right Alternator Out this warning is activated when any of the following occur: a. The left or right alternator is switched off. b. The over voltage relay has been activated. c. The bus voltage is below 24.0 volts. d. The left or right alternator has failed. Fuel Pump On this warning is activated when the fuel pressure is less than 5.5 psi. Traffic: With TCAD installed This warning phrase is always preceded by a tone and then begins as Traffic. The clock position, relative altitude, and range of the intruder is then announced. Refer to Audible Advisories on page 7-61 for a more detailed description. With TIS only installed The warning phrase is either Traffic when TIS traffic alert is received or Traffic Not Available when TIS service is not available or out of range. Timer Expired this annunciation is activated by the G1000 Count Down timer and is programmed by the pilot.

AFCS Alerts The following alert annunciations appear in the AFCS System Status Field on the PFD.
Condition Pitch Failure Roll Failure Pitch Trim Axis Control Failure System Failure Elevator Mistrim Up Annunciation Description Pitch axis control failure. AP is inoperative. Roll axis control failure. AP is inoperative. If annunciated when AP is engaged, take control of the aircraft and disengage the autopilot. AP is unavailable. FD may still be available. A condition has developed causing the pitch servo to provide a sustained force. Be prepared to apply a substantial stick force in either direction upon AP disconnect. A condition has developed causing the pitch servo to provide a sustained force. Be prepared to apply a substantial stick force in either direction upon AP disconnect. A condition has developed causing the roll servo to provide a sustained force. Ensure the slip/skid indicator is centered and observe any maximum fuel imbalance limits. Be prepared to apply a substantial stick force in either direction upon AP disconnect. A condition has developed causing the roll servo to provide a sustained force. Ensure the slip/skid indicator is centered and observe any maximum fuel imbalance limits. Be prepared to apply a substantial stick force in either direction upon AP disconnect. Performing preflight system test. Upon completion of the test, the aural alert will be heard. Preflight system test has failed.

Elevator Mistrim Down

Aileron Mistrim Left

Aileron Mistrim Right

Preflight Test

RC050005 7-30

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

TAWS Alerts Annunciations appear on the PFD and MFD. Pop-up alerts appear only on the MFD.
Alert Type Excessive Descent Rate Warning (EDR) Reduced Required Terrain Clearance Warning (RTC) Imminent Terrain Impact Warning (ITI) Reduced Required Obstacle Clearance Warning (ROC) Imminent Obstacle Impact Warning (IOI) Reduced Required Terrain Clearance Caution (RTC) Imminent Terrain Impact Caution (ITI) Reduced Required Obstacle Clearance Caution (ROC) Imminent Obstacle Impact Caution (IOI) Premature Descent Alert Caution (PDA) Altitude Callout 500 Excessive Descent Rate Caution (EDR) Negative Climb Rate Caution (NCR) PFD/MFD TAWS Page Annunciation MFD Map Page Pop-Up Alert Aural Message Pull Up Terrain, Terrain; Pull Up, Pull Up or Terrain Ahead, Pull Up; Terrain Ahead, Pull Up Terrain Ahead, Pull Up; Terrain Ahead, Pull Up or Terrain, Terrain; Pull Up, Pull Up Obstacle, Obstacle; Pull Up, Pull Up or Obstacle Ahead, Pull Up; Obstacle Ahead, Pull Up Obstacle Ahead, Pull Up; Obstacle Ahead, Pull Up or Obstacle, Obstacle; Pull Up, Pull Up Caution, Terrain; Caution, Terrain or Terrain Ahead; Terrain Ahead Terrain Ahead; Terrain Ahead or Caution, Terrain; Caution, Terrain Caution, Obstacle; Caution, Obstacle or Obstacle Ahead; Obstacle Ahead Obstacle Ahead; Obstacle Ahead or Caution, Obstacle; Caution, Obstacle Too Low, Terrain None None Five-Hundred Sink Rate Dont Sink or Too Low, Terrain

TAWS System Status Annunciations


Alert Type TAWS System Test Fail TAWS Alerting is disabled No GPS position or excessively degraded GPS signal System Test in progress System Test pass None PFD/MFD TAWS Page Annunciation MFD Pop-Up Alert None None None None None Aural Message TAWS System Failure None TAWS Not Available None TAWS System Test OK

Other Annunciations For Garmin G1000 system annunciations and message advisories related to the PFD, MFD, LRUs, and databases refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01. ChartView Garmin ChartView brings an electronic version of Jeppesens extensive library of charts and airport diagrams directly to the MFD. ChartView displays approach charts, geopolitical features, airspace, Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 7-31

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

airways, and airport diagrams. In addition, pilots will see the aircrafts present position on the chart. Pilots subscribing to ChartView will receive periodic DVD updates from Jeppesen so they can update the information on the aircraft. The DVD may also be loaded onto a personal computer to display and print charts while on the ground. Refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01, for operational procedures.
FliteCharts Garmin FliteCharts is an electronic version of the National Aeronautical Chart Office (NACO) U.S. Terminal Procedures Publication. FliteCharts lets pilots quickly find and view all NACO Departure Procedures (DP), Standard Terminal Arrival Routes (STARs), approach charts, and airport diagrams on the MFD. G1000 equipped aircraft with FliteCharts will have access to all approach plates currently published by NACO, which encompasses 17,500 approach plates at over 2,916 airports. Garmin will offer regular updates to FliteCharts as they become available from NACO. Refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01, for operational procedures. SafeTaxi Garmin SafeTaxi is a service that helps pilots navigate unfamiliar airports while taxiing. SafeTaxi identifies runways, taxiways, and hangars, as well as the aircrafts exact location on the field. The SafeTaxi information is integral in the basemap and is displayed on the MFD. Over 700 U.S. airports and diagrams are loaded on G1000 equipped aircraft with the SafeTaxi feature, and Garmin will continue to develop and offer new airport charts as NACO provides new information. Garmin also plans to offer international airport diagrams in the future, pending approvals from the necessary agencies. Refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01, for operational procedures. Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) The Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) and the Department of Transportation (DOT) are developing the WAAS program for use in precision flight approaches. WAAS corrects for GPS signal errors caused by ionospheric disturbances, timing, and satellite orbit errors, and it provides vital integrity information regarding the health of each GPS satellite. Typical WAAS position accuracy is less than 9 feet (3 meters).

WAAS consists of approximately 25 ground reference stations positioned across the United States that monitor GPS satellite data. Two master stations, located on either coast, collect data from the reference stations and create a GPS correction message. This correction accounts for GPS satellite orbit and clock drift plus signal delays caused by the atmosphere and ionosphere. The corrected differential message is then broadcast through one of two geostationary satellites positioned over the equator. Currently, WAAS satellite coverage is only available in North America. A GDU 1044 MFD, two GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Units, a GA 35 antenna, and a GA 37 antenna are required to utilize WAAS. Refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01, for operational procedures.
FLIGHT INSTRUMENTS The backup attitude, airspeed, and altitude indicators are located in a column next to the PFD. The discussion that follows will identify each instrument. A drawing of the airplane cockpit is shown on page 7-11. Magnetic Compass The airplane has a conventional aircraft, liquid filled, magnetic compass with a lubber line on the face of the window, which indicates the airplanes heading in relation to magnetic north. The instrument is located on the top of the windshield and is labeled at the 30 points on the compass rose with major increments at 10 and minor increments at 5. A compass RC050005 7-32 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

correction card is on the compass and displays compass error at 30 intervals with the engine, radios, and strobes operating.
Backup Airspeed Indicator The backup airspeed indicator is part of the pitot-static system, which is discussed on page 7-34. The instrument measures the difference between total pressure and static pressure and, through a series of mechanical linkages, displays an airspeed indication. The source of the ram pressure is from the pitot tube, and the source of the static pressure is from the static air vent. The instrument shows airspeed in knots on the outer circumference of the instrument, which ranges from 0 to 260 knots with 10-knot increments. Airspeed limitations in KIAS are shown on colored arcs as follows: white arc 60 to 117 knots; green arc 73 to 181 knots; yellow arc 181 to 230 knots; and red line 230 knots. Backup Attitude Indicator The backup attitude indicator is electrically powered and protected by a three-amp circuit breaker. The instrument uses a self-contained vertical gyroscope mounted on a pitch gimbal that is mounted on a roll gimbal. The gyro provides information relating to movement around the pitch and roll axes. The indicator has no restriction on operation through 360 degrees of aircraft pitch and roll displacement. The instrument has a caging knob that provides simultaneous erection of the pitch and roll axes. The instrument has a power warning flag on the lower left side of the instrument. When the flag is in view, power is off. When retracted, normal operation is indicated.

To cage the instrument pull the PULL TO CAGE knob to the fully extended position until the display stabilizes, then carefully allow the knob to quickly return to the inward position avoiding a snap release. The instrument does not normally need to be caged prior to takeoff. If necessary, the instrument may be caged prior to takeoff. In the event of excessive attitude errors caused by extended bank, acceleration or deceleration, the indicator should be momentarily caged after the aircraft is returned to level flight.
Picture of the Attitude Indicator

Figure 7 - 14 The roll is indicated by displacement from a fixed white index at the top of the instrument. The displacement indications range left and right between 0 and 90 with major indexes of 30 and minor indexes of 10 between the 0 to 30 ranges. Roll is also indicated by the relationship between the airplane-like bar in the foreground and horizon-like display in the background. The background horizon display is a painted disc with a white horizontal line through the diameter. The upper portion of the disc is blue to represent the sky, and the lower ground portion is brown. Pitch is indicated by displacement of the orange airplane-like bar above and below the horizon line. There are white lines

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-33

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

above and below the horizon line indexed in increments of 5 with a label at the 10 and 20 points. The position of the orange bar may be adjusted for parallax using a 5/64 Allen wrench on the adjustment bolt to the left of the cage knob.
Backup Altimeter The backup altimeter is part of the pitot-static system, which is discussed on page 7-34. The instrument measures the height above sea level and is correctable for variations in local pressure. The pressure source for the instrument is from the static air vent. An aneroid or diaphragm within the instrument either expands or contracts from changes in air pressure, and this movement is transferred, through a series of mechanical linkages, into an altitude reading. Adjustments for variations in local pressure are accounted for by setting the station pressure (adjusted to sea level) into the pressure adjustment window, most commonly known as the Kollsman Window. The altimeter has one Kollsman Window calibrated in inches of mercury (labeled inches Hg). The adjustment knob for the window is at the seven oclock position on the dial. HOUR METER The hour meter is located on the pilots side of the center console. Two conditions are required for the hour meter to operate. The airplane must have an indicated speed of approximately 60 knots to activate the air switch, and oil pressure must be present at a sufficient level to activate the oil pressure switch. The oil pressure switch is integrated to preclude inadvertent operation of the hour meter when the airplane is secured on the ground during extremely high wind conditions.

The hour meter will run even if the master switches are turned off during flight operations. The hour meter is provided to record time in service, which is the basis for routine maintenance, maintenance inspections, and the time between overhaul (TBO) on the engine and other airplane components.
PITOT-STATIC SYSTEM The pitot-static system, as the name suggests, has two components, ram air from the pitot tube and ambient air from the static air vent. The amount of ram compression depends on air density and the rate of travel through the air. The ram air, in conjunction with static air, operates the airspeed indicator. The static system also provides ambient uncompressed air for the altimeter, and the Garmin GDC 74A air data computer. (See page 7-33 for a discussion of the static system instruments.)

The pitot tube is located in the pitot housing on the right wing of the airplane, and the static air vent is on the right side of the fuselage between the cabin door and horizontal stabilizer. The pitot housing contains a heating element to heat the pitot tube in the event icing conditions are encountered. The heating element is protected by a 7.5-amp circuit breaker, which is located in the cockpit circuit breaker panel. If the normal static source becomes blocked, an alternate static source, which uses pressure within the cabin, can be selected. The alternate static source is located on the pilots side of the tower under the instrument panel. To access the alternate static source, rotate the knob clockwise from the NORM to the ALT position. Water accumulation in the static line reservoirs is a possibility, and certain precautions should be taken to prevent excessive accumulation. Normal accumulation is anticipated in the system, which is why a reservoir is incorporated. The reservoir is designed to collect this accumulation, but excessive accumulation can result in errors to the instruments and equipment connected with the pitot-static system causing erroneous flight instrument indications that may affect the autopilot. At 100-hour and annual inspections, a routine inspection is performed. Asking your mechanic how much fluid there was in the reservoir after an inspection can give you an idea of how well the airplane has been protected from excessive water accumulation. To prevent water accumulation, be sure to cover the pitot tube and static port inlet when washing the airplane. When these items are covered, they MUST be removed prior to flight. Leaving the airplane exposed to strong wind and rainstorms may also cause accumulation. If at all possible, hangar the airplane or ensure the aircraft cover protects the static port.

RC050005 7-34

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

ENGINE RELATED SYSTEMS


FUEL SYSTEM The fuel system has two tanks that gravity feed to a three-position (Left, Right, and Off) fuel selector valve located in the forward part of the armrest between the pilot and copilot seats. The fuel flows from the selected tank to the auxiliary fuel pump and then to the strainer. From this point it goes to the engine-driven pump where, under pressure, it is sent to the throttle/mixture control unit and then to the fuel manifold valve for distribution to the cylinders. Unused fuel from the continuous flow is returned to the selected fuel tank. The diagram in Figure 7 - 15 shows a general layout of the fuel system.

Each fuel tank contains a slosh box near the fuel supply lines. A partial rib near the inboard section of the fuel tank creates a small containment area with a check valve that permits fuel flow into the box but restricts outflow. The slosh box is like a mini-fuel tank that is always full. Its purpose, in conjunction with the flapper valves, is to ensure short-term positive fuel flow during adverse flight attitudes, such as when the airplane is in an extended sideslip or subject to the bouncing of heavy turbulence.
Fuel Quantity Indication The airplane has integral fuel tanks, commonly referred to as a wet wing. Each wing has two internal, interconnected compartments that hold fuel. The wings slope or dihedral produces different fuel levels in each compartment and requires two floats in each tank to accurately measure total quantity.

The floats move up and down on a pivot point between the top and bottom of the compartment, and the position of each float is summed into a single indication for the left and right tanks. The positions of the floats depend on the fuel level; changes in the float position increases or decreases resistance in the sending circuit, and the change in resistance is reflected as a fuel quantity indication on the MFD. The pilot is reminded that the fuel calculation group of the MFD System page provides approximate indications and are never substitutes for proper planning and pilot technique. Always verify the fuel onboard through a visual inspection, and compute the fuel used through time and established fuel flows.
Fuel Selector The fuel tank selector handle is between the two front seats, at the forward part of the armrest. The selector is movable to one of three positions: Left, Right, and Off. The fuel tank selector handle is connected to a drive shaft that moves the actual fuel valve assembly, which is located in the wing saddle. Moving the fuel tank selector handle applies a twisting force to move the fuel selector valve.

When the fuel tank selector handle is moved to a particular position, positive engagement occurs when the fuel selector valve rests in one of the three available detents: Left, Right, and Off. Rotating the handle to the desired tank position changes the left and right tanks; initially, a small amount of additional pressure is required to move the valve out of its detent.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-35

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems Fuel System Diagram

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

FUEL CALCULATION GROUP ON THE MFD SYSTEM PAGE

FUEL FLOWS FROM EITHER LEFT OR RIGHT TANK DEPENDING ON THE TANK SELECTED

FILLER CAP FUEL VENT FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT

LOW FUEL ANNUNCIATION SWITCHES

FILLER CAP FUEL VENT

SLOSH BOXES

FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT FUEL DRAIN

FUEL DRAIN

Fuel Selector Valve VAPOR SUPPRESS SWITCH BACKUP BOOST ARM PRIMER SWITCH FS FUEL STRAINER

AUX FUEL PUMP FUEL VAPOR RETURN TO SELECTED TANK

FUEL VALVE ANNUNCIATOR

ENG. FUEL PUMP

MIXTURE CONTROL MANIFOLD PRESS. GAUGE & FUEL FLOW GAUGE ON MFD SYSTEM PAGE

FFT FUEL STRAINER INTERNAL BYPASS LINE

FFT FUEL FLOW TRANSDUCER

THROTTLE AND TAMU METERING UNIT

THROTTLE TRANSDUCER AND LATCHING RELAY

FUEL MANIFOLD

TO INJECTOR NOZZLES

Figure 7 - 15 A spring-loaded release knob in the selector handle prevents inadvertent movement beyond the right and left tank positions. To move to the Off position, pull up on the fuel tank selector, and rotate the handle until the pointer is in the Off position and the fuel valve is seated in the detent. To move the handle from the Off position to the left or right tank, pull up on selector, and rotate the handle to the desired tank. When a tank is selected and the selector is properly seated in its detent, one of two blue lights on the fuel calculation group on the MFD System page will illuminate to indicate which tank is selected. If a tank is selected, and a blue light is not illuminated, then the selector handle is not properly seated in the detent. In addition, if the fuel selector is not positively seated in either the left or right detent, or is in the Off position, the PFD annunciation window will display a red FUEL VALVE message.
Fuel Low Annunciation Messages There is a separate system, independent of the fuel quantity indicators, which displays a low fuel state. A fuel level switch in each tank activates a L LOW RC050005 7-36 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

FUEL or R LOW FUEL message in the PFD annunciation window when there is less than 8 gallons US (30 L) (S/N 41501 to 41799), or 10 gallons US (38 L) (S/N 41800 and on), of usable fuel remaining in that tank. The fuel warning annunciation message has a 30 second delay switch, which limits false indications during flight in turbulent air conditions.
Fuel Vents There is a ventilation source for the fuel tank in each wing. The vents are wedgeshaped recesses built into the access panel. They are located under the wing approximately five feet inboard from the wing tip and positioned to provide positive pressure to each tank. The vents should be open and free of dirt, mud, and other types of clogging substances. When fuel expands beyond a tanks capacity, it is sent out the fuel vent if both tanks are full. An internal tank pressure of more than two to three psi will allow fuel to drain from the vents. Fuel Drains and Strainer The inboard section of each tank contains a fuel drain near the lowest point in each tank. The fuel drain can be opened intermittently for a small sample or it can be locked open to remove a large quantity of fuel. The gascolator or fuel strainer is located under the fuselage, on the left side, near the wing saddle. Open the accessory door in this area for access to the gascolator. There is a conventional drain device that operates by pushing up on the valve stem. There is an internal bypass in the strainer that routes fuel around the filter if it becomes clogged. Backup Fuel Pump and Vapor Suppression The auxiliary fuel pump is connected to two switches located in the flaps panel, just to the left of the flaps switch. One switch is labeled BACKUP PUMP with red letters, and the other is labeled VAPOR SUPPRESS with amber letters. The vapor suppression switch, which uses the low power function of the auxiliary pump, is used primarily to purge the system of fuel vapors that form in the system at high altitudes or atypical operating conditions. The vapor suppression must be turned on before changing the selected fuel tank. If proper engine operations are observed, turn off the pump.

The positions on the backup pump switch are placarded with the terms BACKUP PUMP, ARMED, and OFF. The switch is normally in the ARMED position for takeoff and climb to cruise altitude and in the OFF position for cruise, descent, and approach to landing. If the engine driven pump malfunctions and the backup pump is in the ARMED position, the backup fuel pump will turn on automatically when the fuel pressure is less than about 5.5 psi (0.5 psi). This condition will also activate a yellow FUEL PUMP message in the PFD annunciation window. Please see an amplified discussion on page 3-16.
Primer The primer is a push-button switch located next to the ignition switch. Depressing the primer button activates the backup fuel pump and sends raw gasoline, via the fuel manifold, to the cylinders. The mixture must be rich and throttle partially opened for the primer to work properly. Fuel Injection System The engine has a continuous-flow fuel injection system. This system meters fuel flow as a function of engine speed, throttle position, and the mixture control. Metered flow is passed to pressurized, continuous flow nozzles at individual intake ports. The engine is equipped with a speed-sensing fuel pump. The continuous-flow system uses a rotary vane pump. ENVIRONMENTAL CONTROL SYSTEM (ECS) The aircraft is equipped with the environmental control system (ECS) or the optional Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS). The ACCS utilizes much of the valves, vents, and ducting of the ECS. For information on the ACCS see page 7-62.

The ECS incorporates the use of bleed air, ram intake air, and an electric fan to distribute heated and outside air to various outlets within the cabin. The ECS essentially consists of two subsystems, heated air and the fresh air. Heated air is sent to the floor vent system and defroster, and fresh air is ducted through the eyeball vents. The system demand affects the volume of flow to a particular vent. As more vents are opened, the airflow to each vent is decreased.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 7-37

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Airflow Ram air enters through a duct on the right side of the engine cowling and flows to the fresh air manifold. Cabin heat is produced using heated air off the bleed air valves (sonic nozzles) located on the back of each intercooler. Heated air next passes through the ECS valve and onto a fan unit before entering the distribution system. Operating the fan will increase the airflow through the system (not including the eyeball vents). Fresh air flows directly from the manifold to the eyeball vents. A diagram of the ECS system is shown in Figure 7 - 16. Floor Vent System The floor vent system provides mixed air to vents under both knee bolsters in the front seat area and to an eyeball vent in the back lower portion of the front seat center storage console. Rotating the vents clockwise and counterclockwise controls the airflow to the rear floor eyeball vents, while the front vents have fixed grates. The ECS control panel is used to adjust the temperature of the air and the amount of airflow. Additional airflow is provided by operating the ECS fan. In flight, under most conditions, the ram air provides sufficient airflow, and use of the fan is unnecessary. However, the fan is useful for ground operations when the ram air source is limited. Defrosting System The defrosting system is operated by adjustment of the ECS control panel. Individual Eyeball Vents Outside, unheated ram air is ducted to the eyeball vents. Individual eyeball vents are located at each of the four seating positions. The pilots vent is below the Garmin G1000 flight displays to the left of the flap panel, and the copilots vent is positioned in a similar location to the right of the flap panel. The two rear vents are behind the left and right cabin doorsills. Each vent is adjustable in terms of airflow volume and direction. Turning the adjustment ring on the vent counterclockwise opens the vent and increases airflow; turning the vent clockwise closes the vent and decreases airflow. In most situations, the eyeball vents are for fresh air, and the floor vents are for heated air. On warmer days, during taxi operations, some additional circulation is available from the floor vent system by operating the cabin fan with the heat control set to the lowest setting.

RC050005 7-38

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Environmental Control System Diagram and Panel

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

COLD AIR HEATED AIR MIXED AIR OUTSIDE RAM AIR

AIR BLEED NOZZLE OFF INTERCOOLER MANIFOLD ECS VALVE

FRONT SEAT EYEBALL VENT DEFROSTER

FRONT SEAT EYEBALL VENT

FAN

CONTROL PANEL REAR SEATING EYEBALL VENTS FRONT FLOOR VENT REAR EYEBALL FLOOR VENT FRONT FLOOR VENT

Figure 7 - 16

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-39

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

ELECTRICAL AND RELATED SYSTEMS


ELECTRICAL SYSTEM General Description The electrical system in this aircraft consists of two independent buses, which are referred to as the left bus and right bus. The left and right (continuous output) alternators are 65 amp and 52 amp, respectively, and provide charging power for the two 28 volt lead-acid batteries, as well as system power. The batteries will also provide additional power in the event of an over demand situation where the requirements on the system are greater than what can be provided by the alternator. The left and right buses in turn feed the avionics and essential buses. Please refer to Figure 7 18 for a diagram of the electrical system. A summary of the buses and related circuit breaker protection is shown in Figure 7 17.

Five current limiters protect the alternators and bus outputs. In addition, the left and right buses are physically isolated at the aft end of the avionics bay. Left and right bus controls, grounds, and outputs are routed through separate holes, connectors, and cable runs so any failure on one bus will not affect the operation of the other bus. Control of the buses is via the master switch panel located on the overhead. There is also a crosstie switch on this panel, which will restore power in the event of failure of the right or left systems. For example, if the alternator or some other component on the left side should fail, the crosstie switch will restore power to the electrical items on the left bus by connecting the left bus to the right bus. As its name may suggest, power to the essential bus is never affected, provided power from at least one bus (left or right) is available. The essential bus is diode fed, i.e., current will only flow in one direction, from both the right bus and the left bus allowing the essential equipment to have two sources of power.
Avionics Bus The avionics bus provides power to the Audio/MKR, Integrated Avionics #2, Com #2, Transponder, Avionics Fan, Traffic, Autopilot, MFD, and Weather. Left Bus The left bus provides power for the Aileron Trim, Pitot Heat, SpeedBrakes, Position Lights, Landing Light, Left Voltage Regulator, and Fan. Right Bus The right bus provides power for the Strobe Lights, Taxi Light, Right Voltage Regulator, Door Seal/Power Point, Carbon Monoxide Detector, Oxygen, Display Keypad, and Air Conditioning. Essential Bus The essential bus is diode fed from either the right or the left bus and provides power for the PFD, Attitude Horizon, Elevator Trim, Panel Lights, Air Data Computer, Engine Airframe, Integrated Avionics #1, Com #1 Left Bus Relays, Fuel Pump, Stall Warning, Flaps, Standby Attitude Horizon, and the Right Bus Relays. Battery Bus The Hobbs Meter, ELT, and courtesy lights/flip lights are connected to the battery bus. These items will operate even if the left and right buses are turned off since the Hobbs meter and ELT are directly connected to right battery, and the courtesy lights/flip lights are directly connected to the left battery. A 3-amp fuse protects each component and is not accessible from the cockpit. Master Switches The systems two master switches are located in the master switch panel in the overhead console. This manual refers to each of the left and right split-rocker switches as a master switch (left master switch and right master switch). Although these switches are not technically master switches, as they do not control the entire system, it is a common term used to prevent confusion. Each switch is a split-rocker design with the alternator switch on the left side and the battery switch on the right side. Pressing the top of the alternator portion of the split-switch turns on RC050005 7-40 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

both switches, and pressing the bottom of the battery portion of the split-switch turns off both switches. The battery side of the switch is used on the ground for checking electrical devices and will limit battery drain since power is not required for alternator excitation. The alternator switches are used individually (with the battery on) to recycle the system and are turned off during load shedding. See the discussion on page 3-23.
Crosstie Switch The crosstie switch is the white switch located between the left and right master switches. This switch is to remain in the OFF position during normal operations. The crosstie switch is only closed, or turned on, when the aircraft is connected to ground power or in the event of an alternator failure. This switch will join the left and right buses together for ground operations when connected to ground power. In the event of a left or right alternator failure, this switch will join the two buses allowing the functioning alternator to carry the load on both buses and charge both batteries. If the crosstie switch is turned on during normal operations, the system will operate normally, however, the two main buses will not be isolated and they will function as a single bus. Avionics Master Switch The avionics master switch is located in the right side in the master switch panel. The switch is a rocker-type design and connects the avionics distribution bus to the primary distribution bus when the switch is turned on. The purpose of the switch is primarily for protection of delicate avionics equipment when the engine is started. When the switch is turned off, no power is supplied to the avionics distribution bus. Battery Charging Circuit A battery charging circuit is standard on aircraft built mid 2007 or is available for retrofit. The battery charging circuit allows the battery relays to be closed allowing flat or discharged batteries to be charged, without removal from the aircraft, using an external ground power unit. Batteries will start charging when the ground power unit is connected and the Master and Crosstie switches are ON. Flat or discharged batteries on aircraft without the battery charging circuit must be removed from the aircraft before charging. NOTE Batteries that are suspected to be bad must be removed from the aircraft and serviced or replaced. See Chapter 24 of the Maintenance Manual for battery testing and maintenance procedures.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-41

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems Summary of Buses

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Bus

SUMMARY OF BUSES Bus Component


Audio/MKR Integrated Avionics #2 Com #2 Transponder Avionics Fan Traffic Autopilot MFD Weather Aileron Trim or Rudder Hold/Aileron Trim Pitot Heat SpeedBrakes Position Lights Landing Light Left Voltage Regulator Fan Strobe Lights Taxi Light Right Voltage Regulator Door Seal/Power Point Carbon Monoxide Detector Oxygen Display Keypad Air Conditioning Attitude Horizon Elevator Trim Panel Lights Air Data Computer PFD AHRS Engine Airframe Integrated Avionics #1 Com #1 Left Bus Relays Fuel Pump Stall Warning Flaps Standby Attitude Horizon Right Bus Relays Hobbs Meter ELT Courtesy Lights

Circuit Breaker
5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 3 amp 3 amp 5 amp 5 amp 3 amp 2 amp 7.5 amp 3 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 2 amp* 5 amp * 5 amp 2 amp 3 amp 2 amp 15 amp 5 amp 2 amp 7.5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 5 amp 1 amp 5 amp 2 amp 10 amp 3 amp 1 amp 3 amp 3 amp 3 amp

BATTERY BUS

ESSENTIAL BUS

RIGHT BUS

LEFT BUS

AVIONICS BUS

* 5 amp for Precise Flight taxi light, S/N 41563 and on. Figure 7 17

RC050005 7-42

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Electrical System Diagram

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

RIGHT ALTERNATOR

RIGHT BATTERY

RIGHT BATTERY BUS

Hobbs Meter ELT

Strobe Lights Taxi Light

RIGHT BUS JUNCTION

Right Voltage Regulator Door Seal/Power Point

Air Conditioning

ESSENTIAL BUS CIRCUIT BREAKERS

GROUND POWER PLUG

RIGHT BUS

CO Detector Oxygen Display Keypad Attitude Horizon Elevator Trim Panel Lights Air Data Computer PFD AHRS Engine Airframe Integrated Avionics #1 Com #1 Left Bus Relays Fuel Pump Stall Warning Flaps Standby Attitude Horizon Right Bus Relays

CROSSTIE SWITCH

STARTER MOTOR

LEFT BUS JUNCTION

LEFT BUS

Aileron Trim Pitot Heat SpeedBrakes Position Lights Left Voltage Regulator Fan Landing Light

LEFT BATTERY BUS

Courtesy Light

LEFT ALTERNATOR

AVIONICS BUS

LEFT BATTERY

Audio/MKR Integrated Avionics #2 Com #2 Transponder Avionics Fan Traffic Autopilot MFD Weather

Figure 7 18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-43

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

AIRPLANE INTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM The interior lighting system is one of the more sophisticated systems available for single-engine, general aviation airplanes. A good understanding of the following discussion is important to properly use all the features of the interior lighting system. The salient features of this system are summarized in Figure 7-19, on page 7-45. Flip and Access Lights The flip lights are rectangular shaped fixtures located in the middle of the overhead panel and in the baggage compartment. The lights bypass the system master switch and operate without turning on power to the system. Rotating or flipping the lens right or left turns on the two flip lights. In the center position, they are used as part of the airplanes access lighting system.

When either entrance door is unlatched, a switch in the door latching mechanism activates the two flip lights and two lights that illuminate each entrance step. The access lights are on a ten-minute timer and turn off automatically unless reset by activating both main door-latching mechanisms when all the doors are closed. This design has two advantageous features. First, opening either of the main cabin doors provides an immediate light source for preflight operations, passenger access, and baggage loading. Second, the flip lights, when rotated either left or right, serve as emergency lighting in situations, which necessitate turning off the master switch. The only disadvantage is that the flip lights can inadvertently be left on, depleting battery power. To prevent this from happening, ensure the flip lights are in the centered or flush position when securing the airplane at the end of a flight.
Overhead Reading Lights There are four overhead reading lights, two between the front seats and two between the backseat positions. Each light is on a swivel that can be adjusted to an infinite number of positions. The intensity of the lights can be adjusted by moving the left slide-type dimmer switch located in the center of the overhead panel, just aft of the master switches. The dimmer has an on-off switch at the extreme forward position, and moving the slide aft increases the light intensity. Instrument Flood Bar There is a tube array of LEDs inserted under the glare shield. The intensity of the lights can be adjusted by moving the right slide-type dimmer switch located in the center of the overhead panel, just aft of the master switches. The dimmer has an on-off switch at the extreme forward position, and moving the slide aft increases the light intensity. Upper Instruments The brightness of the PFD, MFD, audio panel, and keypad are controlled by photo cells located on the devices. The brightness of backlighting for the backup flight instruments is controlled by the left slide dimmer switch at the front of the center console. The dimmer has an on-off switch at the extreme up position, and moving the slide down increases the light intensity. Lower Instruments, Circuit Breaker, and Master Switches Panels Backlighting of the pitot heat, door seals, and optional equipment switches, flap panel, lighted position bar, slide dimmer labels, master switches and circuit breaker panel is controlled by the right slide switch at the front of the center console. Backlighting of the fuel pump armed light is controlled by the position lights switch. The backlighting illuminates the placards on or next to the breaker, switch or control, and the internally lighted switches. The dimmer has an on-off switch at the extreme up position, and moving the slide down increases the light intensity. Backlighting of the pitot heat, door seals, and optional items switches will dim down to a preset value while all other lighting controlled by this switch will dim to zero.

RC050005 7-44

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NOTE

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

The slide dimmer switches are alive at all times. During daylight operation they should be slid to off to increase bulb life. Summary of Interior Lights and Switches
LIGHT LOCATION OF LIGHTS Front and rear flip lights in overhead console Exterior lights near the right and left entrance steps Courtesy Lights LOCATION OF SWITCH If all doors are latched, fliplight is activated by flipping the lens from the neutral position. If a door is unlatched, a switch activates flip-lights when the lens is in the neutral position. The left slide-type dimmer switch is in the overhead panel. REMARKS Door switch activates timer that turns off access lights after 10 minutes. Operates with master switch on or off Master switch and navigation lights must be on for the system to operate.

Overhead Swivel Lights

Two overhead swivel lights in the front seat area Two overhead swivel lights in the rear seat area Flood bar under the glare shield which lights the flight instruments and front panel areas

Glare Shield Flood Bar

The right slide-type dimmer switch is in the overhead panel.

Master switch must be on for the system to operate.

Upper Instrument Panel

Provides backlighting for the flight instruments

The left slide-type dimmer switch is on the front of the center console.

Master switch must be on for the system to operate.

Lower Inst. & Circuit Breaker Panels

Provides backlighting for switches, or placards next to switches, circuit breakers, and controls

The right slide-type dimmer switch is on the front of the center console.

Master switch must be on for the system to operate.

Figure 7 19
Press-to-Test PTT Button The Press-to-Test PTT button is located to the right of the master switches in the overhead console. Pushing the test button verifies the operation of all the LEDs or indicators associated with the flaps panel, pitot heat, door seals, rudder hold switch, and optional equipment switches. When the test position is selected, all related LEDs illuminate in the bright mode. A light that fails to illuminate should be replaced. The rudder hold assembly brake will engage while the button is pressed and disengage when the button is released; system override by pedal pressure will function normally.

When the position lights are on, these lights operate in the dim mode. When the position lights are off, the lights operate in the bright mode. The degree of luminance is set at the factory and cannot be adjusted manually. In the daytime, during periods of reduced ambient light, the position lights can be turned on if the illumination of the LEDs is distracting.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 7-45

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Interior Light Protection With the exception of the flip lights, all interior lights are connected to the essential bus and will only operate when the master switches are on. The light systems are protected by circuit breakers in the circuit breaker panel. AIRPLANE EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM Aircraft position and anti-collision or strobe lights are required to be lighted whenever the aircraft is in operation. Anti-collision lights, however, need not be lighted when the pilot-in-command determines that, because of operating conditions, it would be in the interest of safety to turn off the lights. For example, strobe lights shall be turned off on the ground if they adversely affect ground personnel or other pilots and in flight when there are adverse reflections from clouds.

The exterior lighting system includes the position lights, the strobe or anti-collision lights, the landing light, and the taxi lights. These lights are activated through use of switches located on the center console. The light system is protected by circuit breakers in the circuit breaker panel.
Position and Anti-collision Lights The left and right position lights (red and green) are mounted on each wing tip. Each wing position light contains the required aft or rearward projecting white lights. The anti-collision lights are on each wingtip and contained within the same light fixture as the position lights. Taxi and Landing Lights The taxi and landing lights are contained in the leading edge of the left wing. The outboard bulb in the light housing is the taxi light that provides a diffused light in the immediate area of the airplane. The inboard bulb is the landing light, which has a spot presentation with a slight downward focus. The taxi and landing lights are sized for continuous duty and can be left on for operations in high-density traffic areas. STALL WARNING SYSTEM Stall Warning The aural stall warning buzzer in the overhead console is actuated by a vane-type switch located on the leading edge of the left wing. Under normal flight conditions, the angle of relative wind flow keeps the vane in the down position. The vane is connected to an electrical switch that is open under normal flight operations. When the airplane approaches its critical angle of attack, the relative wind pushes the vane up and closes the switch. The switch is set to activate approximately five to ten knots above the actual stall speed in all normal flight configurations. NOTE The audio entertainment from the GDL 69A is inhibited automatically when the stall horn is active. Stall Warning System (Electrical) Operation of the stall warning system requires the master switch to be on since the stall warning is connected to the left and right buses. Breakers in the circuit breaker panel protect the stall warning indicator. The stall warning is protected by a 2-amp circuit breaker. GROUND POWER PLUG The ground power plug allows external power to be connected to the aircraft. The ground power plug is located below and aft of the baggage door. The plug allows connection to a 24-volt power source for maintenance and allows the engine to be started from a ground power cart. The aircraft power must be off when the plug is connected or disconnected to the power source. Once connected, turning the BATT switches on will charge the batteries. CAUTION The battery should be carefully monitored while charging. Do not exceed 28 volts DC. RC050005 7-46 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

During normal operation of the ground power plug, the crosstie switch should be on to energize the left and right buses, and the BATT and ALT switches should be off to keep from overheating the battery. The procedure for starting the engine using the ground power plug and a power cart is contained on page 4-8 of this manual.
12 VDC AUXILIARY POWER OUTLETS There are two 12 VDC auxiliary power outlets. One located in the front of the center console and the other located in the back of the center console. These outlets have a 2 amp continuous, 5 amp intermittent, limit. CAUTION Use of 12 VDC power exceeding 2 amps for more than 5 minutes may over heat the regulator causing it to shut down.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007

RC050005 7-47

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

STANDARD AVIONICS INSTALLATION


NOTE The Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 400, document number 190-00567-01 is the primary source document for operation of the airplanes avionics and autopilot. This manual describes operation as well as G1000 system integration with other standard and optional systems. CONTROL STICK SWITCHES AND HEADSET PLUG POSITIONS As discussed on page 7-9, there is a hat switch on the top portion of the pilots and copilots control stick for operation of the trim tabs. In addition, both sticks have a Push-to-Talk (PTT) microphone transmitter switch, and an autopilot switch (A/P DISC). A control wheel steering switch (CWS) is on the pilots stick only. Please see Figure 7 20 for a drawing of the pilots control stick grip. Autopilot Disconnect/Trim Interrupt Switch (A/P DISC) The A/P DISC is a spring-loaded push button switch on the top left side of the control stick. Pressing the switch will disengage the autopilot and trim. Operating the elevator trim switch will also disconnect the autopilot. Push-to-Talk (PTT) Switch The PTT is a trigger switch on the forward side of the grip and, on the pilots side, is engaged with the index fingertip of the left hand. There is a PTT switch on the copilots stick that is normally operated with the index fingertip of the right hand. The PTT switches are used in conjunction with headsets that have a small, adjustable, boom-type microphone.

Autopilot Disconnect/Trim Interrupt Switch

Control Wheel Steering Switch (CWS)

Trim Switch

Push To Talk Switch

Figure 7 20
Plug Positions The airplane has four headset plug positions, two at the front of the center console and two in the backseat area under each fresh air vent. The headsets, in conjunction with voice activated microphones, are normally used for communications and intercom functions. See page 721 for a discussion of the audio panel and intercom. However, either the pilot or copilots plug can be used to add a hand-held microphone if desired. The airplane has special Bose headset plugs, which are designed to operate with the active noise reduction (ANR) headsets. The Bose headsets

RC050005 7-48

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

provide a significant reduction in cabin noise. The Bose headset jacks for the pilot and copilot are located under the entertainment center panel in the back of the center console.
Headsets It is suggested that the owner or operator purchase headsets for use in the airplane, as opposed to use of a hand-held microphone and cabin speaker. Pilot and passenger comfort is enhanced in terms of noise fatigue, and the use of headsets facilitates both radio and intercom communications. Moreover, in situations involving extended over water operations, where two microphones are required, a second headset with a boom microphone will fulfill this requirement and eliminate the purchase of a seldom-used, hand-held microphone.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-49

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

MISCELLANEOUS ITEMS
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER (ELT) General The Emergency Locator Transmitter (ELT) is installed in the airplane as required by Federal Aviation Regulations to aid in search and rescue operations. It is located aft of the baggage compartment hat rack or storage shelf. There is an access panel in the vertical partition of the storage shelf with the following placard: EMERGENCY LOCATION TRANSMITTER LOCATED AFT OF THIS POINT. IT MUST BE MAINTAINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH FAR PART 91. In this instance, the ELT battery must be replaced every two years (Artex 200) or every 5 years (Artex ME406). The batteries must also be replaced when the transmitter has been in use for more than one cumulative hour; or when 50 percent of their useful life has expired. The access panel is secured with Velcro strips and is removable. Artex 200 ELT The ELT is automatically activated from the ARM setting when subjected to a change in velocity of more than 3.5 feet per second. When activated, the unit will transmit a signal on 121.5 and 243.0 MHz for about 50 hours depending on the age and condition of the battery. The range of the ELT depends on weather and topography. Transmission can be received up to 100 miles distant depending on the altitude of the search aircraft. In case of a forced landing in which the ELT is not activated, the unit can be turned on with either the remote switch or the switch on the ELT. Do not turn the ELT off even at night, as search aircraft may be en route 24 hours per day. Turn off the unit only when the rescue team arrives at the landing site. Switches There is a two-position remote ELT switch located to the right of the MFD which is used to arm, test, and reset the transmitter. In addition, there is a three-position switch on the ELT that is used to arm, test, reset, and turn off the unit. Under normal conditions, the switch on the ELT is set to the ARM position, and accessing the unit is unnecessary since most functions are accomplished with the remote switch. The one exception is the ELT cannot be turned off with the remote switch. In the event the ELT remains on during normal operations and cannot be reset, moving the three-position toggle switch on the ELT to neutral turns off the transmitter.

Since there are three selectable switch positions on the ELT and two positions on the remote panel, a total of six switch combinations exist. The table below, Figure 7-21, summarizes the six possible combinations and describes how the unit will work with each switch combination.

ELT Unit Switch Setting


ARM (Normal) ON ARM ON OFF OFF

Remote Switch Setting


ARM (Normal) ARM ON ON ARM ON

How ELT Will Function


ELT G-switch is activated by 3.5 ft/sec. change in velocity Overrides G-switch and activates ELT. Normally this setting is used for maintenance and emergencies when the ELT is not activated. WARNING, the ELT will not operate under any of these conditions.

Figure 7 21
Testing and Reset Functions If the ELT is tested while installed in the airplane, use the following procedures. First, the test shall be conducted only during the first 5 minutes after any hour unless special arrangements are established with the controlling ATC entity. Next, place the remote switch in the ON position and verify that the red light on the remote switch flashes. Also, verify that the ELT is heard on the airplanes communication radio, which shall be set to 121.5 MHz. Limit the test period to about three bursts or three flashes of the remote red light, and then RC050005 7-50 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

move the remote switch to the ARM position. Verify that a signal is no longer audible on 121.5 MHz and that the red light on the remote switch is not flashing. If desired, a system function test is possible using the switch combinations in with verification that the appropriate function is displayed. Remember that the functional check does not verify the condition of system components such as antenna, G-switch, cabling, and battery condition. During post flight shutdown operations, monitoring 121.5 MHz on the communications radio will verify the absence of an ELT transmission. If an ELT tone is heard, reset the unit by moving the remote switch to the ON position for one second and then moving the switch back to the ARM position. The ELT, if it is functioning properly, should be reset. If this procedure does not reset the ELT and a tone is still audible on the communication radio, the ELT must be turned off by moving the switch on the transmitter to the neutral position. The problem with the ELT shall be corrected in a timely manner. Refer to FAR 91.207 for additional information.
Artex ME406 ELT In the event of a crash, the ME406 activates automatically, and transmits the standard swept tone on 121.5 MHz lasting until battery power is gone. This 121.5 MHz signal is mainly used to pinpoint the beacon during search and rescue operations. NOTE In October 2000 the International Cospas-Sarsat Program, announced at its 25th Council Session held in London, UK that it plans to terminate satellite processing of distress signals from 121.5 and 243 MHz emergency beacons on February 1, 2009.

In addition, for the first 24 hours of operation, a 406 MHz signal is transmitting at 50- second intervals. This transmission lasts 440 ms and contains identification data programmed into the beacon and is received by Cospas-Sarsat satellites. The transmitted data is referenced in a database (maintained by the national authority responsible for ELT registration) and used to identify the beacon and owner.
Accuracy Doppler positioning is employed using both 121.5 MHz and 406 MHz signals. Position accuracy of the 121.5 MHz signal is within an area of approximately 15-20 km radius about the transmitter. Due to the better signal integrity of the 406 MHz, its location accuracy is within about a 3 km radius. Switch Operation An acceleration activated crash sensor (G-switch) turns the ELT on automatically when the ELT experiences a change in velocity (or deceleration) of 4.5 fps 0.5 fps. Activation is also accomplished by means of the remote switch located to the right of the MFD or the panel (local) switch on the ELT. To deactivate the ELT set either switch to the ON position, then back to ARM. The ELT does not have an OFF position. Instead, a jumper between two pins on the front D-sub connector must be in place for the G-switch to activate the unit. The jumper is installed on the mating half of the connector so that when the connector is installed, the beacon is armed. This allows the beacon to be handled or shipped without nuisance activation (front connector removed). NOTE The ELT can still be manually activated using the local switch on the front of the ELT.

Care should be taken when transporting or shipping the ELT not to move the switch or allow packing material to become lodged such as to toggle the switch.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-51

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Self Test Mode Upon turn-off, the ELT automatically enters a self-test mode that transmits a 406 MHz test coded pulse that monitors certain system functions before returning to the ARMed mode. The 406 MHz test pulse is ignored by any satellite that receives the signal, but the ELT uses this output to check output power and correct frequency. If the ELT is left activated for approximately 50 seconds or greater, a distress signal is generated that is accepted by one or more SAR satellites. Therefore, when the self-test mode is required, the ELT must be activated, then, returned to ARM within about 45 seconds otherwise a live distress message will be transmitted. NOTE All activations of the ELT should be kept to a minimum. Local or national regulations may limit testing of the ELT or special requirements or conditions to perform testing. For the self test, Artex recommends that the ELT be ON for no more than 5 seconds during the first 5 minutes after the hour.

In addition to output power of the 121.5/406 MHz signals and 406 MHz frequency, other parameters of the ELT are checked and a set of error codes generated if a problem is found. The error codes are displayed by a series of pulses of the ELT LED, remote LED and alert buzzer. See below.
Testing Always perform the tests within the first 5 minutes of the hour. Notify any nearby control tower of your intensions, in accordance with AC 43.13-1B, Section 12-22, Note 3. If outside of the US, always follow all local or national regulations for testing of ELTs. WARNING Do not allow test duration to exceed 5 seconds.

Any time the ELT is activated it is transmitting a 121.5 MHz distress signal. If the unit operates for approximately 50 seconds, a live 406 MHz distress signal is transmitted and is considered valid by the satellite system. Any time that the ELT is cycled from ARM to ON and then back to ARM, a 406 MHz signal is transmitted, however it is specially coded as a self test signal that is ignored by the COSPAS-SARSAT satellites.
Self Test Artex recommends that the ELT be tested every 1-2 months. Follow the steps outlined below. NOTE The self-test time is accumulated in a register on the battery pack. The register records activation time in 30 second increments so all activations will count as at least 30 seconds, even if the actual time is much less. Total allowable time is 60 minutes as determined by FAR 91.207 and RTCA DO-204. After this time has been accumulated a 7- flash error will be presented after the self test. The battery must be replaced at this point for the ELT to remain in compliance. Always follow ELT testing requirements per local or national authorities.

Tune a receiver (usually the aircraft radio) to 121.5 MHz. Turn the ELT aircraft panel switch ON for about 1 second, then back to the ARM position. The receiver should voice about 3 audio sweeps. At turn-off (back to ARM state) the panel LED and buzzer should present 1 pulse. If more are displayed, determine the problem from the list below. Codes displayed with the associated conditions are as follows:
1 Flash Indicates that the system is operational and that no error conditions were found.

RC050005 7-52

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

3 Flashes Bad load detect. Detects open or short condition on the antenna output or cable. These problems can probably be fixed by the installer.

Check that the RF cable is connected and in good condition. Perform continuity check of center conductor and shield. Check for a shorted cable. Check for intermittent connection in the RF cable. If this error code persists there may be a problem with the antenna installation. This can be checked with a VSWR meter. Check the antenna for opens, shorts, resistive ground plane connection.

4 Flashes Low power detected. Occurs if output power is below about 33 dBm (2 watts) for the 406 signal or 17 dBm (50 mW) for the 121.5 MHz output. Also may indicate that 406 signal is off frequency. For this error code the ELT must be sent back for repair or replacement. 5 Flashes Indicates that the ELT has not been programmed. Does not indicate erroneous or corrupted programmed data. 6 Flashes Indicates that G-switch loop between pins 5 and 12 at the D-sub connector is not installed. ELT will not activate during a crash.

Check that the harness D-sub jumper is installed by verifying less than 1 ohm of resistance between pins 5 and 12.

7 Flashes Indicates that the ELT battery has too much accumulated operation time (> 1hr). Battery may still power ELT; however, it must be replaced to meet FAA specifications. May also indicate damage to the battery circuit. FIRE EXTINGUISHER General The airplane fire extinguisher is located below the copilots seat in a metal bracket and is mounted parallel to the lateral axis. The extinguisher is stored with the top of the unit near the middle of the airplane so that it is accessible from the pilots seat.

The extinguisher is filled with a 1211/1301 Halon mixture (commonly called Halonaire) that chemically interrupts the combustion chain reaction rather than physically smothering the fire. The hand extinguisher is intended for use on Class B (flammable liquids, oil, grease, etc.) and Class C (energized electrical equipment) type fires.
Temperature Limitations The fire extinguisher has temperature storage limitations that may need to be considered depending on the operating environment of the airplane. If it is anticipated that the cabin temperature will exceed the extremes shown in the table below Figure 7 22 the extinguisher must be removed and stored in a more temperate location. Temperature Extremes Maximum/Minimum Temperatures

Lowest Cabin Temperature Highest Cabin Temperature Figure 7 22


Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

-40F (-40C) 120F (49C)

RC050005 7-53

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Operation and Use To operate the fire extinguisher, use the following procedures after securing the ventilation system: Remove the fire extinguisher from its mounting bracket by pulling up on the bracket release 1. clamp.

2. 3.

With the unit in an upright position, remove the retaining pin from the handle. Discharge the extinguisher by pushing down on the top handle. For best results, direct the discharge towards the base of the fire, near the edge. Use a small side-to-side sweeping motion while moving towards the back of the fire. The extinguisher has a continuous discharge capability of approximately eight seconds. Do not direct the initial discharge at the burning surface at close range since the high velocity stream may scatter the burning materials. Short bursts from the extinguisher of one or two seconds are more effective than a long continuous application. When the fire is extinguished, open all ventilation and return the fire extinguisher to its mounting bracket. Do not lay it on the floor or in a seat. Have the fire extinguisher replaced or recharged before the next flight.

4. 5. 6.

LIGHTNING PROTECTION/STATIC DISCHARGE While composite construction provides both strength and low air resistance, it does have high electrical resistance and, hence, very little electrical conductivity. Conductivity is necessary for lightning protection, since it is important that all parts of the airplane have the same electrical potential. Moreover, in the event of a lightning strike, the energy is distributed to and absorbed by all the skin area, rather than to an isolated location. One method of lightning protection, which is used in this airplane, is achieved by integrating aluminum and copper mesh as part of the composite sandwich. The depth of the mesh varies from 10 to 30 thousandths of an inch below the surface of the paint and encompasses most surfaces of the airplane. The various parts of the airplane are then interconnected through use of metal fasteners inserted through several plies of mesh, mesh overlaps, and bonding straps. WARNING The thickness of the surface paint is important for lightning protection issues, and the color is important because of heat reflection indices. The owner or operator of the airplane must only repaint the airplane according to the specifications for Columbia 400 LC41-550FG as shown in the airplane maintenance manual.

Static wicks are used to bleed an accumulated static electrical charge off the airplanes surface and discharge it into the air. An airplane that does not properly dissipate static build-ups is susceptible to poor or inoperative radio navigation and communication. The wick is made of carbon, enclosed in a plastic tube. One end of the wick is connected to the trailing edge of the airplanes surface, and the other end sticks out into the air. As the airplane flies through the air, static electricity builds up on the surfaces, travels through the mesh to the static wicks, and discharges into the air. The over application of wax increases the generation of static electricity. See page 8-19 in Section 8 for instructions about the care of the airplanes surfaces. Also refer to page 4-17 in Section 4 for more information about the static wicks.
PRECISE FLIGHT FIXED OXYGEN SYSTEM The Precise Flight fixed oxygen system is installed to provide supplemental oxygen for the pilot and passengers. The system consists of three, 14 cu ft oxygen bottles located in the right wing, a regulator/valve assembly, a filler port in the aft baggage compartment, an overpressure protection device, a guarded overhead emergency manual valve, an overhead distribution manifold, and associated lines, fittings, valves, and sensors. The oxygen bottles are located in the right hand wing locker between WS 25.0 and WS 46.0 wing rib, and between the forward and aft spars. The total oxygen capacity of the system is 42 cu. ft (1189 L). The maximum oxygen cylinder pressure is 2000 psi. The low pressure operating pressure is 20 to 33 psi. The bottles are interconnected by bottle RC050005 7-54 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

fittings and the high-pressure stainless steel lines to the high-pressure manifold of the regulator valve assembly mounted to the inboard side of the root rib. Also attached to this high-pressure manifold are the stainless steel lines connected to the filler port located in the baggage compartment and to the remote overpressure burst assembly located in the belly of the wing. The regulator/valve assembly includes a regulator to reduce the bottle pressure to the low-pressure manifold for distribution. This assembly also includes a valve, on the low-pressure side, that is activated by a latching solenoid to turn on and off the flow of oxygen to the cabin distribution (low pressure) manifold. The lowpressure lines are then routed into the cabin area, behind the interior, to a manual valve, and then to the low-pressure distribution manifold where the dispensing systems are attached to deliver the supplemental oxygen to the pilot and passengers. Attached to both the high pressure manifold and the low-pressure distribution manifold are electronic pressure transducers to measure the oxygen pressure at the respective locations. These values are sent to the Oxygen Quantity Gauge and the Oxygen Outlet Pressure Gauge displayed on the MFD System page. Oxygen is required to be used by the pilot above 12,500 ft for flight time exceeding 30 minutes and above 14,000 ft for the duration of the flight above 14,000 ft. If climbing to an altitude where oxygen will be required, it is recommended that at approximately 10,000 ft, the pilot should begin using the oxygen. Passengers are required to be supplied with oxygen above 15,000 ft.
Oxygen Flow Controls Four manually operated oxygen flow controls can be connected to the oxygen distribution manifold. The flow controls are calibrated and adjustable for altitude by the user. The flow controls can be one of the following:

A4 and A5 Flowmeters and Oxygen Conserving Cannulas Up to 18,000 ft A4 and A5 Flowmeters and Masks (Standard and Microphone) Up to 25,000 ft.

The flow controls provide the means to distribute the appropriate amount of oxygen for the pressure altitude of flight and indicate the presence of flowing oxygen to the pilot or passenger(s). The flowmeter or flow indicator and the oxygen quantity gauge should be checked periodically (approximately every 10 minutes). The flow control should be reset with each change in pressure altitude or as required by the user for physiological requirements. The A5 Flowmeter may develop static charge/buildup that causes the ball to stick and work in an erratic manner. This condition can be remedied by filling the flowmeter with a mild soap and water solution; fill from the breathing station side with the valve open until the fluid reaches the tapered tube and a slight amount is visible around the ball. The flowmeter is then attached to an air or oxygen pressure source and run until the flowmeter and tubing are visibly dry.
Oxygen Display Oxygen system information is provided on the Oxygen Quantity Gauge and the Oxygen Outlet Pressure Gauge of the MFD System page. The Oxygen Quantity Gauge displays the amount of remaining oxygen in terms of pressure. The Oxygen Outlet Pressure Gauge displays the oxygen outlet pressure at the distribution manifold in psi.

The pilot may choose at this time to connect a flow control and breathing device to the oxygen distribution manifold as required. Pressing the OXYGEN softkey on the MFD turns the oxygen system on or off. Higher outlet pressures will be indicated at lower altitudes and with fewer users, whereas increasing the altitude and/or number of users will cause a normal decrease in the indicated outlet pressure. Outlet pressure in the green band indicates normal outlet pressure with the system ON. If the outlet pressure is in the red area, it is an indication of a malfunction and the system should be checked. Problems with oxygen distribution as indicated through low pressure, or low flow indications on the breathing stations due to leaks or due to constrictions must be identified and must be corrected. Normally there will be an annunciation that oxygen should be used if the pressure altitude is above 12,000 ft. and the oxygen is not turned on. There will not be an annunciation if the oxygen is turned on but the flow is turned off at the flow meter.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-55

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Oxygen Annunciation Messages There are four annunciation messages that may be displayed on the PFD. They are as follows:

1. 2. 3. 4.

OXYGEN Altitude is at or above 12,000 ft. PA and the oxygen system has not been turned on. OXYGEN QTY Low oxygen quantity pressure. OXYGEN PRES Low oxygen pressure on the distribution manifold. OXYGEN ON Reminder that the oxygen system is still turned on and the aircraft is on the ground.

When the OXYGEN annunciation displays, the pilot should confirm the altitude and use oxygen as required.
Breathing Devices (Masks and Cannulas) The breathing devices have attached placards indicating the proper method for donning, use, and safety precautions. When using nasal cannula devices, breathing exclusively through the mouth, extremely light breathing, or nasal blockage will inhibit oxygen flow. NOTE Breathing through the nose, and limiting conversation is required for the user to achieve proper oxygenation when using nasal cannulas. WARNING Do not use oxygen when utilizing lipstick, chapstick, petroleum jelly, or any product containing oil or grease. These substances become highly flammable in oxygen rich conditions. NOTE If the pilot has nasal congestion, or other breathing conditions, a mask with microphone should be used. Flowmeter The oxygen flowmeters (see Figure 7 23) are simple devices to regulate the flow of oxygen and provide flow indication to the pilot and passengers. Connect the flowmeters to the distribution manifold and while holding the flowmeter vertical, adjust the ball so that the center of the ball rests on the line for the planned cruise altitude for the type of breathing device used. If changing altitude or requiring more oxygen for physiological reasons, adjust the flowmeter as required. Periodically check the flowmeter (approximately every 10 min.) to ensure oxygen is flowing and at the correct amount for the conditions.

RC050005 7-56

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Flexible Line

Flowmeter Altitude Scale

Flowmeter Valve

Flowmeter

Flexible Line

Figure 7 23
Filler Port The filler port for refilling the oxygen bottles is located on the pilots side of the hat rack in the aft portion of the baggage compartment. The port is placarded Oxygen Fill Port Do Not Exceed 2000 p.s.i. Refer to page 8-8 for details on servicing the oxygen system. Preflight Testing Prior to any flight that may require the use of the oxygen system, the pilot should verify the oxygen valve opens and the system retains pressure (low pressure will be indicated as an annunciation on the PFD). This test may be accomplished on the MFD System page. The pilot should also verify the proper flow of oxygen to each mask plugged into the oxygen manifold prior to departure. At the conclusion of the test the pilot may close the main oxygen valve.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-57

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
PRECISE FLIGHT SPEEDBRAKE 2000 SYSTEM System Overview Precise Flight SpeedBrake 2000 System is installed to provide expedited descents at low cruise power, glide path control on final approach, airspeed reduction, and an aid to the prevention of excessive engine cooling in descent. The SpeedBrakes can be extended at aircraft speeds up to VNE. WARNING If icing is encountered with the SpeedBrakes extended, retract the SpeedBrakes immediately. Do not extend the SpeedBrakes when flying in areas of potential structural icing.

The Series 2000 SpeedBrake option consists of wing mounted electric SpeedBrake cartridges. A central logic-switching unit interconnects each SpeedBrake cartridge electronically and a panel mounted SpeedBrake actuator switch controls SpeedBrake deployment. The SpeedBrake cartridges receive electrical power from the aircraft electrical bus through a disconnect type circuit breaker. The SpeedBrake rocker switch is located next to the throttle in the center of the instrument panel. The switch is positioned UP/ON to fully deploy and is positioned DOWN/OFF to retract the SpeedBrakes. A message will display in the PFD annunciations window to indicate SpeedBrake deployment, if and only if, both SpeedBrake units are deployed. A failure of a single cartridge drive unit will prevent the annunciation. If both brakes do not extend after the switch is toggled on, it indicates a failure of one or both SpeedBrake cartridge(s) and the SpeedBrake switch should be toggled off. The system can be checked again for proper operation, but after the second attempt the SpeedBrake switch should be left off. When the SpeedBrake switch is toggled OFF, the annunciation message will clear when both brakes are fully stowed in the wing. The SpeedBrakes will not automatically re-extend and must be recycled after the following conditions: 1. 2. 3. Circuit Breaker Pull Automatic Stowage Due to Asymmetric Deployment or Low Voltage Automatic Stowage Due to Stall Warning Activation

CO GUARDIAN CARBON MONOXIDE DETECTOR The Model 452-201 Series Carbon Monoxide Detector is designed to detect, measure, and provide a visual and aural alert to the pilot before the level of carbon monoxide (CO) reaches a critical level.

The installation consists of a single carbon monoxide detector installed behind the instrument panel that activates a red message in the PFD annunciations window, a flashing red annunciation in the lower left of the MFD System page, and an aural warning. The aircraft supplied power and aircraft wiring is protected by a 2 amp circuit breaker. There is a reset softkey labeled CO RST located on the MFD System page. The carbon monoxide alarm level is calibrated to alert the pilot within five minutes or less whenever the carbon monoxide level reaches 50 parts per million (PPM) by volume or above. The warning time is shortened at higher levels of CO concentrations and becomes approximately instant should the CO level reach 400 parts per million by volume (PPM) or above. In case of a CO alert, the red annunciation message will display, the CO level will display on the MFD, and the aural warning will state Carbon Monoxide every two seconds. The visual alert will remain until the CO level is again reduced below the alert level. The aural warning may be silenced
RC050005 7-58 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

by pressing the alert softkey on the PFD. The indicator is automatically reset when the CO level drops below 50 PPM. On initial power up, the detector goes through a self-test. There will be a three minute warm-up time before the detector is operational. To reset the system, press the reset softkey on the MFD. If the detector sensor fails, a message will be displayed on the PFD indicating the detector has failed.
XM WEATHER (WX) DATA SYSTEM The Garmin GDL 69A Data Link Receiver receives broadcasts from XM Satellite Radio, Inc. through one or both of the two geosynchronous satellites which transmit over the contiguous 48states of the USA. Broadcast weather information received is displayed on the MFD. For additional information on the Garmin GDL 69A see page 7-24. For operating instructions on the system, refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01.

The tear-drop style antenna receives line-of-site transmissions from the satellites. The antenna consists of a LH circular polarized, hemispherical element with an integrated low noise amplifier (LNA). This LNA is powered by a +5VDC offset from the receiver through the coax cable.
RYAN MODEL 9900BX TCAD (TRAFFIC AND COLLISION ALERT DEVICE) General The Ryan Model 9900BX TCAD is an on-board air traffic display system used to identify potential collision threats. The TCAD, within defined limits, creates a shield of airspace around the aircraft, whereby detected traffic cannot penetrate without generating an alert. The TCAD will display multiple aircraft threats. TCAD information is displayed through integration with the Garmin G1000 system. See Figure 7 24 for a schematic of TCAD, Traffic Information System (TIS), and G1000 integration. CAUTION The intruder bearing information provided by the traffic system is only accurate to within 45 degrees of true intruder track. Take this into account when visually acquiring system reported traffic. Keep in mind that intruder traffic can maneuver at any time, and the displayed intruder track direction does not guarantee the intruder will continue along that track. WARNING The 9900BX TCAD (Traffic and Collision Alert Device) does not detect all aircraft. It is designed as a backup to the See and Avoid concept and the ATC Radar environment. It is dangerous to rely on the 9900BX as your sole source of data for collision avoidance. Maneuver your aircraft based only on ATC guidance or positive acquisition of conflicting traffic. It is your duty as pilot in command to See and Avoid.

The system is comprised of a processor, a transponder coupler, and two antennas (one antenna mounted to the top of the aircraft and the other mounted to the bottom). The processor is located on the avionics shelf and the transponder coupler is located in the foot well of the passenger seats. The TCAD monitors the altitude difference and range, and warns the pilot when the calculated time to closest approach (CPA) of the intruder meets a certain threshold (15 to 30 seconds, depending on aircraft configuration). The altitude data from the intruder is referenced to pressure altitude (29.92 inches or 1013 mb). The range is determined using radar time of arrival technique. Bearing to the traffic is determined using the dual directional antennas, on the top and bottom of the aircraft.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007 RC050005 7-59

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

The TCAD actively interrogates transponders from nearby aircraft to identify and track intruders. The vertical separation of the host and intruder is determined by comparing the decoded altitude replies to the hosts altitude (from the ADC). The TCAD computes relative altitude and range of threats from nearby Mode C and Mode S equipped aircraft. Aircraft with non-Mode C transponders can provide range, bearing and horizontal closure information only. The TCAD will not detect aircraft without operating transponders. Use of the TCAD is advisory only, and is a back up to the See and Avoid Concept, and the ATC radar environment. Additional functions provided by the TCAD are: Data and Altitude The TCAD will display the identity, transponder code (when available), and N-number (Mode S traffic) of detected aircraft.
Airspeed switch Flap switch

TCAD 9900BX

MFD

GMA 1347 Audio Panel

ARINC 429 GIA #2 ARINC 429

GTX 33 TIS

Traffic Audio from TCAD only. When Airspeed switch is grounded (aircraft speed less than 60 kts), TCAD system turns to Ground mode, all advisory audio muted. When Flap switch is Down, TA is Sensitivity Level A (SL A). See Figure 7 25. When Flap switch is Up, TA is in Sensitivity Level B (SL B). See Figure 7 26. Figure 7 24

Advisory Levels There are three advisory levels: Traffic Advisories (TA), Proximate Advisories (PA), and Other Traffic (OT). A TA is audibly announced, a PA is displayed traffic within defined display parameters, and OT is defined as intruders that are not TAs or PAs. A TA is generated and an initial TA announcement is issued when an intruders tau (time to closest approach) value and/or range and altitude separation is less than the TA threshold. A TA is also generated if the processor detects that the current track of the intruder could result in a near miss or collision. A TA remains in effect until the range between the host aircraft and the intruder begins to diverge or for 8 seconds, whichever is longer. See Figure 7 25 for TA thresholds (SL A) when the

RC050005 7-60

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

TCAD is in Approach or Departure Mode (automatically activated when flaps are deployed). See Figure 7 26 for TA thresholds (SL B) for all other flight conditions.
Approach or Departure Mode TA Thresholds

Host to Intruder Intruder Type Tau (seconds) Range (nm) Altitude Separation (ft.)

Altitude reporting intruders Non-altitude reporting intruders

< 20 < 15 Figure 7 25

< 0.20 < 0.20

< 600 < N/A

All Other Flight Condition TA Thresholds

Host to Intruder Intruder Type Tau (seconds) Range (nm) Altitude Separation (ft.)

Altitude reporting intruders Non-altitude reporting intruders

< 30 < 25 Figure 7 26

< 0.55 < 0.20

< 800 < N/A

Audible Advisories When an intruder generates a TA, the TCAD creates an audible voice annunciation. The announced phrase is always preceded by a tone and then begins as Traffic. The clock position, relative altitude, and range of the intruder is then announced. If the intruder is more than 200 feet above or below the host aircraft, the relative altitude is announced as High or Low. If the intruders relative altitude is within 200 feet, Same Altitude is announced. The TCAD announces Altitude Unavailable for non-Mode C TAs. TCAD Display on the G1000 Refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-61

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (ACCS) General The Automatic Climate Control System (ACCS), incorporating an R-134a Air Conditioning System in coordination with the aircrafts Environmental Control System (ECS), is fully automatic and designed to cool and heat the aircraft cabin to desired temperature settings during all phases of flight operations. See Figure 7 27. The ACCS cools cabin air temperature, establishes the humidity level of the cabin at a comfortable level and reduces dust and pollen particles from the cabin air. The system may be used during any phase of the flight, offering a choice of fully automatic or mode override.

The air conditioning system components of the ACCS consist of an engine driven or electrically driven compressor, a condenser with fans, a receiver-dryer with trinary pressure switch, an evaporator with an expansion valve, an evaporator coil temperature sensor, and interlock assembly (only with electrically driven compressor). On aircraft equipped with the electrically driven compressor the ACCS may be used to pre-cool the cabin using ground power supply.

OUTSIDE RAM AIR

ECS CONTROL VALVE

FRONT SEAT EYEBALL VENTS

DEFOG
DEF/HTR FAN

REAR SEAT EYEBALL VENTS

ECS SHUT OFF VALVE

FRONT SEAT OVERHEAD EYEBALL VENTS

OVERHEAD FLOOD DUCTS

DEFOG/FLOOR SELECTOR VALVE

REAR SEAT OVERHEAD EYEBALL VENTS FRONT FLOOR VENT FRONT FLOOR VENT CABIN AIR OUTLET VENTS REAR EYEBALL FLOOR VENT

EVAPORATOR WITH INTAKE

Figure 7 27

RC050005 7-62

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

System Operation Electric fan, forced air, directed through the condenser coil, located beneath the baggage compartment floor, cools the hot, high pressure R-134a refrigerant. The condenser intake air is taken from two screen covered ducts on the belly of the aircraft. Condenser exhaust air exits through four screen covered ducts on the belly of the aircraft, aft of the two condenser intake ducts. Control of the refrigeration temperature cycle is done with a computer controlled thermostatic cycling switch. The switch senses evaporator temperature and cycles the engine driven compressor to regulate the evaporator coil temperature and to prevent the coil from freezing up.

Outside air can be introduced into the cabin through the eyeball vents on the side interior panels of the aircraft by opening the instrument panel and rear side wall vents at any time. During warm cabin temperatures the ACCS operates in the air conditioning mode, supplying cooled, dehumidified air to the ceiling console vents and the flood ducts above the rear seats. When the system switches to heating operation during cool cabin temperatures, heated, outside air will be delivered to the front and rear floor vents and/or the windshield based on temperature conditions and the mode of operation settings. In the rare occurrence of a refrigeration overpressure condition, a high/low pressure trinary safety switch, located on the receiver/dryer, will disengage the compressor to allow pressures to return to a safe level. This same switch senses a low pressure condition in the system and disengages the compressor to prevent damage. The trinary safety switch automatically resets once refrigerant pressures have returned to a safe level. The ACCS can be left on in any mode at the time of aircraft shut-down and will resume the previously selected temperature and mode when reactivated. The system will be active once both electrical buses are on and the voltage annunciation clears. For safety purposes the ACCS will deactivate if the voltage annunciation message displays or either bus voltage falls below a predetermined threshold. In the event that the Air Conditioning portion of the ACCS does not seem to be functioning button correctly, the ACCS should be switched to the Compressor Off mode by pressing the until the adjacent indicator light is out. An air conditioning performance evaluation should be performed by an authorized Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Service Center to determine and correct the problem prior to resuming the use of the air conditioning portion of the ACCS.
NOTE If the air conditioning system is turned off, on aircraft equipped with the electric compressor, wait at least 3 minutes before turning it on again. This ensures the electric compressor will start, otherwise the compressor may not start until the system stabilizes. System Operation Using Ground Power Supply Only 28 Volt ACCS equipped with electrically driven compressor may be used to pre-cool the aircraft cabin using a ground power supply. After connecting a ground power source and switching the unit on, the ACCS can be activated by pushing the external switch found near the ground power receptacle. When activated the aircraft power grid is disabled and the electric compressor and evaporator blower will run continuously while the condenser fans automatically cycle as needed. The external ACCS switch does not function when a battery master is on. The ACCS control panel is disabled during external power air conditioning operation and the ACCS cools at max capability. External power ACCS operation can be deactivated by pushing the external switch, removing the ground power source, or turning on either battery master switch. With a battery master on, the ACCS will be fully functional except the electric compressor will be off.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-63

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems NOTE

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Ground power operation of the air conditioning will require a 24 V ground power source that can deliver 100 amps during use. NOTE If the air conditioning system is turned off, wait at least 3 minutes before turning it on again. This ensures the electric compressor will start, otherwise the compressor may not start until the system stabilizes. Control Buttons The system is operated by control buttons. See Figure 7 28 and Figure 7 29. -AIR CONDITIONING, -DEFOG A small LED indicator light will glow next to the and AUTO buttons to indicate which of those operating modes has been selected. The selected temperature is displayed in the control panel. A list of the control buttons and their use and functions follows: AUTO-All Season Standard Setting Air temperature, air delivery and air distribution are regulated automatically to achieve and maintain the desired interior temperature as quickly as possible. The system automatically compensates for any variations in outside temperature. In cold outside temperatures, heated air will flow from the front and rear floor vents along with a small amount from the windshield defog duct. In warmer outside temperatures, cooled air will flow from the vents on the ceiling console and the overhead flood ducts above the rear seats. A panel light adjacent to the AUTO button indicates when this mode is active. Defogging the Windshield Use this setting to defog the windshield. Maximum air volume is directed towards the windshield. A panel light adjacent to the button indicates when this mode is active. Press the button again to cancel the defog mode. Compressor on/off When maximum aircraft performance is desired the compressor can be switched off. In this case the system no longer provides full climate control. If the cabin becomes too warm, press the switch again to activate the compressor to provide cooling and button indicates when compressor on dehumidification. A panel light adjacent to the button alternately will toggle the compressor selection On mode is active. Pressing the and Off. NOTE If maximum aircraft performance is desired, the Automatic Climate Control System should be switched to the Compressor Off mode by pressing the button until the adjacent indicator light is out. Temperature Setting (+) or (-) The desired interior temperature can be preset within a range from 55F (13C) to 95F (35C). Within this range, the temperature will be automatically adjusted. The settings selected prior to the shutdown of the aircraft will be restored upon restart. Fan (+) or (-) The automatically selected fan speed (volume of air delivery) can be reduced or increased manually by operating these buttons. This mode overrides the automatic fan speed control feature. Incremental fan speeds up or down in 11 steps are available. The digital display indicates the fan speed as a percentage or HI when the maximum fan speed is reached or LO when the minimum fan speed is reached. The digital display returns to the normal mode of interior temperature selection 5 seconds after either fan speed button is depressed. The selected fan speed is maintained until it is changed or the AUTO button is depressed. RC050005 7-64 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

OAT (Outside Air Temperature) When depressed, the outside air temperature is displayed as measured by the outside air temperature sensor. The outside air temperature will be displayed for a duration of 5 seconds then return to the normal mode of interior temperature selection. The sensor is mounted in the condenser bay and will often indicate a higher temperature than the ship OAT. WARNING The outside temperature display is not to be considered an indicator for possible icing conditions. Ice formation can occur at indicated temperatures above freezing and in a multitude of conditions. OFF When the OFF button is depressed, the entire climate control system is switched off. In this mode of operation the heater/ECS mixing valve closes the hot air supply from the engine heat exchanger. This mode does NOT need to be selected prior to aircraft shutdown. ON This switches on the climate control system. The LED numeric display will show the current interior temperature and mode selections. WARNING At lower engine RPM operations of the air conditioning, the BATT mode of the ammeter must be monitored. The electrical load must be reduced, or the RPM increased, to prevent a discharge of the batteries.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-65

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Figure 7 28
Turns the compressor On or Off in any Mode. Pressing this button toggles the compressor selection On and Off.

Temperature Display

Displays outside air temperature for 5 seconds. Raises fan speed. Possible in all Mode selections. Speed is indicated as a percentage in the display for 5 seconds after the selection is made. Lowers fan speed. Toggles into manual mode.

Raises cabin temperature in 1 increments.

Lowers cabin temperature in 1 increments.

Turns ACCS off. Turns ACCS on. Resumes present mode and temperature. -Automatic ModeAll functions are controlled automatically. All previously selected manual settings are cancelled. -Defog ModeBlower runs at highest speed but can be regulated. The majority of the air is directed to the windshield. Pressing this button toggles the defog mode On and Off.

Figure 7 29

RC050005 7-66

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

General Hints for ACCS Operation At low outside air temperatures the air conditioning compressor will shut off automatically. When the air conditioning is operating, the interior temperatures and humidity will be reduced. This helps to reduce the possibility of windshield and side window fog up. For the quickest cooling of a hot cabin, leave cabin doors open for a few minutes prior to startup to allow the hot air to escape. When it is very hot and humid, condensed water can drip from the evaporator drain tube onto the surface beneath the aircraft for an extended period of time. This is normal and does not indicate a leak. For maximum ACCS performance during air conditioning or heating modes of operation, assure that the instrument panel vents and the rear side wall fresh air vents are closed. The condenser should be checked periodically for cleanliness. If clogged with dirt or debris, the condenser should be cleaned with compressed air and/or water. Should you suspect that the air conditioning system has been damaged through outside influences (i.e. by debris, FOD); the system should be checked immediately by an authorized Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Service Center. If there is a defect in the refrigerant circuit of the air conditioner, a safety switch switches the compressor off temporarily or completely. In this case contact your authorized Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Service Center. Repairs or maintenance to the air conditioning system requires trained personnel and special tools. If there should be any malfunction in the system, contact your nearest authorized Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Service Center. GARMIN GFC 700 AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM (AFCS) The GFC 700 is a digital Automatic Flight Control System (AFCS) which is fully integrated within the G1000 system avionics architecture. For operating instructions on the features of the GFC 700 system, refer to the latest revision of the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 350/400, document number 190-00567-01.

The GFC 700 AFCS is made up of the following Line Replaceable Units (LRUs):

GDU 1040 Primary Flight Display (PFD) GDU 1042/GDU 1044 Multi-Function Display (MFD) GIA 63/GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Units (2) GSA 81 Servos (2) GSM 85 Servo Mounts (2) GTA 82 Trim Adapter

The GFC 700 AFCS system can be divided into Two main operating functions:
Flight Director Flight Director operation takes place within the #1 GIA 63/GIA 63W and the GDU 1040 PFD. The Flight Director provides the system with:

Command Bars showing Pitch/Roll Guidance Pitch/Roll Mode Selection & Processing Autopilot Communication

Autopilot Autopilot operation occurs within the pitch, roll, and pitch trim GSA 81 servos and provides:

Automatic Flight Control Servo Monitoring

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

RC050005 7-67

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

WARNING When using GPS autopilot mode in the terminal area, care should be exercised when selecting Vectors to Final on the G1000. When VTF mode is selected without selecting HDG or another autopilot roll mode first, the airplane will turn to a 45 degree intercept to the final approach course regardless of the airplanes position relative to the airport or the approach. WARNING The G1000 cannot command the autopilot to fly procedure turns or holding patterns automatically. Use HDG mode to accomplish both of these tasks. Generally, switching to HDG upon receipt of the holding pattern entry or procedure turn message is appropriate. Failing to use HDG mode will cause the airplane to navigate away from the hold or procedure turn. GIA 63/GIA 63W Integrated Avionics Units Each GIA 63/GIA 63W contains the AFCS software which controls the Flight Director. During normal operation, the GRS 77 AHRS and GDC 74A Air Data Computer send attitude and air data information to the GIA 63/GIA 63Ws. This information, combined with GPS and other system data, is used by the Flight Director and Autopilot. Flight Director commands are calculated within the #1 GIA 63/GIA 63W and are sent to the PFD for display and mode annunciation. Flight information is also sent to the GSA 81 servos for Autopilot operation. A GIA #1 failure results in the loss of the AFCS system. Any GIA 63/GIA 63W failure results in loss of the Autopilot, and Manual Electric Trim functions. GSA 81 AFCS Servos (2) Two GSA 81 servos are used for automatic control of the aircraft flight control surfaces. One servo is used for the each of the following:

Pitch Roll

Each servo moves its respective aircraft control surface in response to commands generated by internal servo calculations. For pitch trim, the servo positions the aircraft pitch trim surface in response to commands generated by automatic and manual electric pitch trim calculations. Calculations are performed using data sent through the common serial data bus from the GIA 63/GIA 63W. Manual electric pitch trim is also provided in response to the Manual Electric Trim (MET) switch. See Figure 7 30.
GSM 85 Servo Mounts (2) The GSM 85 servo mounts are used to connect the servos to the aircraft control system. They contain a spiral capstan which connects via a bridle cable to the main aircraft control cables. There is also a slip clutch to limit overpower forces in the unlikely event of a mechanical jam. An engage clutch is used to disconnect the capstan from the servo when the AFCS is disengaged. See Figure 7 30.

RC050005 7-68

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Figure 7 30
GTA 82 Trim Adapter The GTA 82 Trim Adapter is a remote mounted device that is used to allow the GFC 700 to drive a trim actuator. The GTA 82 interfaces with two GIA 63/GIA 63Ws Integrated Avionics Units through serial communication on separate RS-485 ports. See Figure 7 31.

Figure 7 31
Dedicated AFCS Controls The GDU 1042/GDU 1044 MFD has the following dedicated AFCS keys located on the lower left side of the bezel (See Figure 7 - 32): AP Key Engages/disengages the Autopilot FD Key Activates/deactivates the Flight Director only

Pressing the FD key turns on the Flight Director in the default vertical and lateral modes. Pressing the FD key again deactivates the Flight Director and removes the command bars, unless the Autopilot is engaged. If the Autopilot is engaged, the FD key is disabled.
NAV Key Selects/deselects the Navigation mode ALT Key Selects/deselects the Altitude Hold mode VS Key Selects/deselects the Vertical Speed mode FLC Key Selects/deselects the Flight Level Change mode HDG Key Selects/deselects the Heading Select mode APR Key Selects/deselects the Approach mode RC050005 7-69

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

NOSE UP/NOSE DN Keys Controls the active pitch reference for the Pitch Hold, Vertical Speed, and Flight Level Change modes

Figure 7 - 32
Additional AFCS Controls The following buttons and switches used by the AFCS are located in the cockpit separately from the PFD and MFD: A/P DISC (Autopilot Disconnect) Button Disengages the Autopilot and interrupts pitch trim operation.

This button may be used to mute the aural alert associated with an Autopilot disconnect. The A/P DISC button is colored red and is located on the pilots and copilots control stick. The A/P DISC button mutes AP disconnect alerting if pressed during an alert.
CWS (Control Wheel Steering) Button Momentarily disengages the Autopilot and synchronizes the Flight Directors command bar to the current aircraft attitude.

The CWS button is located on the pilots control stick. Upon release of the CWS button, the Flight Director may establish new reference points, depending on the current pitch and roll modes.
GO AROUND Button Disengages the Autopilot and selects the Go Around pitch and roll modes on the Flight Director.

The GO AROUND button is located on the flap panel. Before using Go Around Mode, review the missed approach procedure in the Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide carefully and then determine the best sequence of autopilot modes to be used to execute the missed approach as published. Upon selection of Go Around mode, the autopilot will automatically disconnect. The pilot should apply go around power, select flaps up when sufficient airspeed is achieved, and then select the appropriate autopilot roll and pitch modes. The autopilot may be coupled to the flight director after the airplane has been cleaned up and trimmed appropriately. Go Around mode will automatically capture the missed approach altitude selected on the altitude preselector on the G1000 (ALT in white). FLC is recommended for missed approach climbout using Vx or Vy as appropriate. Depending upon the missed approach procedure, autopilot HDG mode may be required for initial maneuvering if the missed approach sequence requires a heading to be flown to a particular altitude.
RC050005 7-70 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

When the aircraft is in position to fly direct to the missed approach hold point, the pilot should select GPS data on the HSI, then unsuspend the GPS waypoint sequencing enabling GPS navigation to the missed approach hold waypoint. GPS autopilot mode may then be used to fly to the missed approach hold waypoint. The airplane must be in a position to intercept the magenta GPS course to capture the course using GPS autopilot mode. Navigating the holding pattern must be accomplished using autopilot HDG mode.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

RC050005 7-71

Section 7 Description of the Airplane and Systems

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 7-72

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: E/05-15-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................... 8-3 General................................................................................................................................... 8-3 Fuselage Identification Plate ........................................................................................ 8-3 Publications .................................................................................................................. 8-3 Address Information..................................................................................................... 8-3 SERVICES AND SERVICING ..................................................................................................... 8-4 Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Advisory Service ....................................... 8-4 Customer Delivery Package .................................................................................................. 8-4 Fuel Servicing........................................................................................................................ 8-4 Recommended Fuel Grades.......................................................................................... 8-4 Fuel Capacities ............................................................................................................. 8-4 Approved Fuel Additives ............................................................................................. 8-5 Fuel Additive Mixture Table........................................................................................ 8-5 Grounding During Refueling and Defueling................................................................ 8-5 Fuel Contamination ...................................................................................................... 8-6 Oil Servicing.......................................................................................................................... 8-7 Oil Grades Recommended for Various Temperature Ranges...................................... 8-7 Sump Capacity.............................................................................................................. 8-7 Oil Filter ....................................................................................................................... 8-7 Brakes and Tire/Nose Strut Pressures ................................................................................... 8-7 Tire Considerations................................................................................................................ 8-7 Battery Replacement Cycles.................................................................................................. 8-8 Oxygen System Servicing ..................................................................................................... 8-8 MAINTENANCE AND DOCUMENTATION........................................................................... 8-10 Maintenance......................................................................................................................... 8-10 Airplane Inspection Periods ....................................................................................... 8-10 Airworthiness Directives ............................................................................................ 8-10 Preventive Maintenance ............................................................................................. 8-10 Alterations or Repairs................................................................................................. 8-10 Required Oil Changes and Special Inspections ......................................................... 8-10 Recommended Oil Changes and Special Inspections ................................................ 8-10 Warranty Work .......................................................................................................... 8-11 Airplane Documentation ..................................................................................................... 8-11 ADLOG Maintenance Recordkeeping System (MRS) ................................................... 8-11 HANDLING AND STORAGE .................................................................................................... 8-13 Ground Handling ................................................................................................................. 8-13 Towing........................................................................................................................ 8-13 Parking........................................................................................................................ 8-13 Securing the Airplane ................................................................................................. 8-14 Windshield Cover....................................................................................................... 8-14

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-1

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Jacking and Leveling ........................................................................................................... 8-14 Jacking ........................................................................................................................ 8-14 Leveling ...................................................................................................................... 8-14 Storage ................................................................................................................................. 8-15 Flyable Storage (7 to 30 days).................................................................................... 8-15 Temporary Storage (up to 90 days)............................................................................ 8-15 Return to Service from Temporary Storage ............................................................... 8-15 Indefinite Storage (over 90 days) ............................................................................... 8-16 Return to Service from Indefinite Storage ................................................................. 8-16 Airframe Preservation for Temporary and Indefinite Storage................................... 8-17 Airframe Preservation Return to Service ................................................................... 8-17 Inspections During Temporary Storage ..................................................................... 8-17 Inspections During Indefinite Storage........................................................................ 8-17 AIRFRAME AND ENGINE CARE ............................................................................................ 8-19 Airframe............................................................................................................................... 8-19 Exterior ....................................................................................................................... 8-19 Anti-Erosion Tape and Leading Edge Tape............................................................... 8-19 Windshield and Windows........................................................................................... 8-19 Interior Cleaning and Care ......................................................................................... 8-20 Engine and Propeller ........................................................................................................... 8-21 Engine Cleaning and Care .......................................................................................... 8-21 Propeller Cleaning and Care....................................................................................... 8-21

RC050005 8-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance


INTRODUCTION

This section contains procedures for ground handling of the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG), as well as recommendations and techniques for routine care of the airplanes interior and exterior. In addition, maintenance intervals and procedures are addressed. Finally, publications, the Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Advisory Service, and servicing information are discussed.
GENERAL The owner or operator of the airplane is responsible for ensuring the airworthiness of the airplane is maintained. The responsibility extends to maintaining the airplane logbooks, ensuring the required inspections are performed in a timely manner, and ensuring that mandatory service directives and part replacements are accomplished within the specified period.

While the owner or operator is responsible for the continued airworthiness of the airplane, the use of an authorized dealer or certified service station will facilitate compliance. It is recommended that the owner or operator of the airplane contact a dealer or a certified service station for service information. All correspondence regarding the airplane should include the airplane serial number.
Fuselage Identification Plate The airplane serial number, make, model, Type Certificate (TC) number, year of manufacture, and Production Certification (PC) number is contained on the Fuselage Identification Plate on the tail cone of the airplane. The serial number is also listed on the cover page of the Pilots Operating Handbook and FAA Approved Flight Manual. Publications Owners and noncommercial operators may do preventive maintenance as described in part 43 of the Federal Aviation Regulations. To do this requires the use of an authorized maintenance manual. In some instances, the owner or operator may wish to maintain a copy of the maintenance manual to assist other appropriately certified individuals in maintaining the airplanes continued airworthiness. In either event, a maintenance manual, and other related documentation can be obtained by contacting: Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Attn: Customer Service 22550 Nelson Road Bend Municipal Airport Bend, Oregon 97701-9710 Phone: (541) 318-1144 Fax: (541) 318-1177 Email: [email protected]

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-3

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

SERVICES AND SERVICING


COLUMBIA AIRCRAFT MANUFACTURING CORPORATION ADVISORY SERVICE Changes that affect the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG), including the maintenance and operation of the airplane, are provided to all registered owners free of charge. The Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Advisory will contain two basic types of data, compulsory and informational. Compulsory items must be accomplished within a specified time to maintain the continued airworthiness of the airplane. Informational items are non-binding and usually contain details and tips that enhance the use of the airplane.

Domestic owners, unless otherwise instructed, will receive information at the address listed in the FAA database. However, it is important that all owners and particularly international airplane owners advise Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing of any address changes. This will ensure uninterrupted advisory information. Individuals who are not registered owners can obtain the advisory service on a subscription basis by contacting the manufacturer at the address listed on page 8-3.
CUSTOMER DELIVERY PACKAGE The items listed below are provided with the airplane when it is delivered to the owner. If any of the items are lost or damaged, replacements can be purchased by contacting the manufacturer at the address shown on page 8-3. Publications are also available for purchase by non-owners. Pilots Operating Handbook and FAA Approved Flight Manual (1) Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide for the Columbia 400, Document No. 190-00567-01

Normal Procedures Checklist (1) Emergency Procedures Checklist (1) ADLOG MRS (1) Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Warranty Program (1)

Columbia 400 Electrical Manual Columbia 400 Passenger Briefing Card (4) Columbia 400 Maintenance Manual

In addition to the items listed above, the owner will receive a number of other items including but not limited to: tie-down rings, jack points, pitot tube cover, and an assortment of other manufacturers pilot guides, owner guides, operator manuals, software, video tapes, etc.
FUEL SERVICING Recommended Fuel Grades 100LL Grade Aviation Fuel (Blue) 100 Grade Aviation Fuel (Green) Fuel Capacities Total Capacity: 106 Gallons US (401 L) Total Capacity Each Tank: 53 Gallons US (201 L) Total Usable Fuel: S/N 41501 to 41799 49 Gallons US (186 L)/tank, 98 Gallons US (371 L) Total S/N 41800 and on Standard: 43 Gallons US (163 L)/tank, 86 Gallons US (326 L) Total Long Range: 51 Gallons US (193 L)/tank, 102 Gallons US (386 L) Total RC050005 8-4 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: G/10-16-2007

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Approved Fuel Additives Under certain ambient conditions of temperature and humidity, water can be supported in the fuel in sufficient quantities to create restrictive ice formation along various segments of the fuel system. To alleviate the possibility of this occurring, it is permissible to add Isopropyl Alcohol to the fuel supply in quantities not to exceed 3% of the total. In addition, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether (EGME) and diethylene glycol monomethyl ether (DiEGME) compounds to military specification MIL-I-27686E may be added for this purpose. The ethylene glycol monomethyl ether and diethylene glycol monomethyl ether compounds must be carefully mixed with fuel concentrations not to exceed 0.15 percent by volume. FUEL ADDITIVE MIXTURE TABLE Fuel Gal. (L) Isopropyl Alcohol (3%) Fluid Ounces 3.8 7.7 11.5 15.4 19.2 23.0 26.9 30.7 34.6 38.4 42.2 46.1 49.9 53.8 57.6 61.4 65.3 69.1 73.0 76.8 80.6 84.5 88.3 92.2 96.0 99.8 EGME & DiEGME (0.15%) Fluid Ounces 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.3 1.5 1.7 1.9 2.1 2.3 2.5 2.7 2.9 3.1 3.3 3.5 3.6 3.8 4.0 4.2 4.4 4.6 4.8 5.0 Fuel Gal. (L) Isopropyl Alcohol (3%) Fluid Ounces 103.7 107.5 111.4 115.2 119.0 122.9 126.7 130.6 134.4 138.2 142.1 145.9 149.8 153.6 157.4 161.3 165.1 169.0 172.8 176.6 180.5 184.3 188.2 192.0 195.8 199.7 EGME & DiEGME (0.15%) Fluid Ounces 5.2 5.4 5.6 5.8 6.0 6.1 6.3 6.5 6.7 6.9 7.1 7.3 7.5 7.7 7.9 8.1 8.3 8.4 8.6 8.8 9.0 9.2 9.4 9.6 9.8 10.0

1 (3.8) 2 (7.6) 3 (11.4) 4 (15.1) 5 (18.9) 6 (22.7) 7 (26.5) 8 (30.3) 9 (34.1) 10 (37.9) 11 (41.6) 12 (45.4) 13 (49.2) 14 (53.0) 15 (56.8) 16 (60.6) 17 (64.4) 18 (68.1) 19 (71.9) 20 (75.7) 21 (79.5) 22 (83.3) 23 (87.1) 24 (90.8) 25 (94.6) 26 (98.4)

27 (102.2) 28 (106.0) 29 (109.8) 30 (113.6) 31 (117.3) 32 (121.1) 33 (124.9) 34 (128.7) 35 (132.5) 36 (136.3) 37 (140.1) 38 (143.8) 39 (147.6) 40 (151.4) 41 (155.2) 42 (159.0) 43 (162.8) 44 (166.5) 45 (170.3) 46 (174.1) 47 (177.9) 48 (181.7) 49 (185.5) 50 (189.3) 51 (193.0) 52 (196.8)

Figure 8 - 1 It is important that the approved fuel additives are mixed in correct proportions. Consideration is required to ensure the appropriate concentration levels are achieved when the tank is filled. For example, adding 40 gallons (151 L) of fuel with a 0.15 percent concentration of EGME to a tank with 10 gallons (38 L) of untreated fuel will produce a mixture of something less than 0.15 percent. Consideration must also be made for the unusable fuel in the tank since it will be combined with the total mixture.
Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: F/07-12-2007 RC050005 8-5

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

The additives shall be added as the fuel is introduced to the fuel tank so that the mixture is properly combined. Alternatively, the additive can be mixed with a small amount of fuel in a separate container, such as a five-gallon can, and added to the fuel tank before normal fueling. The table in Figure 8 - 1 lists the number of ounces of each additive for a given fuel quantity.
WARNING Mixing of ethylene glycol monomethyl ether and diethylene glycol monomethyl ether compounds is extremely important because concentrations more than the 0.15 percent by volume can have a harmful effect on engine components. Grounding During Refueling and Defueling The high-speed characteristics of the airplane make generation of static electricity more likely, so it is important for the airplane to be grounded to the fuel source during refueling and defueling operations. Place the fuel source grounding clamp on the right or left exhaust stack of the airplane before touching the filler neck of the fuel tanks with metal parts of the ground refueling equipment. Remember that refueling is often done at the conclusion of a flight and the exhaust stacks may still be hot, so care must be used when attaching the clamp.

Some defueling is possible using the defueling feature on the delivery system of the Avgas fuel supplier. This procedure is usually adequate for removing fuel when gross takeoff weight is an issue. To completely defuel the airplane, refer to Chapter 12 in the Columbia 400 Airplane Maintenance Manual.
Fuel Contamination To test for fuel contamination, fuel samples must be taken from each of the wing drains and from the gascolator before each flight and after the airplane is refueled. There are three types of contaminants that can inadvertently be introduced to the fuel system: (1) sediment such as dirt and bacteria, (2) water, and (3) the improper grade of fuel.

1.

2.

3.

The accumulation of sediments is an inherent issue with most aircraft and can never be completely eliminated. Refueling the airplane at the conclusion of each flight and using fuel from a supplier who routinely maintains the filtration of the refueling equipment will lessen the problem somewhat. If specks are observed in the fuel sampler, continue the sampling operation until no debris is observed. Be sure the sampling device is clean before using it. The two more common sources of water contamination are condensation of water from the air within a partially filled fuel tank and water-contaminated Avgas from a fuel supplier. Again, refueling after each flight and proper filtration of the fuel delivery system will mitigate water contamination. Water, which is heavier than Avgas, will collect near the bottom of the sampling device. If water is observed in the fuel sampler, take additional fuel samples until all the water is removed. Aviation fuel is dyed according to its grade, and on new aircraft like the Columbia 400 (LC41550FG), the filler neck is sized to only accept fuel of the proper grade. Still, the color of the fuel shall be verified according to the specifications on page 8-4, since the fuel truck might have been refilled improperly. If fuels of two different grades are mixed, the fuel sample will be clear. If an inferior, improper grade of fuel is noted, completely defuel both tanks, and refuel with the proper grade of Avgas.

Persistent fuel contamination is a serious problem. If repeated fuel sampling is ineffective or there is chronic contamination, approved personnel must inspect the airplane, and it is unsafe to fly. Two final thoughts about refueling and contamination: First, remember that fuel service personnel are people of unknown training and background. It is always a good idea to personally observe refueling operations. Second, if it is necessary to operate in areas where there is questionable fuel delivery, the use of a portable fuel filter is recommended.

RC050005 8-6

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

NOTE There are a number of fuel additives on the market that are formulated for automotive use. While the additives may be beneficial for cars, trucks, etc., they are not approved for aircraft use. OIL SERVICING The oil grades shown below are recommended after the initial engine break-in period. Refer to the Required Oil Changes and Special Inspections heading on page 8-10 for additional details about oil grades during the engine break-in period. Only lubricant oils conforming to Teledyne Continental Motors Specification MHS-24 can be used. NOTE Oil is added to the engine through the filler neck that contains the dipstick. To remove the dipstick, rotate it counterclockwise to unseat it; raise the dipstick approximately six to eight inches or until a slight resistance is felt; rotate the dipstick 90 clockwise and remove from the filler neck. Oil Grades Recommended for Various Average Air Temperature Ranges Below 40F (4C) SAE 30, 10W30, 15W50, or 20W50 Above 40F (4C) SAE 50, 15W50, or 20W50 Sump Capacity The system has a wet type oil sump with a drain-refill capacity of eight quarts. Oil Filter A full flow, spin-on type, 20-micron oil filter is used. NOTE There are a number of oil additives on the market that are formulated for automotive use; however, they are not approved for aircraft operations. BRAKES AND TIRE/NOSE STRUT PRESSURES Proper inflation of the tires reduces tire external damage and heat, which reduces tire wear. Proper inflation of the nose strut ensures a smoother ride. Maneuverability on the ground is enhanced when tire and strut pressures are at proper levels. Figure 8 - 2 summarizes the recommended pressures and types of tires. Tire Considerations The airplane is normally delivered with Goodyear tires. These tires have a profile that provides about in. (0.95 cm) clearance between the tire and wheel pants. Other brands of tires with similar specifications and TSOs may have slightly larger profiles. Tires with larger profiles are not recommended since damage to the tire or wheel pant is possible, particularly during landing. If other brands of tires are used, the profile of the tire must be precisely measured and compared with the Goodyear tire. CAUTION The profile of replacement tires that are not a recommended brand should be measured precisely to ensure they are the same height and width. The use of tires that have slightly larger profiles can cause damage to the tire and to the wheel pant, particularly during landing operations.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-7

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance ITEM SPECIFICATIONS

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) PRESSURE TYPE OF GAS

Nose Strut Nose Gear Tire Main Gear Tires

N/A 5.00-5 (10 ply) 15x6.00-6 (6-ply) Figure 8 - 2

250 psi 88 psi 55 psi

Nitrogen Air Air

Normally, a trained mechanic adds brake fluid. However, this is an approved item of preventive maintenance, and servicing by a private pilot who is the owner or operator is permitted. The brake fluid levels shall be serviced according to instructions contained in the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Maintenance Manual with MIL-H-5606 hydraulic fluid.
BATTERY REPLACEMENT CYCLES The Columbia 400 has three separate batteries that require periodic replacement. While the system batteries indicate their charge on the installed voltmeter and ammeter, the ELT battery does not have a positive test to indicate its charge. The table below summarizes the replacement cycles. BATTERY REPLACEMENT CYCLES

BATTERY TYPE

BATTERY LOCATION Aft of the baggage compartment hat rack Please see page 7-50 for more information.

REPLACEMENT CYCLE Every 2 years (Artex 200), every 5 years (Artex ME406), or when the battery had been used for more than one hour or used 50% if its power Alternate replacement every two years First replace the right battery, after two more years replace the left battery. Alternate replacement every two years. However, if the battery fails to hold a charge, it must be replaced.

Emergency Locator Transmitter (ELT) Battery

System Dry Sealed LeadAcid Type Battery (Two each)

Under the left side of the hat rack in the baggage compartment.

Figure 8 - 3
OXYGEN SYSTEM SERVICING When servicing the oxygen, only the following approved oxygen may be used:

Oxygen per Mil-O-27210 Aviators Breathing Oxygen To refill the oxygen supply use the following steps: Set the Right Bus switch to ON 1. Set the Avionics Master to ON. 2. Unscrew the filler port safety cap, and connect the service line to the Oxygen Service 3. fitting located in the aft baggage on the left hand side of the aircraft. Slowly fill the oxygen supply. By filling slowly, the temperature rise due to the 4. compressed gas in the oxygen supply bottles will be kept to a minimum. Monitor the cockpit oxygen display to ensure that the oxygen supply is filled. 5.

RC050005 8-8

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) NOTE

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

This fixed oxygen system has a maximum bottle pressure of 2,000 psi.

When the system is filled to the intended capacity, turn the oxygen system on using the OXYGEN softkey on the MFD. Ensure that the Outlet Pressure Display is in the green band. Outlet pressure in the green 7. or amber bands is normal unless the amber indication remains on with multiple flow devices plugged in, and flowing oxygen. Turn the oxygen system off using the OXYGEN softkey on the MFD. 8. Set the Avionics Master to OFF. 9. 10. Set the Right Bus switch to OFF. 11. Ensure safety cap is installed over the filler port. 6. See the Columbia 400 Maintenance Manual for additional maintenance instructions if oxygen quantity drops faster than the duration charts in Chapter 5 indicate or there is either very high or very low outlet pressure.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-9

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

MAINTENANCE AND DOCUMENTATION


MAINTENANCE Airplane Inspection Periods Part 91, Subpart E of the Federal Aviation Regulations requires that each U.S. civil registered airplane not used for hire be inspected every 12 calendar months in accordance with Part 43. If the airplane is used for hire, the regulations require that it must be inspected before or at each 100 hours of time in service. Airworthiness Directives The FAA may issue notifications known as Airworthiness Directives (ADs) that are applicable to the airplane or one of its components. The directives specify what action is required and normally have a compliance period. It is the responsibility of the owner/operator of the airplane to ensure compliance with all applicable ADs. Preventive Maintenance A certificated pilot who owns or operates an airplane not used as an air carrier is authorized by FAR Part 43 to perform limited preventive maintenance on his or her airplane. Appendix A of Part 43 of the Federal Aviation Regulations is specific as to what items constitute preventive maintenance. Only the certificated pilot who owns or operates the airplane can perform the specific items listed in FAR Part 43. The work must be performed according to procedures and specifications in the applicable handbook or maintenance manual. Appropriately licensed personnel must perform all other maintenance items not specifically identified in Appendix A of Part 43. For more details regarding authorized maintenance, contact the factory or a service center. Alterations or Repairs All alterations or repairs to the airplane must be accomplished by licensed personnel. In addition, an alteration may violate the airworthiness of the airplane. Before alterations are made, the owner or operator of the airplane should contact the FAA for approval. Required Oil Changes and Special Inspections During the engine break-in period, Nondispersant mineral oil conforming to SAE J1966 shall be used. However, if the engine is flown less than once a week, a straight mineral oil with corrosion preventative MIL-C-6529 for the first 25 hours is recommended. After the first 25 hours of the airplanes time in service, the oil and oil filter must be changed and a new supply of Teledyne Continental Motors specification MHS-24 (latest revision) ashless dispersant oil must be used. At 50 hours of time in service, the oil and oil filter shall be changed and the filter and discarded oil checked for evidence of metal particles. Thereafter, the oil and oil filter must be changed at every 50 hours of time in service.

At the first oil change, the engine and related accessories including the magnetos, starter, alternator, engine driven fuel and oil pumps, oil cooler, and propeller governor, should be inspected for oil leaks and security. Spark plug leads and other electrical circuits should be checked for proper routing, abrasion, chafing, and security. Check engine controls and linkages for proper operation. Finally, check the intake and exhaust system for security and evidence of cracking.
Recommended Oil Changes and Special Inspections At approximately every 50 hours of time in service it is recommended the engine oil be changed. Since the cowling is removed for an oil change, a cursory inspection of other engine systems is possible, and the engine can be cleaned and degreased if necessary. The airplanes engine is the single most expensive component in the airplane and arguably the most important. The comparative nominal expense and time involved in doing 50hour oil changes are more than offset by the long-term benefits and peace of mind.

RC050005 8-10

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Warranty Work The Columbia 400 warranty covers basic airframe items manufactured by The Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation, but does not include tires, batteries, filters, and other consumables. In addition, the engine and its components, avionics, and other replaceable units carry their own separate warranties from their respective manufacturers. For example, if an owner or operator has a warranty issue with the engine, autopilot, or GPS, the application for reimbursement must be submitted to the appropriate manufacturer.

Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation will submit the initial application for warranty of installed items that are warranted by other manufacturers. A list of these manufacturers, as well as all the phone numbers, is included at the beginning of the ADLOG MRS, which is part of the Customer Delivery Kit discussed on page 8-4. Warranty work must be performed at the Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation factory or at one of the Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Sales and Service Centers (SSC), including other maintenance providers that are approved by a particular SSC. Warranty work by a non-approved maintenance facility may be permitted, but the owner or operator of the airplane must obtain permission from Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation prior to engaging a nonapproved facility. Warranty work by a non-approved maintenance provider must be obtained for each warranty incident. That is, an approval by Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation for a specific issue does not constitute blanket permission.
AIRPLANE DOCUMENTATION There are certain items required to be in the airplane at all times. Moreover, some of the items must be displayed near the cabin or cockpit door. The required items are provided with the airplane when it is delivered to the new owner. A description of all required documentation is summarized in the table below in Figure 8 - 4. Item Must be Displayed Yes Location

Aircraft Airworthiness Certificate Aircraft Registration Pilots Operating Handbook and FAA Approved Flight Manual Garmin G1000 Cockpit Reference Guide Weight & Balance documentation (FAA Form 337 if applicable) Equipment List (Section 6, Appendix B of the POH/AFM)

Yes No No No No

In display pocket on the copilots side near the rudder pedals

All these items are located in the front passenger seatback pocket.

Figure 8 - 4
ADLOG MAINTENANCE RECORDKEEPING SYSTEM (MRS) The ADLOGTM MRS is included in the airplanes delivery package. Its color-coded, indexed sections simplify, organize, and centralize all relevant airplane maintenance data. The ADLOGTM MRS also includes a one-year airworthiness directive (ADs) revision service for the applicable equipment, instruments, and components for the airplane based on its serial number. Thereafter, the owner of the airplane can continue the subscription at a fairly nominal cost. Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 8-11
TM

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This system is the best available and ensures that the maintenance history of the airplane and all applicable ADs are precisely documented in a logical format. The system has been in use for more than 20 years and is revered by both mechanics and Part 135 operators. The ADLOGTM service also includes ADs for STC equipment that the owner may add to the airplane.

RC050005 8-12

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

HANDLING AND STORAGE


GROUND HANDLING Towing A locking, hand-held tow bar is provided with the airplane and stored in the baggage compartment. The tow bar is inserted into two small holes in the nose wheel fairing, forward of the nose wheel axle. The tow bar must be locked in place before attempting to move the airplane.

Removing the locking pin in the bottom of the sleeve and pulling up on the tow-handle extends the tow bar handle. When the hole at the end of the tow-handle is aligned with the hole in the sleeve, reinsert the locking pin to keep the tow-handle in place. To collapse the tow bar, reverse the previous steps. Attach the tow bar to the airplane using the following steps: 1. Open the towing fork by pushing on the expansion handle until it is locked in place, past the over-centering point. 2. Insert one of the two fork tips into one of the nose wheel pant holes. 3. Carefully close the fork so that the remaining fork tip is inserted into the other wheel pant hole.
CAUTION When attaching the tow bar to the nose wheel pant, care must be taken when closing the fork. Maintain a good amount of forward pressure on the expansion handle when inserting the second fork tip into the wheel pant hole. Once the expansion handle is released past the over-centering point, the fork can close quickly and scratch the wheel pant.

It is recommended that the airplane only be maneuvered during towing by use of the hand-held tow bar. If it is necessary to tow with a vehicle, extreme care is required to ensure the rotation limits of the nose wheel (60 left and right) are not exceeded. Since the rotation of the nose gear is limited by physical stops, rotating the gear beyond 60 will damage the airplane. It is always a good idea to have another person serve as a spotter when moving the airplane. Remember that the airplane has vertical limitations as well as horizontal restrictions. The vertical stabilizer is frequently overlooked as an airplane is being pushed into a hanger with most of the attention directed towards the wingtips. When moving the airplane over uneven surfaces, remember that small up and down oscillations of the nose strut result in amplified movement of the vertical stabilizer. Finally, keep in mind that inflation levels of both the nose tire and strut affect the height of the vertical stabilizer. A flat tire or low nose strut will increase the height of the vertical stabilizer.
CAUTION Do not attempt to move the airplane by pushing or pulling on the propeller. This a common practice for airplanes with fixed pitch propellers; however, it is not recommended for constant speed propellers, since pressures applied to the propeller blades are transmitted to moving parts within the propeller hub. Over time, these forces could cause damage to the propeller. Parking During parking operations, it is best to head the airplane into the wind if possible. Normally, setting the parking brake is recommended; however, there are two situations where doing so is not a good idea. 1. If the brakes are overheated, which might result from a short field landing or extensive taxiing, it is best to not set them until they have had a sufficient cooling period. A brake pad clamped to a hot chrome disc can cause uneven cooling of the brake disc, which has the potential of warping it.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-13

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

2. It is also not a good idea to set the brakes in cold weather. Accumulations of freezing rain, ice, and snow can freeze-weld the brake pad to the disc. Landing or taxiing in standing water at near freezing temperatures can cause similar problems if the brakes are set when the airplane is parked.
Securing the Airplane In any event, whether the brakes are set or not set, the airplane should be chocked and the following items should be accomplished to secure the airplane. 1. Chock the main gear tires with chocks on both sides of each tire. 2. Attach a rope or chain to each tie-down point, and secure the rope or chain to a ramp tie-down point. There are three tie-down points, one on each wing and one on the tail. The ropes or chains should have a tensile strength of at least 750 lbs. 3. Install the pitot tube cover. WARNING Do not use any device except approved tie-down rings to secure the airplane. While the proper size eyebolt from a hardware store will fit in the threaded tiedown socket, the eyebolt length is critical. A tie-down bolt of incorrect length could cause jamming or interfere with proper movement of the ailerons. Windshield Cover The use of a windshield cover is an often-debated issue and is a decision the owner or operator of the airplane must make. Windshield covers have both positive and negative benefits. Ultimately, a number of factors must be weighed, including (1) the geographical area of operations, (2) the time of year, (3) the specific parking location, and (4) the integrity of the covering device. 1. From a positive standpoint, the cover limits the intrusion of ultraviolet (UV) light. Over time, UV rays significantly accelerate the aging process, which makes the windshield and windows more brittle and impregnates them with an irremovable yellowish tinge. 2. On the negative side, dust and dirt can accumulate between the cover and the windshield. When the wind blows, the whipping action of the cover beats the dust and dirt into the windshield. JACKING AND LEVELING Jacking There are two jack points under each wing proximate to the wing saddle. The points are near the center of mass of the longitudinal axis, and great care must be used when jacking the airplane. The tailskid is used as a third point of stabilization. The following points should be considered when the airplane is raised by jacks.

1. If the airplane is simultaneously lifted by both jacks, then specific procedures established in Chapter 7 of the maintenance manual must be followed. This procedure is fairly involved. It requires special equipment to stabilize the airplane, sandbags for tail ballast, and three or four people to operate the jacks and keep the airplane steady. 2. If only one jack is used, as when changing a single tire, the airplane can be safely jacked by one person using the following procedure: The operation must be performed in a level area, such as an airplane hangar. a. Set the parking brake and chock the nose tire and the main gear tire that is not raised. b. Place 50 pounds of ballast (usually sandbags) on the engine cowling, near the propeller. c. Place a jack under the jack point of the wing to be lifted and raise the jack up to the d. wing jack point. Take extra precaution to ensure the jack is properly stabilized, the base is locked in position, and the jack is lifting vertically. Be sure the raising point of the jack is properly inserted into the jack point on the wing. Slowly raise the jack until the desired ground clearance is achieved. However, the e. clearance between the bottom of the tire and lifting surface (ground or hangar floor) must not exceed three inches.
Leveling Please see page 6-5 for information about leveling the airplane. RC050005 8-14 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

STORAGE The storage of an airplane mostly deals with engine related items. Very little needs to or can be done to preserve the airframe, particularly for flyable and temporary storage. The best protection for the exterior is, of course, to hangar the airplane, if possible. If the airplane cannot be hangared, then a coat of wax using the material and techniques described on page 8-19 should be applied to all exterior surfaces. In addition, all typical items associated with securing the airplane should be done. These include: (1) installing the pitot tube cover, (2) chocking all wheels and tying the airplane down with the parking brakes released, (3) installing the control lock, (4) topping off the fuel tanks, (5) cleaning the bolts and nuts on the brakes and applying a non-stick preservative like graphite or a silicone, and (6) installing other owner-option protection devices. There are three types of storage categories, flyable, temporary, and indefinite. The time period and applicable storage procedure for each type is discussed below. Flyable Storage (5 to 30 days) If the airplane is to be maintained in flyable storage, then it should be flown for a minimum of 30 minutes every 30 days; ground running the engine is not a substitute for flying the airplane. During flyable storage, the propeller should be rotated by hand every seven days. This operation should include at least six complete revolutions of the engine. Stop the propeller 45 to 90 from its original position. For maximum safety use the following procedures: 1. Ensure that the ignition switch is set to the OFF position. 2. Set the throttle to the CLOSED position. 3. Set the mixture to IDLE CUTOFF. 4. Set the parking brake, and chock the wheels. 5. Ensure that airplane tie-downs are secure. 6. Open cabin door on the pilots side of the airplane. 7. Always assume the propeller could start when moving it manually, and use an appropriate technique for hand turning the propeller. 8. Release the parking brake when the operation is completed. WARNING Always assume that the engine could start when rotating the propeller by hand. Remain clear of the arc of the propeller blades at all times. Temporary Storage (up to 90 days) Use the following procedures to preserve the engine for temporary storage. See the Airframe Preservation for Temporary and Indefinite Storage heading on page 8-17 for airframe preservation items. 1. Remove the top spark plug from each of the six cylinders, and apply an atomized injection of preservation oil, MIL-L-46002, Grade 1 at room temperature through the upper spark plug hole of each cylinder with the piston in approximately the bottom dead center position. Rotate the crankshaft as opposite cylinders are sprayed. Stop the crankshaft with none of the pistons at top dead center. 2. When Step 1 is complete, and with none of the pistons at dead center, re-spray each cylinder thoroughly making sure to cover all interior surfaces. 3. Install spark plugs. 4. Spray approximately two ounces of preservation oil through the oil filler tube. 5. Seal all engine openings exposed to the atmosphere with suitable plugs or moisture resistant tape. 6. Tag engine, cowling, and other appropriate areas with the statement, Do not turn propeller, engine preserved. Return to Service from Temporary Storage To return an airplane that has been in temporary storage to active service, perform the following steps: 1. Remove seal plugs, tape, and all methods of tagging the airplane, including items tagged on the airframe.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-15

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

2. Remove the bottom spark plug from each of the six cylinders, and rotate the propeller several times to remove the preservation oil. 3. Reinstall the spark plugs according to manufacturers recommendations. 4. Conduct a normal engine start, and idle the engine for several minutes until oil temperature is within normal limits. Monitor engine instruments to ensure they are within normal operating ranges. 5. Stop the engine and inspect the entire airplane before test flying.
Indefinite Storage (Over 90 Days) If the airplane is to be stored for a long period, follow the procedures listed below to preserve the engine. See the Airframe Preservation for Temporary and Indefinite Storage heading on page 8-17 for airframe preservation items. 1. Drain the engine oil and refill with MIL-C-6529 Type II preservation oil. Start the engine and operate until normal temperature ranges are achieved. Fly the airplane for about 30 minutes and then allow the engine to cool to the ambient temperature. 2. Follow Steps 1, 2, and 4 for Temporary Storage. 3. Install dehydrator plugs MS27215-1 or -2, in each of the top spark plug holes. Ensure the dehydrator plug is blue when installed. Protect and support the spark plug leads with AN4060 protectors. 4. Place a bag of desiccant in the exhaust pipes, and seal the openings with moisture resistant tape. 5. Seal the induction system with moisture resistant tape. 6. Seal the engine breather by inserting a dehydrator plug, M527215-2, in the breather hose and clamping in place.

7. Tag engine, cowling, and other appropriate areas with the statement, Do not turn propeller, engine preserved. 8. Install plugs in the engine cowl inlets and all other openings. Do not plug or seal tank vents on the bottom of each wing.
NOTE During the various storage periods, FAA Airworthiness Directives and manufacturers service bulletins may apply which require action based on calendar dates, not operating hours. These items must still be completed even though the airplane is in storage. NOTE The dehydrator plugs must be visually checked every 15 days to verify that the color has not changed. Bad dehydrator plugs should be replaced. If more than half of the plugs change color, the bad plugs and all the desiccant bags on the engine should be replaced. Every six months the dehydrator plugs should be replaced and the cylinders resprayed with preservation oil. When removing the plugs, check the cylinder interior. If rust stains are noted, spray the cylinder with preservation oil, turn the prop through six revolutions, and then respray all cylinders. Return to Service from Indefinite Storage To return an airplane that has been in indefinite storage to active service, perform the following steps: 1. Remove all dehydrator plugs, seal plugs, tape, and all methods of tagging the airplane including items tagged on the airframe. 2. Drain the preservation oil, and service the engine with the recommended lubricating oil. 3. Remove the bottom spark plugs from each of the six cylinders, and rotate the propeller several times to remove the preservation oil. 4. Apply Champion thread lubricant to spark plugs in accordance with the manufacturers instructions. Install and torque the spark plugs 300 to 360 in-lbs. RC050005 8-16 Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

5. Rotate the propeller by hand through the compression strokes of all the cylinders to check for possible liquid lock. 6. Conduct a normal engine start, and idle the airplane for several minutes until oil temperature is in within normal limits. Monitor all engine instruments to ensure they are within normal operating ranges. 7. Stop the engine and inspect the entire airplane before test flying. 8. Test fly the airplane.
Airframe Preservation for Temporary and Indefinite Storage If the airplane is to be stored for over 30 days, some or all the procedures below may be applicable, depending on the anticipated storage time period. 1. Ensure the tires are free of grease, oil, tar, and gasoline. The presence of these items accelerates the aging process. Sunlight and static electricity convert oxygen to ozone, a substance that accelerates the aging process. Special tire covers can be installed which retard the erosion process. 2. It is best if the weight of the airplane is removed from the tires to prevent flat spots. If the airplane cannot be blocked or set on jacks, then every 30 days each wheel should be rotated about 90 to expose a new tire pressure point. 3. If the airplane does not have a recent coat of wax, a new coat should be applied as discussed on page 8-19. 4. Lubricate exposed exterior metal fittings, hinges, push rods, etc. Use plugs or moisture resistant tape to seal all openings except fuel vent holes and drain holes. 5. Remove the batteries and store in a cool, dry location. The batteries may need periodic servicing and recharging depending on the storage period. 6. Prominently tag areas where tape and plugs are installed. Airframe Preservation Return to Service To return the airframe portion of an airplane that has been in temporary or indefinite storage to active service, perform the following steps, as applicable: 1. Remove all methods of tagging and sealing including any items on or in the engine area. 2. Remove tire covers or other protection devices. Check the condition of the tires and service to proper pressures. Cracked, deformed, and desiccated tires should be replaced. 3. Thoroughly clean the exterior of the airplane including the transparencies. If necessary, renew the protective wax coat. See page 8-19 for instructions on care of the airframe. 4. Check the condition and charge of the batteries. If the batteries are still serviceable, reinstall them in the airplane; otherwise, install new batteries. NOTE When an airplane has been in storage for a long period, the date of the required annual inspection may have passed. There is no requirement to perform this inspection during the temporary or indefinite storage period. However, the inspection must be completed before than airplane is returned to service. Inspections During Temporary Storage The following inspections should be performed while the airplane is in temporary storage: 1. Check the cleanliness of the airframe as frequently as possible, and remove any dust that has collected. 2. Check the condition and durability of the protective wax coat, and renew as required. 3. Every 30 days, check the interior of at least one cylinder for evidence of corrosion. Inspections During Indefinite Storage The following inspections should be performed while the airplane is in indefinite storage:

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-17

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

1. Check the condition of the dehydrator plugs every 15 days to verify that the color has not changed. Bad dehydrator plugs should be replaced. If more than half of the plugs change color, the bad plugs and all the desiccant bags on the engine should be replaced. 2. Every six months the dehydrator plugs should be replaced and the cylinders re-sprayed with preservation oil. When removing the plugs, check the cylinder interior. If rust stains are noted, spray the cylinder with preservation oil, turn the prop through six revolutions, and then re-spray all cylinders.

RC050005 8-18

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

AIRFRAME AND ENGINE CARE


AIRFRAME Exterior The exterior painted surfaces are cleaned by washing with a mild soap and water and drying with a soft towel or chamois. The seal coats that are applied to the painted surface, in most instances, will provide adequate protection from moisture and the sun. Some additional protection is provided by waxing the painted surface and facilitates washing the airplane since bugs and dirt will not adhere as tightly to a waxed surface. A wax with a high concentration of carnauba is recommended. There are several commercial boat waxes available that are ideal for this use. Be sure to read the label with an eye for the percentage of carnauba in the compound. CAUTION Do not wax the airplane with silicone-based wax for at least 60 days from the date of purchase. The paint curing process involves the expulsion of certain substances within paint. A coat of wax can impede or stop the curing process, which inhibits adhesion of the paint to the composite surface.

The exterior paint color on the upper fuselage area and the top of the wings has a good heat reflection index. This good index is required to ensure the continued bonding and integrity of the composite material. Only approved Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation paint colors are permitted in these areas. Care must be taken to not lay dark, heat absorbing material on the top area of the wings and fuselage.
Anti-erosion Tape and Leading Edge Tape The anti-erosion tape is located on the leading edges of the wings, horizontal tail, vertical tail, and gear fairings. Leading edge tape is located on the leading edges of the wings and horizontal tail only. Care should be taken to prevent damage to the tape on the wing when entering the aircraft. People who sit on the wing by lifting themselves up over the leading edge should take care not to drag their legs over the tape when sliding on or off the wing. If the tape is starting to fray, detach, crack, crinkle, etc., it should be replaced using the instructions in the maintenance manual. Windshield and Windows The proper care of the windshield and windows (sometimes referred to as transparencies) is one of the more important exterior care items on the airplane and often the least understood. The cardinal rule is never do anything that will scratch the surface of the acrylic plastic. The following points for cleaning and caring for the transparencies will help to keep windows looking and performing like new. 1. First, when cleaning the windows, it is recommended that rings and watches be removed as they can cause deep scratches. In this vein, long sleeve shirts should be turned up a few rolls to hide exposed buttons. 2. When removing bugs and dirt, avoid touching the surface. If possible, remove most of the dirt by flushing the windows and windshield with water and a mild dish soap mixture. Allow the accumulation of dirt and/or bugs to soak for a few minutes. If rubbing is required, a bare hand is best. When all the debris on the surface of the window is loosened, apply a second water flush and then dry with a 100% cotton cloth. 3. Use a good quality non-abrasive cleaner/polish specifically intended for acrylic windows, and apply per the manufacturers instructions. Use up and down or side to side movements when polishing. Never use a circular movement as this can cause glare rings. 4. The best polishing cloth is the softest cotton available. One hundred percent cotton flannel is ideal and available in yard goods stores. Never use any type of paper product or synthetic material. In particular, never use shop rags or shop towels. Be sure the polishing cloth is clean and dry. Reserve polishing cloths should be stored in a plastic bag to limit dirt accumulation. Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006 RC050005 8-19

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

5. Small scratches, the type that can be seen but cannot be felt with a fingernail, should be filled with a polishing compound that has scratch filling properties. The cleaner/polisher mentioned in paragraph 3 frequently has scratch filling properties and is satisfactory for regular use. Some scratches are not correctable with a scratch-filling product. While the scratches cannot be felt, they are still visible, particularly when flying into the sun. In this instance, a mildly abrasive scratch removal cream can be used per manufacturers recommendations. Scratches of greater magnitude require the use of high abrasives and removal of some of the windows surface around the greatest depth of the scratch. This procedure requires considerable expertise and frequently makes areas where the scratch was removed more objectionable than the original scratch. 6. As mentioned previously in this section, the use of canopy or window covers can grind dirt particles into the acrylic and are virtually impossible to remove.
CAUTION Do not use anything containing ammonia, aromatic solvents like methyl ethyl ketone, acetone, lacquer thinner, paint stripper, gasoline, benzene, alcohol, anti-ice fluid, hydraulic fluid, fire extinguisher solutions, or window cleaner on the acrylic window surfaces. The use of these substances may cause the surface to craze. NOTE To remove difficult substances such as tape residue, oil, and grease, the safest solvents are 100% mineral spirits or kerosene. Some alcohols are safe, such as isopropyl alcohol. Interior Cleaning and Care The useful life of the airplanes interior can be extended through proper care and cleaning. One of the major elements in the aging process is the interiors exposure to sunlight. If possible, the airplane should be hangared. Routine vacuuming is another item that helps extend the life of the airplanes interior. A general rule for spills is to blot the affected area with firm pressure for a few seconds. Never rub or pat an area to remove a spill.

Portions of the airplanes seats are covered with leather. The leather is treated with a sealant, which provides a protective cover. Do not attempt to feed the leather in any way. In particular, the use of spray polishes, saddle soaps, waxes, and so-called hide foods create a sticky surface, which attracts dirt and can cause irreversible damage. The leather and ultra-leather seats, seatbacks, knee bolsters, and the like, should be routinely wiped with a moist soft cotton cloth after vacuuming. Use a mild non-detergent soap such as Neutrogena. Wipe the leather and ultra-leather using a light circular motion taking care not to soak the surface. Once the seats and other areas are clean, repeat the process using clean water and then wipe the surfaces with a dry cloth. For ink stains, use a special application available through Douglas Interior Products known as a D.I.P. Stick. Since the D.I.P. Stick application must be used within 24 hours, one should be held in reserve at all times. The carpet can be cleaned with a mild foam product, but care must be used not to over saturate. Follow the manufacturers instructions regarding use of the foam cleaner. Small spots can be cleaned with a commercial spot remover; however, this must be done with care. Again, follow the recommended procedure of the manufacturer, and try a test application in an area of limited exposure.

RC050005 8-20

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

ENGINE AND PROPELLER Engine Cleaning and Care If necessary, the engine is normally cleaned at the recommended 50hour oil change interval since the cowling is removed to change the oil. In addition, the air filter should be replaced at every 100 hours of time in service or if the filter element is more than 50% covered with dirt and debris; it may require more frequent cleaning depending on the operating environmental conditions. If the engine is cleaned at the 50 or 100-hour oil change intervals, this should be adequate under most operating conditions.

In any event, the engine must be kept relatively clean for all flight operations. It is difficult to establish a precise time in service recommendation since much depends on the environmental conditions and the types of airplane operations. Engine cleaning, air filter cleaning and replacement, and lubrication of the engine controls is permitted as an item of preventive maintenance and can be performed by the owner or operator if that person possesses a private pilot or higher level of certification. It is best to clean the engine with a spray type cleaner, preferably under pressure. There are a number of approved commercial solvents specifically designed for this use. Care must be exercised to ensure that application of the solvent does not damage other components in the engine area. Refer to the Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG) Approved Maintenance Manual for additional instructions.
Propeller Cleaning and Care It is important to keep the propeller clean since it facilitates detection of cracks and other problems. The propeller must be cleaned with a non-oil based substance such as Stoddard Solvent. The solvent must only be applied to the surface of the blades with a soft brush or cloth; care must be used to avoid contact with the propeller hub and seals. Do not use any type of spray application, pressurized or unpressurized, since over-spray particles could contact the propeller hub and seals. The use of water and a mild soap is also acceptable; however, never use any alkaline-based products.

Nicks on the leading edge of the propeller blade, particularly towards the blades tip should be dressed out as soon as possible. Undressed nicks, over time, can lead to problems that are more serious. The repair of the airplanes propeller, including propeller nicks, can only be performed by authorized maintenance personnel and is not an item of authorized preventive maintenance. When the propeller is clean, dry the surface with a soft cloth and wax the blades with a good quality automobile paste wax. The major issue with propeller care is corrosion control. Frequent cleaning and applications of paste wax will significantly retard the erosion process. These procedures are particularly applicable in geographical areas of high humidity and salt particles. Never try to remove corrosion pitting with an abrasive material such as steel wool or sandpaper since this accelerates the corrosion process.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 8-21

Section 8 Handling, Servicing, and Maintenance

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

This Page Intentionally Left Blank

RC050005 8-22

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

Section 9 Supplements

Section 9 Supplements
GENERAL This section contains information about optional equipment that is installed in the airplane as a Supplemental Type Certificate (STC). A log for STC equipment is provided on page 9-2. Each STC installation will have an FAA approved supplement that must be included in this section of the FAA Approved Airplane Flight Manual and Pilots Operating Handbook (AFM/POH).

Each Supplement is designed as a self-contained miniature AFM/POH and contains the same first five sections as the primary AFM/POH. Each supplement has its own table of contents and series of unique page numbers. This arrangement makes locating a particular supplement somewhat more difficult since the page numbers are restarted for each supplement. In the Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation Information Manual for the Columbia 400, the actual supplements provided by the holder of the STC are not included. However, to assist the reader in understanding the special equipment that is installed through an STC, a discussion of these components is included on the following pages. A generic format is used for each supplemental section, since this will provide a consistent form of presentation for the reader. The formats of each supplement in the airplanes AFM/POH may differ significantly. The intent of the AFM/POH is to be a self-contained document. That is, the goal was to provide enough information about operating the airplane and its special equipment in a single publication. Detailed and advanced techniques are not included in the supplements since this information is available in the respective pilot/owner operating publications. The instructions in the various supplements, for the most part, are copied directly from the manufacturers documentation. However, the format was changed, and a few spelling, grammatical, and typographical errors were corrected.

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

RC050005 9-1

Section 9 Supplements

Columbia 400 (LC41-550FG)

LOG OF SUPPLEMENTS
The table below is for tabulating the installation of equipment and/or devices that are installed as supplemental equipment. Such equipment and/or devices must have their own Supplemental Type Certificate (STC) number. Some equipment may be installed at the Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation factory, in which case, the STC information will be logged in this section. The installation of after-market supplemental items is totally at the discretion of the owner or operator of the airplane. Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation neither endorses nor opposes after-market installations; however, such an installation can limit or invalidate the warranty on the airplane. Columbia Aircraft Manufacturing Corporation does not provide technical support or documentation for after-market installations. The holder of the STC normally provides these services. This log is provided as a service to the owner or operator of the airplane so that after-market supplemental installations are documented in a consistent format. It is suggested that when an aftermarket product is installed in the airplane, the appropriate information be entered in the log below, and the supporting documentation inserted at the end of the Pilots Operating Handbook. Supp. No. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. Manufacturer/Type of Equipment Date Installed Revision No.

RC050005 9-2

Initial Issue of Manual: December 9, 2005 Latest Revision Level/Date: C/10-10-2006

You might also like